MATHS QUEST Preliminary Mathematics General (4th Edition)
MATHS QUEST Preliminary Mathematics General (4th Edition)
MATHS QUEST Preliminary Mathematics General (4th Edition)
4TH EDITION
MATHS QUEST
Preliminary
Mathematics General
Contents
Introduction vi
About eBookPLUS viii
Acknowledgements ix
Chapter 3
Taxation
Chapter 1
Earning money
3B
Exercise 1A
3D
1C
3E
1E
1F
1G
1H
3C
1B Calculating wages
1D
3
Exercise 1B 5
Commission and royalties 8
Exercise 1C 9
Payment by piece 12
Exercise 1D 13
Working overtime 14
Exercise 1E 16
Government allowances 19
Exercise 1F 20
Additions to and deductions from
gross pay 22
Exercise 1G 23
Budgeting 27
Exercise 1H 29
3F
4C
Chapter 2
Exercise 2A
2D
2E
2F
2G
4D
43
functions 48
Exercise 2B 50
Calculation of compound interest 53
Exercise 2C 55
Calculating compound interest from a table
of compounded values 57
Exercise 2D 60
Share dividends 62
Exercise 2E 62
Graphing share performance 64
Exercise 2F 66
Inflation and appreciation 68
Exercise 2G 69
Summary 72
Chapter review 73
ICT activities 76
Answers 77
4E
43
46
2C
Summary 103
Chapter review 104
ICT activities 106
Answers 107
4B
81
Exercise 3A 83
Taxable income 85
Exercise 3B 87
Medicare levy 90
Exercise 3C 90
Calculating tax 91
Exercise 3D 94
Calculating GST and VAT 97
Exercise 3E 98
Graphing tax functions 101
Exercise 3F 101
Chapter 4
Summary 35
Chapter review 36
ICT activities 39
Answers 40
Investing money
81
109
Exercise 4A 112
Target populations and sampling
Exercise 4B 116
Population characteristics 118
Exercise 4C 120
Types of data 122
Exercise 4D 123
Bias 125
Exercise 4E 128
114
Summary 132
Chapter review 133
ICT activities 136
Answers 137
Chapter 5
141
plots 141
Exercise 5A 144
5B Frequency tables and cumulative
frequency 146
Exercise 5B 149
5C Range and interquartile range, deciles and
percentiles 154
Exercise 5C 158
5D Five-number summaries 164
Exercise 5D 166
Exercise 5E
173
169
Chapter 9
Summary 177
Chapter review 178
ICT activities 182
Answers 183
285
Exercise 9A 287
9B Solving problems using similar f igures 291
Exercise 9B 293
9C Calculating trigonometric ratios 297
Exercise 9C 301
9D Finding an unknown side 302
Exercise 9D 305
9E Finding angles 308
Exercise 9E 309
9F Applications of right-angled triangles 312
Exercise 9F 315
Proportional diagrams 316
Chapter 6
Summary statistics
189
189
Exercise 6A 193
6B Median and mode 198
Exercise 6B 201
6C Standard deviation 205
Exercise 6C 208
6D Best summary statistics 212
Exercise 6D 214
Summary 220
Chapter review 221
ICT activities 226
Answers 227
Probability
7C
7D
7E
231
Exercise 7A 233
Units of measurement and scientific
notation 234
Exercise 7B 237
Ratios 239
Exercise 7C 240
Rates 242
Exercise 7D 245
Percentage change 247
Exercise 7E 248
Summary 250
Chapter review 251
ICT activities 253
Answers 254
259
262
Exercise 8B 264
8C Field diagrams 268
Exercise 8C 270
8D Applications of area 271
Exercise 8D 271
8E Volume of prisms 273
Exercise 8E 275
iv
Summary 279
Chapter review 280
ICT activities 282
Answers 283
Contents
10B
10C
10D
10E
10F
10G
10H
Chapter 8
325
231
7A Measurements as approximations
7B
Summary 317
Chapter review 318
ICT activities 321
Answers 322
Chapter 10
Chapter 7
Measurement
285
257
257
10I
325
Exercise 10A 327
The fundamental counting principle 329
Exercise 10B 331
Probability statements 333
Exercise 10C 335
Relative frequency 336
Exercise 10D 338
Equally likely outcomes 341
Exercise 10E 342
The probability formula 343
Exercise 10F 345
Writing probabilities as decimals and
percentages 348
Exercise 10G 349
Range of probabilities 351
Exercise 10H 353
Complementary events 356
Exercise 10I 357
Summary 360
Chapter review 361
ICT activities 364
Answers 365
Chapter 11
Algebraic manipulation
369
369
Exercise 11A 371
11B Further multiplication and division 372
Exercise 11B 373
11C Expanding and simplifying algebraic
expressions 374
Exercise 11C 375
11D Substitution
376
Exercise 11D 377
11E Solving linear equations
Exercise 11E 381
439
Exercise 13F 439
13G Random selection 440
Exercise 13G 441
379
Summary 384
Chapter review 385
ICT activities 387
Answers 388
Chapter 12
12D
12E
Summary 442
Chapter review 443
ICT activities 445
Answers 446
391
391
Chapter 14
Summary 414
Chapter review 415
ICT activities 418
Answers 419
Chapter 13
448
Summary 478
Chapter review 479
ICT activities 482
Answers 483
436
486
Glossary 489
Index 492
Contents
Introduction
Maths Quest Preliminary Mathematics General is the fourth edition in a series specifically designed for
the Mathematics General Stage 6 Syllabus 2012.
There are five strands and two Focus studies:
Strand: Financial Mathematics
Strand: Data and Statistics
Strand: Measurement
Strand: Probability
Strand: Algebra and Modelling
Focus study: Mathematics and Communication
Focus study: Mathematics and Driving
There is a suite of resources available:
a student textbook with accompanying eBookPLUS
a teacher edition named eGuidePLUS
flexi-saver versions of all print products
a Solutions Manual containing fully worked solutions to every question.
student textbook
Full colour is used throughout to produce clearer graphs and diagrams,
to provide bright, stimulating photos and to make navigation through
the text easier.
MATHS QUEST
Preliminary
Mathematics General
4TH E D ITION
ROWLAND
4T H E D I T I ON
Preliminary
Mathematics General
ROBERT ROWLAND
vi
Introduction
MATHS QUEST
Preliminary
Mathematics General
SOLUTIONS MANUAL
ANITA CANN
4 T H EDIT IO N
ROBERT CAHN
Introduction
vii
About eBookPLUS
Next generation teaching and learning
This book features eBookPLUS:
an electronic version of the
entire textbook and supporting
multimedia resources. It is
available for you online at the
JacarandaPLUS website
(www.jacplus.com.au).
viii
About eBookPLUS
Minimum requirements
A modern internet browser such as InternetExplorer7+,
MozillaFirefox3+, GoogleChrome8+, Safari3+
or Opera9+
Adobe Flash Player 10+
Javascript must be enabled (most browsers are
enabled by default).
Troubleshooting
Go to the JacarandaPLUS help page at
www.jacplus.com.au/jsp/help.jsp.
Contact John Wiley & Sons Australia, Ltd.
Email: support@jacplus.com.au
Phone: 1800 JAC PLUS (1800 522 7587)
Acknowledgements
The authors and publisher would like to thank the following copyright holders, organisations and
individuals for their assistance and for permission to reproduce copyright material in this book.
Images
Photodisc: 1, 2, 4, 14, 32, 36, 43, 50, 54, 61, 63, 69, 84, 85, 94, 110, 120, 124, 144, 145, 147, 150, 151,
157, 189, 192, 202, 207, 208, 211, 238, 240 top, 241, 248 top, 268, 272, 274, 294, 307, 311, 329, 330
top, 331 bottom, 339, 340 bottom, 341, 354 bottom, 358, 382 middle, 393, 395, 400 bottom and top,
406, 408, 416/Copyright 2001 PhotoDisc, Inc. Rubberball Productions: 3/ Rubberball Productions.
Shutterstock: 5/ Monkey Business Images, 2010; 8 top/ Goodluz; 10/ Dmitriy Shironosov;
23/ Losevsky Pavel, 2010; 31/ Poulsons Photography, 2010; 33/ Microstock Man; 47/ Jesse
Kunerth, 2010; 60/ egd; 83 top/ Regien Paassen, 2010; 83 bottom/ Ivanova Inga/2010; 87/
CandyBoxPhoto/2010; 88/ Golden Pixels LLC/2010; 99 bottom/ Pichugin Dmitry, 2010; 99 top/
Simon Krzic/2010;100/ vesilvio; 100/ CandyBox Images; 112, 208, 245/ Neale Cousland, 2010;
125/Tupungato, 2010; 131/ Sportsphotographer.eu, 2010; 134/ Rich Carey 2010; 135/ Dmitry
Kalinovsky; 145/ hfng; 156/ Aspen Photo; 159/ Vicky German/2010; 162/ Sam Chadwick/2010;
163/ Buida Nikita Yourievich 2010; 168/ Ministr-84, 2010; 193/ Johannes Compaan, 2009; 195/
Ptur sgeirsson, 2010; 196/ Maria Gioberti, 2010; 201/ Vasily Smirnov; 214/ Konstantin
Sutyagin, 2010; 218/ All32/2010; 239/ Elena Elisseeva, 2010; 247/ Alexey Fursov, 2010; 288/
Lisa F. Young, 2010; 289/ First Class Photos PTY LTD; 314/ Thorsten Rust; 330 bottom/ charles
taylor; 331 top/ Maksim Toome, 2010; 338/ SPb photo maker; 340 top/ Supri Suharjoto/2010;
342/ .shock; 347/ Andresr; 350 top/ Rossario, 2010; 354 top/ Eastimages, 2010; 359 top/ Ralph
Gosch; 378/ Yanick Valle, 2010; 379/ Dmitry Skutin/2010; 382 top/ Dmitry Kalinovsky/2010; 382
bottom/ Michael William, 2010; 394/ Batareykin, 2010; 425 top/ kentoh; 425 bottom/ 3Dstock;
426 bottom/ Ekaterina Pokrovsky; 426 middle/ Elena Kharichkina; 426 top/ Oleksiy Mark; 427
middle/ blanche; 427 top/ mirana; 427 bottom/ Alliance; 431/ philippou; 432/ Leifstiller;
435/ David Mzareulyan; 436/ cherezoff; 437/ voyager624; 440/ milo827; 441 top/ upthebanner;
441 bottom/ Jorge Juan Perez Suarez; 448 bottom right/ dragon_fang; 448 top left/ Andresr; 448
bottom left/ Brenda Bailey; 449/ Matthias Pahl; 451/ Kzenon; 452 top/ cherezoff; 453 top/
Dikiiy; 453 bottom/ Jakub Krechowicz; 454 bottom/ Dariusz Gora; 454 top/ Stuart Miles; 456
top left/ Adam Hicks; 456 top right/ Lisa S.; 456 bottom/ Tomasz Pado; 457/ Motion Karma; 458
top left/ DDCoral; 458 top middle/ Michael Bou-Nacklie; 452 top, 458 top right and bottom right,
461 right/ Ritu Manoj Jethani; 458 bottom left, 461 top left/ Rob Wilson; 460/ Tatiana Popova;
462/ megainarmy; 463/ Fabio Berti; 465/ Mechanik; 467/ Dirk Ercken; 468/ Masekesam; 469/
Centurion Studio; 470/ Ribah Nasir; 472/ VitezslavValka; 473/ Dragomer Maria; 474/ bayberry;
475/ szefei; 476/ marcogarrincha; 486 left/ nulinukas; 486 bottom right/ ArchMan; 486 top
right/ SergeyDV; 487/ mmutlu. Used under license from Shutterstock.com. Microsoft Corporation:
7, 18, 26, 52, 57, 88, 89, 97, 127/Screenshot reprinted by permission from Microsoft Corporation.
Digital Vision: 8 bottom, 210, 240 bottom, 350 bottom, 383/ Digital Vision. John Wiley & Sons
Australia: 12/ John Wiley & Sons Australia/Narelle Kremmer; 55, 70/ John Wiley & Sons Australia/
Renee Bryon; 194, 233, 248 bottom, 359 bottom/ John Wiley & Sons Australia/Taken by Kari-Ann
Tapp; 326/ John Wiley/Taken by Jo Patterson. iStockphoto: 15/ GYI NSEA/iStockphoto; 311/
iStockphoto.com/Michael Krinke. Corbis Royalty Free: 24, 151/ Corbis Corporation; 37/ Corbis
Images; 126, 150/ Corbis; 197/ Corbis Royalty Free. Origin Energy: 31/Origin Energy. AGL:
32/AGL. Blue Mountains City Council: 33/ Blue Mountains City Council 2012. AAP Image: 66/
2012 EPA/JUSTIN LANE. Corbis Australia: 69/ Virgo Productions/Corbis. Image Addict:
111/www.imageaddict.com.au. Getty Images: 242/Getty Images/AFP/Rob Elliott. Jennifer Wright:
267/Creative Cohesions Jennifer Wright; 278/Jennifer Wright. Fancy: 327/ Fancy Images.
Stockbyte: 345, 349/ Stockbyte.
Text
Virginia Tech: 474/ Virginia Tech/Campus Alcohol Abuse Prevention Center.
Every effort has been made to trace the ownership of copyright material. Information that will enable the
publisher to rectify any error or omission in subsequent editions will be welcome. In such cases, please
contact the Permissions Section of John Wiley & Sons Australia, Ltd.
Acknowledgements
ix
ChAptEr 1
Earning money
ChAptEr ContEntS
1A
1B
1C
1D
1E
1F
1G
1h
1A Calculating salary
Methods of payment
payments
Salaries
Many people employed in professional occupations are paid a salary. Such
employees include teachers, lawyers, accountants and some doctors.
A salary is a fixed amount of money that is paid to employees to do their
jobs. The amount paid does not change, regardless of the number of hours
worked.
Salaries are usually calculated on an annual basis. A salary is therefore
usually stated as an amount per annum, which means per year. Salaries are
paid in weekly, fortnightly or monthly amounts. To make calculations about
salaries, you will need to remember the following information.
1 year = 52 weeks
= 26 fortnights
= 12 months
WorkED ExAMplE 1
Dimitri works as an accountant and receives an annual salary of $46 800. Calculate the amount
that Dimitri is paid each fortnight.
think
1
Evaluate.
WritE
We reverse this calculation when we are given the weekly, fortnightly or monthly pay of a person and
are then asked to calculate the annual salary.
WorkED ExAMplE 2
Grace is a solicitor who is paid $3500 per month. Calculate Graces annual salary.
think
WritE
Evaluate.
To compare a salary payment with other forms of income it may be necessary to calculate the equivalent
daily or hourly payment. To do this, we need to know the number of days or hours worked per week.
WorkED ExAMplE 3
WritE
Exercise 1A
1 WE1 Toni is paid a salary of $44 200 per annum. Calculate Tonis fortnightly pay.
2 Roger is paid a salary of $49 920 per annum. Calculate Rogers weekly pay.
DiGitAl DoC
Spreadsheet
doc-1439
payroll calculations
3 Frieda is paid a salary of $54 000 per annum. Calculate Friedas monthly pay.
4 Wendy works as an office secretary and is paid a salary of $38 740 per annum. Calculate Wendys pay
if she is paid:
a weekly
b fortnightly
c monthly.
5 Darren earns a salary of $43 000 per annum. Calculate Darrens fortnightly pay, correct to the
nearest cent.
6 Copy and complete the table below for food production employees.
Annual salary
$30 000
$39 500
$42 250
$54 350
$86 475
Weekly pay
Fortnightly pay
Monthly pay
7 WE 2 Maxine is paid a salary. She receives $460 per week. Calculate Maxines annual salary.
8 Thao receives $1250 per fortnight. Calculate Thaos annual salary.
9 Deidre is paid monthly and receives $5800. Calculate Deidres annual salary.
2
11 WE 3 Fiona receives a salary of $29 700 per annum. If Fiona works an average of 40 hours per week,
hours that Henry will need to work each week to earn more money than Garry does.
Further development
15 Calculate the monthly salary that is equivalent to earning $500 per week.
16 Dan earns $1045 per fortnight while Brian earns $2100 per month. Brian claims that he earns $10 per
Stephanie also works as a lawyer and receives the same salary as Sandra. Stephanie asks for a salary
increase on the basis that she must work 45 hours per week to complete her workload.
a What would be an equivalent salary that Stephanie would ask for?
b Is it necessarily correct to say that since Stephanie works more hours than Sandra that she works
harder than Sandra?
18 The monthly salary that Alan earns in his job as a sports broadcaster is $4550. Calculate the equivalent
fortnightly salary.
19 Michelle is earning $74 000 per year at the time that she retires. In retirement she is paid a fortnightly
pension that is equivalent to 65.75% of her salary at retirement. Calculate the amount of Michelles
fortnightly pension.
20 Garrys superannuation package allows for a lump sum payment of 8.3 times his final salary.
a At retirement Garrys gross weekly salary was $765.70. Calculate his annual salary.
b Calculate the amount of Garrys lump sum payment.
1B
Calculating wages
Most people in the workforce earn a wage. A wage is paid at an hourly rate.
The hourly rate at which a person is usually paid is called an ordinary rate. The wage for each week
is calculated by multiplying the ordinary rate by the number of hours worked during that week.
WorkED ExAMplE 4
Sadiq works as a mechanic and is paid $13.65 per hour. Calculate Sadiqs wage in a week where he
works 38 hours.
think
WritE
Wage = $13.65 38
= $518.70
To compare two peoples wages, we cant just look at the amount of money each receives in a pay packet. We
must also consider the number of hours each has worked. Wages are compared by looking at the hourly rate.
To calculate the hourly rate of an employee we need to divide the wage by the number of hours worked.
WorkED ExAMplE 5
Georgina works 42 hours as a data entry operator for a computer company. Her wage for the
week totalled $483.84. Calculate Georginas hourly rate of pay.
think
WritE
Using a similar method we are able to calculate the number of hours worked by an employee, given their
wage and hourly rate of pay. The number of hours worked is found by dividing the wage by the hourly
rate.
In some cases, wages are increased because an allowance is paid for working in unfavourable
conditions. An allowance is an additional payment made when the working conditions are difficult or
unpleasant.
For example, a road worker may be paid an allowance for working in the rain. In these cases, the
allowance must be multiplied by the number of hours worked in the unfavourable conditions and this
amount added to the normal pay.
WorkED ExAMplE 6
Ryan is a road worker and is paid $9.45 per hour for a 35-hour week. For working on wet days he
is paid a wet weather allowance of 86c per hour. Calculate Ryans pay if for 12 hours of the week
he works in the rain.
think
1
WritE
Allowance = $0.86 12
= $10.32
This type of allowance is also paid to casual workers. When you are employed on a casual basis you
do not receive any holiday pay and you do not get paid for days you have off because you are sick. The
casual rate is a higher rate of pay to compensate for this.
Exercise 1B
Calculating wages
1 WE 4 Allan works in a newspaper printing mill and is paid $12.95 per hour. Calculate Allans wage in
DiGitAl DoC
Spreadsheet
doc-1439
payroll calculations
2 Copy and complete the table below by calculating the wage of each of the workers.
Name
Hourly Hours
rate
worked
A. Smith
$14.52
40
B. Brown
$16.45
38
N. Tran
$15.95
37.5
A. Milosevic $20.10
41
$18.04
36
L. McTavish
Wage
7 WE 5 Calculate the hourly rate of a person who works 40 hours for a wage of $387.20.
8 Julie earns $11.42 per hour. Calculate the number of hours worked by Julie in a week where she is paid
$445.38.
ChAptEr 1 Earning money
Name
A. White
B. Black
C. Green
D. Brown
E. Scarlet
F. Grey
Wage
$416.16
$538.80
$369.63
$813.96
$231.30
$776.72
Hours worked
36
40
37
Hourly rate
$19.38
$15.42
$20.44
10 Calculate the hourly rate of a casual worker who earns $250.80 for 20 hours work.
11 MC Which of the following workers is paid at the highest hourly rate?
A
B
C
D
13 WE 6 Richard works as an electrical linesman and is paid $10.94 per hour for a 38-hour week. When
he has to work at heights he is paid a 46c per hour height allowance. Calculate Richards pay in a
week where 15 hours are spent working at heights.
14 Ingrid works as an industrial cleaner and is paid $14.60 per hour for a 35-hour working week. When
Ingrid is working with toxic substances she is paid an allowance of $1.08 per hour. Calculate Ingrids
pay if she works with toxic substances all week.
15 Rema works as a tailor and earns $9.45 per hour.
a Calculate Remas wage in a week where she works 37 hours.
b Zhong is Remas assistant and earns $8.20 per hour. Find the least time Zhong must work if he is
Further development
18 Juanita has a casual job and is paid $10.80 per hour on weekdays and $14.85 per hour on weekends.
Calculate Juanitas weekly pay when she works from 5:00 pm until 10:00 pm on Thursday and from
8:30 am until 1:00 pm on Saturday.
19 Naomi works the following hours in one week.
21 John works a 40 hour week at a rate of $12.76 per hour. John receives a 5% pay rise, so decides to
DiGitAl DoC
Spreadsheet
doc-1440
Wages_1
1C
Commission is a method of payment used mainly for salespeople. When paid commission, a person
receives a percentage of the value of goods sold.
A royalty is a payment made to a person who owns a copyright. For example, a musician who writes
a piece of music is paid royalties on sales of CDs; an author who writes a book is paid according to
the number of books sold. Royalties are calculated in the same way as commission, being paid as a
percentage of sales.
WorkED ExAMplE 7
Jack is an author who is paid a royalty of 12% of all sales. Calculate the royalty that Jack earns in
a year where his book has sales to the value of $150 000.
think
WritE
In some cases, commission may operate on a sliding scale. This means that the commission rate changes
with the value of sales. This type of commission is commonly used in real estate sales. In these examples,
each portion of the commission is calculated separately. The final commission is the sum of each portion.
WorkED ExAMplE 8
think
WritE
In some cases, people receive a fixed amount (called a retainer) as well as a commission. This is to
ensure that the person earns some money even if no sales are made. To calculate this type of pay, you
will need to add the retainer to the commission.
WorkED ExAMplE 9
Shelley is a furniture salesperson and is paid $250 per week plus a commission of 2% of all sales.
Calculate Shelleys pay in a week where her sales total $12 250.
think
WritE
In some cases, the commission does not begin to be paid until sales have reached a certain point. Here
the commission is calculated only on sales above this fixed amount.
WorkED ExAMplE 10
Tony is a car salesman. Tony is paid $300 per week and 2% of all sales over $50 000. Calculate
Tonys pay in a week where his sales total $84 000.
think
WritE
Exercise 1C
1 WE 7 Kylie is an insurance salesperson and she is paid 8% of the value of any insurance that she sells.
Calculate the amount that Kylie is paid for selling insurance to the value of $25 000.
2 Beryl sells exercise equipment and is paid a commission of 10% on all sales. Calculate Beryls earnings
c $5687.90.
3 Darren is a songwriter who is paid a royalty. If Darren has songs that have sales that total $400 000,
c 3.4%.
ChAptEr 1 Earning money
4 Linda is a car salesperson who is paid 1.5% commission. Calculate the amount of money Linda earns
his book. Calculate the value of Kens royalty if the value of sales totals $34 500.
6 MC Ursula is a computer software salesperson. Ursulas sales total $105 000 and she is paid a
8 George is paid royalty on all sales. Given that George earns $450 on sales of $10 000:
a calculate the percentage royalty that George is paid
b calculate the royalty that George would be paid on sales of $15 400
c calculate the sales that George would need to make in order to earn $810.
9 MC Asif is a sales representative for a hardware firm. Asif earns $870 commission on sales of
sales each week and 10%commission on the balance. Calculate Gabrielles commission in a week
where her sales total $9500.
12 Using the sliding scale for commission shown in question 10, calculate the commission on a property
b $140 000
c $600 000.
13 WE 9 Stanisa is a car salesman who is paid $250 per week plus a commission of 2% of any sales he
makes. Calculate Stanisas pay in a week where his sales total $35 000.
14 Daniel works as a sales representative for a car accessories firm. Daniel is paid $150 per week plus 4%
of any sales. Calculate Daniels earnings in a week where his sales total is:
a $6000
b $8500
c $12 475.
15 MC A group of sales representatives each have $10 000 in sales for a week. Who earns the most money?
A
B
C
D
10
16 Fred and Gina sell life insurance. Fred is paid a commission of 8% and Gina is paid $250 plus 5%
commission.
a How much does Fred earn for a week in which his sales are $5000?
b How much does Gina earn for a week in which her sales total $5000?
c In another week Gina earns $650. What is the value of Ginas sales?
d Fred wishes to earn $650 in a week. How much should his sales be?
17 WE10 Mario is a pay television salesman. Mario earns $500 per week plus 5% commission on all
sales above $5000. Calculate Marios pay in a week where his sales total $7500.
18 Neville is a door-to-door encyclopedia salesman. He is paid $300 per week plus 3%commission on all
sales greater than $5000. Calculate Nevilles pay in a week where his sales total is:
a $4000
b $6500
c $8560.
Further development
19 MC A firm employs five sales representatives. Which representative will earn the most in a week
sales. Bonito is paid $250 plus a 3.5% commission on all sales over $3000.
a Calculate Andrews commission in a week where his sales total $6500.
b Calculate Bonitos commission in a week where his sales total $6500.
c Who will earn the most money in a week where both Andrew and Bonito make $16 000
in sales?
21 Fiona is an auctioneer and has the choice of payment packages.
estate agent pays a commission of 0.5% on all sales above $200 000.
a Calculate the commission earned on selling a block of land for $250 000 for J. L. Booker
compared to selling a block of land for Ray Black.
b Calculate the commission earned on selling a house for $500 000 for J. L. Booker compared to
selling a block of land for Ray Black.
c Find the sale price for which the salesperson would earn the same commission under either
employer.
23 Tom earns $1650 in a week. This includes a retainer of $350 and a commission component.
a If Tom is paid a flat rate of commission and sales total $65 000, calculate the rate of commission
paid.
b If Tom receives commission only for sales above $15 000 calculate the rate of commission that he
receives.
24 If Geoff is paid a flat 4% of all sales as commission and Linda is paid $250 plus 2.4%commission,
calculate the weekly sales for which both would receive the same pay.
25 Henrietta is paid a retainer and receives a 4% commission on all sales. Given that Henrietta
earned $830 on sales of $12 000 and $950 on sales of $15 000 calculate the amount of Henriettas
retainer.
ChAptEr 1 Earning money
11
1D
payment by piece
Payment by piece, or piecework refers to payment for the amount of work completed. It is commonly
paid for jobs such as car detailing and letterbox delivery.
The amount earned is calculated by multiplying the rate of payment by the number of pieces of work
completed.
Len has a job washing cars in a car yard. He is paid $2.25 per car washed. Calculate what Len
earns in an afternoon where he washes 24 cars.
think
WritE
Pay = $2.25 24
= $54.00
In some cases, piecework is paid for multiples, rather than for single units. For example, for letterbox
deliveries you may be paid per 1000 deliveries made.
WorkED ExAMplE 12
Holly is delivering brochures to letterboxes in her local area. She is paid $23.00 per thousand
brochures delivered. Calculate what Holly will earn for a delivery of 3500 brochures.
think
WritE
There are also examples where you will be asked to compare payment by piece with other methods of
earning income, in particular, wages.
WorkED ExAMplE 13
think
WritE
per basket).
b Divide $92.40 (total pay) by 8 (number of hours
worked).
Exercise 1D
a Pay = 21 $4.40
= $92.40
= $11.55
payment by piece
1 WE11 Julia works after school at a car yard detailing cars. If Julia is paid $10.85 per car, calculate
14 baskets of ironing.
4 Matthew charges $15 to mow a lawn. Calculate Matthews earnings in a week if he mows 9lawns.
5 Dean works as a house cleaner. He charges $46.50 to clean a house. If Dean cleans 7houses, calculate
his earnings.
6 WE12 Barbara delivers pamphlets to local letterboxes. She is paid $21.80 per thousand pamphlets
delivered. Calculate what Barbara will be paid for delivering 15 000 pamphlets.
7 A local business employs four people to deliver advertising to letterboxes. They are paid $18.40 per
c 540 toys.
9 Carolina works as a bicycle courier. She charges $5.70 per kilometre for her deliveries. Calculate
b 15.5 km
c 10.2 km.
11 WE13 Denise works as a fruit picker. She is paid $4.20 for every basket of fruit picked.
a Calculate the amount Denise will earn in a day during which she picks 32 baskets of fruit.
b If it takes Denise 8 hours to pick the fruit, calculate the equivalent hourly rate of pay.
12 Charlie works in a car yard as a detailer. Charlie is paid $11.60 per car.
a What will Charlie earn in an afternoon during which he details 15 cars?
b If it takes Charlie 8 hours to detail the cars, calculate his hourly rate of pay.
c If Charlie could finish in 6 hours, calculate the hourly rate of pay he would earn.
Further development
13 George is paid $1.20 for each toy that he assembles, up to the first 100. For the next 50 he receives
$1.60 per toy. For any further toys that he assembles he is paid $2.
Calculate his gross pay for a day in which he assembles:
a 98 toys
b 136 toys
c 167 toys.
14 Paul types manuscripts for a publishing company. Paul is paid $7 per page for the first 50pages, $9 per
page from 51100 pages and $10 per page thereafter. Calculate his gross pay for a period in which he
types:
a 38 pages
b 68 pages
c 140 pages.
ChAptEr 1 Earning money
13
15 Ravi delivers newspapers and is paid $28 per 1000 newspapers delivered.
a What is Ravi paid for delivering 3500 newspapers?
b How many must he deliver to earn $100?
1
c If it takes Ravi 3 2 hours to deliver 1000 newspapers, find his equivalent hourly rate of pay.
16 Garry delivers pizzas. He is paid $4 per delivery between 5:00 pm and 9:00 pm and $5.50 per pizza
20cents per box up to 600 boxes and 25 cents per box thereafter.
Tina is offered the chance to be paid a wage of $16.09 per hour. Given that Tina works an8-hour
shift:
a which package should Tina choose if she packs 500 boxes per shift?
b which package should Tina choose if she packs 800 boxes per shift?
c for both packages to be equivalent, how many boxes would Tina have to pack?
18 MC If a pieceworker earns x cents per article, up to 100 articles and y cents per article thereafter, then
A 100x + 45y
1E
B 100y + 45x
100 x + 45 y
100
45 x + 100 y
100
Working overtime
Overtime is paid when a wage earner works more than the regular hours each week. When an employee
works overtime a higher rate is paid. This higher rate of pay is called a penalty rate. The rate is
normally calculated at either:
1
time and a half, which means that the person is paid 1 2 times the usual rate of pay,
or
double time, which means that the person is paid twice the normal rate of pay.
A person may also be paid these overtime rates for working at unfavourable times, such as at night or
during weekends.
To calculate the hourly rate earned when working overtime we multiply the normal hourly rate by the
1
overtime factor, which is 1 2 for time and a half and 2 for double time.
WorkED ExAMplE 14
think
14
WritE
1
To calculate the pay for a period of time worked at time and a half or double time, we multiply the
1
normal pay rate by the overtime factor (either 1 2 or 2) and then by the number of hours worked at that
overtime rate.
WorkED ExAMplE 15
Adrian works as a shop assistant and his normal rate of pay is $12.84 per hour. Calculate the
amount Adrian earns for 6 hours work on Saturday, when he is paid time and a half.
think
WritE
1
12
Pay = $12.84 1 2 6
= $115.56
When we calculate the total pay for a week that involves overtime, we need to calculate the normal pay
and then add the amount earned for any overtime.
WorkED ExAMplE 16
Natasha works as a waitress and is paid $11.80 per hour for a 38-hour week. Calculate Natashas
pay in a week where she works 5 hours at time and a half in addition to her regular hours.
think
1
WritE
Some examples will have more than one overtime rate to consider and some will require you to work out
how many hours have been worked at each rate.
WorkED ExAMplE 17
Gina is employed as a car assembly worker and is paid $10.40 per hour for a 36-hour week. If
Gina works overtime, the first 6 hours are paid at time and a half and the remainder at double
time. Calculate Ginas pay in a week where she works 45 hours.
15
think
WritE
Overtime = 45 36
= 9 hours
Exercise 1E
Working overtime
1 WE14 Reece works in a restaurant and is paid a normal hourly rate of $11.30. Calculate the amount
Reece earns each hour when he is being paid time and a half.
2 Carmen works as a waitress and is paid $11.42 per hour. Calculate Carmens rate per hour on a Sunday
is paid double time and a half (overtime factor = 2 1). Calculate Gareths hourly rate of pay on a public
2
holiday.
4 WE15 Ben works in a hotel and is paid $11.88 per hour. Calculate the total amount Ben will earn for
Ordinary
rate
Overtime
rate
A. Nguyen
$8.90
M. Donnell
$9.35
Double time
F. Milosevic
$11.56
J. Carides
$13.86
6.5
Y. Robinson
$22.60
Double time
5.5
Name
Hours
worked
Pay
7 MC Ernie works as a chef and is paid $9.95 per hour. What will Ernies hourly rate be when he is paid
B $14.92
D $19.90
8 MC Stephanie works in a shop and is paid $9.40 per hour. Calculate how much more Stephanie will
earn in 8 hours work at time and a half than she would at ordinary rates.
A $37.60
B $75.20
C $112.80
D $188.00
16
9 MC Eric works on the wharves unloading containers and is paid $14.20 per hour. Calculate the
number of hours at time and a half that Eric will have to work to earn the same amount of money that
he will earn in 9 hours at ordinary rates.
A 4.5 hours
B 6 hours
C 10.5 hours
D 13.5 hours
10 WE 16 Rick works 37 hours at ordinary time each week and receives $12.64 per hour. Calculate Ricks
pay in a week where, in addition to his normal hours, he works 4hours overtime at time and a half.
11 Kirsty works 36 hours each week at a pay rate of $16.40 per hour. Calculate Kirstys pay in a week
where, in addition to her ordinary hours, she works 4 hours on Sunday, when she is paid double time.
12 Grant works as a courier and is paid $13.25 per hour for a 35-hour working week. Calculate Grants
pay for a week where he works 4 hours at time and a half and 2 hours at double time in addition to his
regular hours.
13 Copy and complete the table below.
Ordinary
rate
Normal
hours
Time and a
half hours
Double time
hours
W. Clark
$8.60
38
A. Hurst
$9.85
37
6.5
S. Gannon
$14.50
38
2.5
G. Dymock
$16.23
37.5
1.5
D. Colley
$24.90
36
8.5
Name
Total pay
14 MC Jenny is a casual worker at a motel. The normal rate of pay is $10.40 per hour. Jenny works
8 hours on Saturday for which she is paid time and a half. On Sunday she works 6 hours for which she
is paid double time. Jennys pay is equivalent to how many hours work at the normal rate of pay?
A 14
B 21
C 24
D 28
15 MC Patricia works a 35-hour week and is paid $14.15 per hour. Any overtime that Patricia does is
paid at time and a half. Patricia wants to work enough overtime so that she earns more than $600 each
week. What is the minimum number of hours that Patricia will need to work to earn this amount of
money?
A 40
B 41
C 42
D 43
16 WE 17 Steven works on a car assembly line and is paid $12.40 for a 36-hour working week. The
first 4 hours overtime he works each week is paid at time and a half with the rest paid at double time.
Calculate Stevens earnings for a week in which he works 43 hours.
17 Kate works as a computer technician and is paid $18.56 per hour for a 38-hour working week. For
the first 4 hours overtime each week Kate is paid time and a half and the rest is paid at double time.
Calculate Kates pay in a week where she works:
a 38 hours
b 41 hours
c 45 hours.
18 Zac works in a supermarket. He is paid at an ordinary rate of $8.85 per hour. If Zac works more than
8 hours on any one day the first 2 hours are paid at time and a half and the rest at double time. Calculate
Zacs pay if the hours worked each day are:
Monday 8 hours
Tuesday 9 hours
Thursday 7 hours
Wednesday 12 hours
Further development
19 Yvette is on a salary equivalent to $700 per week. She is offered the chance to accept a wage of
$14.65 per hour for a 38 hour week, and time and a half for any overtime.
a Calculate the number of whole hours that Yvette needs to work to ensure that she does not receive
less money if she accepts the offer.
b Yvette estimates that she works an average 41 hours each week. If Yvette is to move from a salary
to a wage, what is the minimum hourly rate that she should ask for?
20 Judy is paid $16.58 per hour for a 36 hour working week. Any overtime that Judy works is paid at a rate of
time and a half. Calculate the number of hours that Judy worked in a week where she earned $721.23.
ChAptEr 1 Earning money
17
21 Jack is a casual worker who is paid time and a quarter for all hours worked. The standard rate of pay is
worked. Calculate Tims hourly rate of pay given that he receives $746.36 for 44hours work.
23 Carla is a nurse and works a 40 hour week. On a particular Monday, which is a public holiday, Carla is
paid double time and a half. Carlas pay for the week will be equivalent to how many normal hours?
24 Georgia earns $18.45 for a 38 hour working week and is paid time and a half for any overtime worked.
Lily earns $16.76 for a 36 hour working week and is paid time and a half for the first four hours of
overtime worked and double time thereafter.
Calculate the minimum number of hours that Lily needs to work to earn more than Georgia who
works a total of 42 hours.
1. Load the spreadsheet Wages_1 that you started earlier in this chapter and edit it with the following
information. Alternatively, access the spreadsheet Wages_2 from the Maths Quest Preliminary
Mathematics General eBookPLUS.
2. In cell G7 write the formula =C7*D7 + C7*1.5*E7 + C7*2*F7. This formula will calculate the gross
wage for Frederick Astini. (You should get $526.40.)
3. Highlight cells G7 to G11 and choose the Fill Down option to copy this formula to the rest of this
column. (Your answers should show $526.40, $442.40, $537.60, $481.60 and $644.00.)
4. Check the functioning of your spreadsheet by changing the hours worked by Frederick Astini to
38 normal hours, 3 hours at time and a half and 4 hours at double time. You should now have $554.40
in cell G7. Now change the hours for the other employees and notice the gross pay changing. Now
change the hourly rate of pay for each employee.
5. Use the Save As option to save this spreadsheet under the name Wages_2. (This will mean that you
have copies of both version 1 and 2 of the spreadsheet.)
18
1F
Government allowances
Many people rely on government allowances for their income, or at least to supplement their income. In
this activity we look at some of these allowances and how they are calculated.
To complete the investigation, go to the website www.centrelink.gov.au and answer the following
questions.
inVEStiGAtE: Youth allowance
The following table shows the amount of youth allowance paid under various circumstances. The table
is correct at the time of publishing; however, you can go to the eBookPLUS and this table and all other
material, including the worked examples and exercises, will be kept current.
The maximum
fortnightly payment is
If you are
single with no children, under 18 years and living at home
$220.40
$402.70
$265.00
single with no children, 18 years and over and required to live away
from home
$402.70
$527.50
$402.70
$442.10
income limits
The income test reduces the amount of youth allowance received, depending upon your weekly income.
The rate at which the youth allowance decreases is described in the table below.
Job seekers
Students and Australian
apprentices
Reduction
50 cents in the dollar
60 cents in the dollar
50 cents in the dollar
60 cents in the dollar
WorkED ExAMplE 18
Angelo is 17 years old, single, has no children and lives at home while he works as an apprentice
electrician.
a Calculate the maximum amount of youth allowance that Angelo can receive.
b If Angelo earns $300 per fortnight calculate the amount of his youth allowance payment.
think
WritE
19
WorkED ExAMplE 19
Riana is single, 17 years old with no children, lives at home and is a job seeker
a Calculate the maximum amount of youth allowance that Riana can receive.
b If Riana earns $280 per fortnight calculate the amount of her youth allowance payment.
think
WritE
The above worked examples show the typical Centrelink calculations for the youth allowance. There are
several other government payments such as Austudy, Abstudy, fares allowance and the aged pension.
Similar calculations can be applied to each of these.
Exercise 1F
Government allowances
1 WE18 Katrina is a single 18 year old, with no children, and lives at home while she works as an
apprentice baker.
a Calculate the maximum amount of youth allowance that Katrina can receive.
b If Katrina earns $310 per fortnight calculate the amount of her youth allowance.
2 Calculate the amount of youth allowance payable to Greg, who is 17 years old, single with no children,
lives away from home and is employed as an apprentice carpenter earning $280 per fortnight.
3 Benjamin, 20 years old, partnered with a child, is earning $210 per fortnight. Calculate the amount of
6 WE19 Jenny is 20 years old, has no children, lives away from home and is a job seeker. Calculate the
amount of youth allowance paid to Jenny given that she has income of $260 per fortnight.
7 Calculate the youth allowance payable in each of the following circumstances.
a
b
c
d
e
f
g
h
Family situation
Single, no children, under 18, at home, in an apprenticeship.
Single, no children, under 18, at home, job seeker
Single, no children, 18 and over, at home, and in an apprenticeship.
Single, no children, 18 and over, at home, job seeker
Single, no children, 18 and over, away from home, in an apprenticeship.
Partnered, no children and a job seeker.
Partnered, with dependants, and in an apprenticeship.
Partnered, with dependants, job seekers
8 Austudy is payable to people 25 years or older who are studying full-time or are in an apprenticeship. It
is paid at the following rates and is subject to the same income and test as the youth allowance for a job
seeker.
If you are
The maximum fortnightly payment is
single
$402.70
single, with children
$527.50
partnered, no children
$402.70
partnered, with children
$442.10
Calculate the amount of Austudy payable to each of the following.
a
b
c
d
Status
Single
Single, with children
Partnered, with children
Partnered, no children
Fortnightly income
Nil
$153.50
$327.75
$279.80
9 Johann is a 30 year old who has gone back to university to full-time study. Johann is partnered with no
C $265.00
D $465.60
Andrea who is single, living at home and a job seeker earning $75 per fortnight.
Bryce who is partnered with dependants is an Australian apprentice who earns $290 per fortnight.
Cathy who is single, long-term unemployed, aged 24, who earns $240 per fortnight.
David, who is single with no dependants, lives away from home, is a job seeker and earns $50 per
fortnight.
Further development
12 Frank is a student who is over 18 years old and lives at home.
a What is the maximum amount of youth allowance that Frank can receive?
b What is the maximum amount that Frank can earn before the youth allowance begins to reduce?
c What is the maximum amount that Frank can earn before his youth allowance cuts out completely?
13 Josie is single, living away from home, 28 years old, long-term unemployed but is returning to full-time
study.
a Calculate the amount of Austudy that Josie receives.
b If Josie earns the most money possible from casual work without affecting her payment, what
would be her total fortnightly income?
ChAptEr 1 Earning money
21
Although we may calculate a persons pay, this is not the amount that is actually received by that person.
The amount that we calculate based on their wage or salary is called gross pay or gross wage. From
gross pay several deductions may be made for items such as tax, union fees, private health insurance
and superannuation.
Many of you who are considering tertiary education may be aware that you may be left with what is
called a HECS debt on completing a university course. HECS (higher education contribution scheme)
is paying back the cost of your tertiary education to the government, although payment only needs to be
made once your annual income passes a certain level. Repayment is through HELP (higher education
loan program) and is a percentage of income that increases as annual income increases.
The amount of money that you actually receive each week is called your net pay and is calculated by
subtracting all deductions from your gross pay.
WorkED ExAMplE 20
Roberts gross pay is $643.60 per week. Robert has deductions for tax of $144.46, superannuation
of $57.92 and union fees of $11.40. Calculate Roberts net pay.
think
WritE
In some cases, you will be required to calculate the size of a deduction based on either an annual amount
or a percentage.
WorkED ExAMplE 21
Bruce is a shop assistant and he has his union fees deducted from his pay each week. If the annual
union fee is $324.60, calculate the size of Bruces weekly union deduction.
think
1
WritE
WorkED ExAMplE 22
Charissa is a salary earner and her gross fortnightly salary is $1320. Charissa pays 9% of her
gross pay each fortnight in superannuation. Calculate how much is deducted from Charissas pay
each fortnight for superannuation.
think
WritE
Superannuation = 9% of $1320
= 9 100 $1320
= $118.80
When employees take annual leave,, they may receive an annual leave loading. When on holidays, such
1
employees are paid an additional 17 2 % of their gross pay for up to 4weeks.
22
WorkED ExAMplE 23
think
WritE
= $531.00
worked).
b 1 Multiply $531.00 (weekly pay) by 4to find
= $2124.00
1
= 17 2 100 $2124.00
= $371.70
Exercise 1G
gross pay
1 WE 20 Trevor is a tiler and his gross pay is $532.75 per week. His weekly deductions are $106.20 for
tax, $47.95 for superannuation and $17.70 for health fund contributions. Calculate Trevors net pay
each week.
2 Copy and complete the table below.
Gross pay
$345.00
$563.68
$765.90
$1175.60
$2500.00
Deductions
$89.45
$165.40
$231.85
$429.56
$765.40
Net pay
23
9
10
11
12
for a 36-hour working week. His deductions are $118.02 for tax,
$32.50 for health insurance, $51.03 for superannuation and
$5.00 for the miners social club. Calculate Davids net pay.
Belinda is on an annual salary of $65 500. Belinda is paid
fortnightly.
a Calculate Belindas fortnightly pay.
b If Belinda has fortnightly deductions of $834.92 for tax,
$226.73 for superannuation and $23.50 as a contribution to
a professional organisation, calculate Belindas net pay.
WE 21 Lars works as a train driver and is a member of the
union. If Lars union fees are $394.00 per year and Lars has his
fees deducted from his pay weekly, calculate the size of Lars
weekly deduction.
Yasmin is a salary earner who is paid fortnightly. Yasmin has
her fees for private health insurance deducted from her pay
fortnightly. If the annual premium for Yasmins health cover is $1456.50, calculate the amount that
needs to be deducted from Yasmins pay each fortnight.
Dorothy is paid a wage of $13.45 per hour for a 38-hour working week.
a Calculate Dorothys gross weekly pay.
b Dorothy pays union fees of $265.60 per annum. Calculate the amount that should be deducted
from her pay each week for union fees.
c Dorothy has $98.73 deducted from her pay each week for tax and union fees. Calculate Dorothys
net pay.
Patrick is on an annual salary of $56 000 and is paid fortnightly.
a Calculate Patricks gross fortnightly pay.
b Patrick pays fortnightly into a private health fund for which the annual premium is $1165.75.
Calculate the fortnightly payment.
c Patrick has his health fund payment and tax (total $660.60) deducted from his fortnightly pay.
Calculate Patricks net fortnightly pay.
WE22 Sabrina earns a weekly wage of $623.50. She puts 9% of this wage into a superannuation fund.
Calculate the amount that Sabrina pays in superannuation.
Arthur earns a gross fortnightly salary of $1520.50. He pays 11% of his gross salary in superannuation.
Calculate the amount that Arthur has deducted from his salary each fortnight for superannuation.
Rex is paid $11.12 per hour for a 38-hour working week.
a Calculate Rexs gross weekly wage.
b Rex pays 10.5% of his gross weekly wage in superannuation. Calculate Rexs weekly
superannuation contribution.
c Rex pays tax of $68.18 as well as his superannuation contribution. Calculate Rexs weekly net wage.
The table below shows the rate at which HECSHELP is to be paid.
HELP repayment income (HRI)
Below $49 096
$49 096$54 688
$54 689$60 279
$60 280$63 448
$63 449$68 202
$68 203$73 864
$73 865$77 751
$77 752$85 564
$85 565$91 177
$91 178 and above
Repayment rate
Nil
4% of HRI
4.5% of HRI
5% of HRI
5.5% of HRI
6% of HRI
6.5% of HRI
7% of HRI
7.5% of HRI
8% of HRI
Calculate the amount of the annual HECSHELP payment for a person whose HRI is:
b $72 500
c $82 670
d $142 456.
a $32 000
24
deducted from her pay fortnightly. Calculate the amount of the fortnightly deduction made for
union fees and also for health insurance.
e If Raylene pays $1009.22 in fortnightly tax, as well as the above deductions, calculate her weekly
net pay.
14 WE23 Liang-Yi earns $13.60 per hour for a 38-hour working week.
a Calculate the amount Liang-Yi will earn in a normal working week.
b Calculate the total amount Liang-Yi will receive for his 4 weeks annual leave if he receives a
1
17 2 % holiday loading.
15 Paula is paid an annual salary of $45 800.
a Calculate Paulas gross weekly salary.
1
b Calculate the total amount Paula will receive for her 4 weeks annual leave if she is paid a 17 2 %
holiday loading.
Calculate how much health insurance Scott must pay for a 4-week period.
d If Scott pays $1779.92 in tax for this 4 weeks, calculate his net pay for the 4-week holiday.
Further development
18 Tyrone is paid $15.65 per hour for a 40 hour working week. Tyrone pays 23% of his gross pay in tax
and 6% in superannuation.
a Calculate Tyrones net pay.
b Tyrone receives a 5% pay rise. This causes his tax to increase to 24% of his gross pay and his
superannuation rises to 7% of his gross pay. Calculate the increase in Tyrones net pay as a
percentage correct to 1 decimal place.
19 Ricky has a job that pays him an annual salary of $55 000. When negotiating a pay rise the company for
which Ricky works asks the employees to give up their 17.5% holiday loading in return for the pay rise.
What is the minimum percentage pay increase that is required so that the employees will not be worse off?
20 Nancy is paid a fortnightly salary of $2397.68. Nancys employer also contributes an amount equal to
6% of her salary to her superannuation fund and provides a car under a lease arrangement which has a
value of $724.50 per month.
Calculate the total value of Nancys salary package.
21 Frank earns an annual salary of $90 000. He must pay 8% of his gross annual salary in superannuation
payments and 32% of his gross annual salary in taxation. Grace earns 85% of Franks salary but only
pays 6% in superannuation and 30% in taxation.
What percentage of Franks net annual salary is Graces net annual salary?
22 Richard earns an annual salary of $76 000. He pays 28% of his gross annual income in taxation and has
no other deductions.
a What is Richards net annual salary?
b Richard needs a new computer and chooses to salary package the computer. This means that his
employer buys the computer for him and deducts the cost from his gross salary. As the computer
is used for work purposes its value is not taxed. Given that the computer he chooses has a value of
$3000 calculate the amount by which his net salary is reduced.
ChAptEr 1 Earning money
25
23 Indore has a gross annual salary of $62 750. Indores salary package includes a car that has a monthly
cost of $859.60.
a Find the annual cost of packaging the car.
b Calculate Indores net annual salary given that her only deduction is 27% in tax.
c Calculate the amount that the car actually costs Indore from her net pay, per month, given that the
car cost is taken from her gross salary and that this deduction causes her tax to fall to 25%.
DiGitAl DoC
Spreadsheet
doc-1452
Wages_3
2. In cell I7 write the formula = G7 H7. This formula will calculate Net Pay by subtracting Deductions
from Gross Pay.
3. Your spreadsheet will now calculate both a persons Gross Pay and Net Pay. Save this as Wages_3.
(You should now have three versions of the spreadsheet saved.)
4. Now clear all the data from the columns Pay Rate, Normal Hours, Time and a half Hours, Double
Time Hours and Deductions. You should then have a spreadsheet set up with no data and $ - (as can be
seen below) where there are formulas.
DiGitAl DoC
Spreadsheet
doc-1453
Wages template
When a spreadsheet is in this form it is called a template. The spreadsheet is now ready to accept new
data and make new calculations. Save this version as Wages template. Alternatively, download the Wages
template from the Maths Quest Preliminary Mathematics General eBookPLUS.
26
1h
Budgeting
Once we have earned money we need to allocate the money to cover our expenses; otherwise, we may
spend more than we earn! Allocating money to cover expenses is called making a budget. A budget is
divided into two parts: income and expenditure. A budget is balanced when income and expenditure
are equal.
Consider the budget below, drawn up for Tanya, who earns a net wage of $700.
Income
Wages
$700
Total
$700
Expenditure
Rent
Groceries
Bills
Car loan
Car running costs
Entertainment
Credit card
Savings
Total
$150
$100
$100
$75
$50
$60
$50
$115
$700
When designing a budget, it is important to look for all your expenses and set money aside for them.
For example, electricity bills arrive every three months and money should be set aside each week so that
when the bill does arrive you have the money to pay for it. The amount set aside should be based on the
normal amount of the bill over a year, with that amount divided into weekly or fortnightly amounts.
For bills such as electricity and telephone, an extra amount should be allowed, as you do not know
the exact amount of the bill until it arrives. Such an allowance covers the possibilities of a price rise or
increased usage. This is not necessary for bills such as council rates or insurance, as these are known in
advance.
WorkED ExAMplE 24
Ben receives four electricity bills each year. For the previous year they were for $136, $187, $169
and $105. How much should Ben budget for electricity bills out of each weeks pay? We should
allow an extra 10% to cover the possibility of price increases or extra usage.
think
WritE
Some bills are calculated over different lengths of time, so the simplest way to develop a budget is to
calculate all bills over a year.
WorkED ExAMplE 25
27
think
WritE
Electricity = $110 6
= $660
Telephone = $95 4
= $380
Rates = $1250
To bring a budget into balance, any money that is not spent can be saved. The amount saved can be
calculated by subtracting the expenses to which we are committed from the total earnings.
WorkED ExAMplE 26
Peter earns $950 per fortnight. He allows $110 per fortnight for his bills, $250 per fortnight for
groceries, $70 for car running costs and $80 per fortnight for entertainment. Peter also has a
mortgage for which the payment is $600 per month.
a Calculate the amount Peter should allocate each fortnight for his mortgage.
b Calculate the amount of money Peter can save each fortnight.
c Draw up a budget for Peter, showing his income and expenditure.
think
a 1
2
= $7200
WritE
= $786.92
Income
Wages
$950
Total
$950
Expenditure
Mortgage
$276.92
Bills
$110
Groceries
$250
Car
$70
Entertainment
$80
Savings
$163.08
Total
$950
To do work on budgeting you will need to be able to interpret the information on various household bills.
28
WorkED ExAMplE 27
a What is
the to
tal of thebill?
c How much of the bill is for service and equipment?
think
was $51.45.
Exercise 1h
Budgeting
1 WE24 Vesna gets her telephone bill quarterly. Last year her four bills were $89.50, $103.40, $110.30
and $95.00. Calculate the amount that Vesna should budget for her telephone bill each week, allowing
approximately 10% to cover price increases or extra usage.
2 Christopher pays $1360 each year in council rates. Calculate how much he should budget for each
Electricity
Telephone
Car insurance
House insurance
Council rates
DiGitAl DoC
Spreadsheet
doc-1455
Budgets
29
Calculate the amount that Mr and Mrs Banks should budget for each week, to pay all these bills,
allowing an extra 10% for extra usage or price increases.
6 Mr and Mrs Duric have the following bills.
Electricity
$105 every 2 months
Telephone
$115 per quarter
Car insurance
$287 every 6 months
Home contents insurance $365 per year
Private health insurance
$1200 per year
Rent
$180 per week
Calculate the total amount that Mr and Mrs Duric must budget for each fortnight, to cover all these bills.
7 WE26 Neville earns $685 per week. His expenses are $100 for rent, $90 for groceries, $75 for bills,
$70 in car running costs, $60 in entertainment and $50 for miscellaneous expenses.
a Calculate the amount that Neville can save each week.
b Present the above information in the form of a budget for Neville.
8 Petria has the following bills.
Electricity
$120 every quarter
Telephone
$80 every quarter
Council rates
$800 per annum
Water rates
$700 per annum
Insurance
$70 per month
a Calculate the amount that Petria must budget each fortnight for the above bills.
b Petria has a mortgage with a monthly repayment of $900. Calculate the amount that Petria must
budget each fortnight for her mortgage.
c Petria has a net fortnightly pay of $1345. If Petria budgets $250 per fortnight for groceries,
$80 for entertainment, $30 for medical expenses and $70 for car running costs, calculate the
amount that Petria can save each fortnight.
d Prepare the above information in a budget for Petria.
9 WE27 Look at the extract from a sample telephone bill below.
a
b
c
d
30
this bill?
c How many days does this bill cover?
d How many kWh of power were used under the
Domestic heading?
e What is the present reading of the domestic
f
meter?
What was the previous reading of the off-peak
meter?
31
a
b
c
d
32
12 Look at the extract from the sample bill for council rates below.
a
b
c
d
33
Further development
13 Petria earns $13.60 per hour in her casual job at McDonalds. Petria works an average 12hours per
14
15
16
17
18
DiGitAl DoC
WorkSHEET 1.2
doc-10308
34
week.
a Calculate Petrias gross weekly pay.
b Petria spends an average $30 per week on her mobile phone. Calculate the percentage of her gross
pay that she spends on her phone.
Olivia has a home telephone that costs her an average $65.00 per month. She also spends an average
$30 per week on her pre-paid mobile phone. Calculate the weekly saving if Olivia replaces both phones
with a mobile plan that costs $119.95 per month.
Damien has insurance costs of $562.50 for home and contents insurance with GOI Insurance,
$1650 per year for health insurance with HBF insurance and $739.60 for car insurance with RMNA
Insurance.
GOI offers a 5% discount on its $1720 health insurance premium and a 10% discount on its
$812.60 car insurance premium if Damien switches all policies to GOI.
HBF will match its competitors premiums and discount the health insurance by 5% if all policies
are with them.
Which, if either, offer should Damien choose and what will be his total cost?
Mr and Mrs Forrester have a combined net income of $1650 per week. Their weekly expenses include
$600 per week for mortgage repayments and $450 per week in household bills.
a What is the percentage of net pay that the Forresters allocate to their mortgage repayment and
household bills?
b Over the next year the Forresterss pay increases by 3%. Their mortgage repayment remains
unchanged; however, they allocate an extra 10% to cover their bills. Calculate the new percentage
of net pay allocated to each of these items.
Mr and Mrs. Marone have a $300 000 mortgage. They have a combined net income of $6000per month
and repay the loan at a rate of $2121 per month.
a What percentage of their net income is allocated to repaying the home loan?
b After a series of interest rate rises, their loan repayment increases to $2316 per month. Calculate
the change in percentage of income allocated to the loan.
Economists often talk of the cost of items in real terms. This is the percentage increase or decrease in
purchasing power after wage rises and cost increases are factored. If the average income is $1500 per
week and average expenses are $1350 per week, and wages rise by 5% and expenses increase by 10%,
calculate the loss of income as a percentage in real terms.
Summary
Methods of payment
A salary is a fixed amount paid to an employee to do a job. This is usually based on an annual
amount divided into weekly or fortnightly instalments.
A wage is an amount paid to an employee according to an hourly rate. The weekly wage is the
hourly rate multiplied by the hours worked.
Commission or royalties are payments based on a percentage of sales.
Payment by piece is payment to an employee according to the amount of work completed.
Working overtime
Overtime is paid when the employee works more than the regular hours each week. Usually the
employee will be paid at either:
1
time and a half 1 2 times the normal hourly rate, or
double time twice the normal hourly rate.
Government
allowances
Government payments can be received as youth allowance, aged pension and for study purposes.
The Centrelink website can be used to look up the amount of these payments.
Most government payments are subject to an income test. In such cases the amount of the payment
reduces once income reaches a certain level. At another, higher level of income the allowance cuts
out altogether.
Payments are also subject to an assets test which works in a similar way. If you have more than a
certain level of assets, payment is reduced.
Additions to and
deductions from gross
pay
Gross pay is the pay the employee receives before any deductions are taken out.
Deductions are made from gross pay for tax, superannuation, union fees and so on.
The amount left from gross pay after deductions are taken out is called net pay.
1
Employees receive an extra 17 2 % when they take their annual leave. This is called the annual leave
loading.
Budgeting
35
Chapter review
M U lt ip l E
C h oiCE
2 Simone works as a florist and receives a normal hourly rate of $13.60. Simones pay for a
Saturday night, when she works 6 hours at a rate of time and a half, is:
A $20.40
B $81.60
C $122.40
D $163.20
3 Noel sells computer software and receives a $250 per week retainer plus a commission of 5% of all
sales over $10 000. In a week where Noels sales reach $13 460, he is paid a total of:
A $17
B $423
C $673
D $923
4 Janelle works a 38-hour week at a rate of $14.50 per hour. When Janelle takes her 4 weeks annual leave
1
she is paid a loading of 17 2%. Janelles weekly wage, when she takes her leave, is:
A $551
B $647.43
C $2204
D $2589.70
5 Which of the following employees is paid a wage?
A
B
C
D
Anthony, who receives a payment of 4% of the value of all sales each month
Beth, who is paid fortnightly at a rate of $13.50 per hour
Carmel, who is paid weekly based on an annual amount of $37 500
Damien, who is paid $1.2 million for every movie that he appears in
6 Cherry is single, for whom the full youth allowance is $402.70 per fortnight. The income test reduces
the amount of youth allowance by 50c in the dollar for fortnightly income between $62 and $250,
and 60c in the dollar thereafter. Cherry has fortnightly income of $286.60, so the youth allowance she
receives is:
A $230.74
B $255.74
C $259.40
D $286.74
Sh ort
AnS WEr
1 Carole earns a salary of $39 600 per year and is paid weekly. Calculate her weekly pay.
2 Neil earns a salary of $67 400 per year and is paid fortnightly. Calculate his fortnightly pay.
3 Lainie earns a salary of $1326 per month. Calculate her annual salary.
4 Paul earns a salary of $51 000 per annum and works an average of 44 hours per week. Calculate the
$13.80per hour.
a Kevin is a full-time bartender who works a 36-hour week. Calculate his weekly wage.
b Len is a casual bartender who works 16 hours a week. Calculate Lens weekly wage.
36
7 Charlotte works 36 hours for a wage of $410.40. Calculate her hourly rate of pay.
8 Brian earns $11.83 per hour. Calculate the number of hours that Brian would need to work in a week if
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
37
22 Lance is paid $14.86 per hour and works 38hours at normal time and 3 hours overtime for which he is
$80 for entertainment, $50 for car running costs, $125 for groceries and $30 for medical needs.
Calculate the amount that Ruth can allocate for savings in her budget.
24 Amy has to budget for the following bills.
Electricity
$115 every 2 months
Telephone
$120 per quarter
Insurance
$62.50 per month
Rates
$1050 per year
Calculate the amount that Amy should budget for each week to pay all of these bills.
E x t EnDED
r E SponS E
1 Ken works as a pest inspector. Ken is paid a wage of $15.40 per hour.
a If Ken works a normal 36-hour week, calculate his wage.
b Calculate Kens wage for a week if, in addition to his normal hours, he works 3 hours at time and
DiGitAl DoC
Test Yourself
doc-10309
Chapter 1
38
in a week if he works his normal 36 hours, but 23 of those hours are spent working in confined
spaces.
d Calculate the total amount which Ken will receive for his 4 weeks annual leave if he is paid an
1
annual leave loading of 17 2 %.
2 Danielle is a preschool teacher who receives a salary of $47 600 per annum.
a Calculate the amount that she will receive each fortnight.
b Danielle pays 9% of her gross salary in superannuation. Calculate her fortnightly superannuation
contribution.
c If Danielle also has $485.38 in tax, $45.80 for health insurance and $15.60 in union dues
deducted from her pay, calculate her net fortnightly pay.
ICT activities
1A
DiGitAl DoC
Spreadsheet (doc-1439): Payroll calculations (page 2)
1B
Calculating wages
DiGitAl DoCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1439): Payroll calculations (page 5)
Spreadsheet (doc-1440): Wages_1 (page 7)
1C
DiGitAl DoC
Spreadsheet (doc-1443): Calculations with percentages (page 10)
1D
payment by piece
DiGitAl DoC
WorkSHEET 1.1 (doc-10307): Perform calculations related to earning
money. (page 14)
1E
1h
Budgeting
DiGitAl DoCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1455): Budgets (page 29)
WorkSHEET 1.2 (doc-10308): Perform calculations about earning
money and budgeting. (page 34)
Chapter review
Test Yourself Chapter 1 (doc-10309): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 38)
Working overtime
DiGitAl DoC
Spreadsheet (doc-1448): Wages_2 (page 18)
39
Answers CHAPTER 1
EArninG MonEY
Exercise 1A
1 $1700
3 $4500
4 a $745
b $1490
c $3228.33
5 $1653.85
6
Annual
salary
$30 000
$576.92
$1153.85
$2500.00
$39 500
$759.62
$1519.23
$3291.67
$42 250
$812.50
$1625.00
$3520.83
$2090.38
$4529.17
$3325.96
$7206.25
7
9
10
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
$23 920
8 $32 500
$69 600
C
11 $14.28
a $634.62
b $17.63
a $688
b Karina ($16.38 per hour)
45 hours
$2166.67
Compare the annual salaries. Dans
equivalent monthly salary is found by
multiplying by 26 and dividing by 12,
giving $2264.17, $164.17 per month more
than Brian.
a $88 312.50
b Not necessarily correct. It is possible
that Sandra works more efficiently than
Stephanie, completing the same or more
work in a shorter period of time.
$2100 per fortnight
$1871.35
a $39 816.40
b $330 476.12
Exercise 1B
1 $518
2
Calculating wages
Name
Hourly Hours
rate
worked
A. Smith
$14.52
40
$580.80
B. Brown
$16.45
38
$625.10
N. Tran
$15.95
37.5
$598.13
A. Milosevic
$20.10
41
$824.10
L. McTavish
$18.04
36
$649.44
3 a $424.80
c $501.50
4 a $432
c $600.75
5 a $17.34
6 D
8 39
40
Wage
Name
A. White
B. Black
C. Green
D. Brown
E. Scarlet
F. Grey
Wage
$416.16
$538.80
$369.63
$813.96
$231.30
$776.72
Hours
worked
36
40
37
42
15
38
Hourly
rate
$11.56
$13.47
$9.99
$19.38
$15.42
$20.44
$12.54
11 C
12 D
$422.62
14 $548.80
a $349.65
b 43 hours
a $471.20
b $11.78
a $1666
b $4.52
$120.83
19 $103.67
a $25.98
b 44.4 hours
a 38 hours
b John will earn $1.28 less each week.
Current pay = $510.40,
new pay = $509.12
22 a 40 $18.49 = $739.60
b The employer figure is
$18.49 1.05 = $19.4145 rounded down
to $19.41. Traceys figure
$739.60 1.05 = $776.58
c $776.40
d $19.4145 it is possible to pay this
amount by multiplying this hourly rate
by the number of hours worked and
rounding to the nearest cent after the
calculation not before the calculation.
e Tracey is correct as under the
employers plan the pay rise is less than
5%.
23 a $566.96
b $15.5019
c 42 hours.
10
13
15
16
17
18
20
21
Exercise 1C
1 $2000
2 a $260
c $568.79
3 a $400
c $1360
4 $1425
6 B
7 a $1425
8 a 4.5%
c $18 000
9 C
11 $800
12 a $4125
c $16 875
13 $950
b $566.40
b $499.50
b $225.42
7 $9.68
b $327
b $1200
5 $4140
b $110 000
b $693
10 $8125
Exercise 1D
payment by piece
1 $75.95
2 a $103.50
c $85.50
3 $175
4 $135
5 $325.50
6 $327
7 a $92
c $87.40
8 a $57.75
c $103.95
9 $22.80
10 a $11
c $19.32
11 a $134.40
12 a $174
c $29.00/h
13 a $117.60
c $234.00
14 a $266
c $1200
15 a $98
c $8.00/h
16 a $70
17 a The wage
b The piecework
c 635 boxes
18 C
Exercise 1E
1 $16.95
3 $28.70
5 $157.20
b $5375
14 a $390
b $490
c $649
15 B
16 a $400
b $500
c $8000
d $8125
17 $625
18 a $300
b $345
c $406.80
19 D
20 a $462.50
b $372.50
c Bonito ($705)
21 a Package C
b $2 080 000
c 43 hours
d She has an incentive to sell more.
22 a J. L. Booker $625. Roy Black $250
b J. L. Booker $1250, Roy Black $1500
c $400 000
23 a 2%
b 2.6%
24 $15 625
25 $350
b $94.50
d $81
b $138
d $114.08
b $125.13
b $27.80
b $16.80
b $21.75/h
b $177.60
b $512
b 3572
b $15.56/h
Working overtime
2 $22.84
4 $142.56
Ordinary
rate
Overtime
rate
Hours
worked
Pay
$8.90
$53.40
M. Donnell
$9.35
Double time
$112.20
F. Milosevic
$11.56
$121.38
J. Carides
$13.86
6.5
$135.14
Y. Robinson
$22.60
Double time
5.5
$248.60
Name
A. Nguyen
7C
10 $543.52
13
8 A
11 $721.60
Name
W. Clark
A. Hurst
S. Gannon
9 B
12 $596.25
Ord. rate
Normal hours
Time and a
half hours
$8.60
38
$9.85
37
$14.50
38
13
$732.25
$717.75
$16.23
37.5
1.5
$754.70
36
8.5
$1543.80
Exercise 1F
9
10
12
6
2
$24.90
permanent job.
$492.50
G. Dymock
22 $15.88
24 43.2 hours
6
7
Total pay
D. Colley
14 C
15 A
16 $595.20
17 a $705.28
b $788.80
c $928
18 $455.78
19 a 45 hours
b $16.47
20 41 hours
21 a $574.20
b Jack will earn less by taking the
1
2
3
4
5
Double
time hours
a $265
23 52 hours
Government allowances
b $228
$380.70
$442.10
a $236
a No
b A further $367
$302.70
a $220.40
c $45.12
e $236.22
g $141.10
a $402.70
c $301.45
a No
C
a $265
c $691
a $402.70
5 $7.58
6 $56.02
7 a $511.10
c $407.26
8 a $2153.85
c $1448.41
9 $56.12
10 $167.26
11 a $422.56
c $310.01
12 a $0
c $5786.90
13 a $2884.62
c $4875
b $44.84
b $44.37
b $4350
d $11 396.48
b $367.79
$187.50
b $616.67
b
d
f
h
b
d
b
11
b
$195.15
$189.55
$293.70
$261.25
$481.75
$290.82
$318.70
D
$236
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
b $638.70
Exercise 1h
1
3
4
6
7
Gross pay
Deductions
Net pay
$345.00
$89.45
$255.55
$563.68
$165.40
$398.28
$765.90
$231.85
$534.05
$1175.60
$429.56
$746.04
$2500.00
$765.40
$1734.60
b $1434.08
$2869.60.
ChAptEr rEViEW
MUltiplE ChoiCE
Exercise 1G
3 $360.45
4 a $2519.23
b $5.11
10 a $198.17
b $60.70
c 55
d 1753
e 10 000
f 58 552
11 a $143.75
b 72 days
c 1.24c/MJ
d 161
12 a $1007.70
b $90 000
c $91.50
d 4, $251.90
13 a $163.20
b 18.38%
14 $17.32
15 The HBF offer will give a total cost of
$2428.96
$4139.61
$81.59
$922.12
$4315.28
2.0%
$2160
$45 807.50
Budgeting
$8.42
2 $52.31
$8.00
$346.15
5 $59.78
$484.19
a $240
b Check with your teacher.
8 a $120.77
b $415.38
c $378.85
d Check with your teacher.
9 a $181.60
b 5 Oct. to 4 Jan.
c $29.35
d $14
1 B
4 B
2 C
5 B
3 B
6 D
Short AnSWEr
1 $761.54
3 $15 912
5 a $522
c $588.24
6 a $442.80
7 $11.40/hr
9 $395.20
10 $798.50
12 $340.75
13 $98
14 a $21.30
15 a $98.10
16 a $368.60
c $426.80
17 $590.24
18 a $220.40
19 $311.64
20 $4.05
21 a $1855.77
b $176.30
22 a $631.55
b $13.26
c $72.63
d $405.36
23 $135
24 $57.12
2 $2592.31
4 $22.29/hr
b $594.70
b $220.80
8 43 hours
11 $534
b
b
b
d
$28.40
$109
$426.80
$485
b $355.14
ExtEnDED rESponSE
1 a
b
c
d
2 a
b
c
$554.40
$685.30
$572.57
$2605.68
$1830.77
$164.77
$1119.22
41
ChapTer 2
Investing money
ChapTer ConTenTs
2a
2B
2C
2d
2e
2F
2G
2a
When you deposit money in a bank, building society, or other financial institution you are actually
lending them your money. Since you are lending them money you expect to receive your money back,
plus an extra amount commonly known as interest. Similarly, if you borrow money from an institution,
you must pay back the original sum, together with interest.
A measure of the interest paid is called the interest rate. The interest rate
is a percentage of the amount of money invested or borrowed and is paid each
year. Even though all interest rates are expressed in the same way, interest
can be calculated by using several different methods. Whether depositing or
borrowing, it is important that you understand how the interest is calculated.
The simplest method of interest calculation is called simple interest.
Interest is calculated as a percentage of the initial deposit or borrowing (called
the principal) and multiplied by the period the money was invested.
The formula used to calculate simple interest is:
I = Prn
where I = simple interest
P = initial quantity
r = percentage interest rate per period, expressed as a decimal
n = number of periods
Worked example 1
Calculate the simple interest earned on an investment of $5000 at 4% p.a. for 3 years.
Think
WriTe
I = Prn
P = $5000
r = 0.04
n=3
I = $5000 0.04 3
Calculate.
= $600
43
The total amount (A) that your deposit or debt has become after interest is added can be found using the
formula:
A=P+I
where A = total amount at the end of the term
P = initial quantity
I = simple interest
Worked example 2
$12 000 is invested for 5 years at 9.5% p.a. simple interest. Calculate the value of this investment at
the end of the term.
Think
WriTe/display
Method 1
1
I = Prn
Calculate.
= $17 700
Method 2
44
= $5700
A=P+I
Care must be taken with simple interest questions when the length of the investment is not given in
years. If the investment is given as months, it must be converted to years by writing the number of
months as a fraction over 12, for example,
18
18 months = 12 = 1 2 years.
Worked example 3
Calculate the simple interest earned on an investment of $7600 at 5.2% p.a. for 9 months.
Think
WriTe
I = Prn
P = $7600, r = 0.052, n =
I = $7600 0.052
3
4
3
4
= $296.40
Some examples will ask you to calculate the length of time for which money must be invested in order to
earn a given amount of interest.
Worked example 4
How long, to the nearest month, will it take to earn $650 simple interest if $8375 is invested at
6.25% p.a.?
Think
WriTe
I = Prn
= 1.2418 years
15 months
= $523.4375 n
n=
$650
$523.4375
There are many different reasons why most people need to maintain at least one bank account. Different
accounts are designed by the banks to meet peoples needs. The most frequent of these are:
1 Transactional accounts these are accounts that people use to have their pay deposited into, and for
regular withdrawals and shopping using EFTPOS.
2 Savings accounts accounts where people make regular deposits and save towards a specific target. A
Christmas club account is an example of this type of account.
3 Investment accounts accounts where money is locked away, usually at a higher rate of interest, for a
fixed period of time.
45
Bank accounts pay interest on the amount of money in these accounts, but may also charge fees which
can be calculated in different ways.
Find an example of each of the types of accounts listed above and answer the questions below.
1 What is the interest rate payable on this account?
2 Is there a minimum balance that must be maintained in the account?
3 What are the features of this account? (For example, do you get an ATM card or a cheque book?)
4 What are the fees on the account? (For example, the account may have a monthly fee or a fee based on
the number and type of transactions.)
5 Are the fees applied differently to deposits and withdrawals? Are they levied differently for over-thecounter, ATM and EFTPOS transactions?
Examples of investments involving simple interest include investment bonds and debentures.
Investment bonds are offered by the government, either State or Federal, and larger organisations such
as Telstra.
Interest earned on investment bonds can be paid at varying intervals, for example monthly, quarterly,
every six months (semi-annually) or yearly. Bonds are traded on financial markets. That is, they can be
bought or sold prior to the term expiry date (also known as bond maturity).
Debentures are similar to investment bonds but are issued by private companies to investors to raise
capital. At the end of the term, the principal (or face value) is returned to the investor, while the interest
earned is again paid at varying intervals.
exercise 2a
1 We1 Veronica invests $4000 for 3 years at 5% p.a. Calculate the simple interest earned.
diGiTal doC
GC program Casio
doc-1544
interest
3 Julie has $40 000 to invest. She invests it for 5 years in a State Government bond that pays 5.6% p.a.
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1546
interest
the account.
3
a If the interest rate is 3 4 %, calculate the amount of interest Frank will receive after one year.
b What will be the balance of Franks bank account after one year?
7 Loretta invests $7540 at 5.95% p.a.
a Calculate the simple interest that Loretta will earn in her first year.
b Loretta receives two interest payments per year. Calculate the size of each payment.
1
c Find the total value of the investment after 4 2 years.
8 We3 Kath invests $9450 in a government bond that pays 6% p.a. simple interest for an 18month
46
B $541.17
d $6279.00
10 mC The total value of an investment of $3500 after 2 years and 6 months if simple interest is paid at
B $826.25
d $3975.50
11 Calculate the simple interest that has to be paid, if $4650 is invested on a term deposit for 180 days at
at 9.75% p.a.?
13 A debenture offers to pay 8% p.a. interest on a 4 year investment. Janine wants to earn $2000 interest.
B $12 200
d $21 200
15 Sue and Harry invested $14 500 in State Government bonds at 8.65% p.a. The investment is for
10 years and the interest is paid semi-annually (that is, every six months). Calculate how much interest:
a they receive every payment
b will be received in total.
16 Mrs Williams invested $60 000 in government bonds at 7.5% p.a. with interest paid semi-annually (that
scholarship is $1500. They invest a sum of money at 8% p.a. so that each year $1500 in interest is
earned. How much will Mr and Mrs Tyquin need to invest?
Further development
3
18 Silvia invested $15 000 that she won in Lotto into a government bond that pays 8 4 % simple interest
provided she keeps the bond for 5 years. What is the total value of Silvias bond at the end of 5 years?
19 Silvias bond allows her to withdraw part of the money invested during the term of the loan but will
only pay 5.5% on the funds that were withdrawn over the time it was invested. After 2years Silvia
withdraws $3000 to buy a big screen TV. Calculate the interest earned on the entire investment.
ChapTer 2 Investing money
47
20 Mandy invested $12 000 in a fund paying 9.5% p.a. simple interest over a 4 year period.
a Calculate the interest that Mandy has earned.
b Martin earned the same amount of interest as Mandy but did so at 9% p.a. in only three years.
2B
No. of years
Interest
1
$500
2
$1000
3
$1500
4
$2000
5
$2500
Interest ($)
Suppose that we invest $10 000 at 5% p.a. simple interest. The table below shows the amount of interest
that we will receive over various lengths of time.
3000
2000
1000
0
2 3 4
Years
Worked example 5
b Graph the interest earned against the number of years the money is invested.
Think
WriTe/draW
Method 1
calculate the interest earned on $6000 at
4% p.a. for 1, 2, 3, 4 and 5 years.
b Draw the graph with Years on the horizontal
a No. of years
Interest
b
Interest ($)
1
$240
1500
1000
500
0
2 3 4
Years
Method 2
48
I = Prn
I = 6000 0.04 n
= 240n
2
$480
3
$720
4
5
$960 $1200
We are able to compare the interest that is earned by an investment at varying interest rates by graphing
the interest earned at varying rates on the one set of axes.
Worked example 6
Kylie has $12 000 to invest. Three different banks offer interest rates of 4%, 5% and 6%.
a Complete the table below to show the interest that she would earn over 5 years.
No. of years
Interest (4%)
Interest (5%)
Interest (6%)
b Show this information in graph form.
Think
WriTe/draW
No. of years
Interest (4%)
$480
$960
Interest (5%)
$600
Interest (6%)
$720
Interest ($)
4000
Interest (6%)
Interest (5%)
Interest (4%)
3000
2000
1000
0
2 3 4
Years
49
exercise 2B
No. of years
Interest
b Draw a graph of the interest earned against the length of the investment.
2 $20 000 is to be invested at 8% p.a.
a Copy and complete the table below to calculate the interest for various lengths of time.
No. of years
Interest
b Draw a graph of the interest earned against the length of the investment.
c What is the gradient of the linear graph drawn?
d Use your graph to find the amount of interest that would have been earned after 10years.
3 Draw a graph to represent the interest earned by each of the following investments over 5 years.
a $15 000 at 7% p.a.
b $2000 at 10% p.a.
c $8600 at 7.5% p.a.
d $50 000 at 8.2% p.a.
4 A graph can be drawn to show the interest earned on $6000 at 4.8% p.a. for various
Interest (5%)
Interest (6%)
Interest (8%)
b Show this information in graph form.
7 Theo has $50 000 to invest. Theo investigates the website www.whichbank.com.au, which has an
Interest ($)
interactive component. Theo enters the figure $50 000 and the following graph is displayed.
40 000
35 000
30 000
25 000
20 000
15 000
10 000
5000
0
Whichbank
Eastpac
NZA bank
5 6
Years
9 10
a Find the amount of simple interest earned after 10 years by investing with each of the three banks
listed.
b Use your answer to a to calculate the interest rate paid by each of the three banks.
50
8 The graph below shows the interest earned on an investment of $10 000 with two different banks.
3500
Interest ($)
3000
2500
Bank A
2000
Bank B
1500
1000
500
0
2
3
4
Number of years
Which bank pays the higher rate of interest? Explain how you know this.
9 Mark has $5500 to invest at 3%, 3.5% or 3.75%.
a Complete the table below to show the interest that he would earn over various lengths of time.
No. of years
Interest (3%)
Interest (3.5%)
Interest (3.75%)
b Show this information in graph form.
10 Draw a graph to show the interest earned on an investment of $12 500 at 4.5%p.a., 5%p.a. and
Further development
12 The graph below right shows the interest earned under a simple interest investment.
a Find the gradient of this line.
I (interest)
b How does this relate to the investment?
$500
(5, 480)
c Given that the interest rate is 6% p.a. calculate
$400
$300
$200
$100
0
5 n (years)
13 The graph below right shows the growth of an investment under simple interest.
a What was the amount of money invested?
A (amount $)
b What is the interest rate earned?
5000
c Find the value of the investment after
4000
8 years.
3000
(5, 300)
2000
1000
0
5 n (years)
51
14 When graphing interest earned and the value of the investment on maturity on the same axes the lines
2. The spreadsheet Simple Interest (Sheet 1) models an investment of $10 000 at 5%p.a.
3. Use the graphing function on your spreadsheet to draw a line graph for the amount of interest earned
each year and the value of the investment after each year.
4. Change the amount of the principal and the interest rate, and note the change in the figures displayed
and the chart.
5. Use this function to check your answers to Exercise 2B.
6. Save the spreadsheet as Simple Interest.
52
2C
In practice, most investments are not calculated using simple interest. If you have a bank account, you
would know that when interest is paid the balance of your account grows and it is on this new balance
that your next interest payment is calculated.
When interest is added to the principal and this new balance is used to calculate the next interest
payment, this is called compound interest. We can calculate compound interest by calculating
simple interest one period at a time. The amount to which the initial investment grows is called the
compounded value or future value.
inTeraCTiViTy
int-0810
Compound interest
Worked example 7
Calculate the future value of an investment of $10 000 at 10% p.a. for 3 years with interest paid at
the end of each year, by calculating the simple interest for each year separately.
Think
WriTe
To calculate the actual amount of interest received, we subtract the initial principal from the future value.
In the example above CI = $13 310 $10 000
= $3310
To compare this with simple interest earnings at the same rate.
I = Prn
= $10 000 0.1 3
= $3000
The table below shows a comparison between the value of an investment of $10 000 earning 10% p.a.
at both simple interest and compound interest.
Year
Simple interest
$1000
$2000
$3000
$4000
$5000
$6000
$7000
$8000
Compound interest
$1000
$2100
$3310
$4641
$6105
$7716
$9487
$11 436
We can develop a formula for the future value of an investment rather than do each example by repeated
use of simple interest. Consider Worked example 7. Let the compounded value after each year be An.
After 1 year
After 2 years
A1 = 10 000 1.1
A2 = A1 (1.1)
= 10 000 1.1 1.1
= 10 000 1.12
53
A3 = A2 1.1
= 10 000 1.12 1.1
= 10 000 1.13
The pattern then continues such that the value of the investment after n years equals:
$10 000 1.1n
We can generalise this example to any investment.
A = P(1 + r)n
where A = final balance
P = initial quantity
r = percentage interest rate per compounding period, expressed as a decimal
n = number of compounding periods.
In the financial world, the terms future value (FV ) and present value (PV ) are sometimes used instead
of amount and principal.
After 3 years
Worked example 8
Calculate the future value of an investment of $12 000 at 7% p.a. for 5 years, where interest is
compounded annually.
Think
WriTe
A = P(1 + r)n
Calculate.
= $16 830.62
Calculate the future value of an investment of $6000 at 8% p.a. for 2 years with interest
compounded quarterly.
Think
54
WriTe
A = P(1 + r)n
P = $6000, r = 0.02, n = 8
A = $6000 1.028
Calculate.
= $7029.96
exercise 2C
1 We7 Ray has $5000 to invest. He invests it for 3 years at 10% p.a. with interest paid annually.
Calculate the future value of the investment by calculating the simple interest on each year separately.
2 Suzanne is to invest $15 000 for 2 years at 7% p.a. with interest paid annually.
a Calculate the future value of the investment by calculating the simple interest for each year
separately.
b Find the amount of interest earned.
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1552
Compound interest
3 We8 Kiri has $2000 to invest. She invests the money at 8% p.a. for 5 years with interest compounded
annually. Use the formula A = P(1 + r)n to calculate the future value of Kiris investment.
4 Use the compound interest formula to calculate the future value of each of the following investments
compounding monthly.
a Convert the interest rate of 6% p.a. to a rate per month.
b Calculate the future value of the investment upon maturity.
9 Calculate the compounded value of each of the following investments.
a $960 for 1 year at 4.50% p.a. with interest compounded six-monthly.
1
b $7500 for 3 2 years at 5.6% p.a. with interest compounded quarterly.
1
c $152 000 for 2 2 years at 7.2% p.a. with interest compounded six-monthly.
d $14 000 for 4 years at 9% p.a. with interest compounded monthly.
e $120 000 for 20 years at 11.95% p.a. with interest compounded quarterly.
10 mC A sum of $5000 is invested for 2 years at the rate of 4.75% p.a., compounded quarterly. The
d $5495
11 mC After selling their house Mr and MrsDengate have $61 800. They plan to invest it at 6% p.a.,
with interest compounded annually. The value of their investment will first exceed $100 000 after:
a 8 years
B 9 years
C 10 years
d 11 years
55
12 mC Warren wishes to invest $10 000 for a period of 5 years. The following investment alternatives are
compounded six-monthly. The future value of the investment is $15 049.70. The initial principal (the
sum of money invested) is
a $900
B $8500
C $9400
d $11 000
14 Brittany has $13 500 to invest. An investment over a 2-year term will pay interest of 8% p.a. Calculate
compounded daily.
a Calculate the daily percentage interest rate, correct to 4 decimal places.
b Calculate the compounded value of Kerrys investment on maturity.
c Calculate the amount of interest paid on this investment.
d Calculate the extra amount of interest earned, compared with the interest calculated at the end of
the year.
16 Simon invests $4000 for 3 years at 6% p.a. simple interest. Monica also invests $4000 for 3 years, but
Further development
18 mC The greatest return on a compound interest investment will be made if interest is compounded:
a monthly
C six-monthly
B quarterly
d annually
19 Find the amount at maturity for each of the following investments under compound interest.
a $3000 at 8% p.a. for 2 years interest compounded quarterly
b $2000 at 6% p.a. for 5 years interest compounded six-monthly
c $5000 invested at 12% p.a. for 4 years interest compounded monthly
d $6800 invested at 9% p.a. for 6 years interest compounded quarterly
20 Andrea invests $2050 for 4 years. For the first two years of the investment the interest rate is 6%p.a.
and for the second two years the interest rate rises to 8% p.a. Given that interest is paid quarterly,
calculate the value of Andreas investment at maturity.
21 Lily wishes to have $24 000 in her bank account after 6 years. If Lily can invest at 15.5% p.a.
with interest compounded quarterly, calculate the amount of money that she needs to place in the
investment.
22 Rita invests $10 000 at 8% p.a. simple interest. Shaun invests $9000 at 8% p.a. with interest
compounded annually.
a Which investment is worth more at the end of 5 years and by how much?
b Find the number of whole years taken for the value of Shauns investment to exceed Ritas.
23 Michelle and Jack each invest $15 000 at 7.2% p.a. Michelle earns simple interest, Jack earns
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 2.1
doc-10310
56
compound interest.
a Create a table to show the value of each investment at 5 year intervals for 30 years.
b Find the amount of interest earned by each person in the 1st and 30th year.
c Compare the growth in the value of each investment over the 30 year period.
2. Select Sheet 2, Compound Interest. This spreadsheet models a $10 000 investment at 5% p.a. interest
with interest compounded annually (one compounding period per year).
3. Use the graphing function to draw a graph showing the growth of this investment over 10 years.
Compare this graph with the graph drawn for the corresponding simple interest investment.
4. Change the number of compounding periods per year to see the change in the value of the investment.
Your graph should change as you change the information.
5. Change other information, such as the principal and interest rate, to see the change in your graph.
6. Save this spreadsheet as Compound Interest.
So far we have looked at the calculation of compounded values and the amount of compound interest
paid. Suppose we have $10 000 saved for a world holiday, which is going to cost $15 000. The best
interest rate for investing the money is at 8%, compounded quarterly. We want to know how long we
need to invest the $10 000, so that it will have a compounded value of $15 000.
To solve this example we need to calculate the value of n, having been given the values of CV, PV
and r. The best way to do this is to use a table showing the compound value interest factor for various
investments.
A compound value interest factor (CVIF) is the compounded value that $1 will amount to under a
certain investment. For example, if $1 were invested at 5% p.a. for 4years, compounded annually, its
compounded value would be $1.216. We can use this to calculate the value of other amounts of money
under the same investment pattern.
ChapTer 2 Investing money
57
For example, if $7600 were invested at 5% p.a. for 4 years, to calculate the compounded value of the
investment we multiply $7600 by the CVIF which is 1.216.
Therefore CV = $7600 1.216
= $9241.60
In this example $7600 is the present value (PV ) of the investment and $9241.60 is the compounded
value (CV).
We can therefore use the formula:
CV = PV CVIF
This formula simply states: compounded value = present value interest factor.
The CVIF table below shows the interest factors.
Interest rate per period
Periods
1%
2%
3%
4%
5%
6%
7%
8%
9%
10%
1.010
1.020
1.030
1.040
1.050
1.060
1.070
1.080
1.090
1.100
1.020
1.040
1.061
1.082
1.103
1.124
1.145
1.166
1.188
1.210
1.030
1.061
1.093
1.125
1.158
1.191
1.225
1.260
1.295
1.331
1.041
1.082
1.126
1.170
1.216
1.262
1.311
1.360
1.412
1.464
1.051
1.104
1.159
1.217
1.276
1.338
1.403
1.469
1.539
1.611
1.062
1.126
1.194
1.265
1.340
1.419
1.501
1.587
1.677
1.772
1.072
1.149
1.230
1.316
1.407
1.504
1.606
1.714
1.828
1.949
1.083
1.172
1.267
1.369
1.477
1.594
1.718
1.851
1.993
2.144
1.094
1.195
1.305
1.423
1.551
1.689
1.838
1.999
2.172
2.358
10
1.105
1.219
1.344
1.480
1.629
1.791
1.967
2.159
2.367
2.594
Use the CVIF table to find the compounded value of $4560 invested at 8% p.a. for 2 years with
interest compounded sixmonthly.
Think
WriTe
CVIF = 1.170
CV = PV CVIF
= $4560 1.170
Calculate.
= $5335.20
This table can also be used to help us calculate the present value of an investment that is required to
produce a given compounded value.
This is done using the same formula; however, you will need to solve the equation to find the value
of PV.
58
Worked example 11
Liz is 16 years old. She hopes to have $3000 in 3 years to buy a used car. She finds an investment
of 6% p.a. with interest compounded sixmonthly. Calculate the amount of money that Liz must
invest to generate a compounded value of $3000 in 3 years.
Think
1
Calculate.
WriTe
$3000
1.194
= $2512.56
Liz will need to invest $2512.56 to generate
$3000 in 3 years.
We can also use the table to determine the length of time that a given present value will take to reach a
certain compounded value. This is done by calculating the required CVIF and looking for the first CVIF
in the table, at the given interest rate, greater than that required.
Worked example 12
How long will it take $2500 to grow to $3200 when invested at 8% p.a. with interest compounded
sixmonthly?
Think
WriTe
PV = $2500, CV = $3200
CVIF =
CV = PV CVIF
$3200
$2500
= 1.28
59
1 We10 Toshika has $10 000 to invest for 4 years. The bank offers her 7% p.a. with interest
inTeraCTiViTy
int-2400
simple and compound
interest
compounded annually. Use the CVIF table on page 248 to calculate the compounded value of Toshikas
investment.
2 Greg has $8500 to invest for 5 years. A building society offers 8% p.a. with interest compounded twice
a year
a Use the CVIF table to calculate the compounded value of Gregs investment.
b Find the amount of interest earned.
3 Marlene invests $40 000 for 2 years at 8% p.a. with interest compounded quarterly. Use the CVIF table
quarterly. Use the CVIF table to calculate the future value of this investment.
5 Use the CVIF table to calculate the interest earned on each of the following investments.
a $5000 at 9% p.a. for 6 years with interest compounded annually
b $6700 at 10% p.a. for 4 years with interest compounded six-monthly
c $250 at 6% p.a. for 5 years with interest compounded six-monthly
d $23 670 at 4% p.a. for 2 years with interest compounded quarterly
e $13 250 at 8% p.a. for 18 months with interest compounded quarterly
f $115 000 at 12% p.a. for 6 months with interest compounded monthly
6 Use the formula A = P(1 + r)n to calculate the CVIF, correct to 3 decimal places, for an investment at
2.5% for:
a 1 interest period
d 4 interest periods
b 2 interest periods
e 6 interest periods
c 3 interest periods
f 8 interest periods.
7 Using the CVIFs found in question 6 will allow you to calculate each of the compounded values of the
following investments.
$900 at 2.5% p.a. for 3 years with interest compounded annually
$2340 at 5% p.a. for 2 years with interest compounded six-monthly
$7200 at 10% p.a. for 1 year with interest compounded quarterly
$11 000 at 10% p.a. for 2 years with interest compounded quarterly
$5750 at 10% p.a. for 1 12 years with interest compounded quarterly
a
b
c
d
e
B 1.035
C 1.175
d 1.188
9 mC For a certain investment the CVIF = 2.147. If the present value of the investment is $32 546, the
d $69 877
10 We11 Jason wants to save for a car in 3years. He needs to have $10 000. Use the CVIF table to
calculate the amount of money that he will need to invest at 5%p.a. with interest compounded
annually, to have $10 000 in 3 years. Give your answer correct to the nearest dollar.
60
11 We12 How long will it take $2000 to grow to $2500 when invested at 8% p.a. with interest
12
13
14
15
compounded six-monthly?
Calculate the length of time that it will take:
a $1000 to grow to $1100 at 10% p.a. with interest paid annually
b $1000 to grow to $1500 at 7% p.a. with interest paid annually
c $3000 to grow to $4000 at 6% p.a. with interest paid six-monthly
d $9000 to grow to $10 000 at 8% p.a. with interest paid quarterly
e $12 000 to grow to $17 500 at 10% p.a. with interest paid six-monthly.
Calculate the interest rate required for $1000 to grow to $1300 in 2 years, if interest is compounded
quarterly. (Hint: Find the CVIF required and use the table for 8 interest periods.)
Use the CVIF table to calculate the interest rate, to the nearest whole number, required for each of the
following investments.
a $1000 to grow to $1200 in 3 years with interest compounded annually
b $2000 to grow to $2600 in 4 years with interest compounded six-monthly
c $500 to grow to $650 in 1 year with interest compounded quarterly
d $10 000 to grow to $20 000 in 8 years with interest compounded annually
e $3500 to grow to $6000 in 5 years with interest compounded six-monthly
Bruce, Keith and Max each have $10 000 to invest over
a 5-year term.
a Bruce invests at 10% p.a. simple interest. Calculate
the value of Bruces investment at maturity.
b Keith invests at 10% p.a. with interest
compounded annually. Calculate the value of
Keiths investment at maturity, using the
CVIF table.
c Max invests at 10% p.a. with interest
compounded six-monthly. Calculate the
value of Maxs investment at maturity,
using the CVIF table.
d Calculate the total amount of interest each
man received.
e Write down the amount of interest each
received as a percentage of their original
investment.
Further development
16 Use the compound interest formula to find the value of $1 invested at 12% for 1 to 10 interest periods.
17
18
19
20
21
61
2e
share dividends
Investing money in banks and similar financial institutions is the most common type of investment, as it
is safe and the return can be calculated in advance.
An alternative to investing in a bank is to purchase shares. Shares have a risk associated with them
and there is no fixed return; however, they have the potential to return more money to the investor than
through a bank.
When buying shares you are purchasing a share of the company. In other words, you become a part
owner of that company. You can earn money from shares in two ways:
1. The profit made by a company will be paid to the companys owners (the shareholders). That part of
the profit distributed to shareholders is called a dividend.
2. The value of shares changes daily. People invest in the share market with the expectation that the
value of shares will rise and they can be sold at a profit. The risk is that the shares may fall in value.
Once or twice a year the directors of a company calculate the companys profit. A certain proportion of
the profit may be spent on developing the company, the remainder being distributed to the shareholders as
dividends.
A dividend is calculated by dividing the profit that is to be distributed by the number of shares in the
company. The dividend is then declared on a per-share basis.
Worked example 13
A company has an aftertax profit of $34.2 million. There are 90 million shares in the company.
What dividend will the company declare if all the profits are distributed to the shareholders?
Think
WriTe
We cant accurately compare the values of investments from the dividend alone. We need to consider the
money that was invested in order to earn that dividend. A 38c dividend paid by a company with a share
value of $12.00 is a lower return than a company that pays a 15c dividend and has a share value of $2.50.
To compare the true return from any investment, we need to calculate that return as a percentage of
the amount invested. For the income part of a share investment, this percentage is called the dividend
yield. To calculate the dividend yield for any share, we calculate the dividend as a percentage of the
share price.
Worked example 14
A company with a share price of $5.42 declares a dividend of 25c. Calculate the dividend yield,
correct to 2 decimal places.
Think
WriTe
exercise 2e
Dividend yield =
0.25
5.42
100%
= 4.61%
share dividends
Unless stated otherwise, for the calculations in this exercise, assume that companies distribute all their
profits as dividends.
1 We13 A company has issued 20 million shares and makes an after-tax profit of $5 million. Calculate
declared.
62
3 A company makes an after-tax profit of $150 000. If there are 2.5 million shares in the company,
the shareholders. Calculate the dividend per share in cents correct to 1 decimal place.
8 A company declares a dividend of 14 cents per share and there are 23.4 million shares in the company.
a Find the net profit of the company.
b Given that the company paid tax at the rate of 36% find the gross profit of the company.
9 A company declares a dividend of 78c. If there are 4.2 million shares in the company, calculate the
Dividend
Share price
$0.56
$8.40
$0.78
$7.40
$1.20
$23.40
$1.09
$15.76
$0.04
$0.76
12 Hsiang purchased shares in a company for $3.78 per share. The company paid Hsiang a dividend of
11c per share. Calculate the dividend yield, correct to 2 decimal places.
13 mC Which of the following companies paid the highest dividend yield?
a
B
C
d
Further development
15 Rank each of the following share performances in order
63
16 Jerry buys 1000 shares in Cannington Ltd at $5.60 each. The company pays a dividend of 57cents per
share. He also buys 500 shares in Warragul Ltd at $23.45 which pays a dividend of $1.98 per share.
a Calculate the dividend yield for Cannington Ltd.
b Calculate the dividend yield for Warragul Ltd.
c Calculate the overall dividend yield for Jerrys investment.
17 Andrea bought shares in a company for $11.50 each. The company paid a dividend of 76c/share.
a Calculate the dividend yield for this company.
b One year later the share value is $12.12. The company then has a dividend yield of 8.75%.
price is $21.50.
a Calculate the dividend paid if the dividend yield in the prospectus is paid.
b If there are 5.2 million shares in the company, calculate the after-tax profit of the company.
19 Janice buys shares in a company at $5.76. The company pays a dividend in July of 22.7c and a
dividend in February of 26.4c. Calculate the dividend yield for the whole financial year (July to the
following June).
20 The dividend paid by a company for the 200809 financial year was 5.6c/share, with a share price
of $9.50.
a Calculate the dividend yield for 200809.
b In the 200910 financial year the share price rose by 12%. Calculate the share price for this year.
c In 200910 the dividend paid to shareholders increased by 15%. Calculate the dividend paid, in
cents, correct to 1 decimal place.
d Calculate the dividend yield for 200910.
21 A company that has 18.6 million shares has an after tax profit of $25.7 million.
a Calculate the dividend paid to the shareholders.
b Calculate the dividend yield given that the share price is $10.60.
c To raise funds the company issue another two million shares. Given that the company increases its
the dividend.
2F
Because shares offer no guaranteed returns, we can only use the past performance of a share to try to
predict its future performance. This is done by graphing the value of the share at regular intervals and
then drawing a line of best fit to try to monitor the trend.
By continuing the line of best fit you can make a prediction for future share prices. This is called
extrapolating information from the graph. Interpolate is the opposite of extrapolate and occurs when
drawing a graph using data found at the end points.
Worked example 15
The graph shows the share price of a company over a 3month period.
a On the graph draw a line of best fit.
b Use your line of best fit to estimate the share price after another three months.
4.40
4.20
4.00
3.80
64
ec
D
ov
Month
ct
O
1
Se
pt
3.60
Think
WriTe/draW
4.80
Share price ($)
4.60
4.40
4.20
4.00
3.80
1
Fe
b
1
M
ar
1
Oc
t
1
No
v
1
De
c
1
Ja
n
1
Se
pt
3.60
Month
b Extend the line of best fit for three
You should be able to produce your own graph to answer this type of question from a set of data that you
have been given or have researched.
Worked example 16
Below is the share price of a company taken on the first day of the month for one year.
Month
Share price
Month
Share price
January
$10.34
July
$10.98
February
$10.54
August
$11.56
March
$10.65
September
$11.34
April
$10.89
October
$11.23
May
$10.72
November
$11.48
June
$11.10
December
$11.72
a On a set of axes plot the share price for each month and draw a line of best fit.
b Predict the share price in June of the following year.
WriTe/draW
a
Share price ($)
the data.
12.40
12.20
12.00
11.80
11.60
11.40
11.20
11.00
10.80
10.60
10.40
10.20
1
Ja
1 n
Fe
1 b
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
1 ay
Ju
1 n
J
1 ul
Au
1 g
Se
1 p
O
1 ct
No
1 v
De
1 c
Ja
1 n
Fe
1 b
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
1 ay
Ju
n
Think
Month
65
12.40
12.20
12.00
11.80
11.60
11.40
11.20
11.00
10.80
10.60
10.40
10.20
1
Ja
1 n
Fe
1 b
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
1 ay
Ju
1 n
J
1 ul
Au
1 g
Se
1 p
O
1 ct
No
1 v
De
1 c
Ja
1 n
Fe
1 b
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
1 ay
Ju
n
Month
months.
Predict the share price by reading
from the line of best fit.
exercise 2F
6.50
6.30
6.10
5.90
Month
4.50
4.00
3.50
3.00
2.50
1
M
a
1 y
Ju
n
1
Ju
1 l
Au
1 g
Se
p
1 t
Oc
1 t
No
1 v
De
c
a 6-month period.
a Copy the graph into your book and on it draw a line of
best fit.
b Use your graph to predict the value of the share on
1 February.
1
Ju
n
1
M
ay
5.70
1
Ju
l
Month
1.14
Share price ($)
1.12
1.10
1.08
1.06
1.04
1
Ja
n
1
Fe
1 b
M
a
1 r
Ap
1 r
M
a
1 y
Ju
n
1
Ju
1 l
Au
1 g
Se
p
1 t
Oc
t
1.02
Month
66
4 We16 The table below shows the share price of a large multinational company over a 12-month
period.
Month
Share price
Month
Share price
January
$12.86
July
$13.45
February
$13.43
August
$13.86
March
$11.98
September
$14.40
April
$12.10
October
$13.65
May
$12.11
November
$13.20
June
$12.98
December
$12.86
a Plot the share prices on a set of axes and on your graph draw a line of best fit.
b Use your graph to predict the value of the share after a further 6 months.
5 The table below shows the share price of BigCorp Productions Ltd over a period of one year.
Month
Share price
Month
Share price
January
$12.40
July
$13.17
February
$12.82
August
$13.62
March
$12.67
September
$13.41
April
$13.05
October
$13.30
May
$13.06
November
$13.46
June
$12.89
December
$13.20
a Graph the share price for each month and show a line of best fit.
b Use your line of best fit to predict the share price in December of the next year.
Further development
6 Shares are considered by most people to be a riskier investment than putting money in the bank.
a Suggest a reason why this may be the case.
b How is this demonstrated by the share graphs?
7 Explain why predictions are made about future share performance by using a line of best fit.
8 When drawing a line of best fit:
a What type of line is normally drawn?
b Is this type of graph necessarily the best? Explain your answer.
9 A share price has lost value over a period of years. A line of best fit is drawn on the graph of the
declining price.
a How will the vertical intercept relate to the share price?
b What do you know of the gradient of the line of best fit?
10 The graph below shows the fluctuating share price over a five year period.
a Find the equivalent simple interest rate to the growth in share price.
b Find the equivalent compound interest rate to the growth in share price.
$20
(5, $20)
$10
0
5
ChapTer 2 Investing money
67
Internet.
3 Graph the information on the share price that you have found. Include the highest and lowest point of the
share price.
2G
One of the measures of how an economy is performing is the rate of inflation. Inflation is the rise in
prices within an economy and is generally measured as a percentage. In Australia this percentage is
called the Consumer Price Index (CPI). By looking at the inflation rate, we can estimate what the cost of
various goods and services will be at some time in the future.
To estimate the future price of an item one year ahead, we increase the price of an item by the rate of
inflation.
Worked example 17
The cost of a new car is $35 000. If the inflation rate is 5%, estimate the price of the car after
one year.
Think
WriTe
When calculating the future cost of an item several years ahead, the method of calculation is the same as
for compound interest. This is because we are adding a percentage of the cost to the cost each year.
Remember the compound interest formula is A = P(1 + r)n and so in these examples P is the original
price, r is the inflation rate expressed as a decimal and n is the number of years.
Worked example 18
The cost of a television set is $800. If the average inflation rate is 4%, estimate the cost of the
television set after 5 years.
Think
WriTe
P = $800, r = 0.04, n = 5
A = P(1 + r)n
= $800 (1.04)5
Calculate.
= $973.32
A similar calculation can be made to anticipate the future value of collectable items, such as stamp
collections and memorabilia from special occasions. This type of item increases in value over time if
it becomes rare, and rises at a much greater rate than inflation. The amount by which an item grows in
value over time is known as appreciation.
68
Worked example 19
Think
WriTe
P = $250,
r = 0.2,
n = 10
A = P(1 + r)n
= $250 (1.2)10
= $1550
exercise 2G
1 We17 The cost of a motorcycle is $20 000. If the inflation rate is 4%, estimate the cost of the
beginning of 2010.
4 When the Wilson family go shopping, the
69
8 If a basket of groceries costs $98.50 in 2008, what would the estimated cost of the groceries be in 2015
five years, the cost of the soft drink in five years will be:
a $2.60
B $2.70
C $2.75
d $2.76
10 We19 Veronica bought a shirt signed by the Australian cricket team after it won the 2007 World Cup
for $200. If the value of the shirt increases by 20% per annum for the next 5 years, calculate the value
of the shirt (to the nearest $10).
11 Ken purchased a rare bottle of wine for $350. If the value of the wine is predicted to increase at
10% per annum, estimate the value of the wine in 20 years (to the nearest $10).
12 The 1968 Australian 2c piece is very rare. If a coin collector purchased one in 2012 for $400and the
value of the coin increases by 15% per year, calculate its value in 2025 (to the nearest $10).
13 Inflation figures are generally released every quarter. If the average inflation rate is 0.9% per quarter,
price of an iPod is $250 today estimate the cost of the iPod at the end of the 5 year period.
Further development
15 During a severe recession the economy goes into a state of deflation. This is where average prices fall.
If, over a 2 year period the deflation average is 0.2% per quarter, find the price of a new car that was
priced at $35 000 at the beginning of the period.
16 At the beginning of 2011 the average wage was $745 per week and the average basket of groceries cost
$143.50.
a What percentage of the average wage was the cost of the average basket of groceries?
b Over the next three years inflation is expected to be 4.1% p.a. Estimate the cost of the average
basket of groceries at the end of the three years.
c Over the same period of time wages are expected to rise by only 3% p.a. Estimate the average
wage at the end of the three year period.
d Economists say that wages over the three years have dropped in real terms. By comparing the
cost of an average basket of groceries and wages at the beginning and end of the three year period
explain what the economists mean.
70
17 Eddie has $15 000 to invest. In three years he wants to buy a car that currently costs $18 000. Eddie
invests his money at 4.8% p.a. with interest compounded quarterly. Over the same period inflation is
expected to average 0.85% per quarter.
a How much more money does Eddie need to purchase the car at the beginning of the three year
period?
b Calculate how far short Eddie is of the money needed to purchase the car at the end of the
three years.
18 Consider an investment of $1000 at 5% p.a. for one year in a period where inflation is running at
3.5% p.a.
a What will the $1000 investment be worth after one year?
b What will the cost of $1000 worth of goods be after one year?
c Write the value of the investment after one year as a percentage of the cost of $1000 worth of
goods after one year.
d By what percentage has the investment grown in real terms?
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 2.2
doc-10311
71
Summary
simple interest
Simple interest is interest paid where the interest is not added to the principal before the next
interest calculation.
It is calculated using the formula:
I = Prn
where P is the initial quantity, r is the percentage interest rate per annum expressed as a decimal
and n is the number of periods.
It can be graphed as a linear function.
Compound interest
Compound interest is the interest added to the principal before the next interest calculation is made.
It can be calculated by using the formula:
A = P(1 + r)n
where A is the final balance, P is the initial quantity, r is the percentage interest rate per interest
period expressed as a decimal and n is the number of compounding periods.
The amount of compound interest paid is found by subtracting the principal from the future value
of the investment.
Compound interest can be calculated by using a table of compounded values of $1.
shares
When you buy shares you purchase a share in the company. There is no guaranteed return with
shares, although there is a greater potential for profit than with investments such as banking and
property, but with that comes a higher risk.
Profit can be made from buying shares in two ways:
(a) The value of the share could rise over time.
(b) The company may pay a dividend to its shareholders. The dividend when written as a
percentage of the share price is called the dividend yield.
To try to predict the future movement in share prices, we can graph the past movement in the share
price and draw a line of best fit on the graph. This line of best fit can be extrapolated to estimate
the future price.
inflation and
appreciation
The price of goods and services rise from year to year. To predict the future price of an item, we
can use the compound interest formula taking the rate of inflation to be r.
The same method is used to predict the future value of collectables and of memorabilia, which tend
to rise at a rate greater than inflation.
72
Chapter review
1 The simple interest paid on $5600 at 5.6% for 3 years is:
a $940.80
C $6540.80
m U lTip l e
C ho iC e
B $994.46
d $6594.47
2 The compound interest paid on $5600 at 5.6% for 3 years with interest compounded annually is:
a $940.80
C $6540.80
B $994.46
d $6594.47
3 A share is valued at $23.40. Greg buys 4000 shares and, at the end of the financial year, Greg receives a
by how much can we expect the cost of the basket of groceries to rise?
a $1.95
B $1.96
C $69.45
d $69.46
s ho rT
a n s W er
1 Calculate the simple interest earned on an investment of $5000 at 4% p.a. for 5 years.
2 Calculate the simple interest earned on each of the following investments.
a $3600 at 9% p.a. for 4 years
b $23 500 at 6% p.a. for 2 years
c $840 at 2.5% p.a. for 2 years
d $1350 at 0.2% p.a. for 18 months
1
e $45 820 at 4.75% p.a. for 3 2 years
3 Dion invests $32 500 in a debenture paying 5.6% simple interest for 4 years.
a Calculate the interest earned by Dion.
b Calculate the total value of Dions investment after 4 years.
c If the debenture paid Dion in quarterly instalments, calculate the value of each interest payment.
4 Bradley invests $15 000 for a period of 4 years. Calculate the simple interest rate, given that Bradley
No. of years
Interest
b Draw a graph of the interest earned against the length of the investment.
c What is the gradient of the linear graph drawn?
d Use your graph to find the amount of interest that would have been earned after 10 years.
7 Vicky invests $2400 at 5% p.a. for 3 years with interest compounded annually. Calculate the
73
investments.
a $6000 at 7% p.a. for 4 years with interest compounded annually
b $7230 at 9% p.a. for 7 years with interest compounded annually
c $3695 at 6% p.a. for 3 years with interest compounded six-monthly
d $12 400 at 10% p.a. for 5 years with interest compounded six-monthly
e $2400 at 4% p.a. for 2 years with interest compounded quarterly
13 A company that has 10.9 million shares makes a profit of $21 million. If this entire amount is distributed
on this investment.
17 The dividend yield from a share valued at $19.48 is 4.2%. Calculate the dividend paid by the company,
Month
Share price
January
$15.76
February
$16.04
March
$16.27
April
$16.12
May
$16.49
June
$16.39
July
$16.60
August
$16.77
September
$16.51
October
$16.71
November
$16.69
December
$16.98
currently costs $125, estimate the cost of the skateboard after five years.
21 In 1985, Cherie bought a limited edition photograph autographed by Sir Donald Bradman for $120. If
the photograph appreciates in value by 15% per annum, calculate the value of the photograph in 2015
(to the nearest $100).
74
1 Jaclyn has $7500 saved for a holiday that she plans to take in two years time.
a If Jaclyn invests the money in a debenture that pays 4.2% p.a. simple interest, calculate the
e x Ten d ed
res p o n s e
b An alternative investment for Jaclyn would be to invest her money at 4% p.a. for two years with
interest compounding quarterly. Would this be a better investment? Explain your answer.
c Jaclyn finally decided to buy 1500 shares in a company at $5.00 each. For the past year the
dividend yield for this company was 5.1%. Is this a safe investment for Jaclyn?
d After two years, the average dividend yield for this company was 4.8% p.a. of Jaclyns initial
investment and the shares were valued at $5.75 each. Calculate the total value of Jaclyns
investment.
e Calculate Jaclyns profit as a percentage of her initial investment.
2 Frank has saved $30 000 to buy a new car. He decides to try to get another two years use out of his
old car and in the meantime invest the money he has saved.
a If Frank invests the $30 000 at 3.5% p.a. for two years with interest compounded annually,
calculate the money that Frank has at the end of the investment.
b Over the two years that Frank has invested his money, the inflation rate has averaged 4.2%p.a.
Calculate the cost of the car at the end of this two years if the price rose at the same rate as
inflation (to the nearest $100).
c How much more money does Frank now need to buy the new car?
diGiTal doC
Test Yourself
doc-10312
Chapter 2
75
ICT activities
2a
diGiTal doCs
GC program Casio (doc-1544): Interest (page 46)
GC program TI (doc-1545): Interest (page 46)
Spreadsheet (doc-1546): Interest (page 46)
2B
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet (doc-1546): Interest (page 52)
2C
diGiTal doCs
Spreadsheet (doc-1552): Compound interest (pages 55, 57)
WorkSHEET 2.1 (doc-10310): Apply knowledge of interest calculations
to questions. (page 56)
inTeraCTiViTy
int-0810: Compound interest (page 53)
76
2G
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 2.2 (doc-10311): Apply knowledge of interest and
inflation rates to problems. (page 71)
Chapter review
diGiTal doC
Test Yourself Chapter 2 (doc-10312): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 75)
Answers CHAPTER 2
exercise 2a
Calculation of simple
interest
1 $600
2 a $120
b $615
c $21 420
d $6656.85
e $90
f $684.47
3 a $2240
b $11 200
4 a $2400
b $12 400
5 $8648.80
6 a $5.25
b $145.25
7 a $448.63
b $224.32
c $9558.84
8 $850.50
9A
10 C
11 $131.86
12 18 months
13 $6250
14 C
15 a $627.13
b $12 542.50
16 a $2250
b $13 500
1
c 7 years
2
Interest ($)
3
4
Years
Interest ($)
Interest ($)
5 a
3
Years
2 a
Interest ($)
16 000
14 000
12 000
10 000
8000
6000
4000
2000
0
c 1600
d $16 000
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Years
Interest
(3.75%)
$165.00
$192.50
$206.25
$330.00
$385.00
$412.50
$495.00
$577.50
$618.75
2
3
Years
$660.00
$770.00
$825.00
$825.00
$962.50
$1031.25
10 000
3.75%
3.5%
3%
1500
1000
5000
1
2 3 4
Years
500
0
2 3 4
Years
400
300
11
200
100
1
2 3 4
Years
5000
6.2%
5.8%
5.2%
4500
4000
0
4000
Interest
(3.5%)
15 000
Investment ($)
Interest
(3%)
1000
500
No. of
years
2000
1000
3000
1500
No. of
years
20 000
2000
Interest ($)
9 a
200
Interest ($)
2 3 4
Years
400
600
Interest ($)
No. of
years
800
4 288
1 a
4000
5000
functions
2 3 4
Years
8%
6%
5%
10 000
0
1
1000
$18 750
18 $21 562.50
$5580
a $4560
b $16 888.89
4 years and 8 months
Ted is correct because interest is calculated
only upon the principal and interest paid
earns no interest.
23 Chris is incorrect. If the interest rate
doubles the amount of interest paid will
double, but the principal will remain the
same.
Interest
2000
17
19
20
21
22
exercise 2B
4000
6000
Interest ($)
Interest ($)
3 a
Interest ($)
inVesTinG money
3000
Years
2000
12 a 96
b The interest earned each year
c $1600
13 a $2000
b 10% p.a.
c $3600
14 This statement is correct as the amount
1000
1
3
Years
6 a
No. of
years
Interest
(5%)
Interest
(6%)
Interest
(8%)
$1250
$1500
$2000
$2500
$3000
$4000
$3750
$4500
$6000
$5000
$6000
$8000
$6250
$7500
$10 000
77
$15 000
$15 000
$20 400
$21 235.63
10
$25 800
$30 063.47
15
$31 200
$42 561.12
20
$36 600
$60 254.15
25
$42 000
$85 302.33
30
$47 400
$120 763.26
78
exercise 2e
1
2
3
4
share dividends
25c/share
$1.50/share
6c/share
29.27c/share
21
22
Dividend
yield
$0.56
$8.40
6.7%
$0.78
$7.40
10.5%
$1.20
$23.40
5.1%
$1.09
$15.76
6.9%
$0.04
$0.76
5.3%
2.91%
B
$364
DCBA
a 10.2%
b 8.4%
c 9%
a 6.6%
b $1.06/share
a $1.44
b $7.4906 million
8.5%
a 0.59%
b $10.64
c 6.4c/share
d 0.61%
a $1.38/share
b 13%
c 12.9%
Because the dividend yield expresses the
share market dividend as a percentage
of the share price hence making it
comparable to other shares and other
forms of investment.
1 a
Share price ($)
17
18
19
20
Share
price
7.30
7.10
6.90
6.70
6.50
6.30
6.10
5.90
5.70
1
M
ay
1
Ju
n
1
Ju
l
1
Au
g
1
Se
pt
1
Oc
t
Jack (CI)
12
13
14
15
16
Dividend
Month
b Approximately $7.60
2 a
4.50
4.00
3.50
3.00
2.50
Ju
1 n
J
1 ul
A
1 ug
Se
1 pt
O
1 ct
N
1 ov
D
e
1 c
Ja
1 n
Fe
1 b
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
ay
5 a $1.224 million
b $2.176 million
c 43.52c/share
6 a $9.28 million
b $6.08 million
c $0.76/share
7 a $46.336 million
b 82.7c
8 a $3.276 million
b $5.118 75 m illion
9 $3.276 million
10 4.57%
11
23 a
b Approximately $2.00
3 a
17 a
b
18 a
c
2.04
2.02
2.00
1.18
1.16
1.14
1.12
1.10
1.08
1.06
1.04
1.02
1.00
mUlTiple ChoiCe
1 A
3 C
1
J
1 an
F
1 eb
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
1 ay
J
1 un
1 Jul
A
1 ug
Se
1 pt
O
1 ct
No
1 v
D
1 ec
J
1 an
F
1 eb
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
1 ay
J
1 un
1 Jul
A
1 ug
Se
1 pt
Oc
t
14.00
1 $1000
2 a $1296
d $4.05
3 a $7280
4 6.5%
5 15 months
6 a
No. of years
12.00
10.00
1
Ja
1 n
Fe
1 b
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
1 ay
Ju
1 n
J
1 ul
Au
1 g
Se
1 p
O
1 ct
No
1 v
De
1 c
Ja
1 n
Fe
1 b
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
1 ay
Ju
n
16.00
Month
Interest
b
Interest ($)
b Approximately $15.00
5 a
14.50
14.00
13.50
13.00
b $14.50
6 a Because share prices go up and down.
b The graph of the share price is irregular reflecting the rises and
falls.
7 The line of best fit is the average trend over a period of time.
8 a Straight line
b Not always as the growth may be exponential (the same shape as
1 $20 800
2 a $618
b $48.15
c $1.91
d $579.60
e $932.40
3 a $878.05
b $901.76
4 $117.90
5 $619
6 $2.52
7 $1.20
8 $122.80
9 D
10 $500
11 $2350
12 $2460
13 a $1.22
b $3.56
c $95.76
d $1837.29
e $389 728.38
14 $290.07
15 $34 443.90
16 a 19.26%
b $161.88
c $814.08
d The average basket of groceries now takes up 19.88% of the
c $42
c $455
$450
$900
$1350
$1800
$2250
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Years
c 450
d $4500
7 $2778.30
8 $5700.47
9 a $3932.39
b
d $23 851.00
e
10 $756.94
11 a $12 024.02
b $12 052.04
c Compounding interest
12 a $7866
b
d $20 199.60
e
13 $1.93/share
14 $14.74/share
15 5.22%
16 1.6%
17 0.82c/share
18 a
Share price ($)
Month
4500
4000
3500
3000
2500
2000
1500
1000
500
0
b $2820
e $7617.58
b $39 780
$12 596.90
$5334.67
c $14 457.96
$13 216.44
$2599.20
c $4411.83
17.00
16.50
16.00
15.50
1
Ja
1 n
Fe
1 b
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
1 ay
Ju
1 n
J
1 ul
Au
1 g
Se
1 pt
O
1 ct
No
1 v
De
c
12.50
12.00
1
Ja
1 n
F
1 eb
M
1 ar
A
1 pr
M
1 ay
Ju
1 n
J
1 ul
Au
1 g
Se
1 pt
O
1 ct
No
1 v
De
c
2 B
4 B
shorT ansWer
b Approximately $1.20
4 a
exercise 2G
b $1035
d 1.45%
ChapTer reVieW
Month
9 a
b
10 a
b
$3000
$2615.89
$1050
101.45%
Month
b Approximately $18.00
19 $83.44
20 $149.90
21 $7900
exTended response
1 a
b
c
d
e
2 a
$8130
No. The investment will be worth only $8121.43.
No. Jaclyn could lose the money she has saved for her holiday.
$9345
24.6%
$32 136.75
b $32 600
c $436.17
79
ChapTer 3
Taxation
ChapTer ConTenTS
3a
3B
3C
3d
3e
3F
3a
The government collects taxes in order to pay for government services. There are several different ways
in which the government collects these taxes. The one with which we are most familiar is income tax;
however, there are several other forms of tax used by the government to collect money. In this chapter,
we look at how taxes are calculated and collected.
In Chapter 1, we looked at earning money. We learned that the gross pay was the wage or salary
paid by the employer. Before the employee receives this money, deductions are taken out. The amount
actually received by the worker is called the net pay. There may be several payments taken out of a
persons gross pay, but for most people the largest deduction is income tax.
Everyone who earns over a certain amount must pay income tax. Income tax is paid on an increasing
scale, depending on the amount you earn. Most people pay income tax in each pay period. This is called
Pay As You Go tax (PAYG tax). At the end of each financial year, which runs from July 1 of one year
to June 30 the following year, people who earn income must submit a tax return. A tax return is used to
calculate the amount of tax that should have been paid and compares this with the amount of PAYG tax
paid. The taxpayer then either receives a refund or must pay the amount owing.
The amount of tax paid is calculated using your taxable income. Taxable income is your gross pay
less any allowable tax deductions.
Deductions are allowed for expenses incurred while earning an income. For example, a builder is allowed
a tax deduction for the cost of tools, or a bank teller who wears a uniform may be allowed a deduction for the
dry-cleaning of that uniform. Deductions are also allowed for donations to charity over $2.
Worked example 1
A large company employs Ken as a plumber. Ken claims deductions of $1400 to buy tools, $25 for
gumboots, $200 for two pairs of work overalls, $5 per week for dry-cleaning the overalls and $1.50
per week for work-related telephone calls. Calculate Kens total deductions.
Think
WriTe
Dry-cleaning = $5 52
= $260
Telephone = $1.50 52
= $78
ChapTer 3 Taxation
81
People who use their own car for work are entitled to claim a portion of the running costs as a deduction.
The amount of the deduction is based on the size of the engine and the number of kilometres travelled.
The tax deduction covers the cost of the fuel and a portion of the long-term costs of running a car such
as registration, insurance, depreciation and maintenance.
Worked example 2
Raylene is a computer programmer. As part of her job she uses her own car to travel to visit
clients and to attend training seminars. Raylenes car is a 2.4 litre Mitsubishi Lancer, for which
she is allowed a deduction of 74 c/km. Calculate the size of the tax deduction in a year where she
travels 2547 km on work-related matters.
Think
WriTe
Tax deductions are also allowed for the depreciation of major equipment. For example, a teacher may
own a home computer that is used to prepare lessons and store marks. The computer loses value as it
becomes older and so a tax deduction is allowed for this.
Worked example 3
Trevor is an accountant who works from home. He owns a personal computer that is used as part
of his job. Trevor bought a new computer on 1 July 2010 for $3200. Each year he is allowed a 33%
deduction for the depreciation of the computer. Calculate the tax deduction allowed in:
a the 201011 financial year
b the 201112 financial year.
Think
WriTe
= 0.33 $3200
= $1056
= $2144
Another form of tax deduction comes for the cost of property needed while working. If you run a
business from a shop or house, the cost of these premises is tax deductible. This includes expenses such
as rent, interest on a loan if buying the property, rates, electricity and telephone. If the business is run
from the family home, then a percentage of these expenses is allowed.
Worked example 4
Wendy runs a confectionery shop in a shopping centre. She pays rent of $400 per week, has an
electricity bill of $326 per quarter and a telephone bill of $276 per month. Calculate the deduction
that Wendy is entitled to.
Think
1
82
WriTe
Rent = $400 52
= $20 800
Electricity = $326 4
= $1304
Telephone = $276 12
= $3312
exercise 3a
1 Ki-Yeong has a gross annual income of $39 650 and allowable tax deductions of $934. Calculate
binoculars, $25 per week for admittance to sporting events and $1250 for travel. Calculate Matts total
tax deductions.
ChapTer 3 Taxation
83
7 We 2 Rajid uses his car as part of his job as an insurance assessor. He has a 1.6 L Nissan Tiida for
which he is allowed a deduction of 63 c/km. Calculate the tax deduction Rajid is allowed in a year
where he claims 3176 km in work-related travel.
8 The table below shows the rate per kilometre allowed as a tax deduction for travel in a private vehicle
Allowable deduction
63 c/km
74 c/km
75 c/km
Calculate the total tax deduction allowed for a person who claims:
2000 km in a Mazda-2 with a 1.3 L engine
2645 km in a Toyota Corolla with a 1.8 L engine
1564 km in a Ford Focus with a 2.5 L engine
2900 km in a Holden Commodore with a 3.6 L engine.
9 Briony uses her car for work related matters. During the year she changed cars. Briony did 2943km in
her 1.4 litre Mazda 3 before upgrading to a 2.2 litre. She then did 1854 km in the new car. Find the total
amount of Brionys tax deduction for travel.
a
b
c
d
10 Calculate the difference in tax deductions allowed for 2700 km of travel between a 1.6 L vehicle and a
2.6 L vehicle.
11 We 3 Bruce is a teacher with a home computer that he purchased for $2500. If a 40% tax deduction is
allowed for depreciation, calculate the tax deduction that Bruce is allowed in:
a the first financial year
b the second financial year
c the third financial year.
12 Jeff is a builder. At the end of the 200607
84
Further development
16 Greg is a graphic designer who works from home. He has set up one room in the house as his office. In
17
18
19
20
3B
Taxable income
A persons taxable income is the income on which their tax is calculated. Most people have PAYG tax
deducted from their wage or salary throughout the year. The amount of PAYG tax deducted each week or
fortnight is the amount that would be paid, if this amount was earned each week for the entire financial
year.
When calculating the amount of PAYG tax to deduct from an employees pay, the employer makes no
consideration of possible tax deductions or other sources of income.
When a taxpayer completes a tax return at the end of the financial year, the amount of tax that should
have been paid is calculated based on their taxable income. Taxable income is the gross income earned
from all sources less any tax deductions.
ChapTer 3 Taxation
85
When calculating total income you must include your income from all sources. This means that you
include any job for which you received payment throughout the year and other incomes such as interest,
profits from shares, rental income etc.
Worked example 5
Michael is a carpet layer who earned a gross pay of $34 500 during the 201011 financial year.
Michael also earned $278.50 for working as a polling officer during a State election and received
$148.63 in interest from his bank accounts. Michaels total tax deductions for the year were
$1846.30. Calculate Michaels taxable income.
Think
WriTe
In order to calculate a persons taxable income, you may need to calculate their income from a variety of
sources and make a number of calculations about tax deductions.
Worked example 6
Murray works as a full-time jackeroo and plays two evenings per week in a band. Murray earns
$471.52 per week from his full-time job and $118.53 per week from playing in the band. During
the year Murray also earned $87.52 in interest from his bank accounts.
a Calculate Murrays total gross income.
b It is 15 km from the property where Murray works to the club where he plays. When
someone has two jobs, the cost of travel between jobs is tax deductible. If Murray is
allowed a tax deduction of 45.7 c/km for travel, calculate the travel deduction that he is
entitled to claim.
c If Murray has other tax deductions of $948.50, calculate his taxable income.
Think
between jobs.
= $24 519.04
Band earnings = $118.53 52
= $6163.56
= 104
Total km = 104 15
= 1560 km
86
WriTe
= $1661.42
exercise 3B
Taxable income
1 We5 Fernando earns a gross salary of $45 900 per year. His tax deductions total $2145.75. Calculate
Janelle also earned $238.79 in interest from her bank accounts. She also had tax deductions totalling
$2340.45. Calculate Janelles taxable income.
Paula worked as a receptionist and earned a gross wage of $418.50 per week. Paula also earned $45 per
week from a second job conducting telephone surveys. Paula had a bank account that paid her $117.40
in interest.
a Calculate Paulas total income.
b If Paula had tax deductions totalling $1956.80, calculate her taxable income.
Janine has two part-time jobs. For one job she is paid $196.50 per week and for the other she is paid
$395.60 per fortnight.
a Calculate Janines gross annual income.
b If Janine claims tax deductions of $428.40, calculate her taxable income.
Tavit is a telephone salesman. He is paid a commission of 5% of all sales. Over the year, Tavit makes
sales that total $850 000.
a Calculate the gross commission that Tavit earned.
b Tavit makes $10 worth of phone calls that are tax deductable per day (5 days per week). Calculate
the tax deduction that he will claim.
c If Tavit has no other tax deductions, calculate his taxable income.
We6 Stefan worked as a hairdresser and earned a gross wage of $537.90 per week.
He also worked part-time at TAFE for a wage of $112.80 per week. Stefans income
from various investments was $425.90 for the year.
a Calculate Stefans gross annual income.
b Stefan travelled 12 km between the hairdressing salon and TAFE, 80 times during
the year. If he is allowed a tax deduction of 74 c/km for travel, calculate the amount
that Stefan will claim.
c If Stefan has other tax deductions totalling $1560, calculate Stefans taxable income.
mC Waynes gross fortnightly pay is $1156.60. He has tax deductions of $5 per week
for dry-cleaning his work uniform, $50per month in work-related travel expenses and
$348 per year in union dues. Waynes taxable income is:
a $28 863.60
B $29 653
C $29 668.60
d $60 143.20
Garry has a net annual income of $45 670 after tax deductions of $7450. Find Garrys
gross income.
Further development
10 Nicole has a gross income of $48 730 and a net income of $34 970. Calculate the amount that Nicole
he owns in Newcastle.
a Calculate Andrews gross annual income.
b Andrew travels 320 km to Newcastle and back four times a year to inspect his propertyandis
allowed a tax deduction of 63 c/km. Andrew is also entitled to a deduction of $1200 forthe
council rates, $4325 in interest on his loan for the property and $287.50 for insurance. Andrew
claims $2340 in other deductions associated with his work. Calculate his total deductions.
c Calculate Andrews taxable income.
12 Sandra works from home as an editor for a book company. Sandra is paid $986.50 per fortnight.
a Calculate Sandras annual gross income.
b Sandra has one room of her house set up as an office. This room is 15% of the area of the house.
If Sandras total household expenses are $9800 per year, calculate the deduction that she can
claim for her home office.
ChapTer 3 Taxation
87
c Sandra bought a $3850 computer. If Sandra claims 40% of this value as a tax deduction for
week. If the distance is 50 km and Sandra is allowed a deduction at the rate of 51.9 c/km, calculate
the amount that Sandra can claim for a travel deduction.
e Calculate Sandras taxable income.
13 Georgia earns $13.40 per hour in her
retainer.
a Calculate Ians gross income given that his annual sales are $185 750.
b Ian has the following tax deductions, $120 per week for the telephone, 10% of his household
bills of $8750 for his home office and 780 km in travel at 74 cents per kilometre. Calculate Ians
taxable income.
15 Explain what is meant by the terms:
a gross income
b taxable income.
88
1. From your Maths Quest Preliminary Mathematics General eBookPLUS, open the spreadsheet
Tax Calculator.
Enter the following data for income into Sheet 1, Taxable Income:
salary $44 500, casual work $1258.50 and interest $258.50. You should now see a total income of
$46 017.
2. The spreadsheet has a section that calculates the size of various deductions. Scroll down to row 23,
where you will see calculation areas for travel, home office and depreciation.
(a) In cell B24 enter 2200 for the kilometres travelled and in B25 enter 3 for the engine capacity of
the car.
(b) We will now do a similar calculation to find the home office deduction. Enter the following data
for home office.
Home Office Calculator
170
House area (m2)
Office area (m2)
17
Interest/rent
$4500.00
Rates
$1150.00
Telephone
$600.00
Electricity
$800.00
Gas
Insurance
$350.00
Other
(c) The final section we will include is a depreciation calculator. Enter the following data for
depreciation.
Depreciation Calculator
Item
Value
Rate
Amount
Computer
$4000
40%
Car
Capital equipment
$5000
25%
Other
$500
25%
3. Scroll up to the top of your spreadsheet. The results appear in the main calculation section. For Union
fees enter $352, for Charity donations enter $90 and for Other enter $125. You should now see the total
of all allowable deductions and the taxable income.
ChapTer 3 Taxation
89
3C
medicare levy
Medicare is Australias national health care scheme. As part of our tax, we pay the Medicare levy. In
return for this, Medicare pays for basic health care services, such as visits to your local doctor, x-rays
and pathology.
The basic Medicare levy is 1.5% of taxable income. This is the rate that the majority of people pay. People
who are on low incomes do not pay any Medicare levy or pay the levy at a reduced rate.
Worked example 7
Calculate the Medicare levy for a person with an annual taxable income of $44 300.
Think
WriTe
In Australia the government encourages people to take out private health insurance in addition to
Medicare. This is to take the pressure off the public health system. They encourage people to do this in
two ways.
1. The government provides a 30% rebate (refund) on the cost of the private health insurance.
2. People on higher incomes who do not have private health insurance are charged the Medicare levy
surcharge. This surcharge is a further 1% of taxable income. The income threshold upon which
families are charged the Medicare levy surcharge is shown by the table below.
Number of dependent children
01
2
3
4
More than 4 dependent children
For a single person the surcharge applies if their income exceeds $50 000 per annum.
Worked example 8
Calculate the total Medicare levy (including surcharge) paid by a person who has two children, no
private health insurance and a taxable income of $164 000 per annum.
Think
WriTe
exercise 3C
medicare levy
1 We7 Calculate the Medicare levy for a person whose taxable income is $39 870.
2 Calculate the Medicare levy for a person with a taxable income of:
a $43 250
b $56 745
90
c $94 000.
family?
6 We8 Calculate the total Medicare levy (including surcharge) paid by a person who has three children,
no private health insurance and a taxable income of $184 000 per annum.
7 Calculate the total Medicare levy (including surcharge) paid by a person who has eight children, no
private health insurance and a taxable income of $140 000 per annum.
8 James has an annual income of $250 000 and is single with no children. The cost of private health
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 3.1
doc-10313
insurance for James would be $950 per year. Calculate how much James would save each year by
joining a private health fund as opposed to having to pay the Medicare levy surcharge.
Further development
9 James pays $597 in Medicare levy. Calculate his taxable income.
10 Tim has a gross income of $51 000 per year. He does not have private health insurance.
a Calculate the Medicare levy that Tim must pay including the 1% surcharge.
b Tim is able to find $1500 in tax deductions. This brings his income below the threshold for the
1 At the time of writing, the Medicare levy was 1.5% of gross income. This is reviewed each year in the
3d
Calculating tax
The amount of PAYG tax payable is based on a table that shows the annual tax payable in 201112. This
annual amount is then divided into a weekly or fortnightly amount.
Taxable income is broken into five tax brackets. As you earn more money the rate of tax increases,
as shown in the table below. The table is based on whole dollar amounts and so any cents earned are
ignored for the purposes of calculating tax.
Note that we do not round off when ignoring cents; we always round down. For example, a person
who earns $35 956.90 has their tax calculated on $35 956.
Taxable income
0$6000
Nil
$6001$37 000
ChapTer 3 Taxation
91
From the 201112 taxation rate table above we can see that there are five tax brackets:
Bracket 1: People who earn less than $6000 per year pay no tax.
Bracket 2: People who earn between $6001 and $37 000 pay 15c for every dollar over $6000.
Bracket 3: People who earn between $37 001 and $80 000 pay $4650 plus 30c for every dollar over
$37 000.
Bracket 4: People who earn between $80 001 and $180 000 pay $17 550 plus 37c for every dollar over
$80 000.
Bracket 5: People who earn over $180 000 pay $54 550 plus 45c for every dollar over $180 000.
To calculate the amount of PAYG tax that should be deducted from a persons income, we need to see
what tax bracket they are in and then apply the appropriate rule.
Worked example 9
WriTe
Apply the rule $4650 plus 30c for each $1 over $37 000.
Calculate.
= $5430
When calculating the total amount of tax payable, this income tax must be added to the Medicare levy.
Worked example 10
WriTe
Apply the rule $17 550 plus 37c for every dollar over
$80 000.
c Add the Medicare levy to the income tax to find the total
tax payable.
= $20 675
When calculating the weekly tax payable, it is assumed that the gross amount earned that week is earned
for the whole year, without consideration of tax deductions. The Medicare levy is taken out as part of
PAYG tax. The yearly amount of tax is then calculated using this amount, then divided into a weekly
payment.
92
Worked example 11
Trevor earns a gross wage of $772.70 per week. Calculate the amount of PAYG tax that is deducted
by his employer.
Think
WriTe
PAYG tax taken out by an employer is based on the pay being the employees only source of income
without tax deductions. In most cases this means that the amount of tax paid by the end of the year will
not be correct. For this reason, every taxpayer must complete a tax return.
Before completing a tax return the taxpayer must collect a payment summary from each of their
employers. A payment summary is a statement of gross earnings and the amount of PAYG tax that has
been deducted from those earnings.
In a tax return, all payment summaries are collected to find the total gross income and total PAYG
tax already paid. All allowable deductions are then subtracted to calculate taxable income. The correct
amount of tax is then calculated. Based on this calculation, the taxpayer will then either receive a refund
or pay the difference.
Worked example 12
Catherines gross annual salary as a veterinarians assistant is $44 500. She has paid $7567.70
in PAYG tax. Catherine has also earned $560.40 in interest from an investment and has tax
deductions totalling $2345.
a Calculate Catherines taxable income.
b Calculate the tax payable on Catherines taxable income, including the Medicare levy.
c Calculate the amount that Catherine should receive as a tax refund or the amount of
Catherines tax debt.
Think
WriTe
= $42 715.40
bracket.
2
93
The Federal Labor Government, led by Prime Minister Julia Gillard, introduced a carbon tax
which took effect from 1 July 2012. While this tax was to be paid by big businesses, households were
compensated from any resulting price increases through the application of new taxation rates.
The following rates for 201213 apply from 1July 2012.
Taxable income
0$18 200
Nil
exercise 3d
Calculating tax
1 We 9 Use the income tax table on page 91 to calculate the income tax payable on an annual taxable
cents).
94
4 Gregory earns a gross pay of $1963.80 per fortnight. Calculate the annual amount of tax that Gregory
Medicare levy that will be deducted from Henrys pay over a full year will be:
a $4152.84
B $4658.12
C $10 105.68
d $33 685.60
13 mC Ian receives a gross pay of $822.50 per week. The only deduction that Ian has taken from his
gross pay is tax including Medicare levy. Ians net weekly pay will be:
a $122.72
B $135.05
C $687.45
d $699.78
14 Natasha has a gross monthly salary of $6780. Calculate the amount of tax that Natalie has deducted
PAYMENT SUMMARY
Wendell Hancock
Gross income:
$39 600.00
PAYG tax deducted: $6024.00
95
c During the year Raymond earned $45.15 in bank interest and had tax deductions totalling $1296.
Calculate the amount of tax that Raymond should pay for the year, including the Medicare levy
based on his annual taxable income.
d Calculate his refund or tax debt.
Further development
17 Vonda Flockhart is employed by day as a journalist and by night as a radio announcer. Her payment
Job 2
PAYMENT SUMMARY
PAYMENT SUMMARY
Vonda Flockhart
Journalist
Gross income:
$35 000.00
PAYG tax deducted: $4875.00
Vonda Flockhart
Radio announcer
Gross income:
PAYG tax deducted:
$9605.00
$4322.25
a Calculate Vondas gross annual pay from both jobs and the total amount of PAYG tax that Vonda
has paid.
b Vonda earned $184.40 in interest from bank accounts and had $3276 worth of tax deductions for
Medicare levy.
d Calculate the tax refund that Vonda is owed.
18 Jelena receives a gross weekly pay of $1350.52.
a Calculate the amount of PAYG tax, including the Medicare levy, that Jelena should have deducted
that property total $23 500 per annum. Calculate Lois taxable income.
Note: When expenses exceed the income this is called negative gearing.
c Calculate the amount of tax including Medicare levy that Lois should pay.
d Calculate the amount of tax refund that Lois should receive.
20 Clark is also a journalist and receives $68 600 per annum.
a Calculate the PAYG tax including Medicare levy that Clark should have deducted from his pay
any tax on this amount. Clark has a deduction of 4590 km in travel between jobs at a rate of
75cents per kilometre. Calculate Clarks taxable income.
c Calculate the tax including Medicare levy that Clark should pay.
d Calculate the amount of Clarks tax refund or tax debt.
21 Jimmy is a photographer and has a gross salary of $x and has had the correct amount of tax deducted
from his fortnightly pay. At the end of the financial year Jimmy has deductions of $1340 but has earned
$976 in interest from some investments. Explain whether Jimmy will receive a tax refund or have to
pay a tax debt.
22 Explain what is meant by each of the following terms:
a PAYG tax
b tax return
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1608
Tax calculator
96
c tax refund.
1. From your Maths Quest Preliminary Mathematics General ebookPLUS, open the spreadsheet Tax
Calculator.
If you saved your information from the taxable income, then the second spreadsheet, Income Tax,
reads the taxable income and does the appropriate calculations for income tax and the Medicare levy.
2. The formula in cell B7 calculates the Medicare levy by taking 1.5% of the taxable income.
3. The income tax is calculated by making a calculation for the appropriate tax bracket only. This figure
is then transferred to the top of the spreadsheet and added with the Medicare levy to calculate the total
tax payable.
3e
When you purchase most items you must pay the GST on that item. GST stands for Goods and Services
Tax. The GST is a tax amounting to 10% of the purchase price of that item. Some items are exempt from
the GST. These include fresh food, some educational costs and some medical costs.
The GST is an example of an indirect tax. This is because the individual does not pay the tax directly
to the government and there is no record kept of who is paying the tax. The tax is collected at the point
of sale.
To calculate the amount of GST payable on an item, we simply calculate 10% of the purchase price.
Worked example 13
A cricket bat has a pre-GST price of $127.50. Calculate the GST payable on the purchase of the
bat.
Think
WriTe
When calculating the amount required to purchase an item, you will need to add the GST to the pre-tax price.
The quickest way to do this will be to calculate 110% of the pre-tax price. By using this method we add the
10% GST to 100%, which represents the cost of the item. In this way there is only one calculation to make.
ChapTer 3 Taxation
97
Worked example 14
The Besenko family goes to McDonalds for lunch. The cost of the meal before GST is $19.80. How
much will the Besenkos have to pay for the meal, including the GST?
Think
WriTe
When we are given the total cost of an item including GST, we need to reverse the above process to
calculate the pre-tax price of the item. This means that we need to divide the total cost by 110%, written
as a decimal.
Worked example 15
Calculate the pre-tax price of a car that costs $31 350, including GST.
Think
WriTe
Taxes similar to the GST apply in many countries. These taxes are levied at different percentages in
different countries and in many cases are called value added tax (VAT). The methods used to calculate
the amount of VAT are the same as for Australias GST; however, the rate must be checked for each
question.
Worked example 16
New Zealand has a VAT levied at a rate of 12.5%. Vanessa goes on holidays to New Zealand and
rents a car for five days at a rate of NZ$56.50 per day (before VAT). Calculate the total cost of
renting the car including the VAT.
Think
WriTe
Cost = $56.50 5
= $282.50
Note that in other countries there may be 1c and 2c pieces and so we do not take the answer to the
nearest 5c.
exercise 3e
1 We13 Calculate the GST payable on a book that has a pre-tax price of $35.60.
2 Calculate the GST payable on each of the following items (prices given are pre-tax):
a a bottle of dishwashing liquid at $2.30
b a basketball at $68.90
c a pair of cargo pants at $98.50
d a bus fare at $1.30
e a restaurant meal for which the bill totals $89.90.
98
3 Calculate the GST payable on each of the following items (correct to the nearest cent):
a a barbecued chicken with a pre-tax price of $7.99
b a tin of shoe polish with a pre-tax price of $4.81
c a tin of dog food with a pre-tax price of 93c
d a pack of toilet rolls with a pre-tax price of $6.25
e a pack of frozen pies with a pre-tax price of $3.36.
4 We14 A pair of sports shoes that cost $112.50 has 10% GST added to the cost. Calculate the total cost
are pre-tax):
a a football jersey priced at $114.90
b a CD priced at $29.90
c a bunch of flowers priced at $14.70
d a birthday card priced at $4.95
e a jar of coffee priced at $5.88.
6 Jia travels to New Zealand where the VAT is set at 12.5%. Calculate the amount of tax payable on each
a
b
c
d
e
ChapTer 3 Taxation
99
Further development
12 When overseas tourists leave Australia they are entitled to a refund of GST charged on their purchases.
Calculate the amount of GST refund due for purchases totalling $5674.
13 Under a similar arrangement when Australians travel to the UK they are entitled to a refund of the VAT
USA he has receipts for goods US$750 where the VAT was levied at 10%, US$450 where the VAT was
levied at 11% and US$1677 from where the VAT was 7%.
a Calculate the amount of Jasons VAT refund in US$.
b Given that A$1 = US$0.80 calculate the refund in A$.
15 An alcohol product has a wholesale price of $23.67. It is then subject to a 35% tax. After this tax a
retail mark up of 15% is added before the 10% GST is added. Find the final retail price of the alcohol.
16 An item is priced at $220 on the shelf. Keith says that the 10% GST on the item is $22, while Maxine
Service is.
100
3F
We can draw linear graphs to display the tax payable. This is possible for both the GST and income tax.
exercise 3F
inTeraCTiViTY
int-2404
paYG tax graph
1 Draw a set of axes with the price on the horizontal axis and GST on the vertical axis, as shown.
50
GST ($)
40
30
20
10
0
0
below.
80
75
70
65
60
55
50
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
200
195
190
185
180
175
170
165
160
155
150
145
140
135
130
125
120
115
110
105
100
95
90
85
80
75
70
65
60
55
50
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
Income ( $1000)
a What is the tax payable on gross incomes up to $6000? Show this on the axes.
b Calculate the tax payable on a gross income of:
i $10 000
ii $34 000.
This is the second tax bracket. Mark these points on the axes and join these points with a straight
line.
c Calculate the tax payable on a gross income of:
i $37 500
ii $50 000
iii $80 000.
This is the third tax bracket. Mark these points on the axes and join these points with a straight
line.
d Calculate the tax payable on a gross income of:
i $100 000
ii $180 000.
This is the fourth tax bracket. Mark these points on the axes and join these points with a straight
line.
e Calculate the tax payable on a gross income of:
i $180 500
ii $190 000
iii $200 000.
This is the fifth tax bracket. Mark these points on the axes and join these points with a
straight line.
ChapTer 3 Taxation
101
Further development
3 A nation has a two-tiered GST system. For the first $1000 of any item GST is levied at 5% and any
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 3.2
doc-10314
102
iii $3250.
iii $355.
Tax
0$10 000
Nil
Summary
Calculating allowable
deductions
Allowable tax deductions are amounts that are deducted from gross income, as they are not
taxable.
Deductions are allowed for work-related expenses and other items such as charity donations.
Taxable income
medicare levy
The Medicare levy is part of the tax system that funds basic health care services.
For most people the Medicare levy is 1.5% of gross income.
People on low incomes either pay no Medicare levy or pay it at a reduced rate.
People on high incomes with no private health insurance must pay a Medicare levy surcharge of an
extra 1% of taxable income.
Calculating tax
Pay As You Go (PAYG) tax is deducted from your gross pay each week or fortnight.
Tax is calculated on the taxpayers gross annual income. This is then divided into weekly or
fortnightly amounts.
At the end of the financial year the taxpayer submits a tax return.
In a tax return the correct amount of tax for the year is calculated. The taxpayer then either receives
a tax refund or pays a tax debt.
Calculating GST
and VaT
The most common indirect tax is the GST, which began in Australia on 1 July 2000.
The GST is a 10% tax paid on the cost of all goods and services with the exception of some basic
foods.
Some other countries have a value added tax (VAT), which is similar to the GST but levied at
different rates.
ChapTer 3 Taxation
103
Chapter review
m U lT ip l e
C h oiCe
1 Slavisa is a nurse with a gross annual income of $45 675. He has earned $136.50 in interest from his
bank accounts and has allowable deductions of $680. Slavisas taxable income is:
a $44 858.50
B $45 131.50
C $46 218.50
d $46 491.50
2 Allans taxable income is $48 000. Allans tax for the year is (use the PAYG tax table on page91
C $8400
d $9120
3 Bradley receives a bill for $489.50 for car repairs, which includes GST. The cost of the repairs without
B $445.00
C $489.50
d $538.45
1 Tony is employed as a motor mechanic. Tony claims deductions of $1800 to buy tools, $225 for three
pairs of work overalls, $5 per week for dry-cleaning of these overalls and $2.50 per week for workrelated telephone calls. Calculate Tonys total tax deductions.
2 Catherine is a computer consultant who uses her own vehicle for work. Each week she must make
several visits to businesses that use her computer systems. Catherine travelled 4523km on work-related
trips during the year. Calculate the tax deduction that Catherine can claim if she is entitled to claim at
the rate of 63c per kilometre.
3 Brian runs a small bakery and has equipment in his bakery to the value of $45 000 at the beginning of
the 201213 financial year. For tax purposes he depreciates these items at a rate of 28% p.a. Calculate
the tax deduction that Brian can claim for depreciation in:
a 201314
b 201415
c 201516.
4 If a $5000 computer can be depreciated at a rate of 33% p.a., how many years will it take for its value
taxable income.
7 From her job as a journalist, Jana earns a gross annual salary of $72 000. Jana also earns $3540 per year
from her investments. If Jana has tax deductions totalling $5120, calculate her taxable income.
8 Allisons gross weekly wage is $539.50. Allison also earned $107.40 per quarter in interest from a fixed
18
19
20
21
1 Lleyton is employed as a forklift driver and receives a gross weekly wage of $970.
a Calculate Lleytons gross annual wage.
b If Lleyton has tax deductions totalling $1194 and has earned $75.80 from other sources, calculate
ex Ten d ed
r eS p o n S e
diGiTal doC
Test Yourself
doc-10315
Chapter 3
ChapTer 3 Taxation
105
ICT activities
3B
Taxable income
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet (doc-1608): Tax calculator (page 88)
3C
medicare levy
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 3.1 (doc-10313): Answer questions involving tax
calculations. (page 91)
3d
Calculating tax
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet (doc-1608): Tax calculator (page 96)
106
3F
inTeraCTiViTY
int-2404: PAYG tax graph (page 101)
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 3.2 (doc-10314): Answer questions about taxation.
(page 102)
Chapter review
Test Yourself Chapter 3 (doc-10315): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 105)
Answers CHAPTER 3
exercise 3a Calculating allowable
deductions
1 $38 716
2 $54 109
3 $1153.90
4 $1624.55
5 $1070.10
6 $6270
7 $2000.88
8 a $1260
b $1957.30
c $1157.36
d $2175
9 $3226.05
10 $324
11 a $1000
b $600
c $360
12 $3087.50
13 a i $30 000
ii $18 000
iii $10 800
b 201314
14 $960
15 $18 760
16 $712.27
17 $47 937.50
18 a Cents per kilometre
b $3589
19 a $6000
b $3950
20 A tax deduction is subtracted from the
gross income before any tax calculations
are made.
exercise 3B
Taxable income
1 $43 754.25
2 a $16 879.20
b $15 736.50
3 $43 568.34
4 a $24 219.40
b $22 262.60
5 a $20 503.60
b $20 075.20
6 a $42 500
b $2600
c $39 900
7 a $34 262.30
b $710.40
c $31 992.00
8A
9 $53 120
10 $13 760
11 a $74 280
b $8958.90
c $65 321.10
12 a $25 649
b $1470
c $1540
d $1349.40
e $21 289.60
13 a $509.20
b $26 834.84
c $26 083.84
14 a $40 862.50
b $33 170.30
15 a The amount of money earned without
any deductions
exercise 3C
medicare levy
1 $598.05
2 a $648.75
b $851.18
c $1410
3 a $23 491
b $352.37
4 D
5 $106 000
6 $4600
7 $3500
8 $1550
9 $39 800
10 a $1275
b $532.50
11 $504
12 A tax to pay for Australias public medical
system
exercise 3d
Calculating tax
1 $4417.50
2 a $0
b $1901.25
c $3787.50
d $6846
e $22 304.50
f $67 150
3 a $32 639
b $3995.90
4 $8867.40
5 a $44 759
b $6977.70
6 a $4440
b $534
c $4974
7 a $2977.50
b $16 230
c $28 760
8 a $6711.54
b $130 600
c $5235
d $4099.33
9 $61.66
10 $404.23
11 D
12 B
13 C
14 $1606.13
15 a $38 674
b $5732.31
c $291.69
16 a $90 942
b $441.60
c $22 481.04
d Refund $481.94
17 a $44 605, $9197.25
b $41 513
c $6626.60
d $2570.65
18 a $15 671.51
b $2401.56 debt
19 a $18 309
b $75 900
c $17 458.50
d $850.50
20 a $15 159
b $74 257
c $16 940.96
d $1781.96
21 Jimmy will get a tax refund as his
1 $3.56
2 a 23c
b $6.89
c $9.85
d 13c
e $8.99
3 a 80c
b 48c
c 9c
d 63c
e 34c
4 $123.75
5 a $126.39
b $32.89
c $16.17
d $5.45
e $6.47
6 a $30.00
b $0.94
c $47.00
d $2.94
e $9.86
7 $98.50
8 a $1.90
b 19c
9 $348.10
10 a $1.08
b $80.63
c $193.29
d $49.21
e $6.95
11 a $33 550
b $36 630
c $34 705
d $38 885
12 $515.82
13 a 242.09
b $537.98
14 a $US222.48
b $278.10
15 $40.42
16 Maxine is correct as the GST is added on
1 a
i $10
50
40
GST ($)
TaxaTion
30
20
10
0
0 50 00 50 00 50 00 50 00 50 00
1 1 2 2 3 3 4 4 5
Price ($)
ChapTer 3 Taxation
107
90
85
80
75
70
65
60
55
50
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
200
190
180
170
160
150
140
130
120
110
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
ii
ii
ii
ii
ShorT anSWer
$4200
$9000
$58 000
$62 500
250
GST ($)
200
150
100
50
0
b i $22.50
c i $400
4
200 400 600 800 1000 1200 1400 1600 1800 2000
Amount ($)
ii $50
ii $1333.33
iii $387.50
iii $3033.33
35 000
30 000
Tax ($)
25 000
20 000
15 000
10 000
5000
10
00
0
20
00
0
30
00
0
40
00
0
50
00
0
60
00
0
70
00
0
80
00
0
90
00
0
10
00
00
Income ($)
ChapTer reVieW
mUlTiple ChoiCe
1 B
108
2 D
3 B
1 $2415
2 $2849.49
3 a $12 600
c $6531.84
4 6 years
5 $27 783.78
6 $43 883
7 $70 420
8 a $28 483.60
9 a $34 409.30
10 $585
11 a $232.50
c $712.50
e $1485
12 a $1314
c $3900
13 $6900
14 a Nil
c $4450.50
e $98 650
15 a $33 987.20
c $509.81
e $90.54
16 $833.18
17 a $40 225
c $1550.92
18 $99
19 a $1.13
c 12c
e $1.25
20 $22
b $9072
b $26 465.60
b $31 952.34
b $435
d $1252.61
b $1515
b $2003.55
d $21 087.94
b $4198.08
d $4707.89
b $6220.88
b $36.90
d $3.75
21 $112.50
exTended reSponSe
1 a
c
e
2 a
c
$50 440
b $49 321.80
$739.82
d $8346.30
$352.48 refund
$330
b $360
NZ$9.60 cheaper to pay on arrival in New Zealand
Chapter 4
Statistical processes
Target populations and sampling
Population characteristics
Types of data
Bias
4a
statistical processes
There are many cases in society where data needs to be analysed. Governments and businesses have data
analysed regularly to try to make accurate predictions about future trends.
Consider the case of a government department such as the Roads and Traffic Authority. This
department needs to gather data about places where accidents occur. These sets of data are analysed
and decisions made about what areas need to have road works and what places need greater police
supervision.
Data are also analysed in areas such as business and sport. Shops will look at sales figures to
determine stock and staffing requirements, while in sport player performances are measured statistically
by coaches and the media.
The purpose of completing a statistical enquiry is to turn raw data into meaningful information. Data
are sets of facts that are collected, but limited data alone can have very little meaning. When lots of data
are collected and presented and conclusions are drawn, the data becomes more useful information.
There are six stages to completing a statistical investigation.
Stage 1: Posing questions
This first stage of the statistical process is to determine the final information required, then writing
questions that will give us the answer and also allow for easy collation of findings and presentation of
results.
Consider the case where you represent the local council. Your job is to investigate what sporting
facilities are needed in your local area. You will need to pose questions that accurately determine the
needs of an area.
Questions need to target specific needs and not be too vague.
What sporting facilities do you think are needed in this area? is
Please rank the following
open ended and is based only on opinion. The question invites a
sporting needs in this area.
range of responses that may be difficult to tabulate. The question
does not analyse if the respondent would even use the facilities that
Cricket nets
they believe are needed.
Tennis courts
More relevant questions would be
Golf course
1. Do you currently use the sporting facilities in the district?
Netball courts
2. How many hours of sport do you play each week?
Soccer field
3. What sports do you currently play?
Other
4. For the sports that you currently play, are the existing facilities
adequate?
5. Rank the following sporting needs in this area.
A survey form
Chapter 4 Statistics and society, data collection and sampling
109
Brendon is planning a skiing trip and needs to investigate the best places and best times to travel.
Would he use internal or external sources to obtain this information?
thInk
WrIte
A Year 11 class was surveyed on their weekly income. The responses are shown below.
$75
$56
$43
$115
$45
$79
$60
$83
$58
$54
$71
$89
$88
$40
$70
$0
$37
$105
$98
$87
$99
$102
$117
$55
Tally
Frequency
$21$40
$41$60
$61$80
$81$100
$101$120
thInk
WrIte
Income
Frequency
$0$20
$21$40
||
$41$60
|||| ||
$61$80
||||
$81$100
|||| |
||||
$101$120
110
Tally
a a olumn
c
Frequency
6
2
7
2
3
1
2
1
b a sector graph.
thInk
sport.
Draw a vertical axis to show frequencies
up to 7.
Draw the columns.
Frequency
WrIte
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
l e
l t
n r s
FL tbal cke tbal agu nio cce nni
i
e
e
e
e
r
U
So T
sk C N y L by
b
g
Ba
g u
Ru R
Sport
AFL =
6
24
360
Basketball =
= 90
7
Cricket = 24 360
= 105
Rugby League =
3
24
2
24
360
= 30
2
Netball = 24 360
= 30
360
= 45
1
Rugby Union = 24 360
Soccer =
2
24
= 15
360
= 30
Tennis =
1
24
360
= 15
111
Sport
AFL
Basketball
Cricket
Netball
Rugby League
Rugby Union
Soccer
Tennis
exercise 4a
statistical processes
1 For each of the following, state whether the data source would be internal or external.
a The number of cars stolen in NSW each year
b The rise or fall in a share price over the past year
c The number of people who rode bikes to school today
d The number of people who voted in the last federal election
e Who people intend to vote for in the next federal election
f The most popular band among Year 11 students at your school
g The number of Holden cars sold each week in Australia
h The batting average of each player in the Australian cricket team
dIgItal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1505
Frequency tables
2 For each of the following, state whether an internal or external source has been used.
a A football coaching assistant records the number of tackles made by each player in a match.
b To analyse immigration trends, a researcher obtains records of the nations from which immigrants
have come.
c Attendance records at the Royal Easter Show are gathered to plan the required number of trains
school has.
3 For each of the following, state whether the data would be gathered using observation or questioning.
a The number of sets of traffic lights in a country town
b The number of students in Year 11 at your school who started high school at a different school
112
c
d
e
f
g
h
4 We 1 Rewrite the following open-ended questions so that the responses will be easier to tabulate.
a Where is your favourite holiday destination?
b What is your weekly income?
c How many movies have you seen at the cinema this year?
d Who is your favourite singer or group?
e How many hours study do you do each week?
5 We 2 A class of students was asked to identify the make of car their family owned. Their responses are
shown below.
Holden
Ford
Nissan
Mazda
Mitsubishi
Ford
Holden
Holden
Toyota
Toyota
Nissan
Ford
Holden
Ford
Holden
Mazda
Mitsubishi
Ford
Holden
Ford
Toyota
Toyota
Toyota
Holden
Ford
Holden
Toyota
Mazda
Ford
Toyota
70
71
72
69
70
66
70
72
67
73
70
72
72
70
69
71
67
69
72
70
71
70
70
73
73
66
71
69
66
66
70
73
72
71
71
70
69
71
72
68
7 We 3 The marks scored on a Maths exam, out of 100, by 25 Year 11 students are shown below.
87
54
71
44
60
83
95
66
74
66
69
81
78
66
69
69
77
70
66
79
57
92
66
78
71
8 The data below show the number of customers that entered a shop each day in a certain month.
114
178
169
141
195
216
185
155
175
200
173
132
163
147
164
143
180
168
130
190
120
173
119
179
204
102
158
200
199
150
163
Time
Temperature
(C)
7 am 8 am 9 am 10 am 11 am 12 pm 1 pm 2 pm 3 pm 4 pm 5 pm 6 pm 7 pm
11
13
14
16
19
20
22
22
20
17
16
15
14
Plot these points on a graph and join the points. This type of graph is a line graph.
Further development
12 Explain the advantages of using external data sources.
13 Fiona and Suzi collect information about road transport in their county town:
Fiona has found information from the RTA about vehicle registration in NSW.
Suzi records the types of vehicles that pass through the main intersection during the day.
a Which person has used an internal data source?
b What is the advantage of Fionas data collection method?
c State a benefit of Suzis data collection method.
Chapter 4 Statistics and society, data collection and sampling
113
14 The data below shows the marks, out of 100, from an exam taken by 40 students.
93
52
92
77
88
66
67
77
43
70
94
44
59
62
79
64
67
93
55
99
57
56
73
56
79
51
91
95
60
86
97
63
76
49
51
44
55
53
61
91
Score
Frequency
40
41
42
43
44
graph.
a The number of goals kicked by each player in a soccer team.
b The breakdown of reasons for which the NRMA is called to assist broken down drivers.
c The height of a plant as it grows over one year.
d The numbers of various animals living in a national park.
4B
The first step in gathering the relevant data for a statistical investigation is to target the population that
is to be investigated. This means identifying the sections of the population for whom the statistical
investigation will have meaning.
For example, if investigating the medical needs of a community we would not conduct our survey
at the local fitness club. In this case we would survey doctors and other medical personnel, as well as a
selection of patients who use these facilities.
When starting an investigation, we must determine the quantity of information needed for the
database. Consider the case of a company hired to calculate TV ratings. Does the company need to
know what every household is watching? Obviously not; they ask a selection of homes to record their
television viewing.
Conversely, consider the case of selecting a commemorative Year 12 jersey at your school. In this case
it would be reasonable to ask the opinion of every person in Year 12.
Data can be collected in two ways:
1. Census This is where an entire population is counted. Australians complete a census every five
years. This is a survey of every household in the nation. In most statistical investigations a census
involves surveying the entire target population.
2. Sample A sample is a more practical way of obtaining data. Only a selection of the target
population is surveyed; however, it is important that those selected are representative of the whole
population.
Before deciding whether to do a census or sample we need to consider whether it is feasible to obtain
census data.
Consider the case of someone who is analysing the NRL results for a season. The target population is
the result of each match. This is recorded in a number of places and the data easily obtained.
114
Worked exaMple 4
In each of the following, state if the information was obtained by census or sample.
a A school uses the roll to count the number of students absent each day.
b The television ratings, in which 2000 families complete a survey on what they watch over a one
week period.
c A light globe manufacturer tests every hundredth light globe off the production line.
d A teacher records the examination marks of her class.
thInk
WrIte
a Census
b Sample
c Sample
d Census
To ensure that any sample is representative of the whole population the method of sampling is important.
We will look at three methods of sampling.
Method 1 Random sample. In a random sample those to be surveyed are selected by chance. In such
a sample every member of the target population should have an equal chance of being selected. If this
method is used you should get a mix of the population that is representative of the whole.
Calculators and spreadsheets generate random numbers in different ways. In many cases the random
number will be a decimal between 0 and 1. To get a whole number we could multiply this decimal by the
number of people in the target population and then poll the people that correspond to the random number
generated.
Worked exaMple 5
Three students from a school are to be selected to participate in a statewide survey of school
students. There are 750 students at the school. To choose the participants, a random number
generator is used with the results 0.983, 0.911 and 0.421. What are the roll numbers of the students
who should be selected?
thInk
WrIte
If the selection is not random there is a possibility that the sample may have bias. For example, if doing
a survey at school you may
Have a tendency to survey people you know.
Choose an area where more students of a particular year tend to sit.
Choose more of one sex than the other.
Method 2 Stratified sample. In this sampling method the numbers in the survey from each subgroup are chosen in proportion to the whole population. Suppose that you are surveying 60 people from
your school. Should you survey 10 people from each year? It is better to select the numbers from each
year in proportion to the whole population. If, for example, 20% of students are in Year 7, then 20% of
60 (12) students from this year should be chosen.
Worked exaMple 6
Adrian is conducting a survey of school students. At his school, 47% of the population are male
and 53% are female. If Adrian decides to survey 60 students, how many students of each sex
should he choose if he decides to use a stratified sample?
Chapter 4 Statistics and society, data collection and sampling
115
WrIte
thInk
1
47% of 60 = 0.47 60
= 28.2
53% of 60 = 0.53 60
= 31.8
Method 3 Systematic sample. When selecting a systematic sample the participants are chosen in
an organised way. For example, tyres coming off a production line need to be tested for wear. Every
100th tyre produced may be selected.
exercise 4B
1 For each of the following describe what the target population for a survey would be.
a The school end-of-year committee wants to find out the preferred venue for the Year 12 farewell.
b The local council wants to find out what sporting facilities are needed in the area.
c A newspaper wants to predict the winner of the next federal election.
d A group planning to build a preschool would like to know what facilities would attract
enrolments.
e A recording label wants to predict the likely success of a grunge band.
2 We 4 A school conducts an election for a new school captain. Every teacher and student in the
who live in the community are surveyed, is this an example of a census or a sample?
4 For each of the following surveys, state whether a census or a sample has been used.
a Two hundred people in a shopping centre are asked to nominate the supermarket where they do
recorded.
d To find the average mark in the Mathematics half-yearly exam, every students mark is recorded.
e To test the quality of tyres on a production line, every 100th tyre is road tested.
5 Below are a number of statistical investigations. For each state whether data would be available for the
results.
a To find the most watched television program on Monday night at 7:30 pm
b To find the number of cars sold during a period of one year
c To find the number of cars that pass through the tollgates on the Sydney Harbour Bridge each day
d To find the percentage of computers produced by a company that are defective
7 An opinion poll is conducted to try to predict the outcome of an election. Two thousand people are
telephoned and asked about their voting intention. Is this an example of a census or a sample?
8 We5 A factory has 500 employees. Each employee has an employee number between 1and500.
Five employees are selected to participate in an Occupational Health and Safety survey. To choose the
participants, a random number generator is used. The results are 0.326,0.352, 0.762, 0.989 and 0.018.
What are the employee numbers of those to participate inthe survey?
116
9 A school has 837 students. A survey of 10 students in the school is to be conducted. A random number
generator is used to select the participants. If the random numbers chosen are:
0.988 0.251 0.498 0.661 0.247 0.031 0.967 0.932 0.229 0.443
what are the roll numbers of the students who should be selected?
10 A survey is to be conducted of 20 out of 50 000 people in a country town. Those selected are to be
chosen using a random number generator.
a Use your calculator to generate 20 random numbers.
b Calculate the electoral roll numbers of the people who should be chosen for the survey.
11 For each of the following, state whether the sample used is an example of random, stratified or
systematic sampling.
a Every 10th tyre coming off a production line is tested for quality.
b A company employs 300 men and 450 women. The sample of employees chosen for a survey
contains 20 men and 30 women.
c The police breathalyse the driver of every red car.
d The names of the participants in a survey are drawn from a hat.
e Fans at a football match fill in a questionnaire. The ground contains 8000 grandstand seats and
20 000 general admission seats. The questionnaire is then given to 40 people in the grandstand
and 100 people who paid for a general admission seat.
12 MC Which of the following is an example of a systematic sample?
a The first 20 students who arrive at school each day participate in the survey.
B Twenty students to participate in the survey are chosen by a random number generator.
C Twenty students to participate in the survey are selected in proportion to the number of students in
each school year.
d Ten boys and 10 girls are chosen to participate in the survey.
13 MC Which of the following statistical investigations would be practical to complete by census?
a
B
C
d
14 We6 Zara is conducting a survey of the people at work. At her work 68% of the workers are male and
32% are female. If Zara decides to survey 50 workers, how many of each sex should she choose, if she
chooses to use a stratified sample?
15 The table below shows the percentage of students that are in each year of a school.
Year
Percentage of students
7
20%
8
19%
9
21%
10
16%
11
13%
12
11%
If 40 students are to participate in a survey, find the number chosen from each year group if stratified
sampling is used.
Further development
16 When completing a census, explain why it is more practical in most cases to use external sources.
17 Greg is trying to generate a random sample of people in the street. He does this by selecting every
between 0 and 1. He multiplies this number by 100, adds 1 and takes the integer part of the result.
a Demonstrate this process and find the resulting integer if Ricky starts with 0.739.
b Explain the purpose of multiplying by 100.
c Explain the purpose of adding 1.
Chapter 4 Statistics and society, data collection and sampling
117
20 To complete a survey, John collects a sample of 50 people all with surname Smith from the telephone
book.
John claims that since Smith is a very common surname his sample should be representative of
the whole population. Give three reasons why this sample will not be representative of the whole
population.
dIgItal doC
WorkSHEET 4.1
doc-10316
21 Rod claims that a systematic sample is the best way to ensure a sample is representative of the entire
population.
Give one reason for and one reason against Rods claim.
4C
population characteristics
Characteristics about a population can be estimated by taking a sample of that population. For example,
to estimate the average income of Australians we could conduct an anonymous survey of a sample of the
Australian population.
To get an accurate estimate, it is important that the sample taken has similar characteristics to the
entire population. For example, the sample should have an equal number of males and females, and
the ages of those in the sample should be in the same proportion as for the whole population. The area
sampled should include a cross-section of people according to socio-economic level, ethnic background,
religion etc., similar to that of the whole population. In such cases we use the stratified sampling
technique.
Characteristics (such as sex and age) of the population and the sample must also match, if we expect
our sample to have incomes in the same proportions as those of the general population.
InvestIgate: population characteristics
If we are trying to estimate the average income of Australian families, what would be the effect if our
sample:
1 contained a majority of one sex?
2 contained only people in the 1521 age group?
3 contained only people who live in a small country town?
To calculate the number of participants in a sample from each strata of the population, we calculate each
strata as a fraction of the total population and multiply this fraction by the total number to be chosen in
the sample.
Worked exaMple 7
Boys
Girls
96
102
85
87
92
88
10
80
74
11
71
75
12
69
65
493
491
Total
Grand total
118
984
thInk
1
WrIte
96
Boys
Girls
10
11
12
30
30
Total
Grand total
60
Note that on some occasions after rounding off each of the answers, the total number of people to
participate in the sample may add to one more than the number that we planned to select. In such cases,
the person doing the sample should include this extra person as it gives a better sample of the overall
population.
Chapter 4 Statistics and society, data collection and sampling
119
exercise 4C
population characteristics
No. of
students
90
110
90
10
80
11
70
12
60
Total
500
Male
Female
2029
61
44
3039
40
50
40 49
74
16
5059
10
A survey of 50 employees is to be done. Using a stratified survey, suggest the breakdown of people
to participate in terms of age and sex.
7 The table below shows the number of students who are in each year level at a school.
Year
Number of students
10
11
12
187
192
168
157
137
108
If 80 students are to be selected to participate in a survey, how many should be chosen from each
year level?
120
8 A shopping centre has a floor area of 5000 m2. There is one major department store with an area of
1500 m2, two smaller department stores of 750 m2 and 40 small stores of 50 m2. The management of
the centre assigns voting rights in the shopping centre in proportion to the floor area of each business.
Given that there are 200 votes to be distributed, how many votes should each business get?
Year
10
11
12
Boys
104
112
107
97
75
68
Girls
98
119
110
88
82
66
A survey of 100 students is to be conducted. Complete the table below to show the number of
students from each year and sex who should participate in a stratified sample.
Year
Boys
Girls
7
8
9
10
11
12
Further development
10 Use your calculator to generate five random numbers between 0 and 10.
a Find the average of the five numbers. Compare your answer to others in your class by looking for
Year
No. of
students
180
204
191
10
172
11
139
12
114
Male
400
Female
600
How can the information in both tables be incorporated into a stratified sample?
13 Jack wants to complete a survey on the same school population, however, as well as year and gender he
121
14 The table below shows the number of people in each of four strata and the number selected to
participate in a survey from each group. In which of the four strata has the wrong number of
participants been selected?
Strata
No. in population
No. in survey
243
16
347
23
198
14
376
27
15 MC When constructing a stratified random sample Bettina completes the following steps which are
Consider how you would choose your sample if you wished to conduct a survey for your next school disco.
Use the method in Worked example 7 to select the number of boys and girls that should be chosen from
each year to do your survey.
Step 1. Find out the number of boys and girls enrolled in each year at your school.
Step 2. Calculate the percentage of the whole school population in each year for both boys and girls.
Step 3. Choose a suitable sample size and calculate the number of boys and girls needed from each year to
complete your survey.
4d
types of data
122
WrIte
There are two types of categorical data and two types of quantitative data.
Data
Categorical
Data which are placed in categories; thatis,
non-numerical form, such as hair colour, type
of vehicle, and so on.
Nominal
Need sub-groups
to complete the
description, such as hair
colour: blond, brown
and so on.
Ordinal
Need a ranking to
order the description,
such as achievement
levels: very high,
high, satisfactory and
so on.
Quantitative
Data which are in numerical form; such as
height, number of children in the family,
and so on.
Discrete
Counted in exact values,
such as goals scored in
a football match, shoe
size and so on. Values
are often, but not always,
whole numbers.
InteraCtIvItY
int-0219
Classifying data
Continuous
Measured in a
continuous decimal
scale, such as mass,
temperature, length and
so on.
Worked exaMple 9
Classify each of the following data using two selections from the following descriptive words:
categorical, quantitative, nominal, ordinal, discrete and continuous.
a The number of students absent from school
b The types of vehicle using a certain road
c The various pizza sizes available at a local takeaway
d The room temperature at various times during a particular day
thInk
WrIte
represented by a number.
quantitative.
quantitative.
quantitative.
quantitative.
is represented by a number.
exercise 4d
types of data
1 We8 State whether the data collected in each of the following situations would be categorical or
quantitative.
a The number of matches in each box is counted for a large sample of boxes.
b The sex of respondents to a questionnaire is recorded as either M or F.
c A fisheries inspector records the lengths of 40 cod.
Chapter 4 Statistics and society, data collection and sampling
123
d The occurrence of hot, warm, mild and cool weather for each day in January is recorded.
e The actual temperature for each day in January is recorded.
f Cinema critics are asked to judge a film by awarding it a rating from one to five stars.
2 State whether the categorical data formed by each of the following situations are nominal or
ordinal.
a On a school report students are ranked as Unsatisfactory, Satisfactory, Above average or
Outstanding.
b The day of the week that a business has the most customers is recorded.
c Visitors to a museum are recorded as being either male or female.
d The colour of each traffic light on a journey is recorded.
e The make of each television in an electronics store is recorded.
3 State whether the quantitative data formed by each of the following situations are discrete or
continuous.
a The heights of 60 tomato plants at a plant nursery
b The number of jelly beans in each of 50 packets
c The time taken for each student in a class of six-year-olds to tie their shoelaces
d The petrol consumption rate of a large sample of cars
e The IQ (intelligence quotient) of each student in a class
4 We9 Classify each of the following data using two words selected from the following descriptive
legalised. Each person was offered five responses: strongly agree, agree, unsure, disagree and strongly
disagree. Describe the data type in this example.
7 A teacher marks her students work with a grade A, B, C, D or E. Describe the data type used.
8 A teacher marks his students work using a mark out of 100. Describe the data type used.
124
9 MC The number of people who are using a particular bus service are counted over a two week period.
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
0
ot
m
ild
ar
M
W
Weather
ol
Co
180
160
140
120
100
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
Age
Further development
12 Carl says that categorical data is words and quantitative data is numbers. Explain what Carl means
13
14
15
16
17
4e
Bias
No doubt you have heard the comment, There are lies, damned lies and statistics. This implies that we
should be wary of statistical figures quoted. Indeed, we should always make informed decisions of our
own and not simply accept the mass of statistics that bombards us through the media.
Bias can be introduced into statistics by:
1. questionnaire design
2. sampling bias
3. the interpretation of results.
Chapter 4 Statistics and society, data collection and sampling
125
sampling bias
As discussed previously, an ideal sample should reflect the characteristics of the population.
Statistical calculations performed on the sample would then be a reliable indication of the
populations features.
Selecting a sample using a non-random method, as discussed earlier, generally tends to introduce an
element of bias.
Particular responses can be selected from all those received. In collecting information on a local
issue, an interviewer on a street corner may record responses from many passers-by. From all the data
collected, a sample could be chosen to support the issue, or alternatively another sample could be chosen
to refute the same issue.
A sample may be selected under abnormal conditions. Consider a survey to determine which
lemonade was more popular Kirks or Schweppes. Collecting data one week when one of the brands
was on special at half price would certainly produce misleading results.
Data are often collected by radio and television stations via telephone polls. A Yes response is
recorded on a given phone-in number, while the No respondents are asked to ring a different phone-in
number. This type of sampling does not produce a representative sample of the population. Only those
who are highly motivated tend to ring and there is no monitoring of the number of times a person might
call, recording multiple votes.
When data are collected from mailing surveys, bias results if the non-response rate is high (even if
the selected sample was a random one). The responses received often represent only those with strong
views on the subject, while those with more moderate views tend to lack representation in their correct
proportion.
The aim of this investigation is to study statistical data that you suspect to be biased.
Conduct a search of newspapers, magazines or any printed material to collect instances of quoted
statistics that you believe to be biased. There are occasions when television advertisements quote statistical
figures as a result of questionable sampling techniques. For each example, discuss:
1 the purpose of the survey
2 how the data might have been collected
3 the question(s) that may have been asked (try to pose the question(s) in a variety of ways to influence
different outcomes)
4 ways in which bias might be introduced
5 variations in interpretation of the data.
InvestIgate: Biased sampling
Discuss the problems that would be caused by each of the following biased samples.
1 A survey is to be conducted to decide the most popular sport in a local community. A sample of
100 people was questioned at a local football match.
2 A music store situated in a shopping centre wants to know the type of music that it should stock.
A sample of 100 people was surveyed. The sample was taken from people who passed by the store
between 10:00 and 11:00 am on a Tuesday.
3 A newspaper conducting a Gallup poll on an election took a sample of 1000 people from Sydney.
InvestIgate: spreadsheets creating misleading graphs
Let us practise producing misleading graphs. Consider the data in this table.
Year
Wages ($m)
% increase in wages
Profits ($m)
% increase in profits
1990
6
25
1
20
1995
9
50
1.5
50
2000
13
44
2.5
66
2005
20
54
5
100
Graph 2
Graph 3
1 Enter the data as indicated in the spreadsheet above.
2 Graph the data using the Chart Wizard. You should obtain a graph similar to Graph 1.
Chapter 4 Statistics and society, data collection and sampling
127
obtained by reducing the horizontal axis. Experiment with shortening the horizontal length and
lengthening the vertical axis.
5 In Graph 3 we get the impression that the wages and profits are not very different. This effect was
obtained by lengthening the horizontal axis and shortening the vertical axis. Experiment with various
combinations.
6 Print out your three graphs and examine their differences.
Note that all three graphs have been drawn from the same data using valid scales. A cursory glance leaves
us with three different impressions. Clearly, it is important to look carefully at the scales on the axes of
graphs.
Another method which could be used to change the shape of a graph is to change the scale of the axes.
7 Right click on the axis value, enter the Format axis option, click on the Scale tab, then experiment with
changing the scale values on both axes.
Techniques such as these are used to create different visual impressions of the same data.
8 Use the data in the table to create a spreadsheet, then produce two graphs depicting the percentage
increase in both wages and profits over the years giving the impression that:
a the profits of the company have not grown at the expense of wage increases (the percentage increase in
wages is similar to the percentage increase in profits)
b the company appears to be exploiting its employees (the percentage increase in profits is greater than
that for wages).
Worked exaMple 10
Discuss why the following selected samples could provide bias in the statistics collected.
a In order to determine the extent of unemployment in a community, a committee phoned two
households (randomly selected) from each page of the local telephone book during the day.
b A newspaper ran a feature article on the use of animals to test cosmetics. A form beneath the
article invited responses to the article.
thInk
WrIte
circulation.
Consider the urge to respond.
exercise 4e
Bias
1 Rewrite the following questions, removing any elements or words that might contribute to bias in
responses.
a The poor homeless people, through no fault of their own, experience great hardship during the
freezing winter months. Would you contribute to a fund to build a shelter to house our homeless?
b Most people think that, since weve developed as a nation in our own right and broken many ties
with Great Britain, we should adopt our own national flag. Youd agree with this, wouldnt you?
c Youd know that our Australian 50 cent coin is in the shape of a dodecagon, wouldnt you?
d Many in the workforce toil long hours for low wages. By comparison, politicians seem to get life
pretty easy when you take into account that they only work for part of the year and they receive
all those perks and allowances. Youd agree, wouldnt you?
128
after school
5 Comment on the following statement:
University tests have demonstrated that DoubleWhite toothpaste is consistently used by the majority
of teenagers and is more effective than most other
toothpastes.
6 Surveys are conducted on samples to determine the
characteristics of the population. Discuss whether the
samples selected would provide a reliable indication of
the populations characteristics.
Sample
a Year 11 students
b Year 12 students
c Residents attending a neighbourhood
d
e
f
g
watch meeting
Students in the school choir
Cars in a shopping centre car park
Males at a football match
Users of the local library
Australian currency
70c
69c
Population
Student drivers
Students with part-time jobs
Residents of a suburb
Music students in the school
Models of Holden cars on the road
Popular TV programs
Popular teenage magazines
Further development
105
104
103
102
101
100
2000
2004
Years
2008
Total employment
(millions)
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1947
1954
1961
1966
1971
1976
1981
129
600
550
500
450
400
1987
1984
1981
1978
1975
1972
1969
and your plant is
Source: Qld Year Book, 1989, p. 205 and the Australian Bureau of Statistics.
discharging heavy metals
into a waterway. Your chemists do tests on the water every three months. The table below shows the
results over a 2-year period.
Draw a graph that will show your company in the best light.
2009
Date
Concentration (parts per million)
Jan.
7
Apr.
9
July
18
2010
Oct.
25
Jan.
30
Apr.
40
July
49
Oct.
57
11 The sector graph shows the break-up of workers compensation costs incurred by employers other than
government.
a What fraction of the
total costs are weekly
compensation payouts
and statutory lump sum
claims?
b What angle should be
at the centre of this
sector?
c What angle is at the
centre of this sector?
d Why has this distortion
of angle occurred?
Discuss how this might
be used to mislead the
reader?
Total $202.8m
Weekly compensation
payouts and statutory lump
sum claims $40.3m
12 The graph below shows how the $27 that a buyer pays for a CD is distributed among departments
Record company
administration costs $1.54
Mechanical
royalties $1.57
Sales tax
$3.27
Production
$3.40
You are required to find out whether or not the graph is misleading, and fully explain and support
any statements you make.
130
InvestIgate: Bias
131
Summary
statistical processes
target populations
and sampling
population
characteristics
A stratified sample can be used to ensure that the characteristics of your sample match the
characteristics of the whole population.
To select a stratified sample:
1. Write each number in each stratum as a fraction of the whole population.
2. Multiply by the size of the sample that you wish to take.
3. Round off the answer for each stratum to the nearest whole number.
Sometimes this method increases the sample size, but this may be necessary to get the best
representation possible in your sample.
types of data
Bias
Bias occurs when the results of an investigation are skewed to one side. This can occur because of:
1. A poorly worded question that can lead the responder into a response favouring one side.
2. A poorly chosen sample. Those participating in the investigation may not represent the whole
population and be more inclined to a certain point of view.
3. Misinterpretation of results. This can occur when a graph is drawn to give a certain impression.
132
Chapter review
1 Which of the following is an example of a census?
a
B
C
d
M U ltIp l e
C ho IC e
1 For each of the statistical investigations below, state whether the data source would be external or
internal.
a The wins recorded by a major football team
b The number of brick homes in an area
c The number of sales made by a department store in a month
d The amount of traffic passing through an intersection in one hour
s ho rt
a n s W er
2 For each of the following, state whether the data would be gathered using observation or questioning.
a The number of surfers on various beaches
b The brand of surfboard preferred by surfers
c The average height of Year 11 students at your school
d The most popular movie among Year 11 students at your school
3 Rewrite each of the following questions so that the results are easier to tabulate.
a What is the distance from your home to school?
b Describe the type of house you live in.
c What is the number of kilometres that your family car travels in one year?
d What is your favourite sport?
4 A survey is conducted on the number of people living in each household in a street. The results are
shown below.
1
6
3
4
4
3
5
4
4
2
6
2
2
3
2
3
2
4
3
6
5
1
1
2
3
5
4
1
5
6
13
11
18
20
0
7
5
14
10
22
25
9
35
3
6
12
8
23
17
10
14
20
9
19
Put the results into a table using the categories 0 4, 59, 1014 etc.
6 Draw a column and a sector graph to represent the results to question 4.
Chapter 4 Statistics and society, data collection and sampling
133
7 For each of the following statistical investigations, state whether a census or a sample has been used.
a The average price of petrol in Sydney was estimated by averaging the price at 40 petrol stations.
b The Australian Bureau of Statistics has every household in Australia complete an information form
played.
d Public opinion on an issue is sought by a telephone poll of 2000 homes.
8 Name and describe three different methods for selecting a sample.
9 Which method of sampling has been used for each of the following?
a The quality-control department of a tyre manufacturing company road tests every 50th tyre that
Year
No. of students
212
200
189
10
175
11
133
12
124
In a survey of the school population, how many students from each year should be chosen, if a
sample of 60 is selected using a stratified sample?
12 State whether each of the following data types are categorical or quantitative.
a The television program that people watch at 7:00 pm
b The number of pets in each household
c The amount of water consumed by athletes in a marathon run
d The average distance that students live from school
e The mode of transport used between home and school
13 For each of the quantitative data types below, determine if the data are discrete or continuous.
a The dress sizes of Year 11 girls
b The volume of backyard swimming pools
c The amount of water used in
households
d The number of viewers of a
statistics through:
a questionnaire design
b sample selection
c interpretation of statistical
results.
Discuss how bias could be a
result of techniques in the above
three areas.
134
1 Carolyn is a marine biologist. She spends the day on a boat and 500 fish are netted. Carolyn notes the
types of fish netted. There are 173 blackfish, 219 drummer and 108 mullet.
a Are Carolyns data categorical or quantitative?
b The fish are tagged and released back into the school from which they were caught. Another 250
are then caught and it is noted that 63 have tags. What type of sample has been taken?
2 A paint company says that 1 litre of paint can paint an area of 4 m2. To test this, every 100th can is
tested to see that it will cover at least 4 m2.
a Are the data categorical or quantitative? If they are quantitative, are the data discrete or
continuous?
b What type of sample has been used?
c The paint is mixed in one of five machines. Every can tested therefore comes from the same
machine. A quality control officer then says that the data are biased. What is meant by the term
bias?
d Explain what could be done to prevent the data from being biased.
e x ten d ed
res p o n s e
dIgItal doC
Test Yourself
doc-10318
Chapter 4
135
ICT activities
4a
statistical processes
dIgItal doC
Spreadsheet (doc-1505): Frequency tables (page 112)
4B
dIgItal doC
WorkSHEET 4.1 (doc-10316): Answer questions on statistics and
data. (page118)
4d
types of data
InteraCtIvItY
Classifying data (int-0219): Interact with data classification. (page123)
136
4e
Bias
dIgItal doC
WorkSHEET 4.2 (doc-10317): Answer questions on statistics and
data. (page130)
Chapter review
Test Yourself Chapter 4 (doc-10318): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 135)
Answers CHAPTER 4
statIstICs and soCIetY,
data ColleCtIon and
saMplIng
10
Number of students
Marks on maths
exam
4049
5059
exercise 4a
Tally
|||
Ford
|||
Nissan
||
Mazda
|||
||
Mitsubishi
||
Score
Tally
Frequency
66
||||
67
68
10
5
Time
13 a
b
c
14 a
c
4049
||
5059
10
6069
7079
10
8089
71
||
9099
72
||
73
||||
Mark
Tally
4049
Class
Frequency
4044
Frequency
4549
5054
5059
||
5559
6069
||||
6064
6569
7074
7579
8084
8589
9094
9599
7079
|||
8089
|||
9099
||
15
Frequency
70
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
i
a ta
n
d
n
de For issa azd yo bish
N M To itsu
Make of car M
ol
20
Class
69
25
Frequency
Holden
Toyota
11
9
a
10 m
a
11 m
a
12 m
pm
1
pm
2
pm
3
pm
4
pm
5
pm
6
pm
7
pm
Make
9099
am
am
4
5
8089
7079
Temperature (C)
6069
statistical processes
a External
b External
c Internal
d External
e Internal
f Internal
g External
h External
a Internal
b External
c External
d Internal
a Observation
b Questioning
c Questioning
d Observation
e Questioning
f Observation
g Questioning
h Observation
Check with your teacher.
137
population characteristics
Male
Female
2029
10
3039
4049
12
5059
Year
Boys
Girls
10
11
10
10
10
11
12
11
12
13
14
15
4 a Quantitative, discrete
b Categorical, nominal
c Quantitative, continuous
d Quantitative, continuous
e Categorical, nominal
f Quantitative, continuous
g Quantitative, discrete
h Quantitative, continuous
i Quantitative, discrete
j Categorical, nominal
k Quantitative, continuous
l Quantitative, discrete
m Quantitative, discrete
n Categorical, nominal
o Categorical, ordinal
p Quantitative, continuous
q Quantitative, discrete
r Categorical, ordinal
s Categorical, nominal
t Categorical, ordinal
5 a Quantitative and discrete
b Categorical
c Categorical
d Quantitative and continuous
e Quantitative and continuous
f Quantitative and discrete
6 Categorical and ordinal
7 Categorical and ordinal
8 Quantitative and discrete
9 C
10 Categorical and ordinal
11 Quantitative and continuous
12 This statement means that words are
13
14
15
exercise 4d
1 a
b
c
d
e
f
2 a
b
c
d
e
3 a
b
c
d
e
138
types of data
Quantitative
Categorical
Quantitative
Categorical
Quantitative
Quantitative
Ordinal
Ordinal
Nominal
Nominal
Nominal
Continuous
Discrete
Continuous
Continuous
Continuous
16
17
exercise 4e
Bias
characteristics of population.
No control over responses
Unrepresentative sample
Abnormal conditions
Only extreme groups in sample
110
100
90
Health care cost ($m)
exercise 4C
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
2000
2004
Years
2008
that period.
even.
Chapter revIeW
MUltIple ChoICe
2 B
4 C
Frequency
1D
3A
short ansWer
1 a External
c External
2 a Observation
c Observation
3 Check with your teacher.
4
Score
Tally
1
2
3
4
5
6
5
Number of
CDs
04
59
1014
1519
2024
2529
3034
3539
|||
|
|
|
|||
|||
Tally
|||
||||
||||
|||
||||
|
|
b
d
b
d
Internal
Internal
Questioning
Questioning
Frequency
3
6
6
6
3
3
Number of
students
3
9
9
3
4
1
0
1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1 2 3 4 5 6
Number of people in a household
Number of people
in a household
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 a Sample
b Census
c Census
d Sample
8 Random sample where the participants
12 a Categorical
b Quantitative
c Quantitative
d Quantitative
e Categorical
13 a Discrete
b Continuous
c Continuous
d Discrete
e Continuous
14 Check with your teacher.
extended response
Categorical
Random
Quantitative and continuous
Systematic
The data are influenced by factors that
dont make them representative of the
whole population.
d Take cans of paint from each of the five
machines.
1 a
b
2 a
b
c
139
Chapter 5
Data can be displayed in many different ways. Most commonly data are displayed on some type of
graph. Graphs such as column graphs, sector graphs and line graphs were looked at in chapter 4 and
more can be found on these types of graphs using the skillsheets if you need them. In this section we are
going to look at some displays that are of particular use to statisticians.
radar charts
A radar chart is similar to a line graph except it is circular. It is particularly suitable for showing data
trends that repeat.
The radar is drawn with the data being measured placed in equal sectors around the circleand the
results having a scale emanating from the centre. The points are then plotted andjoined.
Worked example 1
The information below shows the sales in a department store over a year.
Month
Sales ($m)
Month
Sales ($m)
January
2.8
July
1.8
February
1.7
August
1.1
March
1.1
September
1.6
April
1.2
October
1.9
May
1.3
November
2.5
June
1.6
December
3.4
141
think
draW
Sales ($m)
January
3.5
3
2.5
2
1.5
1
0.5
0
December
November
October
February
March
April
September
May
August
June
July
dot plots
A dot plot is used to display a set of scores on a number line. This graph is useful for showing a small
number of scores.
Worked example 2
draW
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Stem-and-leaf plots
A stem-and-leaf plot is a method of tabulating data that generally consists of two parts.
A stem is made using the first part of each piece of data. The second part of each piece of data forms
the leaves. Consider the case below.
The following data show the mass (in kg) of 20 possums trapped, weighed then released by a wildlife
researcher.
1.8 0.9 0.7 1.4 1.6 2.1 2.7 2.2 1.8 2.3
2.3 1.5 1.1 2.2 3.0 2.5 2.7 3.2 1.9 1.7
The stem is made from the whole number part of the mass and the leaves are the decimal part. The
first piece of data was 1.8 kg. The stem of this number could be considered to be 1 and the leaf 0.8. The
second piece of data was 0.9. It has a stem of 0 and a leaf of 0.9.
To compose a stem-and-leaf plot for these data, rule a vertical column of stems then enter the leaf
of each piece of data in a neat row beside the appropriate stem. The first row of the stem-and-leaf plot
records all data from 0.0 to 0.9. The second row records data from 1.0 to 1.9 etc. Attach a key to the plot
to show the reader the meaning of each entry.
142
It is convention to assemble the data in order of size, so this stem-and-leaf plot should be written in
such a way that the numbers in each row of leafs are in ascending order.
Key: 0 | 7 = 0.7 kg
Stem Leaf
0 7 9
1 1 4 5 6 7 8 8 9
2 1 2 2 3 3 5 7 7
3 0 2
When preparing a stem-and-leaf plot, it is important to try to keep the numbers in neat vertical
columns because a neat plot gives the reader an idea of the distribution of scores. The plot itself looks a
bit like a histogram turned on its side.
Worked example 3
The information below shows the mass, in kilograms, of twenty 16-year-old boys.
65
61
45
58
56
49
57
52
58
64
54
71
61
66
72
65
70
66
69
60
Write
Write a key.
Key: 5 | 6 = 56 kg
Stem
4
5
6
7
Leaf
5 9
2 4 6 7 8 8
0 1 1 4 5 5 6 6 9
0 1 2
It is also useful to be able to represent data with a class size of 5. This could be done for the
stem-and-leaf plot below by choosing stems 0*, 1, 1*, 2, 2*, 3, where the class with stem 1 contains
all the data from 1.0 to 1.4 and stem 1* contains the data from 1.5 to 1.9 etc. If stems are split in
this way, it is a good idea to include two entries in the key. The stem-and-leaf plot for the possum
data would appear as follows.
Key: 1 | 1 = 1.1 kg
Stem
0*
1
1*
2
2*
3
1* | 5 = 1.5
Leaf
7 9
1 4
5 6 7 8 8 9
1 2 2 3 3
5 7 7
0 2
A stem-and-leaf plot has the following advantages over a frequency distribution table.
Theplotitselfgivesagraphicalrepresentationofthespreadofdata.(Itisratherlikea
histogram turned on its side.)
Alltheoriginaldataareretained,sothereisnolossofaccuracywhencalculatingstatisticssuch
asthemeanandstandarddeviation.Inagroupedfrequencydistributiontable(seepage146)
some generalisations are made when these values are calculated.
143
Worked example 4
think
Write
Since all the original data are recorded on the stem-and-leaf plot and are conveniently arranged in order
of size, the plot can be used to locate the upper and lower quartiles and the median.
exercise 5a
1 We1 The table below shows the average monthly temperature in Sydney.
144
Month
Temp (C)
January
28
July
15
February
30
August
16
March
26
September
20
April
24
October
22
May
20
November
25
June
17
December
27
Month
Temp (C)
2 The table below shows the percentage of televisions that are being watched over a 24-hour period.
Time
Percentage
Time
Percentage
12:00 am
12%
12:00 pm
30%
2:00 am
1%
2:00 pm
33%
4:00 am
2%
4:00 pm
45%
6:00 am
8%
6:00 pm
60%
8:00 am
15%
8:00 pm
78%
10:00 am
24%
10:00 pm
55%
10
30
30
31
29
28 35 33 34 30
32 31 30 31 29
Show this information on a dot plot.
27
29
28
28
29
25
30
26
26
30
28
31
33
29
5 We3 The data below give the number of errors made each week by 20 machine operators. Prepare a
15
26
20
38
25
31
28
26
18
29
32
32
43
46
52
13
27
20
6 The data below give the time taken for each of 40 runners on a 10 km fun run.
Prepare a stem-and-leaf diagram for the data using a class size of 10 minutes.
36
66
42
71
42
75
58
42
52
45
40
50
38
42
41
46
47
55
47
40
59
38
53
52
72
42
68
37
68
46
43
54
57
48
39
48
82
39
48
52
7 We4 The typing speed of 30 word processors is recorded below. Prepare a stem-and-leaf diagram of
102
86
95
92
107
98
96
111
102
95
107
108
102
108
112
95
103
120
115
121
99
110
107
121
108
96
130
Chapter 5 Displaying single data sets
145
8 Twenty transistors are tested by applying increasing voltage until they are destroyed. The maximum
voltage that each could withstand is recorded below. Prepare a stem-and-leaf plot of the data using a
class size of 0.5.
14.8 15.2 13.8 14.0 14.8 15.7 15.5 15.6 14.7 14.3
14.6 15.2 15.9 15.1 14.3 14.6 13.9 14.7 14.5 14.2
Questions 9 and 10 refer to the stem-and-leaf plot below.
Key: 12 | 1 = 1210
12* | 5 = 1250
Stem Leaf
12
1 2 4
12* 5 7 7 9 9
13
0 1 1 2 3 4 4
13* 5 6 6 7 9 9
14
0 2 3 4
14* 0 1
9 mC The class size used in the stem-and-leaf plot is:
a 1
B 10
C 33
10 mC The number of scores that have been recorded is:
a 27
B 33
C 1210
d 50
d 1410
Further development
11 a Describe the advantages of displaying data in a dot plot.
b The data below shows the number of packets of chips sold from a vending machine over a 2 week
period.
15, 17, 18, 18, 14, 16, 17, 6, 16, 18, 16, 16, 20, 18
Display this information in a dot plot.
c Explain why a dot plot is only suitable for discrete data.
12 Explain why it would not be suitable to represent each of the following data sets on a dot plot.
a A cricketers scores in a season were 4, 65, 82, 5, 19, 56, 23, 153.
b The heights of 8 bushes were 1.93 m, 1.76 m, 1.55 m, 1.86 m, 1.97 m, 1.13 m, 1.05 m, 2.06 m.
13 Tina wants to draw graphs to represent the following data:
The average daily sales in her shop over a week
The most frequently sold items in her shop
The amounts of money spent by her customers
Which of these would be most suitable to display on a radar chart? Explain your choice.
14 The data below gives the head circumference (to the nearest centimetre) of 16 four-year-oldgirls.
48 49 47 52 51 50 49 48 50 50 53 52 43 47 49 50
diGital doC
doc-10319
drawing graphs using
graphics calculators
and spreadsheets
and 1s on the first row, 2s and 3s on the second row and so on. Complete the stem-and-leaf plot
using this method.
15 Explain why categorical data is unsuitable to be represented by a line graph.
From previous years you should be familiar with compiling a frequency table. In this section we will
revise compiling frequency tables, but place an emphasis on the use of the cumulative frequency.
When working with quantitative data, each piece of data is known as a score. Quantitative data may be
presented as grouped or ungrouped data. Ungrouped data are suitable for discrete data that do not have a
wide range of scores.
The frequency table will have columns for scores, tally, frequency and cumulative frequency, which is
a running total of the frequency column.
146
Worked example 5
Fifty people were surveyed and asked the number of videos that they had hired from a video store
in the past month. The results are shown below.
2
4
5
3
3
3
3
0
5
1
1
3
3
0
5
2
2
1
3
1
3
4
4
2
0
1
4
0
3
2
0
1
5
5
1
2
3
5
3
4
0
2
0
4
4
4
2
2
4
5
Enter the information in a frequency table.
think
Write/draW
Count the tally marks for each score and enter the
result in the frequency column.
Score
0
1
2
3
4
5
Tally
|||| ||
|||| ||
|||| ||||
|||| |||| |
|||| ||||
|||| ||
Frequency
7
7
9
11
9
7
When data are continuous or spread over a wide range it is useful to group the scores into groups or
classes. When summarising raw data in a frequency table the group size is important. In general we try
to have between 5 and 10 classes.
Later we will be looking at some of the calculations that are done using a frequency table. For this
reason we need to have a single score to represent every score in the group and so an extra column is
created called the class centre.
Worked example 6
The height of 40 students was measured and the results are shown
below.
146
159
152
164
141
143
148
148
155
152
152
168
166
156
142
169
168
146
162
146
158
146
159
162
169
161
141
151
164
150
151
150
141
141
169
143
154
153
169
140
147
think
1
Write/draW
140<145
Class
centre
142.5
Tally
|||| |||
145<150
147.5
||||
150<155
152.5
||||
||||
155<160
157.5
||||
160<165
165170
162.5
||||
167.5
||||
Height
Frequency
8
5
5
||
In analysing statistical data the most useful graph that can be drawn is the cumulative frequency histogram and polygon (ogive). The cumulative frequency histogram is drawn without the half column space
before the first column, while the ogive is drawn to the top right-hand corner of each column.
Worked example 7
The frequency table below shows the heights of people in a basketball squad.
Height (cm)
Class centre
Frequency
170<175
172.5
175<180
177.5
180<185
182.5
12
185<190
187.5
10
190<195
195200
192.5
197.5
148
175<180
177.5
180<185
182.5
12
21
185<190
187.5
10
31
190<195
195200
192.5
39
197.5
40
7.5
19
2.5
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
7.5
172.5
19
170<175
2.5
Cumulative
frequency
18
Frequency
7.5
Class
centre
18
Height
(cm)
2.5
17
Cumulative frequency
Write/draW
17
think
Height (cm)
It is important to see that the increase in each column of the cumulative frequency histogram
represents the frequency of each class. This enables us to reconstruct a frequency table from the
cumulative frequency graph.
Worked example 8
Cumulative frequency
Use the cumulative frequency histogram below to complete a frequency table of the data.
Cumulative frequency
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
think
Write/draW
Class
Class
centre
Cumulative
frequency
150<160
155
160<170
165
14
22
170<180
175
30
180<190
185
14
44
190<200
195
11
55
200210
205
60
Frequency
1 We5 Twenty households were surveyed to find the number of people in that household. The results
Tally
Frequency
4
4
5
7
8
5
5
6
10
7
7
5
6
7
9
8
7
4
6
6
5
8
7
7
diGital doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1559
Frequency tables
149
72
77
77
70
72
75
69
73
72
75
72
72
78
72
72
68
72
71
66
74
73
68
70
72
67
71
70
72
73
74
72
72
72
71
77
71
68
74
73
73
76
68
72
68
67
71
69
67
74
68
68
69
72
73
58
41
45
42
69
73
92
80
38
50
51
60
70
49
65
65
69
94
73
88
52
85
76
53
48
60
Use these results to copy and complete the frequency table below.
Score
Class centre
Tally
Frequency
3039
40 49
5059
6069
7079
8089
9099
5 A farmer measures the heights of his tomato plants.
1.21
1.77
2.14
1.23
1.41
1.39
2.03
1.65
1.53
1.72
1.74
1.76
1.40
0.63
2.07
1.34
1.86
1.67
1.17
1.24
1.96
0.75
1.55
1.28
1.53
1.99
1.05
1.17
1.42
1.43
12.2
11.4
12.2
12.8
11.6
12.0
11.0
12.0
12.4
11.7
11.9
10.9
12.7
11.7
12.2
12.0
11.7
12.9
10.8
12.7
12.6
11.2
11.3
13.3
13.0
11.7
11.8
11.2
11.7
12.2
Construct a frequency distribution table for the data. Use a class size of 0.5 seconds.
150
Frequency
2
8
11
6
2
1
Frequency
2
10
32
9
5
2
polygon.
9 The following frequency table gives the number of oysters of different lengths from a tray in a marine
farm.
Length (cm)
Class centre
4<5
Frequency
6
5<6
10
6<7
60
7<8
58
8<9
910
Cumulative
frequency
151
10 The following frequency table gives the results of testing the lives of 200 torch batteries.
Lifetime (hours)
20<25
Frequency
6
25<30
25
30<35
70
35<40
61
40<45
4550
30
8
a Redraw the table, including a column for class centre and cumulative frequency.
b Draw a cumulative frequency histogram and polygon.
11 Complete the frequency and class columns for the frequency table below.
Class
Class centre
3
8
13
18
23
Frequency
Cumulative frequency
5
12
20
30
35
Cumulative frequency
12 Use the cumulative frequency histogram below to construct a frequency table for the data.
Cumulative frequency
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0 3
6 7 8
Score
10
Cumulative frequency
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0 5
15 25 35 45
Class centre
C 30<40
d 40<50
Cumulative frequency
14 We8 Use the cumulative frequency histogram below to construct a frequency table for the data.
50
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0 5
152
15 25 35 45
Class centre
Further development
15 A survey is conducted where 40 people were asked the number of hours of television that they watched
each week.
a Is the data discrete or continuous?
b The results are as shown below.
10, 13,
7, 12, 16, 11,
6, 14,
6, 11,
5, 14, 12,
8, 27, 17, 13,
8, 14, 10
13,
7, 15, 10, 16,
8, 18, 14, 21, 28,
9, 12, 11, 13,
9, 13, 29,
5, 24, 11
Why is it more practical in this case to use class groupings rather than individual scores?
c Complete the frequency table below.
Class
Tally
Class centre
Frequency
5<10
10<15
15<20
20<25
2530
16 The number of phone calls made, on average, per week in a sample of 56 people is listed below.
21, 50,
8, 64, 33, 58, 35, 61,
3, 51,
5, 62, 16, 44,
56, 17, 59, 23, 34, 57, 49,
2, 24, 50, 27, 33, 55,
7,
52, 17, 54, 78, 69, 53,
2, 42, 52, 28, 67, 25, 48, 63,
12, 72, 36, 66, 15, 28, 67, 13, 23, 10, 72, 72, 89, 80
a Is the data discrete or continuous?
b Explain why classes of 110, 1020, . . . etc. are not appropriate in this case.
c Complete a frequency table using a class size of 10.
17 The following frequency table shows the time taken (in seconds) for 60 people, involved in a
Frequency
6<8
8<10
10<12
15
12<14
18
14<16
12
16<18
1820
Cumulative
frequency
whole numbers.)
30
25
20
15
10
5
0 54.5 64.5 74.5 84.5 94.5
Class centre
diGital doC
WorkSHEET 5.1
doc-10320
153
interaCtiVitY
int-2362
measures of centre
and spread
Once a set of scores has been collected, tabulated and graphed, we are ready to make some conclusions
about the data.
The range and interquartile range are used to measure the spread of a set of scores.
The range is the difference between the highest and the lowest score.
Range = highest score lowest score
Worked example 9
There are 17 players in the squad for a State of Origin match. The number of State of Origin
matches played by each member of the squad is shown below.
2 6 12 8 1 4 8 9 24 4 5 11 14 6 11 15 10
What is the range of this distribution?
think
Write
Lowest score = 1
Highest score = 24
Range = 24 1
= 23
A smaller range will usually represent a more consistent set of scores. Exceptions to this are when one
or two scores are much higher or lower than most.
When we are calculating the range from a frequency distribution table, we find the highest and lowest
score from the score column. We do not use any information from the frequency column in calculating the
range. When the data are presented in grouped form, the range is found by taking the highest score from
the highest class and the lowest score from the lowest class.
Worked example 10
The frequency distribution table below shows the heights of boys competing for a place on a
basketball team.
Find the range of these data.
Height
170<175
Frequency
3
175<180
180<185
12
185<190
10
190<195
195200
think
154
1
Write
In many cases, the range is not a good indicator of the overall spread of scores. Consider the two sets of
scores below showing the wages of people in two small businesses.
A: $240, $240, $240, $245, $250, $250, $260, $800
B: $180, $200, $240, $290, $350, $400, $500, $600
The range for business
A = $800 $240
= $560
While the range for business A is greater, by looking at the wages in the two businesses, we can see
that the wages in business B are generally more spread. The range uses only two scores in its calculation.
The interquartile range is usually a better measure of dispersion (spread).
The quartiles are found by dividing the data into quarters. The lower quartile is the lowest 25% of
scores, the upper quartile is the highest 25% of scores.
To calculate an interquartile range, we must first be able to calculate the median. To calculate the
median, we must first arrange the scores in ascending order. The median is the middle score (if there is
an odd number of scores) or the average of the two middle scores (if there is an even number of scores).
Worked example 11
think
Write
a Median = 8
b Median =
87 + 88
2
= 87.5
The interquartile range is the difference between the upper quartile and the lower quartile. To find the
1
lower and upper quartiles we arrange the scores in ascending order. The lower quartile is 4 of the way
3
through the distribution and the upper quartile is 4 of the way through the distribution.
To find the interquartile range we follow the steps below.
1. Arrange the data in ascending order.
2. Divide the data into two halves by finding the median.
(a) If there is an odd number of scores, the median score should not be included in either half of the
scores.
(b) If there is an even number of scores, the middle will be halfway between two scores and this will
divide the data neatly into two sets.
3. The lower quartile will be the median of the lower half of the data.
4. The upper quartile will be the median of the upper half of the data.
5. The interquartile range will be the difference between the medians of the two halves of the data.
Worked example 12
Find the interquartile range of the following data, which show the number of home runs scored in
a series of baseball matches.
12, 9, 4, 6, 5, 8, 9, 4, 10, 2
think
Write/diSplaY
Method 1
1
2, 4, 4, 5, 6, 8, 9, 9, 10, 12
2, 4, 4, 5, 6
Lower quartile = 4
Upper quartile = 9
Interquartile range = 9 4
=5
8, 9, 9, 10, 12
155
Method 2
1 From the MENU select STAT.
156
Delete any existing data from all lists and then enter the
scores into List 1.
Scroll down using the arrow keys until you can see the
median, which is equal to 7.
To find the range, we need to find the lowest and the highest
score. On the previous screen you will see the lowest score
denoted MinX. Scroll down further to find MaxX. The range
is found by subtracting MinX from MaxX.
Range = 12 2
= 10
On this screen you will see the value of the upper quartile
Q3 and the lower quartile Q1. To find the interquartile
range, subtract Q1 from Q3.
IQR = 9 4
=5
In most cases we are asked to find the interquartile range of a grouped distribution. This requires us to
draw a cumulative frequency polygon and find the 25th and 75th percentile.
A percentile is a measure of where in a set of scores an individual score lies. For example, the
25th percentile has 25% of scores below it and 75% above it.
To find the interquartile range, draw a second vertical axis that shows the 25th, 50th and
75th percentile. A line is drawn from the 25th, 50th and 75th percentile to the ogive and then down to the
horizontal axis. The value for the quartiles can then be calculated.
The median is the score that is found at the 50th percentile.
Cumulative frequency
Worked example 13
50
40
30
20
10
0
think
percentiles.
Write/draW
100%
75%
50%
5 5 5 5 5 5
0.2 0.7 1.2 1.7 2.2 2.7
Volumes of concrete
50
40
30
20
25%
10
0%
5 5 5 5 5 5
0.2 0.7 1.2 1.7 2.2 2.7
Volumes of concrete
Median = 0.9
b Lower quartile = 0.4
A data set can also be divided into deciles. A decile is a band of 10% of all scores. The deciles can be
calculated in the same way as the quartiles, using the appropriate percentage on the vertical scale. For
example, the top decile would be found using the 90th percentile.
Chapter 5 Displaying single data sets
157
scores.
a
Score
1
2
3
4
5
Frequency
2
6
12
10
7
Score
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
Frequency
12
25
36
34
11
9
4
5160
6170
7180
8190
91100
2
8
15
7
1
Class
4043
Frequency
48
4447
112
4851
254
5255
297
5659
199
6063
84
Score
38
39
40
41
42
43
Frequency
23
46
52
62
42
45
Class
150<155
155<160
160<165
165<170
170<175
175180
Frequency
12
25
38
47
39
20
4 The scores below show the number of points scored by two AFL teams over the first 10 games of the
season.
Sydney:
110
Collingwood: 125
95
112
74
89
136
111
48
96
168
113
120
85
85
90
99
87
65
92
5 Two machines are used to fill boxes with approximately 100 Smarties. A check is made on the
operation of the two machines. Ten boxes filled by each machine have the number of Smarties in them
counted. The results are shown below.
Machine A:
Machine B:
100, 99, 99, 101, 100, 101, 100, 100, 101, 108
98, 104, 96, 97, 103, 96, 102, 100, 97, 104
50
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
0 1 2 3 4 5
No. of speeding fines
received by drivers
9 The frequency distribution table below shows the result of a survey of 90 households who were asked
about the number of times they had been the victim of crime.
a
b
c
d
Score
Frequency
26
31
22
159
a 4
Score
Frequency
25
14
26
12
27
19
28
25
29
19
B 5
C 6
d 17
C 5
d 8
12 mC The interquartile range is considered to be a better measure of the variability of a set of scores
Height (cm)
Class centre
Frequency
Cumulative
frequency
140<150
145
150<160
155
160<170
165
10
17
170<180
175
24
180190
185
25
a
B
C
d
14 The frequency distribution table below shows the marks obtained by a group of people on an IQ test.
IQscore
Frequency
7584
12
8594
25
95104
50
105114
24
115124
13
a Redraw the frequency distribution table to include columns for class centre and cumulative
frequency.
b Draw a cumulative frequency histogram and polygon.
c Find the range.
d Use the graph to estimate the i interquartile range ii top decile
160
15 The following frequency distribution table shows the distribution of daily maximum temperatures
a
b
c
d
e
Number of days
0<5
5<10
22
10<15
95
15<20
124
20<25
94
25<30
19
30<35
3540
16 The following data give the number of fruit that have formed on each of 30 trees in an orchard.
a
b
c
d
45
48
52
36
38
72
36
74
56
46
81
73
46
48
44
39
52
58
57
65
60
53
54
58
41
44
47
76
68
55
a
b
c
d
e
f
g
h
Salary ( $1000)
Frequency
15<20
20<25
12
25<30
30<35
35<40
40<45
4550
161
18 A manufacturer of surf clothing needs to know how many clothes of different sizes to produce. The
manager organises a survey of young people which provides the following data:
a
b
c
d
e
f
g
Frequency
70<75
13
75<80
28
80<85
46
85<90
30
90<95
17
95<100
100<105
105110
19 A biologist who counts the number of seeds produced in each of 60 pumpkins presents his findings on
60
100%
50
40
30
50%
20
10
10 20 30 40 50 60 70
Number of seeds
a
b
c
d
e
f
g
h
Cumulative frequency
20 A time trial is a race in which each competitor rides separately, racing against the clock.
The following are the times (in seconds) of 20 competitors in a 1 km cycling time trial.
75
73
162
72
75
68
82
78
90
75
92
68
75
77
73
80
72
85
70
82
83
Time (s)
Cumulative
frequency
Frequency
65<70
70<75
75<80
80<85
85<90
9095
Prepare an ogive of the data.
How many riders finished with a time of 82 seconds or better?
Find the 90th percentile and write a sentence which explains what it means.
The top 20% of riders are to be selected for a special training squad. What time would be needed
to qualify for the squad?
21 The following data, collected from a maternity hospital, gives the birth weights (in kg) of 30babies.
b
c
d
e
3.7
4.2
3.1
3.2
2.5
2.8
3.8
2.7
2.9
4.1
3.9
3.2
2.9
3.6
3.1
3.3
3.2
3.8
3.6
3.0
3.9
3.1
2.9
3.3
3.6
3.4
4.4
3.9
3.0
3.4
Cumulative frequency
a
b
c
d
e
163
5d
interaCtiVitY
int-2788
parallel boxplots
int-0802
Boxplots and
five-number summary
Five-number summaries
Once the median and quartiles have been calculated, we are able to summarise a data set using five
numbers. This five-number summary consists of:
lower extreme the lowest score in the data set
lower quartile the score at the 25th percentile
median the middle score
upper quartile the score at the 75th percentile
upper extreme the highest score in the data set.
Worked example 14
64
50
Write
12
15
29
36
46
50
64
73
Lower extreme = 9
Lower quartile = 15
Median =
Upper quartile = 64
Upper extreme = 85
Five-number summary = 9, 15, 41, 64, 85
85
36 + 46
2
= 41
In most cases you will need to calculate the five-number summary from an ogive.
Worked example 15
Cumulative frequency
The ogive below shows the number of seeds found in each of 60 pumpkins.
100%
60
50
40
50%
30
20
10
0
0%
0 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70
Number of seeds
Write/draW
60
Cumulative frequency
think
50
40
30
50%
20
10
0
164
100%
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70
Number of seeds
0%
Lower extreme = 10
Lower quartile = 31
Median = 38
Upper quartile = 47
Upper extreme = 70
Five-number summary = 10, 31, 38, 47, 70
It is important that you are able to construct a five number summary regardless of what form the data
is presented in. In the example below we are looking at the data in the form of a stem-and-leaf plot.
Worked example 16
The stem-and-leaf plot shown below shows the ages of 25 people who attend a French speaking
course.
Stem Leaf
1 8 8 9
2 0 2 7 9 9
3 1 3 3 5 6 6 7 9
4 0 2 2 6 8
5 5
Produce a five-number summary of the data.
think
Write
Lowest score = 18
Highest score = 55
Median = 36
Lower quartile = 28
18
28
36
39.5
555
Once a five-number summary has been developed, it can be graphed using a box-and-whisker plot
(boxplot), a powerful way to display the spread of the data.
The box-and-whisker plot consists of a central divided box with attached whiskers. The box spans the
interquartile range, the vertical line inside the box marks the median and the whiskers indicate the range.
lower
lower
extreme quartile
median
upper
upper
quartile extreme
Box-and-whisker plots are always drawn to scale. This can be drawn with the five-number summary
attached as labels:
15
21 23
28
10 15
20 25
30
Scale
165
Worked example 17
After analysing the speed of motorists through a particular intersection, the following five-number
summary was developed.
The lowest score is 82.
The lower quartile is 84.
The median is 89.
The upper quartile is 95.
The highest score is 114.
Show this information in a box-and-whisker plot.
think
1
draW
exercise 5d
Five-number summaries
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
Cumulative
frequency
Cumulative frequency
15 17 16 8 25 18 20 15 17
2 For each of the data sets below, write a five-number summary.
a 23 45 92 80 84 83 43 83
b 2 6 4 2 5 7 1
c 60 75 29 38 69 63 45 20 29 93 8 29 93
14
1
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
4 5
Score
45 55 65 75 85 95
Score
5 We16 The data below shows the number of race starts that have been had by 24 horses who are
6 The stem-and-leaf plot below shows the time taken for 13 athletes to run 200 m.
Key: 6 | 4 = 64
6* | 6 = 66
Stem Leaf
6
4
6* 6 8 8 9 9 9
7
0 0 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 3 3 4 4
7* 5 5 5 6 6 7 7 8 8 9
8
0 0 0 1
Present the data in the form of a five-number summary.
8 We17 A five-number summary is given below.
50
30
35 40 45 50 55 60
No. of honey bears
10
15 20
25 30 Scale
B 23
C 35
d 31
C 5
d 20 to 25
B 26
13 mC Which of the following is not true of the data represented by the box-and-whisker plot?
a
B
C
d
167
Jan.
Feb.
Mar.
Apr.
May
June
July
Aug.
Sept.
Oct.
Nov.
Dec.
10
12
21
23
39
22
15
11
22
37
45
30
period.
Mon.
Tues.
Wed.
Thur.
Fri.
Sat.
Sun.
125
144
132
148
187
172
181
134
157
152
126
155
183
188
131
121
165
129
143
182
181
152
163
150
148
152
179
181
Further development
16 The following data show the ages of
40
39
31
18
37
28
18
37
46
24
27
32
20
16
54
43
35
39
14
37
48
46
23
24
38
35
Prepare a five-number summary of the data by first putting the data in a stem-and-leaf plot.
Find the range.
Find the interquartile range.
If the slowest 25% of workers were to be dismissed, what would be the cut off time used?
If you took 21 minutes to assemble an item, write a sentence to convince your employer that you
are a valuable employee.
18 Two classes sat for a Mathematics test. Their results have been summarised by the five-number
summary below.
Class A: 25 40 52 75 95
Class B: 20 35 56 75 85
a Find the range of marks for each class.
b What is the median for each class?
c Calculate the interquartile range for each class.
d Which class has been the most consistent? Explain your answer.
168
19 The stem plot at right details the age of 25 offenders who were
Stem Leaf
1 8 8 9 9 9
2 0 0 0 1 1 3 4 6 9
3 0 1 2 7
4 2 5
5 3 6 8
6 6
7 4
20 Explain what the boxplot below tells you about the distribution of the data it represents.
caught during random breath testing.
a Prepare a five-number summary of the data.
b Draw a boxplot of the data.
When displaying data it is important that the right graph be chosen. To choose the correct graph the type
of data needs to be identified.
If the data is categorical, usually a comparison needs to be made and so a sector graph of a divided bar
graph may be the best choice.
Worked example 18
Write/draW
360 36 = 10
Each room can be represented by an
angle of 10.
Computer room
Manual arts
rooms
10
10
30
Laboratories
40
Art rooms 30
30
s
n
e
tch
Ki
210
Classrooms
169
If the data represents the change in a quantity over time, a line graph will best display this
information, while if the data is cyclical (e.g. months of the year) a radar chart may the best option.
In general, however, if the data is continuous and quantitative a histogram best displays data.
Graphs are often misrepresented in the media depending upon the purpose of the graph. It may be
politicians wishing to magnify their achievements or a company wanting to accentuate their profits.
13 000
Paved
Formed
12 000
Unconstructed
11 000
State
highways
10 000
Developmental
roads
Main roads
9000
8000
7000
6000
5000
4000
3000
2000
1000
Urban and
sub-arterials
170
Secondary
roads
Quarter
JM
AJ
JS
Holdings in $m
200
200
201
OD
202
300
200
100
JM
AJ
JS
Quarter
OD
202
201.5
x
201
200.5
x
200
JM
AJ
Quarter
JS
OD
x
202
201.5
x
201
200.5
x
JM
200
JS
Quarter
OD
Look at the figures below. Notice in graph (a) that the numbers from 0 to 4000 have been omitted. In
graph (b) these numbers have been inserted. The rate of growth of the company looks far less spectacular
in graph (b) than in graph (a).
x
x
x
5000
4500
x
x
4000
2003
x x
x x
04
05
06
Year
(a)
07
Number of employees
in company
Number of employees
in company
5500
08
5000
4000
x x
x x
xx x
3000
2000
1000
2003
04
05
06
Year
(b)
07
08
Foreshortening the vertical axis is a very common procedure. It does have the advantage of giving
extra detail but it can give the wrong impression about growth rates.
Net value of production
Visual impression
$m
400
300
200
100
S
2006
S
2007
Year
S
2008
171
500
400
300
300
200
100
2004 05 06
Year
(a)
07
200
100
2004 05 06
Year
(b)
08
07
08
Both of these graphs show the same numerical information. But graph (a) has a linear scale on
the vertical axis and graph (b) does not. Graph (a) emphasises the ever-increasing rate of growth of
pollutants while graph (b) suggests a slower, linear growth.
Worked example 19
The following data give wages and profits for a certain company. All figures are in millions of dollars.
Year
Wages
% increase in wages
Profits
1990
6
25
1
% increase in profits
20
1995
9
50
1.5
2000
13
44
2.5
2005
20
54
5
50
66
100
20
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
Wages
Profits
100
Profits
75
50
Wages
25
Write
b i
172
linear.
Look at the units on both axes. Graph (a) has
y-axis in $ while graph (b) has y-axis in %.
1
ii
appropriate graphs
and misuse of graphs
exercise 5e
in our region.
a Which country produces the most wheat?
b Of the three countries shown, which one produces the least
wheat?
c What reasons would you give for Australia being able to
produce more wheat than New Zealand?
d From this graph, are you able to tell how much wheat is
produced in each country?
Indonesia
New
Zealand
Australia
Australia.
State/territory
New South Wales
Victoria
Queensland
Western Australia
South Australia
Tasmania
Australian Capital Territory
Northern Territory
Unemployed
213 000
152 000
141 000
67 000
52 000
21 000
9 000
8 000
Find the sector angle for each state and draw a sector graph to show this information.
Chapter 5 Displaying single data sets
173
4 The figure and table below show various time periods during the week, and the number of fatal
accidents in New South Wales during those periods. Use the figure and table to answer the
questions.
Day of week
Time
Monday
Midnight
Tuesday
Wednesday
Thursday
Friday
Sunday
3 am
Saturday
9 am
3 pm
9 pm
Midnight
For example, time period I is from 9 pm on Sunday, Monday, Tuesday and Wednesday
nights to 3 am the following mornings.
Fatal accidents
58
48
115
25
18
73
52
68
42
64
to 1 decimal place)?
How many hours per week are represented by the J period?
What was the total number of fatal accidents for this particular year?
Why is this number different from the number of fatalities for this year (620)?
How many fatal accidents were there during time period F?
During what time period were there 18 fatal accidents?
Which time period was the worst for the number of fatal accidents?
What percentage of the total number of fatal accidents occurred during the C period (correct to
1decimal place)?
j Why do you think the F and G periods were kept separate as 2 different periods?
k What would be the most likely cause of fatal accidents in the I time period?
c
d
e
f
g
h
i
5 The average number of phone calls made per week by a sample of 56 people is listed below.
21, 50, 8, 64, 33, 58, 35, 61, 3, 51, 5, 62, 16, 44, 56, 17, 59, 23, 34, 57, 49, 2, 24, 50, 27, 33,
55, 7, 52, 17, 54, 78, 69, 53, 2, 42, 52, 28, 67, 25, 48, 63, 12, 72, 36, 66, 15, 28, 67, 13, 23,
10, 72, 72, 89, 80
a Organise the data into a grouped frequency distribution table using groupings of 09, 1019 and
so on.
b Display the data as a combined histogram and frequency polygon.
6 Construct the following:
a a frequency distribution table using intervals 1215, 1619, . . . and
b a combined histogram and frequency polygon for the following data.
174
24
16
19
26
20
29
23
22
23
26
18
25
27
15
30
14
27
26
20
21
22
19
23
25
17
22
16
21
30
13
24
31
26
25
18
25
7 We19 This graph shows the dollars spent on research in a company for 2000, 2004 and 2008. Draw
another bar graph that minimises the appearance of the fall in research funds.
1.6
1.5
1.4
1.3
1.2
1.1
2000
2004
Year
2008
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1974
1981
1988
1993
1998
2003
2008
Total employment
(hundreds)
11
10
9
8
7
6
Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec
Source: Overseas Arrivals and Departures, Australia (3401.0).
1995
2005
10
15
20
Ratio
25
30
a Describe what has generally happened to the ratio of students to teaching staff over the 10-year
period.
b A note says that the graph should not be used as a measure of class size. Explain why.
Chapter 5 Displaying single data sets
175
11 You run a company that is listed on the Stock Exchange. During the past year you have given
substantial rises in salary to all your staff. However, profits have not been as spectacular as in the year
before. The following table gives the figures for the mean salary and profits for each quarter. Draw
two graphs, one showing profits, the other showing salaries, that will show you in the best possible light
to your shareholders.
1st quarter
6
4
Profits $m
Salaries $m
2nd quarter
5.9
5
3rd quarter
6
6
4th quarter
6.5
7
12 You are a manufacturer and your plant is discharging heavy metals into a waterway. Your own chemists
do tests every 3 months and the following table gives the results for a period of 2 years. Draw a graph
which will show your company in the best light.
2007
Date
Concentration
(parts per million)
2008
Jan.
Apr.
July
Oct.
Jan.
Apr.
July
Oct.
18
25
30
40
49
57
13 This pie graph shows the break-up of national health expenditure in 200506 from three sources:
Australian Government, State and local government, and non-government. (This expenditure relates to
private health insurance, injury compensation insurers and individuals.)
Break-up of national
expenditure
Australian Government
State and local governments
Non-government
Expenditure source
Australian Government
State and local
government
Non-government
($m)
37 229
21 646
%
45
25
28 004
30
a Comment on the claim that $87 000 m was spent on health from these three sources.
b Which area contributes least to national health expenditure? Comment on its quoted percentage.
c Which area contributes the next greatest amount to national health expenditure? Comment on its
quoted percentage.
d The Australian Government contributes the greatest amount. Comment on its quoted percentage.
e Consider the pie chart.
i Based on the percentages shown in the table, what should the angles be?
ii Based on the actual expenditures, what should the angles be?
iii Measure the angles in the pie chart and comment on their values.
14 This graph shows how the $27 that a buyer pays for a CD is distributed among the departments
Record company
administration costs $1.54
Mechanical
royalties $1.57
diGital doC
WorkSHEET 5.2
doc-10321
176
Sales tax
$3.27
Production
$3.40
You are required to find out whether or not the graph is misleading, to explain fully your reasoning,
and to support any statements that you make. Also,
a comment on the shape of the graph and how it could be obtained.
b Does your visual impression of the graph support the figures?
Summary
types of graphs and
stem-and-leaf plots
range and
interquartile range,
deciles and percentiles
The range is the difference between the highest score and the lowest score.
The interquartile range is the difference between the score at the 25th percentile and the
75th percentile.
The median is the score in the middle of the distribution (50th percentile).
The median, lower quartile and upper quartile can be calculated by using an ogive (cumulative
frequency polygon).
A percentile shows what percentage of scores are below the given score.
A decile shows which band of 10% a score lies in.
Five-number
summaries
A five-number summary of a data set is the lower extreme, lower quartile, median, upper quartile
and upper extreme.
A five-number summary can be graphed using a box-and-whisker plot.
A box-and-whisker plot shows the spread of a data set on a scale.
appropriate graphs
and misuse of graphs
177
Chapter review
m U lt ip l e
C h oiCe
1 The frequency table below shows the marks achieved on a test by a group of students.
Score
Frequency
15
12
16
15
17
10
18
19
20
d 18
2 Which of the following would be greatly affected by the addition of an extreme score to the data set?
a
B
C
d
The median
The range
The interquartile range
All would be greatly affected
a 12
100%
25
20
15
50%
10
5
0
0%
0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45
Weight
B 17
Cumulative frequency %
Cumulative frequency
3 For the cumulative frequency polygon below, the interquartile range of the data is:
C 24
d 12 to 24
10
15
20 25
30 35
40
45 Scale
B 28
C 36
d 42
B 28
C 14 to 42
d 24 to 36
1 A survey is taken about the television stations being watched at 7:30 pm on a Monday night.
3 A cricketer keeps track of the number of wickets he took in each innings in which he bowled during a
4
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
0
0
0
1
4 The following data give the amount of cut meat (in kg) obtained from 20 lambs.
4.5
5.9
6.2
5.8
5.8
5.0
4.7
4.3
4.0
4.0
3.9
4.6
6.2
4.8
6.8
5.3
5.5
4.2
6.1
4.8
Show these data in a frequency table using a class size of 0.5 kg.
5 The table below shows the number of sales made each day over a month in a car yard.
Number of sales
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
Frequency
2
7
12
6
2
0
1
Class
50009999
Class centre
Frequency
1
10 00014 999
15 00019 999
20 00024 999
25 00029 999
30 00034 999
a Copy and complete the class centre column for the frequency table.
b Show the information in a frequency histogram and polygon.
7 The frequency table below shows the marks achieved by Year 11 students on their English exam.
Class
3039
40 49
5059
6069
7079
8079
Class
centre
Frequency
3
6
12
15
18
10
Cumulative
frequency
179
Cumulative
frequency
Cumulative frequency
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
45
36
40
21
21
41
38
38
48
46
45
39
42
44
34
41
40
38
42
29
45
49
28
28
35
35
23
29
35
29
24
33
30
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
0 1 2 3 4
Number of goals scored
in a soccer match
.5 .5 .5 .5 .5 .5
34 44 54 64 74 84
Number of apples on a tree
28
38
40
24
53
91
57
29
69
29
15
84
Cumulative frequency
15 Use the ogive to develop a five-number summary for the data set below.
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
15
25 35
Score
45
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60
17 The number of babies born each day at a hospital over a year is tabulated and the five-number summary
is given below.
Lower extreme = 1 Upper quartile = 16
Lower quartile = 8 Upper extreme = 18
Median = 14
Show this information in a box-and-whisker plot.
180
18 This table shows the number of students in each year level from Years 8 to 12.
Year
8
9
10
11
12
Number of students
200
189
175
133
124
most of the students from Year 10 continue on to complete Years 11 and 12).
b The parents claim that the retention rate of students in Years 11 and 12 is low (that is, a large
25 20 33 41 15 18 24 40 12 29
30 38 26 20 17 23 10 11 16 23
22 27 14 11 12 14 32 24 29 33
a Using classes 1014, 1519, 2024, etc., show this information in a frequency table.
b Draw a frequency histogram and polygon for the data.
c Draw a cumulative frequency histogram and polygon.
d State the range of the data set.
e Use the ogive to find:
i the median
ii the interquartile range.
2 The box-and-whisker plots below show the sales of two different brands of washing powder at a
supermarket each day.
ex ten d ed
r eS p o n S e
Brand A
Brand B
0
a
b
c
d
e
10
15
20 25
30 35
40
45
50
Scale
diGital doC
Test Yourself
doc-10322
Chapter 5
181
ICT activities
5a
diGital doC
Drawing graphs (doc-10319): Draw graphs using graphics
calculators and spreadsheets. (page 146)
5B
diGital doC
Spreadsheet (doc-1559): Use an Excel spreadsheet to interact with
frequency tables. (page 149)
WorkSHEET 5.1 (doc-10320): Apply knowledge of data to questions.
(page 153)
5C
interaCtiVitY
int-2362: Measures of centre and spread: interact with distributions.
(page 154)
5d
Five-number summaries
interaCtiVitY
int-2788: Parallel boxplots interact with distributions and
boxplots. (page 164)
int-0802: Boxplots and five-number summary consolidate your
understanding of boxplots. (page 164)
5e
diGital doC
WorkSHEET 5.2 (doc-10321): Apply knowledge of data to questions.
(page 176)
Chapter review
diGital doC
Test Yourself Chapter 5 (doc 10322): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 181)
182
Answers CHAPTER 5
8 Key 14 | 3 =
diSplaYinG SinGle
data SetS
Stem
13*
14
14*
15
15*
9 D
10 A
11 a A quick graphical way of displaying
May
August
14* | 8 = 14.8
14.3
Leaf
8 9
0 2 3 3
5 6 6 7 7 8 8
1 2 2
5 6 7 9
June
July
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
4.00 am
40%
20%
0%
6.00 pm
6.00 am
4.00 pm
8.00 am
2.00 pm
10.00 am
12.00 pm
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Scores
4
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35
Maximum temperature (C)
5 Key 0 | 6 = 6
Stem
0
1
2
3
4
5
Leaf
6
3 5 7 8
0 0 5 6 6 7 8 9
1 2 2 8
3 6
2
6 Key 3 | 6 = 36
Stem Leaf
3 6 7 8 8
4 0 0 1 2
5 0 2 2 2
6 6 8 8
7 1 2 5
8 2
7 Key 10 | 1 =
Stem Leaf
8* 6 8
9
2
9* 5 5 5
10
2 2 2
10* 7 7 7
11
0 1 2
11* 5
12
12* 0 1 1
13
0
9 9
2 2 2 2 3 5 6 7 7 8 8 8
3 4 5 7 8 9
10* | 6 = 106
6 6 6 8 9
3
8 8
Score
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
Tally
|
|||
|
||
|||
Class
Frequency
3
5
5
7
3
1
1
||
|||
|
|
Frequency
1
3
6
2
3
5
14
5
4
2
1
3
1
||||
||||
||
|
|||
|
3039
4049
5059
6069
7079
8089
9099
Stem Leaf
4
4 3
4
4 7 7
4 8 8 9 9 9
5 0 0 0 0 1
5 2 2 3
5
5
5
Key 4 | 3 = 43 cm
34.5
44.5
54.5
64.5
74.5
84.5
94.5
|||
|
|||
||
1
5
5
8
6
3
2
Class
Tally
|||
Stem Leaf
4 3
4 7 7 8 8 9 9 9
5 0 0 0 0 1 2 2 3
5
Key 4 | 3 = 43 cm
exercise 5B
101
Score
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Score
Tally
Frequency
|||
||||
0.6<0.8
0.7
||
0.8<1.0
0.9
|||
1.0<1.2
1.1
|||
1.2<1.4
1.3
1.4<1.6
1.5
||||
1.6<1.8
1.7
1.8<2.0
2.02.2
1.9
||||
2.1
||||
Class
Class centre
Frequency
10.5<11.0
10.75
11.0<11.5
11.25
11.5<12.0
11.75
|||
12.0<12.5
12.25
|||
12.5<13.0
13.013.5
12.75
13.25
183
10
11
Lifetime Class
Cumulative
(hours) centre Frequency frequency
6
5<10
27.5
25
31
21
10<15
||||
30<35
32.5
70
101
27
15<20
35<40
37.5
61
162
29
40<45
42.5
30
192
30
4550
47.5
200
Cumulative frequency
200
180
160
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
12
Class
50
32
44
15
51
53
6 10
12
52
58
1115
13
20
53
60
1620
18
10
30
2125
23
35
Score
Frequency
60
76
7<8
7.5
58
134
8<9
8.5
142
910
9.5
146
Cumulative
Frequency
5
Class centre
Frequency
09
4.5
1019
14.5
2029
24.5
3039
34.5
4049
44.5
5059
54.5
12
6069
64.5
7079
74.5
8089
84.5
Time
taken (s)
Frequency
Cumulative
frequency
6<8
8<10
10<12
15
20
38
15
12<14
15
30
14<16
12
50
10
40
16<18
58
20
60
1820
60
25
85
10
95
10
100
13 B
14
Class
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
0<10
10
10
10<20
15
18
10 14 18
Time (s)
18
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
20<30
25
14
32
Class
30<40
35
40
5059
54.5
50
6069
64.5
10
7079
74.5
15
8089
84.5
23
9099
94.5
30
4050
17 a
Class
10
6.5
Cumulative frequency
27.5
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
6<7
184
||||
18
48 49 50 51 52 53
No. of jelly beans
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
2530
Class
Cumulative
Centre Frequency Frequency
12
16
16 a Discrete
b The data is discrete and so classes need
10
10
17.5
49
5.5
19
22.5
5<6
12.5
11
||
48
4.5
7.5
20<25
22
.5
27
.5
32
.5
37
.5
42
.5
47
.5
0 1 2 3 4 5
No. of cars
4<5
Class
centre Frequency
22.5
9 a
Length
(cm)
Tally
25<30
No. of jelly
Cumulative
beans
Frequency frequency
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
Class
20<25
b
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
10 a
Cumulative frequency
8 a
Cumulative frequency
Cumulative
No. of cars Frequency frequency
Cumulative frequency
7 a
45
10
15 a Continuous
b There are too many scores to consider
5<10
22
26
10<15
95
121
15<20
124
245
20<25
94
339
25<30
19
358
30<35
363
3540
365
400
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
Frequency
26
26
31
57
Salary
( $1000)
22
79
15<20
Cumulative
Frequency frequency
6
87
20<25
12
18
90
25<30
26
30<35
33
35<40
38
40<45
4550
39
40
2 3
Score
d 2
11 B
13 B
Class
Cumulative
IQscore centre Frequency frequency
75<85
80
12
12
85<95
90
25
37
95<105
100
50
87
105<115
110
24
111
115125
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
c 50
d i 10
120
13
124
ii 115
iii 104
Ogive of salaries
50%
20 30 40 50
Salary ($ 1000)
c 11
f $26 500
18 a
d 26
g $21 500
25
d 16
f 84 cm
b
d
f
h
11
8%
46
30 or less
Time
Frequency
Cumulative
frequency
65<70
70<75
75<80
13
80<85
17
85<90
18
9095
20
Ogive of time
20 trial results
100%
15
10
50%
5
0
65 70 75 80 85 90 95
Time (s)
100%
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
21 a
e $33 000
h $38 500
Cumulative
Waist size Frequency frequency
70<75
13
13
75<80
28
41
80<85
46
87
85<90
30
117
90<95
17
134
95<100
142
100<105
105110
149
150
Cumulative
frequency
Time
Frequency
2.4<2.8
2.8<3.2
11
3.2<3.6
18
3.6<4.0
27
4.0<4.4
29
4.44.8
30
b
Cumulative frequency
50%
50
c 6
d 90% of riders finished with a time of
Cumulative frequency
on class size.
17 a
75
60
96 cm
25%
12
68%
55
37
e 011
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
c
e
g
19 a
c
e
g
20 a
interquartile range = 9
100
70 80 90 100 110
Size (cm)
d Median = 17.5
100%
125
0<5
Score
Cumulative frequency
Cumulative
frequency
No. of
days
Maximum
temperature (C)
Cumulative
frequency
c 1
10 A
12 D
14 a
Cumulative frequency
Cumulative frequency
9 a
15 a
Cumulative frequency
185
c 75%
d 3.45 kg, which represents the centre or
e
22 a
b
c
d
e
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
Class
1519
17
2024
22
15
22
2529
27
26
3034
32
29
37
29
4044
42
29
1
2
4549
47
30
3
4
5
6
7
8
35
40
45 50
15
20 25
30 35
10
5
17 22 27 32 37 42 47
Age
15
20
25 30
35 40
45
b
10
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
124.5
130139
134.5
140149
144.5
11
150159
154.5
17
160169
164.5
19
170179
174.5
21
180189
184.5
28
30
50
70 Age
median.
exercise 5e
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
12
4.
13 5
4.
14 5
4.
15 5
4.
16 5
4.
17 5
4.
18 5
4.5
Cumulative
frequency
120129
c i 155
d
ii 140
iii 182
e
Northern Territory
Western
Australia
New South
Wales
South
Australia
Queensland
Victoria
50
Class
186
15
d
17 a
b
c
d
e
18 a
b
c
d
15 a
20
45
Tasmania
Type of transport
Sector
angle
Sector
graph
New South Wales
Victoria
Queeensland
Western Australia
South Australia
Tasmania
Australian Capital Territory
Northern Territory
25
40
Australian Capital
Territory
30
55 60
9 a 148
b 56
c 90
d 92
e 28
10 a 58
b 31
c 43
d 27
e 8
11 B
12 C
13 D
14 a 10, 13.5, 22, 33.5, 45
b
10
Cumulative frequency
3539
exercise 5d
Five-number summaries
8, 15, 16.5, 18, 25
a 23, 44, 81.5, 83.5, 92
b 1, 2, 4, 6, 7
c 8, 29, 45, 72, 93
1, 3, 4, 5, 7
40, 65, 72, 78, 100
15 25 30.5 39.5 50
19.6 19.9 20.1 20.25 20.8
64 70 73 77 81
16 a
Frequency
213 000
152 000
141 000
67 000
52 000
21 000
9000
8000
116
83
77
36
28
11
5
4
Total 360
4 a 9 am to 3 pm on Saturday
b i 30 h
ii 168 h
iii 17.9%
c 18 h
d 563
e Multiple fatalities in accidents
f 73
g E (9 am to 3 pm on Sunday)
h C (9 am to 3 pm from Monday to
Friday)
i 20.4%
j G includes Thursday night shopping and
Class
Class
interval centre
Tally
Frequency
09
4.5
1019
14.5
||
2029
24.5
|||
3039
34.5
4049
44.5
5059
54.5
5
||||
Bus
10
Bike
Walking
6069
64.5
Train
7079
74.5
||||
Car
Total
24
8089
84.5
||
Total
56
1
12
f 4:5
g Car
||
|||
12
8
Chapter reVieW
6 a
Class
mUltiple ChoiCe
4.5
1 C
3 A
5 A
2 B
4 C
Short anSWer
6 a
Class
Class
interval centre
1215
13.5
ABC (54)
Tally
Frequency
||||
Channel 7 (96)
Channel 9 (144)
1619
17.5
2023
21.5
11
2427
25.5
|||
13
2831
29.5
||||
3235
33.5
3639
37.5
||
Total
b
SBS (10)
Friday
Frequency
Score
Wednesday
Frequency
6
Class
Class
centre
Frequency
3.54.0
3.75
slightly.
14 a
b
15 00019 999
17 500
20 00024 999
22 500
25 00029 999
27 500
30 00034 999
32 500
4.04.5
4.25
4.75
5.05.5
5.25
5.56.0
5.75
6.06.5
6.25
6.57.0
6.75
00 00 00 00 00 00
75 12 5 17 5 22 5 27 5 32 5
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
34.5
4049
44.5
5059
54.5
12
21
6069
64.5
15
36
7079
74.5
18
54
8089
84.5
10
64
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
8 a 7
b 159
c 1.4
9 a i 25
ii 24
iii 27.5
b i 62.5
ii 43
iii 84
c i 1.1
ii 0.7
iii 1.5
10 a 2
b Lower = 1, upper = 3
c 2
11 a 61
b Lower = 54, upper = 70
c 16
12 Key 2 | 1 = 21
Stem
2
3
4
8
6
4
2
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Number of sales
iv 3.5
iv 41
iv 0.8
Leaf
1 1 3 4 8 8 8 9 9 9
0 3 4 5 5 5 6 8 8 8 8 9
0 0 0 1 1 2 2 4 5 5 5 6 8 9
13 a 28
c 12.5
14 6, 24, 41, 69, 91
16 a 43
c 14
17
10
10
8
6
4
2
0
3039
4.55.0
12
Frequency
Class
Tuesday
21.5
29.5
37.5
13.5
17.5
25.5
33.5
Class size
Thursday
7500
12 500
7 a
40
Frequency
50009999
Channel 10 (56)
Monday
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
Class centre
10 00014 999
Frequency
Frequency
Cumulative frequency
b 38
15 0, 21, 26, 32, 50
b 43
0 2 4 6 8 1012 14 16 18 20
187
Class
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
1014
12
1519
17
11
2024
22
18
2529
27
23
3034
32
27
3539
37
28
4044
42
30
188
Frequency
1 a
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
12 17 22 27 32 37 42
No. of admissions to hospital in a day
Cumulative frequency
extended reSponSe
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
12 17 22 27 32 37 42
No. of admissions to hospital in a day
d
e
2 a
d
34
i 23
45
7
ii 13
b 15
c 35
e Check with your teacher.
Chapter 6
Summary statistics
Chapter ContentS
6a
6b
6C
6d
6a
Survey a group of people about what they believe is meant by the word average. Use their answers to
describe what the word is generally understood to mean.
interaCtivitY
int-0084
Measures of centre
When looking at a set of statistics we are often asked for the average. The average is a figure that describes
a typical score. In statistics, the correct term for the average is the mean. The mean is the first of three
measures of location that we will be studying. The others are the median and the mode.
x
The statistical symbol for the mean is x. The formula for the mean is x =
.
n
In Mathematics, the symbol (sigma) means sum or total, x represents each individual score in a list
and x is therefore the sum of the scores. The sum is divided by n, which represents the number of scores.
Chapter 6 Summary statistics
189
Worked exaMple 1
Find the mean of the scores 17, 16, 13, 15, 16, 20, 10, 15.
think
Write/diSplaY
Method 1
1
Total = 17 + 16 + 13 + 15 + 16 + 20 + 10 + 15
= 122
Mean =
122
8
= 15.25
Method 2
1
As we have seen, large amounts of data are often presented in a frequency table. To calculate the mean
in such a case, we need to add an extra column to the table. This column is the f x column. In this
column, we multiply each frequency by the score. We then total this column to find the total of all scores
and divide this by the sum of the frequency column. Written as a formula this is:
x=
f x
f
Worked exaMple 2
190
Score (x)
4
5
6
7
8
9
Frequency ( f )
3
7
11
13
10
6
f =
fx
f x =
think
Write/diSplaY
Method 1
1
Score (x)
Frequency ( f )
fx
12
35
11
66
13
91
10
80
54
f = 50
f x = 338
f x
f
338
=
50
= 6.76
x=
Method 2
1
The same method is used when the frequency table is given in terms of grouped data. In these cases,
however, to calculate the f x column we use the class centre multiplied by the frequency. In these cases,
we obtain an estimate of the mean rather than an exact mean.
Chapter 6 Summary statistics
191
Worked exaMple 3
Complete the frequency distribution table and use it to estimate the mean of the distribution.
Class
2529
3034
3539
40 44
4550
think
Frequency ( f )
4
9
13
12
7
f =
f x =
Write
fx
Class
centre (x)
27
32
37
42
47
Frequency
( f)
4
9
13
12
7
f = 45
fx
108
288
481
504
329
f x = 1710
f x
f
1710
=
45
= 38
x=
In most cases, when calculating the mean you will use your calculator and will need to set it to statistics
mode. Once this is done, each score is entered and the M+ function pressed. When all scores are entered,
the mean is found by using the x function.
If the data are presented in the form of a frequency distribution table, you will need to check how to
enter multiple scores. On many calculators, you press score frequency followed by M+, but check with
your teacher as to how your calculator works.
For all statistical questions, when using your calculator clear the memory at the beginning of each
question. Most calculators will display the number of scores you have entered after each entry. This is a
useful check that you have cleared the memory and entered the data correctly.
Worked exaMple 4
192
Score
67
68
69
70
71
Frequency
10
23
35
28
12
think
Write
Mean = 30.2
b
the memory.
2
exercise 6a
Mean = 69.1
2 Majid sits for five tests in Mathematics. His marks on the tests were 45%, 90%, 67%, 86% and 75%.
Score
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Frequency
2
4
5
9
3
5
2
f =
fx
f x =
193
7 An electrical store records the number of televisions sold each week over a year. The results are shown
digital doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1586
Mean
digital doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1587
Mean (diY)
No. of
weeks
4
4
3
6
7
12
8
2
4
2
f =
fx
f x =
to 1 decimal place.
8 In a soccer season a team played 50 matches. The number of goals scored in each match is shown in
No. of matches
18
10
Frequency
below.
12
10
8
6
4
2
0
10 12 14 16 18
Score
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
14
5
c
15 m
5
c
16 m
5
c
17 m
5
18 cm
5
c
19 m
5
cm
Frequency
10 The graph below shows the distribution in the heights of one hundred 17-year-old boys.
Class centre
a
b
c
d
194
Frequency ( f )
3140
4150
5160
6170
7180
11
8190
91100
2
f =
fx
f x =
Frequency
14 The graph below shows the times swum in the 100 m freestyle at an international swimming meet.
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
Class centre
a Use the graph to complete the frequency table below
Class (time)
Class centre
No of swimmers
Cumulative frequency
50.5
51.5
52.5
53.5
54.5
55.5
b Use the table to estimate the mean time.
Chapter 6 Summary statistics
195
23
25
16
69
0
65
105
70
104
49
8
74
22
57
0
112 54
40
1
33 21
78 158
14 28
0
15
8
0
52
84
33
34
51
21
12
45
36
16
3
21
21
5
6
3
4
47
7
16
7
a Put the above information into a frequency distribution table using appropriate groupings.
b Use the table to estimate the batting average for this player.
16 We4 Use the statistics function on your calculator to find the mean of each of the following scores,
Frequency
17 Use your calculator to find the mean from each of the following.
a
b
Score
Frequency
30
25
3
7
20
15
4
10
10
5
5
18
0
6
7
8
9
10
19
38
27
10
5
28 29 30 31 32 33 34
Score
Height (cm)
150<155
Class centre
152
Frequency
7
155<160
157
14
160<165
162
13
165<170
167
23
170<175
175180
172
24
177
12
19 Seventy students were timed on a 100 m sprint during their P.E. class. The results are shown in the table
below.
Time (s)
Number
1213
13
1314
17
1415
25
1516
15
1617
10
39
59
62
58
84
31
33
72
1
92
31
51
6
9
43
50
27
42
79
71
43
62
83
41
98
70
30
19
2
8
45
90
49
33
97
57
3
11
97
18
71
30
6
71
89
18
97
63
52
21
26
59
4
97
9
3
33
53
69
4
52
44
20
83
17
a Put this information into a frequency distribution table using the classes 110, 1120, 2130 etc.
b Calculate the mean number of cans sold per day over these 10 weeks.
Further development
21 The mean of 5 scores is 12.6.
a What is the total of the five scores?
b An extra score of 19.2 is added to the data set. What is the new total of the scores?
c Find the mean of the six scores.
22 The mean of 9 scores is 58. A tenth score of 19 is added to the data set. Find the new mean of the data
set.
23 The data below shows the ages of 10 people working out at the gym.
23
24
19
59
23
22
16
18
25
197
6b
interaCtivitY
int-2352
Measures of centre
So far we have used the mean as a measure of the typical score in a data set. Consider the case of
someone who is analysing the typical house price in an area. On a particular day, five houses are sold in
the area for the following prices:
$375 000
$349 000
$360 000
$411 000
$1 250 000
For these five houses the mean price is $549 000. The mean is much greater than most of the houses in
the data set. This is because one score is much greater than all the others. For such data sets, we need to
use a different measure of location.
The median is the middle score in a data set, when all scores are arranged in order. For the above data
set, the median house price is $375 000, a much better measure of the typical house price in this area.
Worked exaMple 5
Write
1, 3, 4, 4, 5, 6, 6, 8, 9
Median = 5
The median becomes more complicated when there is an even number of scores because there are
two scores in the middle. When there is an even number of scores, the median is the average of the
two middle scores.
Worked exaMple 6
Find the median of the scores 13, 13, 16, 12, 19, 18, 20, 18.
think
Write
Median =
16 + 18
2
= 17
The median can also be calculated from the cumulative frequency column of a frequency table.
The cumulative frequency column puts the scores into order and tells us what score is in each
position. Consider the frequency distribution table below.
Score
Frequency
Cumulative frequency
16
24
28
30
There are 30 scores in this distribution and so the middle two scores will be the 15th and 16th scores. By
looking down the cumulative frequency column we can see that these scores are both 6. Therefore, 6 is
the median of this distribution.
198
Worked exaMple 7
think
Score
Frequency
34
35
36
12
37
38
39
Write/draW
Method 1
1
Score
Frequency
Cumulative frequency
34
35
11
36
12
23
37
32
38
40
39
45
Method 2
1
Median
199
When the frequency table presents grouped data, the median is estimated from the ogive as shown in the
previous chapter.
There are many examples where neither the mean nor the median is the appropriate measure of the
typical score in a data set.
Consider the case of a clothing store. It needs to re-order a supply of dresses. To know what sizes to
order it looks at past sales of this particular style and gathers the following data:
8
14
12
12
14
14
12
12
16
12
10
8
12
18
14
16
16
12
18
14
For this data set the mean dress size is 13.2. Dresses are not sold in size 13.2, so this has very little
meaning. The median is 13, which also has little meaning as dresses are sold only in even-numbered
sizes.
What is most important to the clothing store is the dress size that sells the most. In this case size 12
occurs most frequently. The score that has the highest frequency is called the mode.
Worked exaMple 8
Write/diSplaY
Method 1
The score 4 occurs most often and so it is the
mode.
Mode = 4
Method 2
1
When two scores occur most often an equal number of times, both scores are given as the mode. In this
situation the scores are bimodal. If all scores occur an equal number of times, then the distribution has
no mode.
To find the mode from a frequency distribution table, we simply give the score that has the highest
frequency.
200
Worked exaMple 9
14
3
15
6
16
11
17
14
think
18
10
19
7
Write
Mode = 17
When a table is presented using grouped data, we do not have a single mode. In these cases, the class
with the highest frequency is called the modal class.
exercise 6b
1 We5 The scores of seven people on a spelling test are given below.
5
Calculate the median of these marks.
8
digital doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1588
Median
2 We6 Below are the scores of eight people who played a round of golf.
75 80 81
Calculate the median for this set of scores.
76
84
83
81
82
digital doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1589
Median (diY)
4 A factory has 80 employees. Over a two-week period the number of people absent from work each day
digital doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1590
Mode
digital doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1591
Mode (diY)
201
Score
Frequency
17
18
19
20
12
21
22
23
24
Cumulative
frequency
No. of accidents
No. of days
12
No. of errors
per day
Frequency
18
13
Score
Frequency
12
13
12th score
12.5th score
13th score
average of the 12th and 13th score.
5
6
6.5
7
11 The frequency distribution table below shows the number of sick days taken by each worker in a small
business.
Days sickness
Frequency
0 4
10
59
12
1014
1519
2024
2529
3034
Cumulative frequency
Score
Frequency
Score
Frequency
Score
Frequency
38
39
40
41
42
10
43
44
45
Frequency
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
Score
203
17 For each of the following grouped distributions, state the modal class.
a
Class
Frequency
1 4
Class
Frequency
17
58
12
814
912
30
1521
1316
23
2228
25
1720
46
2935
12
2124
27
36 42
11
2528
43 49
18 The table below shows the depth of snow during every day of the ski season.
a Redraw the table to include the class centres and cumulative frequency.
b Draw a cumulative frequency histogram and polygon.
c Use the graph to estimate the median depth of snow for the ski season.
Depth (cm)
Frequency
0<50
50<100
100<150
12
150<200
15
200<250
250<300
300<350
350 400
376
223
556
543
592
295
419
532
299
232
226
435
501
325
494
415
375
311
205
540
366
513
307
260
204
348
417
318
359
235
204
593
382
329
528
592
274
203
487
393
a Use the classes $200$249, $250$299, $300$350 etc. to display the information in a frequency
distribution table.
b From your table, calculate the median class.
c Draw a cumulative frequency histogram and polygon, and use it to estimate the median wage in
the group.
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
14
5
c
15 m
5
c
16 m
5
c
17 m
5
18 cm
5
c
19 m
5
cm
Frequency
20 The graph below shows the distribution in the heights of one hundred 17-year-old boys.
Class centre
a State the modal class.
b Use the graph to draw a cumulative frequency histogram and ogive of the distribution.
c Use your ogive to estimate the median height of 17-year-old boys.
204
Further development
21 Consider the stem-and-leaf plot below:
Stem
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
Leaf
2 5 8
1 3 3 6 7 8 9
0 1 2 4 6 7 8 8 9
2 2 4 5 7 8
3 6 7
4 5 8
3 5
4
Key 60 | 3 = 603
6C
digital doC
WorkSHEET 6.1
doc-10323
Standard deviation
In the previous chapter, we discussed using the range and the interquartile range as a measure of the
spread of a data set. The most commonly used measure of spread is the standard deviation.
The standard deviation is a measure of how much a typical score in a data set differs from themean.
The standard deviation is found by entering a set of scores into your calculator, just as you do when
you are finding the mean. Your calculator will have a function that gives the standard deviation.
There are two standard deviation functions on your calculator. The first, n, is the population standard
deviation. This function is used when the statistical analysis is conducted on the entire population.
interaCtivitY
int-0144
Standard deviation
Worked exaMple 10
Below are the scores out of 100 by a class of 20 students on a Science exam. Calculate the mean
and the standard deviation.
87 69 95 73 88 47 95 63 91 66
59 70 67 83 71 57 82 65 84 69
think
Write/diSplaY
Method 1
1
x = 74.05
n = 13.07
205
Method 2
1
When the statistical analysis is done using a sample of the population, a slightly different standard
deviation function is used. Called the sample standard deviation, this value will be slightly higher than
the population standard deviation. The sample standard deviation will be found on your calculator using
the n 1 or the sn function.
Worked exaMple 11
Ian surveys twenty Year 11 students and asks how much money they earn from part-time work
each week. The results are given below.
$65 $82 $47 $78 $108 $94 $60 $79 $88 $91
$50 $73 $68 $95 $83
$76 $79 $72 $69 $97
Calculate the mean and standard deviation.
think
Write/diSplaY
Method 1
1
x = $77.70
n 1 = $15.56
Method 2
206
For most examples, you will need to read the question carefully to decide whether to use the population
or the sample standard deviation.
The standard deviation can also be calculated when the data are presented in table form. This is done
by entering the data in the same way as they were when calculating the mean earlier in this chapter.
Worked exaMple 12
The table below shows the scores of a class of thirty Year 3 students on a spelling test.
Score
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Frequency
1
2
4
9
6
7
1
Write
x = 7.4
n = 1.4
Once we have calculated the standard deviation, we can make conclusions about the reliability and
consistency of the data set. The lower the standard deviation, the less spread out the data set is. By
using the standard deviation, we can determine whether a set of scores is more or less consistent (or
reliable) than another set. The standard deviation is the best measure of this because, unlike the range
or interquartile range as a measure of dispersion, the standard deviation considers the distance of every
score from the mean.
A higher standard deviation means that scores are less clustered around the mean and less dependable.
For example, consider the following two students:
n = 5
Student A: x = 60
n = 15
Student B: x = 60
Both students have the same mean. However, student A has a standard deviation of 5 and student B has
a standard deviation of 15. Student A is far more consistent and can confidently be expected to score
around 60 in any future exam. Student B is more inconsistent but is probably capable of scoring a higher
mark than student A. This concept will be discussed further during the HSC course.
Chapter 6 Summary statistics
207
Worked exaMple 13
Two brands of light globe are tested to see how long they will burn
(in hours).
Brand X: 850
950 1400
875 1200
1150 1000
900
850
825
Brand Y: 975 1100 1050 1000
975
950 1075 1025
950
900
Which of the two brands of light globe is more reliable?
think
Write
Brand X: n 1 = 190.4
Brand Y: n 1 = 62.4
exercise 6C
Standard deviation
1 We10 For each of the sets of scores below, calculate the standard deviation. Assume that the scores
a 3, 5, 8, 2, 7, 1, 6, 5
c 25, 15, 78, 35, 56, 41, 17, 24
e 114, 12, 3.6, 42.8, 0.5
2 We11 For each of the sets of scores below, calculate the sample standard deviation, correct to
2 decimal places.
25, 36, 75, 85, 6, 49, 77, 80, 37, 66
4.8, 9.3, 7.1, 9.9, 7.0, 4.1, 6.2
112, 25, 56, 81, 0, 5, 178, 99, 41
0.3, 0.3, 0.3, 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.8, 0.8, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0
56, 1, 258, 45, 23, 58, 48, 35, 246
a
b
c
d
e
3 For each of the following, state whether it is appropriate to use the population standard deviation or the
208
a
b
c
d
e
A quality control officer tests the life of 50 batteries from a batch of 1000.
The weight of every bag of potatoes is checked and recorded before being sold.
The number of people who attend every football match over a season is analysed.
A survey of 100 homes records the number of cars in each household.
The score of every HSC student in Mathematics is recorded.
4 The band Aquatron is to release a new CD. The recording company needs to predict the number of
copies that will be sold at various music stores throughout Australia. To do so, a sample of 10 music
stores supplied information about the sales of the previous CD released by Aquatron, as shown below.
580
695
547
236
458
620
872
364
587
1207
2.1
2.4
1.8
1.1
0.8
0.9
1.1
1.4
1.6
2.0
0.7
1.2
1.7
1.3
to 1 decimal place) for the information presented in the following tables. In each case, use the
population standard deviation.
a
Score
3
4
5
6
7
Frequency
12
24
47
21
7
Score
45
46
47
48
49
50
Frequency
1
16
39
61
52
36
Score
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
Frequency
22
17
8
10
12
21
29
7 Copy and complete the class centre column for each of the following distributions and use your
calculator to find an estimate for the mean and standard deviation (correct to 2 decimal places). In each
case use the population standard deviation.
a
Class
1012
1315
1618
1921
2224
Class
0 4
59
1014
1519
2024
2529
Class
centre
Class
centre
Frequency
12
16
25
28
13
Class
31 40
4150
5160
6170
7180
8190
91100
Class
centre
Frequency
15
28
36
19
8
7
2
Frequency
15
24
31
33
29
17
209
8 We13 Below are the marks achieved by two students in five tests.
Class
Frequency
1019
2029
30 39
4049
5060
When preparing an analysis of the typical performance of Year 11 students on the test, the standard
deviation used is:
a 9.209
b 9.437
C 21
d 34.048
10 MC The results below are Ians marks in four exams for each subject that he studies.
English:
63 85 78 50
Maths:
69 71 32 97
Biology:
45 52 60 41
Geography: 65 78 59 61
In which subject does Ian achieve the most consistent results?
a English
b Maths
C Biology
d Geography
11 The following frequency distribution gives the prices paid by a car wrecking yard for a sample of
40 car wrecks.
Price ($)
Frequency
10
Find the mean and standard deviation of the price paid for these wrecks.
210
12 Times (to the nearest tenth of a second) for the heats in the open 100 m sprint at the school sports are
given below.
Stem
11
11*
12
12*
Leaf
0 2 3 4 4
5 6 6 8 8 9
0 1 2 2 3 4 4
6 9
Calculate the standard deviation for this set of data correct to 2 decimal places.
13 The number of outgoing phone calls from an office each day over a 4-week period is shown on the
Stem
0
1
2
3
4
5
Leaf
8 9
3 4 7 9
0 1 3 7 7
3 4
1 5 6 7 8
3 8
Calculate the standard deviation for this set of data and express your answer correct to 2 decimal
places.
14 The dot plot drawn below shows the number of days absent that a class of students have had in a term.
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Number of days absent
Life (hours)
Frequency
200<250
250<300
300<350
12
350<400
25
400<450
42
450<500
38
500<550
26
550<600
15
600<650
650700
packets nominally of the same size and for the same price. Upon
investigation of a sample of packets of each, it is found that Crunch and
Crinkle have the same mean mass (25g). The standard deviation of the
masses of Crunch is, however, 5g and the standard deviation of the masses
of Crinkle is 2g. Which brand do you think represents better value for
money under these circumstances? Why?
Chapter 6 Summary statistics
211
Further development
17 Consider the following two groups of people.
Group B
160 170 170 110 230 170 180
Height (cm)
Group A
160 170 170 170 170 170 180
a
b
c
d
Difference
from mean
Standard deviation
after score added
Standard deviation
(increase or decrease)
20 A data set has a mean of 48 and a standard deviation of 23. A score of 55 is added to the data set.
a What effect will adding the extra score have on the mean? Explain your answer.
b What effect will adding the extra score have on the standard deviation? Explain your answer.
21 MC A data set has a mean of 36 and a standard deviation of 8. A score of 12 is added to the data set.
What will be the effect on the mean and the standard deviation?
a The mean will decrease and the standard deviation will decrease.
b The mean will decrease and the standard deviation will increase.
C The mean will increase and the standard deviation will decrease.
d The mean will increase and the standard deviation will increase.
22 Describe in your own words, how adding an extra score to a data set will affect the standard deviation.
6d
Having now examined all three measures of centre (the mean, the median and the mode), it is important to
recognise when it is appropriate to use each one. In some circumstances, one summary statistic may be more
appropriate than the others. For example, a shoe manufacturer notes that in a new style of sporting footwear:
mean size sold is 8.63
median size is 8.75
mode size is 9.
In this case, the mode is the most useful measure as the manufacturer needs to know which size sells the
most. The mean and median are of less use to the manufacturer.
212
Worked exaMple 14
Write
a Total = $5710
Mean = $5710 10
= $571
is the mode.
$440 + $450
2
= $445
Median =
c Mode = $420
When considering the best measure of location and spread we need to consider what the effect an outlier
will have on a data set.
Consider the following set of scores: 90, 80, 85, 75, 85. For this data set
Mean = 83, Median = 85, Mode = 85
Now consider the effect that an extra score will have if it is an outlier. If a score of 20 is added to the
data set then
Mean = 72.5, Median = 82.5, Mode = 85
We can see that the addition has a significant effect on the mean, small effect on the median and no
effect on the mode.
Now consider the effect that the outlier has on the measures of spread. Before the addition of the
outlier
Range = 15, Interquartile range = 10, Standard deviation = 5.7
After the addition of the outlier to the data set these measures become:
Range = 70, Interquartile range = 10, Standard deviation = 26.2
The outlier had a large impact on the range, a significant impact on the standard deviation but very
little impact on the interquartile range. As the number of scores in the data set becomes larger the impact
of an outlier on the standard deviation is decreased, but it only takes a single outlier to have a huge
impact on the range regardless of the number of scores in the data set.
For each of these examples you will need to think carefully about the relevance of each summary
statistic in terms of the particular example.
It is important to consider that when a sample is taken the summary statistics that are found can only
be considered to be estimates of the entire population. Two or more samples that have been taken from
the same population may in fact produce different results. The larger the samples that are taken, the less
likely that this is to occur; however, samples may be subject to some variation depending on whether any
outliers may (by chance) be included.
Chapter 6 Summary statistics
213
Worked exaMple 15
Tegan and April each sample 10 apple trees from an orchard and record the number of pieces of
fruit on each. The results they obtain are given below.
Tegan 45, 38, 44, 56, 50, 55, 62, 59, 41, 42
April 12, 84, 56, 42, 68, 32, 41, 42, 70, 30
a For each data set find the mean and standard deviation.
b Describe the differences between Tegan and Aprils results.
c Give possible reasons for these differences.
think
Write
a Tegan
April
x = 49.2
sn = 8.4
x = 47.7
sn = 21.7
c Think of possible reasons why there may be a c The difference in standard deviations may be
exercise 6d
1 We14 There are ten houses in a street. A real-estate agent values each house with the following results.
digital doC
GC program Casio
doc-1592
Uv stats
$350 000 $390 000 $375 000 $350 000 $950 000
$350 000 $365 000 $380 000 $360 000 $380 000
a Calculate the mean house valuation.
b Calculate the median house valuation.
c Calculate the mode house valuation.
d Which of the above is the best measure of central tendency?
2 The table below shows the number of shoes of each size that were sold over a week at a shoe store.
Size
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
digital doC
GC program TI
doc-1593
Uv stats
a
b
c
d
214
Frequency
5
7
19
24
16
8
7
3 A coffee shop records the number of coffees sold per hour over a 12 hour period. The results are shown
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
Number of coffees sold
a Calculate the mean, median and mode of the data set.
b Find the range and interquartile range of the data set.
c Explain why the range is not a good measure of spread in this data set.
4 The stem-and-leaf plot below shows the number of times that a fire engine was called out each week
Leaf
5 8 9
1 6 9 9
0 0 1 2 8
1
10, 10, 11, 22, 23, 27, 28, 33, 34, 35, 36, 38, 39, 40, 42, 44, 45, 46, 47, 49.
a
b
c
d
There is an outlier in the data set. Explain what is meant by the term outlier.
Find the mean, median and mode of the data set.
Find the mean, median and mode if the outlier is removed.
Explain the effect on each of the above measures if the outlier is removed.
7 The table below shows the crowds at football matches over a season.
a
b
c
d
e
f
Crowd
Class centre
Frequency
10 00019 999
15 000
95
20 00029 999
25 000
64
30 000 39 999
35 000
22
40 00049 999
45 000
15
50 00059 999
55 000
60 00069 999
65 000
70 00080 000
75 000
215
8 MC Mr and Mrs Yousef research the typical price of a large family car. At one car yard they find
six family cars. Five of the cars are priced between $30 000 and $40 000, while the sixth is priced at
$80 000. What would be the best measure of the price of a typical family car?
a Mean
b Median
C Mode
d All are equally important.
9 Thirty men were asked to reveal the number of hours they spent doing housework each week. The
a
b
c
d
1 5
2 12
2
6
2 8 14 18
0 1
1
8 20 25
3 0
1
2
7 10 12
1
5
1 18 0
2
2
Represent the data in a frequency distribution table. (Use classes 0 4, 59, 1014 etc.)
Find the mean number of hours that the men spend doing housework.
Find the median class for hours spent by the men at housework.
Find the modal class for hours spent by the men at housework.
10 We15 Lewis and Jim each sample 10 tyres that come off a production line. They use a machine to
measure the distance the tyres can travel before the tread is worn down. The results they obtain are
given below in thousands of kilometres.
Jim
Lewis
a For each data set find the mean and standard deviation.
b Give a possible reason why Carmen has obtained a much greater mean and standard deviation.
12 The batting scores for two cricket players over six innings are as follows:
13 The following frequency table gives the number of employees in different salary brackets for a small
manufacturing plant.
Position
Salary ($)
No. of employees
Machine operator
38 000
50
Machine mechanic
40 000
15
Floor steward
44 000
10
Manager
82 000
100 000
a Workers are arguing for a pay rise, but the management of the factory claims that workers are
well paid because the mean salary of the factory is $42 100. Are they being honest?
b Suppose that you were representing the factory workers and had to write a short submission in
support of the pay rise. How could you explain the managements claim? Provide some other
statistics to support your case.
216
Group A
160 170 170 170 170 170 180
Group B
160 170 170 110 230 170 180
a Calculate the mean height, median height and mode height for each group.
b Describe the difference between the two groups.
c For each group find the range, interquartile range and standard deviation.
15 The following data give the number of fruit that have formed on each of 30 trees in an orchard.
45
81
60
48
73
53
52
46
54
36
48
58
38
44
41
72
39
44
36
52
47
74
58
76
56
57
68
46
65
55
a Complete a frequency distribution table for the data with the class intervals being 3039, 4049
b
c
d
e
f
g
and so on.
Draw an ogive of the data.
Use the ogive to find the median, lower quartile and upper quartile of the data.
Find the interquartile range of the data.
Use your table to estimate the mean and standard deviation of the data.
Use the scores given in this list to find the mean and standard deviation of the data.
Explain the difference in your answers to parts e and f.
16 MC The addition of a single outlier to a data set is most likely going to have the greatest effect on
a
b
C
d
the mean
the median
the mode
all of the above
17 MC The addition of a single outlier to a data set is most likely going to have the greatest effect on
a
b
C
d
18 A data set is given as 12, 12, 16, 17, 22, 24, 24, 30. This data set is bimodal.
a Explain what is meant by the term bimodal.
b Greg correctly identifies the two modes as being 12 and 24. However, Greg then averages these
two modes, leading to a result of 18. Explain why this result has no meaning.
Further development
19 The data below shows the age of 25 patients admitted to the emergency ward of a hospital.
18 6 16 75 24 23 82 75 25 21 43 19 84 76 30 78 24 20 63 79
a
b
c
d
20 A small business pays the following salaries (in thousands of dollars) to its employees:
38, 38, 38, 38, 46, 46, 46, 55, 100 (the manager)
What is the salary of most workers?
What is the mean salary?
What is the median salary?
The union is negotiating a salary rise for the workers. What measure would be used by:
i the union in negotiations
ii the employer in negotiations.
Explain each answer.
a
b
c
d
217
21 The contents of 20 randomly selected boxes of matches were counted. The following data shows the
139,
141,
139,
141,
141,
139,
137,
141,
140,
138,
137,
139,
141,
140,
139,
141,
142
138.
per box?
c Is this claim by the manufacturer valid?
22 A class of mathematics students got a median mark of 54 for their end of semester test; however,
digital doC
WorkSHEET 6.2
doc-10324
The workers in an office are trying to obtain a wage rise. In the previous year, the ten people who work in
the office received a 2% rise while the company CEO received a 42% rise.
1 What was the mean wage rise received in the office last year?
2 What was the median wage rise received in the office last year?
3 What was the modal wage rise received in the office last year?
4 The company is trying to avoid paying the rise. What statistic do you think they would quote about last
years wage rises? Why?
5 What statistic do you think the trade union would quote about wage rises? Why?
6 Which statistic do you think is the most honest reflection of last years wage rises? Explain your answer.
Quoting different averages can give different impressions about what is normal. Try the following task.
1 Visit a local real estate agent and study the properties for sale in the window.
2 Calculate the mean, median and mode price for houses in the area.
3 If you were a real estate agent and a person wanting to sell their home asked what the typical property
sold for in the area, which figure would you quote?
4 Which figure would you quote to a person who wanted to buy a house in the area?
218
219
Summary
Calculating the mean
For a small number of scores, the mean is calculated using the formula:
x
x=
.
n
When the data are presented in a frequency table, the mean can be calculated using the formula:
f x
x=
.
f
The mean can also be calculated using the statistical function on your calculator.
The median is the middle score of a data set, or the average of the two middle scores.
The mode is the score with the highest frequency.
Standard deviation
best summary
statistics
220
Chapter review
1 For the following data set, which of the statements is correct?
M U ltip l e
C ho iC e
3, 4, 8, 7, 3, 6, 5, 3, 4, 7
a The mean is 5.
C The mode is 5.
b The median is 5.
d all of the above
2 For which of the following data sets is the median greater than the mean?
a 2, 6, 14, 14, 15, 16, 18
C 12, 15, 15, 15, 15, 18
4 Tracey compiles a sample of new car prices. She selects 100 new car buyers and asks what price they
paid for their car. To measure the spread of the distribution Tracey should use:
a the population standard deviation
b the sample standard deviation
C both standard deviations
d the mean
5 For the statistical analysis in question 4 which summary statistic would be the most appropriate?
a mean
C mode
b median
d standard deviation
S ho rt
a n S W er
Score (x)
Frequency ( f )
11
9.2
36
15
9.3
48
24
9.4
74
21
9.5
65
9.6
51
9.7
32
9.8
14
9.9
Score (x)
Frequency ( f )
f =
fx
f x =
f =
fx
f x =
3 Complete the frequency distribution table below and use it to estimate the mean of the distribution.
Class
Frequency ( f )
2124
2528
2932
17
3336
31
37 40
29
41 44
25
45 48
19
4952
10
f =
fx
f x =
221
4 Use the statistics function on your calculator to find the mean of each of the following sets of scores.
a 2, 18, 26, 121, 96, 32, 14, 2, 0, 0
b 2, 2, 12, 12, 12, 32, 32, 47, 58
c 0.2, 0.3, 0.6, 0.4, 0.3, 0.7, 0.8, 0.6, 0.5, 0.4, 0.1
5 Use the statistics function on your calculator to find the mean of the following distributions. Where
Score
10
20
30
40
50
Class
1012
1315
1618
1921
2224
2527
2830
Frequency
23
47
68
56
17
Class centre
11
14
17
20
23
26
29
Score
24
25
26
27
28
29
Frequency
45
89
124
102
78
46
Frequency
18
32
34
40
28
14
6
Score
0
1
2
3
4
5
Frequency
2
6
11
7
6
3
Score
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
Frequency
8
10
12
14
7
5
4
222
Cumulative
frequency
Cumulative
frequency
Score
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
Frequency
2
5
14
11
6
1
1
frequency
Class
Class centre
Cumulative
frequency
Frequency
3039
18
40 49
34
5059
39
6069
45
7079
29
8089
10
9099
Score
Frequency
Score
Frequency
23
14
35
15
15
21
16
19
17
12
18
15
19
20
Class
Class centre
Frequency
3033
31.5
12
3437
35.5
26
38 41
39.5
34
42 45
43.5
45
4649
47.5
52
5053
51.5
23
66
67
46
47
87
87
43
75
49
80
72
70
42
42
82
92
60
92
92
86
93
90
53
71
92
95
62
77
78
67
223
13 To find the number of attempts most people take to get their drivers licence, a sample of twenty Year
2
1
3
2
3
2
1
2
2
3
1
1
2
2
4
2
1
3
Score
Frequency
26
Class
Class centre
Frequency
12
1014
12
27
25
1519
17
12
28
29
2024
22
32
29
28
2529
27
45
30
14
3034
32
40
3539
37
19
40 44
42
15 Below are the number of goals scored by a netball team in ten matches in a tournament.
25
a
b
c
d
26
19
24
28
67
21
22
28
18
16 Give an example of a statistical analysis where the best summary statistic is:
a the mean
b the median
c the mode.
e x t ended
r e SponS e
1 The table below shows the gross annual income for a sample of 100 company executives.
Income
a
b
c
d
e
f
224
Class centre
Frequency
12
18
26
24
12
Cumulative frequency
2 In order to compare two textbooks, a teacher recommends one book to one class and another book to
another class. At the end of the year the classes are each tested; the results are detailed below.
Text A
44 52 95
72 35 48
Text B
65 72 48
58 59 64
a
b
c
d
e
76 13 94 83 72 55 81 22 25 64
56 59 84 98 84 21 35 69 28
63 68 59 68 62 75 79 81 72 64 53
66 68 42 37 39 55 58 52 82 79 55
Calculate the mean and standard deviation for each class group.
Which standard deviation did you use in part a? Explain why.
Which class performed better?
Which class had the more consistent results?
Could a conclusion be drawn about the better textbook from the above information? Explain your
answer.
digital doC
Test Yourself
doc-10325
Chapter 6
225
ICT activities
6a
digital doCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1586): Mean (page 194)
Spreadsheet (doc-1587): Mean (DIY) (page 194)
interaCtivitY
Measures of centre (int-0084): Interact with the mean, median and
mode. (page 189)
6b
digital doCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1588): Median (page 201)
Spreadsheet (doc-1589): Median (DIY) (page 201)
Spreadsheet (doc-1590): Mode (page 201)
Spreadsheet (doc-1591): Mode (DIY) (page 201)
WorkSHEET 6.1 (doc-10323): Apply statistical measures to questions.
(page 205)
interaCtivitY
Measures of centre (int-2352): Interact with measures of centre.
(page 198)
226
6C
Standard deviation
interaCtivitY
int-0144: Standard deviation (page 205)
6d
digital doCS
GC program Casio (doc-1592): UV stats (page 214)
GC program TI (doc-1593): UV stats (page 214)
WorkSHEET 6.2 (doc-10324): Apply your knowledge of statistics to
questions. (page 218)
Chapter review
digital doC
Test Yourself Chapter 6 (doc-10325): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 225)
Answers CHAPTER 6
SUMMarY StatiStiCS
exercise 6a
1 a 5
b 26.5
c 74.25
d 7.72
e 376
2 72.6%
3 125.7 c/L
4 1.81 m
5 Yes, mean mass is 45.035 g.
6 a
Score (x)
Frequency
( f)
fx
8
10
12
14
16
18
2
7
11
6
2
2
16
70
132
84
32
36
f = 30
f x = 370
Score
Frequency
fx
Mean = 12 3
20
30
10 a 10
c 180190 cm
11 D
13 a
63
Class
24
45
10
20
f = 30
f x = 210
b 7
7 a
b 170180 cm
d 171.4 cm
12 C
Class
centre Frequency
(x)
( f)
5.5
12
1120
15.5
2130
25.5
31 40
35.5
4150
45.5
5160
55.5
7180
75.5
8190
85.5
91100
95.5
35.5
4150
45.5
136.5
5160
55.5
222.0
6170
65.5
458.5
7180
75.5
11
830.5
8190
85.5
171.0
91100
95.5
191.0
f = 30
f x = 2045
No. of
weeks
fx
16
64
17
68
18
54
19
114
50.0151.00 50.5
20
140
51.0152.00 51.5
12
618.0
21
12
252
52.0153.00 52.5
23
1207.5
22
176
53.0154.00 53.5
38
2033.0
23
46
54.0155.00 54.5
15
817.5
24
96
55.0156.00 55.5
166.5
25
50
f = 52
f x = 1060
b 68.17
14 a
fx
202.0
f = 95 f x = 5044.5
b 46.4
21 a 63
b 82.2
c 13.7
22 54.1
23 a 25
b 59
c 21.2
d The outlier greatly increases the mean.
24 36
25 24.5
26 a The mean will increase.
b The mean will decrease.
exercise 6b
1 6
2 81
3 a 5
b 5.4
c 62
d 102
4 a 4
b 5.6
c The median is a better measure because
5 a
b 53.1
15 a
Score
Frequency
Cumulative
frequency
17
18
13
fx
19
19
0 19
9.5
20
190
20
12
31
20 39
29.5
12
354
21
39
40 59
49.5
396
22
44
18
36
60 79
69.5
347.5
23
48
10
30
80 99
24
50
Score (x)
Frequency
( f)
fx
b 2.3
110
Class
centre Frequency
(x)
( f)
Frequency
65.5
35.5
Class No. of
centre swimmers
Class centre
6170
31 40
Time
Class
fx
No. of
televisions
sold
b 20.4
8 a
16 a 14.1
b 3.4
c 44.4
17 a 6.6
b 30.67
18 166.25
19 a 12.5, 13.5, 14.5, 15.5, 16.5
b 14.4
20 a
20
20
f = 50
f x = 115
Score
89.5
89.5
328.5
149.5
f = 50
f x = 1855
b 37.1
b 20
6
7
8
9
10
3
1
C
C
A
227
11 a
Days
sickness
Frequency
Cumulative
frequency
04
10
10
59
12
22
1014
29
1519
35
2024
40
2529
43
3034
45
160
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
b 148, 151
d 72
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
Class centres
50<100
75
17
100<150
125
12
29
150<200
175
15
44
200<250
225
50
250<300
275
54
300<350
325
56
Cumulative
frequency
$500$549 524.5
36
$550$599 574.5
40
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
22 27 32 37 42 47 52 57
Weekly wage ($)
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
375
23
24
25
58
26
exercise 6C
25 75 125 175 225 275 325 375
Depth of snow (cm)
Class centres
173 cm
628
613, 628 and 632
The stem-and-leaf plot arranges all the
scores in order, making it easier to find
the centre and the most frequent score.
a 24.5
b 25
c The outlier had only a very small effect.
No, as a single outlier will not change the
score that occurs the most often.
a 82 and 45
b 6069
c The modal class shows the group that
has the most scores. In this case, since
the mode is the highest score and with a
frequency of just two, it is insignificant
compared to the rest of the data.
The middle class in a grouped distribution.
The median is estimated in grouped
distributions using an ogive, which is more
useful.
This is an estimate as the individual
scores are lost once put into a grouped
distribution.
c
21 a
b
c
22
228
28
30
b 8
c 152
4
2
25
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
$400$449 424.5
$450$499 474.5
20 a 170180 cm
b
100
0<50
18
24
Cumulative frequency
b 8
d 0.4
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
350 400
6
6
b $350$399
c
c 16
17 a 1720
b 2228
18 a
Depth
(cm)
$300$349 324.5
$350$399 374.5
15 cm
5
16 cm
5
17 cm
5
18 cm
5
19 cm
5
cm
16
8
12
1 a 2.29
c 20.17
e 42.44
Standard deviation
b 2.19
d 3.07
26.94
b 2.14
57.51
d 0.26
96.04
Sample
Population
Population
Sample
Population
616.6
b Sample
270.97
1.44
b Population
0.48 million
x = 4.9, n = 1.0
x = 48.2, n = 1.2
x = 78.3, n = 2.3
x = 17.45, n = 3.69
x = 56.02, n = 14.26
x = 14.95, n = 7.49
Brianna: x = 75, n = 3.69
Katie: x = 74, n = 18.28
b Brianna is more consistent because she
has a lower standard deviation.
B
C
x = $1825, n 1 = 797
n = 0.51
n = 15.10
n = 2.51
a 500
b x = 455.3, n 1 = 88.9
Crinkle, because the standard deviation
in the weight of each pack is lower and
therefore you are more likely to get the
correct amount.
a Group A = 170 group B = 170
b No, there appears to be greater spread in
group B.
c Group B
d Group A = 5.35 group B = 32.5
a 5
b 1.9
c 4
d 2.2
a x = 36, n = 20.4
2 a
c
e
3 a
b
c
d
e
4 a
c
5 a
c
6 a
b
c
7 a
b
c
8 a
15
8
4
14
14
$200$249 224.5
$250$299 274.5
7 12 17 22 27 32
No. of sick days
10
5
11
110
17
No mode
2.6
4
42, 44
17
Cumulative frequency
13
c
a
c
e
a
c
e
a
c
a
b
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
Class
Cumulative frequency
Cumulative frequency
b 1014
12 a 2, 7, 12, 17, 22, 27, 32
b
19 a
17
18
19
Standard Standard
deviation deviation
Extra Difference after score increase or
score from mean
added
decrease
8
28
21.1
Increase
30
19.4
Decrease
90
54
25.7
Increase
50
14
19.8
Decrease
21 B
22 The standard deviation will increase if the
1 a $425 000
b $370 000
c $350 000
d The median, as the mean is inflated
3 a
b
c
4 a
b
c
d
5 a
b
Class
Class centre
Frequency
1019
14.5
2029
24.5
3039
34.5
4049
44.5
c 4049
d As the mode is the only score that
b
c
d
7 a
b
c
d
Cumulative frequency
6 a
11 a
b
12 a
b
c
d
e
13 a
14 a
b
c
200
15 a
150
100
Class
50
0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
00 00 00 00 00 00 00
15 25 35 45 55 65 75
Crowd number
e 21 000
f Median
8B
9 a
Class
6.8
04
04
Jim x = 33.3, sn = 5.06, Lewis x = 26.7,
sn = 5.21
Lewiss sample has a much lower mean
and both data sets have similar standard
deviations.
This could be because Lewis and
Jim took their samples from different
machines. Check other possible answers
with your teacher.
Carmen x = 32.5, sn = 15.1,
Jade x = 24.8, sn = 7.7
By chance it would appear that Jade
has included an outlier in her sample.
This may be because in this hour the
shop was running some specials or a
promotion.
Player A: 34.3 Player B: 41.8
Player B
Player A: 32.5 Player B: 0
Player A
Player A would be more useful as he
is much more consistent. The mean
includes any outliers and so is affected
by very large or very small data values.
65 out of 80 earn less than the mean and
another 10 only slightly more than the
mean. Hence it is misleading.
The median and the mode would be
useful in your submission as they are
not distorted by the larger salaries as the
mean is.
Group A mean = 170,
median = 170, mode = 170
Group B mean = 170,
median = 170, mode = 170
Group B has a greater spread of scores
Group A range = 20, IQR = 0,
std dev. = 5.77
Group B range = 120, IQR = 20,
std dev. = 35.12
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
0 4
16
16
59
22
1014
12
26
1519
17
28
2024
22
29
2529
27
30
Class
Cumulative
centre Frequency frequency
3039
34.5
4049
44.5
13
5059
54.5
22
6069
64.5
25
7079
74.5
29
8089
84.5
30
Cumulative frequency
2 a
d
b
c
d
10 a
upper quartile = 60
16
Mean = 53.5, std dev. = 13.48
Mean = 54.07, std dev. = 12.50
When scores are put into a table the
individual scores are lost, affecting both
the mean and standard deviation.
16 A
17 B
18 a There are two modes; that is, two scores
19 a
b
c
d
20 a
b
c
d
21 a
b
c
22 a
b
23 a
b
c
24 a
b
Chapter revieW
MUltiple ChoiCe
1
2
3
4
5
A
A
D
B
B
Short anSWer
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
34
.5
44
.5
54
.5
64
.5
74
.5
84
.5
exercise 6d
Class centre
1 a
b
c
d
2 a
b
5.2
64.875
7.7
35.8
7.025
9.46
229
4
5
6
fx
Class
Class centre
Frequency
2124
22.5
67.5
2528
26.5
238.5
2932
30.5
17
518.5
3336
34.5
31
1069.5
37 40
38.5
29
1116.5
41 44
42.5
25
1062.5
45 48
46.5
19
883.5
4952
50.5
10
505.0
f = 143
f x = 5461.5
Mean = 38.2
a 31.1
a 29.9
a 27
d 5.5
a 2
b
b
b
e
b
7
8 a
23.2
26.4
6
128
56
180
160
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
d 58
.5 .5 .5 .5 .5 .5 .5
34 44 54 64 74 84 94
Score
a 2
a 2
b 23, 27
b 15, 18
c No mode
46 49
a 71.8
b Population
c 17.3
a 1.95
b Sample
c 0.89
a x = 0.81, n = 0.42
b x = 67.25, n = 75.3
c x = 28.1, n = 1.2
d x = 27.5, n = 7.03
15 a 27.8
b 24.5
c 28
d Median
16 Check with your teacher.
extended reSponSe
c 0.445
c 18.6
c 3.2
1 a
c 68.5
Class
Class centre
Frequency
Cumulative
frequency
3039
34.5
18
18
40 49
44.5
34
52
5059
54.5
39
91
6069
64.5
45
136
7079
74.5
29
165
8089
84.5
10
175
9099
94.5
180
b 5059
230
9
10
11
12
13
14
Cumulative frequency
Income
Class centre
Frequency
Cumulative
frequency
$62 500
12
12
$87 500
18
30
$112 500
26
56
$137 500
24
80
$162 500
12
92
$187 500
100
b
d
f
2 a
b
c
d
e
$120 000
c 35 622
$100 000$125 000
e $100 000$125 000
mean
Text A: x = 58.6, n = 25.1
Text B: x = 62.25, n = 11.8
Population because the whole classes results have been used.
Text B
Text B lower standard deviation
Check with your teacher.
ChapTer 7
Measurement
ChapTer ConTenTS
7a
7B
7C
7d
7e
Measurements as approximations
Units of measurement and scientific notation
Ratios
Rates
Percentage change
7a
measurements as approximations
How far is it from your house to school? If you live close to school you may give your answer in metres,
but if you are further away you would probably answer in kilometres. In either case your answer would
not be exact. In fact no measurement is exact. Measurements can only be taken to the degree of accuracy
that the instruments used allow.
All measurements are approximations.
No measuring instrument is perfect and different people can sometimes obtain a slightly different
reading from the same instrument. For example, one person may measure a persons height as 162cm
while another may get an answer of 163 cm. To reduce the likelihood of error we may repeat the same
measurement a number of times and average the result.
Worked example 1
Taylor has her height measured by 8 people. They obtain the following results:
169 cm, 169 cm, 168 cm, 170 cm, 169 cm, 169 cm, 168 cm, 168 cm.
What is the average result?
Think
WriTe
Average = 1350 8
= 168.75 cm
As no measurement can ever be exact each measurement taken will be given to some degree of accuracy.
Significant figures
Consider each of the following measurements.
The distance from the Earth to the Sun is 149 000 000 km.
The distance between Sydney and Melbourne is 1040 km.
A circle with a radius of 5 cm has an area of 78.54 cm2.
In each of the above cases the measurement is not exactly correct. As already stated, all measurements
are approximations. Each of these measurements has had a sensible and practical approximation applied.
The distance from the Earth to the Sun has been given to the nearest one million kilometres. The
distance to the nearest kilometre is needed only for very precise scientific work.
ChapTer 7 Measurement
231
The distance between Sydney and Melbourne is given to the nearest kilometre. No-one travelling
between these two cities would need to know the distance with any greater degree of accuracy.
Using the formula A = r 2 the calculator gives the area of the circle as 78.539 816 34. Using 2decimal
places is usually a more practical way to answer such questions.
The accuracy of every measurement taken is limited by the accuracy of the
instrument used to take the measurement. The measurement is then given to the
most practical degree of accuracy.
Measurements are usually given to a required number of significant figures. In the examples above:
149 000 000 km is correct to 3 significant figures
1024 km is correct to 4 significant figures
78.54 cm2 is also correct to 4 significant figures.
Significant figures are the number of non-zero digits at the beginning of a number. The zeros that fill
the remaining places are not significant and are there to maintain the correct place values. (Note: Zeros
between 2 significant figures are taken to be significant, for example, 1024 has 4 significant figures,
not 3.) Consider the situation below.
A star is a distance of 68.04 light-years away from the Earth. If the speed of light is 299 792km/s and
a year is taken to be 365.26 days, what is the distance from the Earth to the star, in kilometres?
A light-year is the distance that light will travel in 1 year. Therefore:
1 light-year = 299 792 60 60 24 365.26
= 9 460 975 039 488 km
Distance = 68.04 9 460 975 039 488
= 643 724 741 686 764 km
With such large numbers it is not usually necessary to be so exact. We could say that the distance was
approximately 644 000 000 000 000 km. In this example we have rounded the distance off, correct to
3 significant figures.
In this example, the zeros are not significant figures. When rounding off, however, we must include
them, so that each significant figure has its correct place value.
When rounding a number off to 3 significant figures, we cut the number off after the first three nonzero digits and round off using the same rules as for decimal places. We then fill out the remaining
places with zeros.
Worked example 2
Round each of the following numbers off to the required number of significant figures.
a 25 854 789 652 (2 significant figures)
b 63 879 258 (1 significant figure)
Think
b 1
2
WriTe
60 000 000
Significant figures can also be used to round off decimals. Care must be taken when reading a question
to see if you are being asked to round off using significant figures or decimal places. Zeros at the front of
a decimal are not considered to be significant figures. For the decimal 0.000 254 878 the first significant
figure is the 2. If we round off to 2 significant figures 0.000 254 878 0.000 25.
When rounding off decimals to a set number of significant figures, the zeros at the front must be left
in place but there is no need to fill out remaining places with zeros.
232
Worked example 3
Round each of the following numbers off to the number of significant figures indicated.
a 0.005 254 8 (3 significant figures)
b 0.014 725 8 (2 significant figures)
Think
WriTe
b 1
2
exercise 7a
0.005 25
b
0.015
measurements as approximations
1 We1 The capacity of a jug is measured by 5 people to be 750 mL, 752 mL, 749mL, 753mL and
take the time of the winner to be 36.4 secs, 36.25 secs, 36.3 secs and 36.15 secs. What time should be
allocated to the winner of the race?
4 In an international diving competition there are 7 judges. Each judge awards the competitor a score out
(2)
6 We3 Round each of the following off to the number of significant figures indicated.
a 0.032 579 81 (2)
d 6.256 677 158 (4)
b 2 significant figures
d 5 significant figures.
B 0.04
C 0.035
d 0.036
9 mC The distance between two cities is 2986 km. Rounded to 2 significant figures, this distance becomes:
a 29 km
B 2900 km
C 2986.00 km
d 3000 km
B 4 significant figures
d Neither A nor B
Further development
11 By first rounding each number correct to one significant figure, estimate the value of each of the
following calculations.
a 183 + 58
d 1010 98
b 78 11
e 17 19
c 632 + 169
f 476 11 + 52
ChapTer 7 Measurement
233
g (51 + 68) 12
j 42 8 + 18 5
h 68 + 19 9
k 176 18 + 689
i
l
5 (78 59)
473 276
12 mC The number 6.831 is rounded to 6.83. The number has been rounded correct to:
a 2 decimal places
C both A and B
13 mC A number rounded to three significant figures is 4.80. The number could have been:
a 4.79
B 4.794
C 4.798
d 4.81
14 The length of a block of land is measured in mm by 8 people who obtained the following results.
figures.
b First round each measurement correct to four significant figures and then take the average of the
By now you should be familiar with all of the main units of measuring length, mass and capacity.
Units of length
Units of length are based on the metre. There are four units
commonly used for measuring length: the millimetre (mm),
centimetre (cm), metre (m) and kilometre (km).
10 millimetres = 1 centimetre
100 centimetres = 1 metre
1000 metres = 1 kilometre
The flow chart at right shows how to convert units of
measurement.
1000
kilometres
1000
metres
100
100
centimetres
10
millimetres
10
Units of mass
The same method can be used to convert units of mass. There
are three main units of mass: the gram (g), kilogram (kg) and
tonne (t).
1000 grams = 1 kilogram
1000 kilograms = 1 tonne
Remembering these conversions can be aided by a flow chart.
1000
tonnes
1000
kilograms
1000
1000
grams
Units of capacity
Capacity is the measure of liquid volume. The three common
kilolitres
units used to measure capacity are: millilitres (mL), litres (L)
1000
1000
and kilolitres (kL).
litres
1000 millilitres = 1 litre
1000
1000
1000 litres = 1 kilolitre
millilitres
The flow chart for converting these units is similar to that for
mass.
With these units of measurements it is important to recognise the use of prefixes.
The prefix kilo means 1000 times larger: 1 kilometre = 1000 metres, 1 kilogram = 1000 grams and
so on.
Similarly, the prefix milli means 1000 times smaller: 1000 millimetres = 1 metres,
1000 millilitres = 1litre.
234
Worked example 4
b 3.2 kg = ___ g
d 0.8 L = ___ mL.
Think
WriTe
a 30 mm = 30 10 cm
= 3 cm
= 3200 g
= 650 kg
= 800 mL
More complex are the units used for area. Area is expressed in square units with the exception of the
hectare.
Consider the case of a square with a side length of 1 cm which is the same as 10 mm.
1 cm
10 mm
The area can be calculated as 1 cm2 (using a side length of 1 cm) or 100 mm2 (using a side length of
10 mm). As they are in fact the same sized square it can be concluded that 1 cm2 = 100 mm2.
Now consider a square of side length 1 m or 100 cm.
1m
100 cm
km2
100 m
10 000
hectares
10 000
10 000
m2
10 000
10 000
cm2
100
100
mm2
ChapTer 7 Measurement
235
Similarly we can find the conversion between units of volume by considering equal sized cubes.
1 cm
10 mm
The volume can be calculated as 1 cm3 (using a side length of 1 cm) or 1000 mm3 (using a side length
of 10 mm). As they are in fact the same sized cube it can be concluded that 1 cm3 = 1000 mm3.
1m
100 cm
m3
1003
Cubic
metres
(m3)
Cubic
centimetres
(cm3)
103
10003
1003
Cubic
kilometres
(km3)
10003
Worked example 5
For very large or very small numbers we use significant figures together
with scientific notation. If you look up in the sky at night, the closest
star you can see is approximately 41 600 000 000 000 kilometres
away.
This measurement has been given correct to 3 significant figures. It
can also be written as 4.16 1013 km, which is in scientific notation
correct to 3 significant figures.
41 600 000 000 000 = 4.16 1013 and is entered as 4.16EXP 13. The
appearance of this on the calculator display will vary with different
types of calculators.
An example of a very small measurement is the width of a human
hair. This may be 0.000 000 041 365 mm. In scientific notation, correct
to 2 significant figures, we would write this as 4.1 108 mm.
236
Worked example 6
Write each of the following measurements in scientific notation, correct to 3 significant figures.
a 25 473 269 000 km
b 0.000 004 583 12 g
c 499.85 L
Think
WriTe
b 1
2
3
c 1
2
2.55 1010
b
4.58 106
c
5.00 102
cm
b 600 cm =
e 12 m =
mm
m
cm
c 5000 m =
f
9 km =
2400 m =
km
2.2 cm =
mm
g 86 mm =
cm
h 9.2 km =
6.4 cm =
mm
k 11.25 m =
cm
b 3000 kg =
c 7t=
f
km
m
kg
d 5 kg =
e 9500 kg =
g 5.5 t =
kg
h 4.84 kg =
kg
2350 g =
kg
b 11 000 L =
kL
mL
e 4800 L =
kL
h 12.8 L =
mL
c 4 kL =
f
8650 mL =
min
d 5 days =
g 2 years =
j
36 h =
days
days
b 360 min =
e 7h=
h
min
c 72 h =
f
3h=
h 3 years =
months
4 years =
k 1 week =
450 min =
days
min
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1459
Converting metric units
weeks
h
5 Richard is planning to have a garage built. The garage is 5.2 m long, 2.4 m wide and 2.5 m high. All
builders, however, work in millimetres. What are the dimensions of the garage, in millimetres?
6 Peter is a truck driver. When he is passing through a small country town a detour takes him to a road
that has a 4 tonne weight limit on all vehicles. Peters truck, including its load, is 3850 kg. How many
kilograms under the weight limit is the truck?
ChapTer 7 Measurement
237
7 A factory is producing orange juice. One kilogram of oranges will produce 400mL of freshly squeezed
juice. How many litres of orange juice can be produced from 4.5tonnes of oranges?
8 We5 Complete each of the following.
a 23 400 m2 = _____ km2
49 000 m2
= ___ ha
h 5 ha = ____
km2
1 m3 = ___ mm3
10 We6 Write each of the following measurements in scientific notation, correct to 2 significant figures.
a 471 591 400 km
b 7 415 200 000 000 mm
c 12 850 t
d 0.002 369 g
e 0.222 221 L
f 0.002 99 s
11 The distance between the planet Mars and the Sun is given by
conversions.
a 2.4 106 mm =
c 4.6
cm =
7
e 3.45 10 t =
g 8.9 107 L =
i
106
7.1 103 L =
m
mm
kg
kL
b 9.1 108 m =
d 4.9 105 kg =
8.11 106 kg =
h 1.09 1010 kL =
f
km
t
g
L
mL
13 Scientists in a laboratory measure the diameter of a certain microbe to be 0.000 000 2mm, and growing
by 0.000 000 000 5 mm/day. What will be the diameter of the microbe in 10 days? (Answer in scientific
notation.)
14 A light-year is defined as the distance travelled by light in one year. If light travels at 2.991 105 km/s,
calculate in scientific notation the size of a light-year, correct to 3 significant figures. (1 year = 365.26 days)
Further development
15 Builders generally work in millimetre measurements. A hardware store sells plasterboard in the
c 2700 mm 1200 mm
16 A marathon is an athletic event run over a distance of 42.2 km. At the Olympic Games the event starts
and finishes with a lap of the stadium which has a circumference of 400 m. Calculate in metres the
distance that is run outside of the stadium.
17 Mario goes to the timberyard to buy three lengths of timber, 2100 mm, 65 cm and 4.25 m. Calculate the
238
7C
ratios
Zhong and Hasam invest money in a business. Zhong invests $25 000 and Hasam invests $30 000. The
business made a profit of $33 000 in the first year. If their profit is to be fairly shared, how much should
each of the partners receive? We need a simple method for comparing the investment of each partner. We
do this by using ratios.
A ratio is a comparison of two or more quantities measured in the same units. For example, a ratio
can be used to compare two quantities of money in dollars, two distances in kilometres or two masses in
grams. However, we cant use a ratio to compare quantities of different types. For example, a ratio cant
compare a distance with a mass.
A ratio can be simplified by dividing each quantity by the highest common factor (HCF). When this is
done, we say the ratio has been fully simplified. The ratio is then easier to use in solving problems.
Worked example 7
WriTe
a 24 : 32
3:4
b $3.60 : $2.10
360 : 210
12 : 7
c 3 m : 80 cm
300 : 80
15 : 4
Once we are able to write ratios, we can use them to compare quantities. We do this by comparing the
two parts of the ratio. We can consider each part of the ratio as consisting of a number of shares. If we
know the value of one part of the ratio we can find the value of one share and hence find the other part of
the ratio. This is known as the unitary method.
Worked example 8
Jane and Brookes heights are in the ratio 9 : 10. If Jane is 162 cm tall,
how tall is Brooke?
Think
1
3
4
5
WriTe
Jane : Brooke
9 : 10
162 cm : ???
9 shares = 162 cm
1 share = 18 cm
10 shares = 180 cm
Brooke is 180 cm tall.
Returning to the problem at the start of this section, we can use ratios to divide a quantity into
unequal parts.
ChapTer 7 Measurement
239
Worked example 9
Think
WriTe
exercise 7C
5:6
b 11 shares = $33 000
1 share = $3000
5 shares = $15 000
6 shares = $18 000
Zhongs share is $15 000 and Hasams share
is $18 000.
ratios
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1467
ratios
B 1 : 15
B 1 : 2500
c
f
i
l
o
r
u
x
300 g : 800 g
375 mL : 500 mL
800 mm : 550 mm
$1 : 60c
40 min : 1 h
900 L : 3 kL
1.25 L : 500 mL
3 t : 450 kg
C 180 : 45
d 4:1
C 2:5
d 1 : 125
4 We 8 The ratio of boys to girls in a class is 5 : 4. If there are 15 boys in the class, how many girls
are there?
5 In a school, the ratio of students to teachers is 35 : 2. If the school has 60 teachers, how many students
is 2 : 15.
a How much water must be added to a 1 litre
bottle of syrup?
b How much cordial will this mixture make?
8 In a cricket match, the ratio of Australias score
9 In Parliament, the ratio of Liberal members to Labor members is 4 : 3. If there are 63 Labor members of
a 49%
C 64%
d 72%
11 Tom and Rachael divide $1000 in the ratio 7 : 3. How much should each receive?
12 Natalie and Kathy share a job in the ratio 3 : 2. If their job is a 35 hour per week job, how many hours
attack in the ratio 7 : 2. How many goals were scored by the goal attack?
14 A game of AFL at the Sydney Olympic Stadium attracts a crowd of 80 000 people. The ratio of Sydney
supporters to Collingwood supporters is 11 : 5. How many Collingwood supporters are at the game?
15 mC A fruit punch drink is to be made for a party. It consists of orange juice, pineapple juice and apple
juice in the ratio 5 : 3 : 2. If we want to fill a 9 litre bucket with the punch, how much pineapple juice
will be needed?
a 0.9 L
B 2.7 L
C 3L
d 5L
16 A radio station plays 14 songs in one hour. Of these, 4 are by Australian artists.
a What is the ratio of Australian music to overseas music played during this hour?
b If during a week this ratio is maintained, how many tracks by Australian artists will be played if a
20 Monica and Vicky share a two bedroom flat. Monicas bedroom has an area of 15 m2, while Vickys has
an area of 12 m2.
a What is the ratio of the area of Vickys bedroom to Monicas?
b The rent on this flat is $180 per week and they agree that the rent should be split in the ratio of
their bedroom areas. How much should they each contribute to the rent?
ChapTer 7 Measurement
241
Further development
21 The ratio of Michaels height to Nevilles height is 4 : 5 and the ratio of Nevilles height to Raymonds
earnings is 8 : 5. Given that Vicky earned $720 calculate the amount that Kerrie earned.
23 Fully simplify each of the following ratios.
a 0.8 : 0.36
e 65% : 1
1
2
24 To make a sauce,
b 3% : 0.5%
f
2
3
:14
1
4
1
3
1
4
d 0.9 : 1 4
g 50% : 1.4 :
7
8
h 0.07 : 49%
1
22
25 Two stroke petrol of varying blends is made by mixing petrol and oil in different ratios.
a Find the amount of petrol to be added to 600 mL of oil in a 16 : 1 blend.
b A second blend is 32 : 1. Find the amount of oil in 6.6 L of this fuel.
c One litre of each blend is mixed. Find the ratio of the combination fuel.
d How much 32 : 1 blend must be added to one litre of the 16 : 1 blend to make a 20 : 1 blend?
26 Given a : b = 4 : 5 and b : c = 4 : 7 find the ratio c : a.
7d
rates
It is the last day of a test cricket match between Australia and India. To win the match, Australia needs to
make 280 runs in 80 overs. How many runs per over do they need to score?
This question requires us to work with rates. A rate is a comparison of two quantities of a different
type. In this example we need to compare runs with overs.
242
Worked example 10
WriTe
measure of time.
b $2.50 is an amount of money. Kilograms is a
measure of mass.
c A kilolitre is a measure of capacity. Years are a
measure of time.
Rates, like ratios, often need to be simplified. To simplify a rate, we divide the first quantity by the
second quantity. A rate is always simplified to a single unit.
Worked example 11
a 240 km in 3 hours
= 80 km in 1 hour
= 80 km/h
= 74.9 c/L
= 3.5 runs/over
Once we are able to simplify rates, we can use them to solve problems. Solving problems usually
involves multiplying or dividing quantities and rates. In each example, we need to carefully think about
which of these we need to do and clearly set out the working steps.
Worked example 12
Giovanni is a plumber who charges $22.50/h for labour. What will be his labour charge for a job
that takes 4 hours?
Think
WriTe
$22.50 4 = $90.00
A common example of where a rate must be used is when modifying a recipe for a set number of
people. A recipe may be given to serve 4 people but we may need to modify it to serve, say, 6. In such a
1
case, each ingredient would need to be multiplied by 1 2 .
ChapTer 7 Measurement
243
Worked example 13
2 eggs
20 g apricot jam
WriTe
Multiplication factor = 9 6
1
= 12
bananas = 4 1 12
=6
eggs = 2 1 1
2
=3
1
coconut = 250 g 1 2
= 375 g
lemon juice = 10 mL 1 2
= 15 mL
castor sugar = 20 g 1 12
= 30 g
1
apricot jam = 20 g 1 2
= 30 g
In a few examples a rate can compare two measurements of the same type. For example, a
concentration of medicine may contain a mass/weight rate or a mass/volume rate. This is where we are
measuring the concentration of a certain substance. The concentration is the amount of one substance
that is contained within another.
Worked example 14
The concentration of pentoxyverine citrate in a cough mixture is 15 mg/100 mL. A person should
not consume more than 9 mg of pentoxyverine citrate per day. If one dose of the cough medicine is
10 mL, what is the maximum number of doses a person can have per day?
Think
WriTe
9 1.5 = 6
We need to be able to use the conversion facts for measurement to convert between rates. We should
be able to convert km/h to m/s and other similar rates. This is done by changing each unit separately at
each stage of the conversion while keeping the equivalent rate.
Worked example 15
244
WriTe
exercise 7d
rates
1 We10 What quantities are being compared in each of the following rates?
a 80 km/h
b $2.50/kg
c $12.40/h
d 50 g/L
e 4 goals/game
f 2 C/min
g 5.1 m/s
h 200 g/m2
i 78.9 c/L
j 6 s/kg
k 40 L/100 km
l 2 m/year
2 We11 Simplify each of the following rates (where necessary answer to 1 decimal place).
a 270 km in 3 hours
b $32 for 8 kg
c 250 runs in 50 overs
d 10 degrees in 2 h
e $65 for 4 h
f 90 m2 with 4 kg
g 600 m in 80 s
h $223 in 5 days
i 500 km on 65 L
j 23 goals in 8 games
k 400 kL for 32 days
l $42.68 for 55 L
3 mC George buys 600 g of bacon at the delicatessen for $5.94. As a rate this is equal to:
a $3.56/kg
B 99 c/kg
C $9.90/kg
d $35.64/kg
4 Josie takes her car to the mechanic for a service. The mechanic worked on the car and charged Josie
$68.50 for 2 12 hours labour. At what rate has she been charged for labour?
5 After 15 minutes of hard exercise, Roulas heart beat 520 times in the next 4 minutes. What is her heart
rate in beats per minute?
6 Judy wants to leave Melbourne at 6:00 am bound for Sydney, a distance of 1040 km. She needs to be in
Sydney by 8:00 pm that evening. If she allows for 2 hours as rest breaks, what speed must she average
to arrive in time? (Answer to the nearest whole number.)
7 The race record for the Melbourne Cup is 3 min 16.9 s held by Kingston Rule. The Melbourne Cup is
run over 3200 m.
245
12 A patient in hospital is placed on an intravenous drip. The medication is given to the patient at a rate of
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1464
Speed converter
15 drips/min. Each drip is 0.25 mL. How much medication will the patient receive in 4 hours?
We13 Below are the ingredients for seafood mornay.
600 g of rice
300 g of pink salmon
1 egg
60 g of butter
30 g of plain flour
450 mL of milk
90 g of shredded cheese
75 g of breadcrumbs
This recipe serves 6 people. Modify the recipe so that it will serve 8 people.
The ingredients below make 15 chocolate cookies.
300 g of brown sugar
90 g of oil
30 g of cocoa powder
120 g of self-raising flour
120 g of plain flour
90 g of choc bits
60 g of white chocolate
Modify the recipe to make 10 chocolate cookies.
We14 A sore throat treatment contains 7.5 g/100 mL of povidone. If the intake of povidone must not
exceed 3 grams per day and each dose of the sore throat treatment is 5mL, calculate the maximum
number of doses a person can take each day.
A dietary supplement for cattle requires that the bull be fed 2.5 g/kg weight. Calculate the amount of
the dietary supplement required for a 760 kg bull.
A river is flowing at a rate of 2 m per second. Given that every metre of river contains 3500 litres of
water, calculate the amount of water that flows through the mouth of the river each hour.
A swimming pool has a volume of 150 m3. Given that 1 m3 = 1000 L of water, calculate the length of
time that it will take to fill a pool using a hose with a flow rate of 40 L/min.
We15 Convert a speed of 15 m/s to km/h.
Convert each of the following rates.
a 90 km/h to m/s
b 2.5 m/s to km/h
c 8 mL/m to L/km
d 8 km/L to L/100 km
B 10 L/100 km
d 12 L/100 km
22 The instructions on a 1 kg bag of lawn food say to use 125 g/m2 of lawn. Nora buys 5 bags of the lawn
food. Does she have enough to do a lawn that is 43 m2 in area? Explain your answer.
23 A car uses 45 L of petrol on a 432 km trip.
a Write the fuel consumption in km/L.
b How much fuel will the car use on a 324 km trip at the same rate?
Further development
24 A car can travel at an economy rate of 14.5 L/100 km of city driving and 9.6 L/100 km of country
driving.
a Calculate the petrol used on a journey of 460 km of which 330 km was country driving.
b Find the overall economy rate for the journey.
25 A Year 7 science class makes two salt water solutions. The first solution has 20 g of salt per litre and
the second solution has 50 g of salt per litre. If 2 litres of the first solution is mixed with 5 litres of the
second solution find the number of grams per litre of salt in the mixture.
26 7500 cars can pass along a toll road each hour. The toll for the road is $4.50.
a Express the maximum earnings for the road as a rate per hour.
b Given that the road operates at capacity for 4 hours per day, 75% capacity for 6 hours per day and
40% capacity for 12 hours per day calculate the daily earnings for the road.
27 The instructions on a container of weed killer say to mix 10 grams of the powder with 5 litres of water.
This mixture will cover an area of 30 m2.
a Express the mixture as a rate in simplest form.
b Express the coverage of the solution as a rate in simplest form.
c How much powder should be added to 14 litres of water?
d What area will the solution in part c cover?
e The powder can be bought in a 125 g jar. Once mixed what area will this cover?
246
water supply for the farm can provide 400 000 L of water per day.
a Express the water requirement as a rate in litres per hectare per day. (Give your answer correct to
three significant figures.)
b The farmer hopes to expand his farm but can access no further water. Calculate the maximum area
of the farm that can be irrigated using the existing system. Give your answer to the nearest hectare.
7e
percentage change
You should be familiar with increasing and decreasing an amount by a percentage. We will now examine
consecutive percentage changes.
Consider the case of a pair of rollerblades that is usually priced at $120. The price rises by 20% but
then a discount of 20% is applied. The price does not revert to $120 because the increase and decrease
are 20% of different amounts.
Worked example 16
The price of a pair of rollerblades is $120. The price is increased by 20% and then decreased by
20%. Calculate the new price of the rollerblades.
Think
1
WriTe
120% of $120
= 120 100 $120
= $144
80% of $144
= 80 100 $144
= $115.20
ChapTer 7 Measurement
247
exercise 7e
percentage change
1 We16 The cost of a stereo system is $750. The price is increased by 10% and then decreased by 10%.
time by 5%.
a Calculate the new travelling time between the two
towns.
b An accident then increases the travelling time on a
particular day by 20%. Calculate the time taken to travel
between the two towns.
4 Increase $150 by 10% and then increase the result by 10%.
5 Decrease 250 kg by 5% and then decrease the result by 5%.
6 Are each of the following calculations equal?
a 50 litres is increased by 10% and then the result is
increased by 20%.
b 50 litres is increased by 20% and then the result is
increased by 10%.
7 A carpenter purchases $600 worth of items from a hardware
during a sale. Calculate the percentage discount that has been applied.
9 Increase $280 by 10% and decrease the result by 5%.
10 Decrease $13.50 by 20% and then increase the result by 20%.
Further development
11 Find the single percentage increase that is equivalent to successive increases of 15% and 5%.
12 An item is increased in price by 10%. Find the percentage discount that is applied to reduce the item
248
13 Tori claims that if an item is discounted by 5% and then 10% it does not matter what order the
discounts are applied. Is Tori correct? Use calculations to justify your answer.
14 Find the single discount equivalent to successive discounts of 20% and 10%.
15 If there is a percentage increase and decrease of the same percentage, is the overall effect an increase or
decrease? Does it matter the order in which the operations are applied.
16 How many price increases of 10% are needed to double the original price of an object?
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 7.2
doc-10327
ChapTer 7 Measurement
249
Summary
measurements as
approximations
Units of measurement
and scientific notation
ratios
rates
percentage change
250
Chapter review
1 One litre of water has a mass of 1 kg. What would be the mass of 1 mL of water?
a 1g
B 10 g
C 100 g
m U lTip l e
C ho iC e
d unknown
2 The diameter of a human hair is 0.000 045 6 mm. In scientific notation this is equal to:
a 4.56 104
B 4.56 105
C 4.56 104
d 4.56 105
C 1.5 km/min
d 2500 km/day
B 30 m/s
4 The ratio of a trees height to its girth is 15 : 4. If the height of the tree is 26.25m, the girth is:
a 1.75 m
B 6.5625 m
C 7m
d 98.4375 m
1 The girth of a tree is measured by five people to be 152 cm, 160 cm, 158 cm, 155 cm, 156 cm. What is
the best measurement that should be given for the trees girth?
S ho rT
a n S W er
2 A group of surveyors measure the height of a bridge to be 32.6 m, 32.7 m, 32.5 m, 35.6 m, 32.7m, 32.4 m.
a Find the average of their readings.
b It is suggested that one surveyor made a large error in her measurement and the measurement should
be discarded. What would be the average reading if the greatest outlying score is disregarded?
3 Write each of the following correct to the number of significant figures stated in the brackets.
a 3 458 258 [2]
b 49 718 564 [4]
c 0.000 097 252 [2]
d 1.587 362 458 5 [ 4]
4 Copy and complete each of the following.
a 90 mm =
d 4800 m =
g 9000 g =
11 000 L =
m 300 s =
j
cm
km
kg
kL
min
b 6m=
c 6.7 km =
e 6.9 cm =
cm
mm
h 9500 kg =
t
k 4550 mL =
L
i
l
11.25 m =
4.84 kg =
12.8 L =
m
cm
g
mL
5 An elevator has a capacity of 1.3 tonnes. If 18 people who each weigh an average of 66 kg are on the
mm
b 9.1 107 g =
kg
c 3.45 107 t =
kg
c 90 m : 150 m
f 500 m : 3 km
9 Jane and Allan share an amount of money in the ratio 5 : 3. If Janes share of the money is $600, what is
Allans share?
10 Divide $2000 in the ratio 3 : 7.
11 Yasmin and Carrie purchase a lottery ticket for $5. Yasmin paid $3.50 and Carrie paid $1.50 for the ticket.
a What is the ratio of their investments in the ticket?
b If the ticket won $250 000, how much should each receive?
12 Simplify each of the following rates.
a $2.50 for 10 L
b 80 km in 2 h
c $42 for 5 h
d 3 h for 2 kg
13 A car is travelling at 90 km/h. How far will it travel in 7 hours at this rate?
14 Eric earns $12.45/h. How many hours does he need to work to earn more than $400?
15 If petrol costs $1.27/L, how much petrol can be bought for $40?
16 The cost of a refrigerator is $900. The price is then increased by the manufacturer by 10%. When on
sale, the refrigerator is sold at a discount of 10%. Calculate the sale price of the refrigerator.
ChapTer 7 Measurement
251
e x T ended
r e SponS e
1 On a set of building plans the length of a rectangular house is given as 20 500 mm.
a State this length in metres.
b Daryl measures the length of the house in metres, correct to 1 decimal place. State the maximum
diGiTal doC
Test Yourself
doc-10328
Chapter 7
252
ICT activities
7B
diGiTal doCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1459): Converting metric units (page 237)
WorkSHEET 7.1 (doc-10326): Apply your knowledge of measurement
to questions. (page 238)
7C
ratios
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet (doc-1467): Ratios (page 240)
7d
rates
7e
percentage change
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 7.2 (doc-10327): Apply your knowledge of measurement
to questions. (page 249)
Chapter review
diGiTal doC
Test Yourself Chapter 7 (doc 10328): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 252)
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet (doc-1464): Speed converter (page 246)
ChapTer 7 Measurement
253
Answers CHAPTER 7
meaSUremenT
exercise 7a
measurements as
approximations
1 750.4 mL
2 79.25 km
3 36.275 secs
4 a 6.8
b One score is much greater than all others.
c 6.7
5 a 25 000 000
b 200 000 000
c 8 780 000
d 5000
e 700 000
f 287
6 a 0.033
b 0.004
c 0.001 50
d 6.257
e 68.3
f 0.0002
7 a 100 000 000 km
b 150 000 000 km
c 147 000 000 km
d 146 570 000 km
8 D
9 D
10 C
11 a 260
b 800
c 800
d 10
e 400
f 100
g 1200
h 270
i 100
j 420
k 710
l 150 000
12 C
13 C
14 a 21 570 mm
b 21 570 mm
c 21 570 mm
exercise 7B Units of measurement and
scientific notation
1 a 7 cm
b 6m
c 5 km
d 90 mm
e 1200 cm
f 9000 m
g 8.6 cm
h 9200 m
i 2.4 km
j 64 mm
k 1125 cm
l 22 mm
2 a 8 kg
b 3t
c 7000 kg
d 5000 g
e 9.5 t
f 2.35 kg
g 5500 kg
h 4840 g
3 a 2L
b 11 kL
c 4000 L
d 15 000 m L
e 4.8 kL
f 8.65 L
g 7900 L
h 12 800 m L
4 a 4 min
b 6h
c 3 days
d 120 h
e 420 min
f 180 min
g 730 or 731 days
1
h 36 months
i 208 weeks j 1 days
2
1
k 168 h
l 7 h
2
2500 mm high
6 150 kg
7 1800 L
8 a 0.0234 km2
b 6 mm2
c 550 m2
d 80 cm2
e 730 000 m2 f 2 cm2
g 4.9 ha
h 0.05 km2
9 a 3 cm3
b 4 200 000 cm3
c 40 000 mm3
d 0.006 m3
e 82.5 cm3
f 1 000 000 000 mm3
10 a 4.7 108 km
b 7.4 1012 mm
4
c 1.3 10 t
d 2.4 103 g
e 2.2 101 L
f 3 103 s
11 a No. It is accurate to the nearest hundred
thousand kilometres.
b 4
c 230 000 000 km
12 a 2.4 103 m
b 9.1 105 km
254
4.6 107 mm
3.45 1010 kg
8.9 104 kL
7.1 106 mL
2.05 107 mm
9.44 1012 km
a 1.8 m 0.9 m
b 2.4 m 0.9 m
c 2.7 m 1.2 m
41 400 m
$53.20
a 4.38 103
c 8.74 1010
e 1.23 102
g 5.29 101
a 1.0 1010
a 31
c
e
g
i
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
exercise 7C
d 4.9 102 t
f 8.11 109 g
h 1.09 1013 L
b
d
f
h
b
b
5.65 107
2.30 105
7.85 104
2.79 101
1.8 1016
35 800 mm
ratios
1 a 5:1
b 10 : 9
c 3:8
d 7:3
e 5:3
f 3:4
g 3 : 16
h 1 : 13
i 16 : 11
j 25 : 6
k 4:5
l 5:3
m 4:1
n 2:5
o 2:3
p 20 : 1
q 3:8
r 3 : 10
s 4:1
t 3 : 50
u 5:2
v 20 : 13
w 9:2
x 20 : 3
2 D
3 B
4 12
5 1050
6 1260 kg
7 a 7.5 L
b 8.5 L
8 320
9 84
10 C
11 Tom gets $700 and Rachael gets $300.
12 Natalie works 21 hours and Kathy works
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
14 hours.
10
25 000
B
a 2:5
b 600
a $9.30
b 5:3
c Sandra $400 000, Kevin $240 000
Sand 75 kg, cement 50 kg and gravel
25 kg
a 4:5:2
b 12
a 4:5
b Vicky pays $80 and Monica pays $100.
16 : 25
$375
a 20 : 9
b 6:1
c 4:3
d 18 : 25
e 13 : 30
f 8 : 15
g 20 : 56 : 35
h 1:7
2
24 a 6 3
b 10
25 a 9.6 L
c 24 : 1
26 35 : 16
b 200 mL
d 647 mL
exercise 7d
1 a
c
e
g
rates
Distance/time
Money/time
Goals/games
Distance/time
b
d
f
h
Money/mass
Mass/capacity
Temperature/time
Mass/area
i Money/capacity j Time/mass
k Capacity/distance l Distance/time
2 a
c
e
g
i
k
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
90 km/h
5 runs/over
$16.25/h
7.5 m/s
7.7 km/L
12.5 kL/day
b
d
f
h
j
l
$4/kg
5/h
22.5 m2/kg
$44.60/day
2.875 goals/game
77.6 c/L
C
$27.40/h
130 beats/min
87 km/h
a 196.9 s
b 16.3 m/s
7.2 km/L
12 L/100 km
C
$471.66
900 mL
800 g of rice
400 g of pink salmon
1 egg (nearest whole number)
80 g of butter 40 g of plain flour
600 mL of milk 120 g of shredded cheese
100 g of breadcrumbs
200 g of brown sugar
60 g of oil
20 g of cocoa powder
80 g of self-raising flour
80 g of plain flour
60 g of choc bits
40 g of white chocolate
8
1.9 kg
25 200 000 L
62 hours 30 minutes
54 km/h
a 25 m/s
b 9 km/h
c 8 L/km
d 12.5 L/100 km
C
No, she has enough lawn food for only
40 m2.
a 9.6 km/L
b 33.75 L
a 50.53 L
b 11 L / 100 km
41.4 g / L
a $33 750
b $448 875
a 2g/L
b 6 m2 / L (or 0.167 L /m2)
c 28 g
d 84 m2
e 375 m2
a 1.6 L
b 18.75 g
a 11 400 L / ha / day
b 35 ha
exercise 7e
percentage change
1 $742.50
2 a 24.9375 km
b 547.4 kg
c 3 h 21 min 36 s
3 a 1 h 54 min
b 2 h 16 min 48 s
4 $181.50
5 225.625 kg
6 Yes, each equals 66 L.
7 $555.75
8 a $250
b 20%
9 $292.60
10 $12.96
11 20.75%
12 9.09%
13 Tori is correct. Check with your teacher to
ChapTer reVieW
mUlTiple ChoiCe
1A
2 B
3 B
4 C
ShorT anSWer
1 156 cm
2 a 33.1 m
3 a 3 500 000
c 0.000 097
b 32.6 m
b 49 720 000
d 1.587
4 a 9 cm
d 4.8 km
g 9 kg
j 11 kL
m 5 min
5 112 kg
b
e
h
k
600 cm
69 mm
9.5 t
4.55 L
6 107 km
1.47 108 m
8.739 101 t
2.874 103 mL
7 a 5.2 106 mm
b 9.1 104 kg
c 3.45 1010 kg
8 a 3:4
c 3:5
e 25 : 4
g 2:9
9 $360
6 a
c
e
g
b
d
f
h
c
f
i
l
6700 m
1125 cm
4840 g
12 800 m L
4 105 mm
6.43 105 t
5.74 104 g
5.874 103 g
10 $600 : $1400
11 a 7 : 3
b Yasmin $175 000, Carrie $75 000
12 a 25 c/L
b 40 km/h
c $8.40/h
d 1.5 h/kg
13 630 km
14 33 h
15 31.5 L
16 $891
exTended reSponSe
b
d
f
h
4:3
8:5
1:6
3 : 10
1 a
b
c
d
2 a
b
c
20.5 m
50 mm
0.24%
1.64 108
55 800 000 km
0.09%
3200 km/h
ChapTer 7 Measurement
255
Chapter 8
8a
The perimeter of a plane figure is the total length of the outside boundary of that figure. For some
figures, a formula can be used to calculate the perimeter. In others, the lengths of each side need to be
added.
Shape
Square
Rectangle
Circle
l
r
Formula for
calculating
perimeter
P = Circumference
C = 2 r, where r is the
radius
As 2r = d (diameter),
C = d
All other shapes have their perimeters calculated by adding their side lengths.
WorkeD exaMple 1
Find the perimeter of each of the following shapes. (Where appropriate, state your answer correct
to 2 decimal places.)
a
12 cm
7 cm
5 cm
5 cm
think
lengths.
Write
a P = 5 + 12 + 5 + 12
= 34 cm
257
b C = 2 r
r=7
C=27
= 43.98 cm
c P=65
= 30 cm
Some figures will require a calculation to be made in relation to one or more sides.
WorkeD exaMple 2
7 cm
think
1
120
Write
P = 14.66 + 7 + 7
= 28.66 cm
= 120
2r
360
= 120
27
360
= 14.66 cm
This calculation may extend to the use of Pythagoras theorem to find one of the side lengths before
finding the perimeter.
WorkeD exaMple 3
258
Write
a2 = c2 b2
a2 = 162 92
a = 175
= 13.2 m
P = 16 + 9 + 13.2
= 38.2 m
= 256 81
= 175
R
16 m
P
9m
Q
exercise 8a
We1
c
9 cm
3 cm
2 cm
5 mm
f
3 cm
8 cm
6 cm
5 cm
4 cm
2 cm
1 cm
12 cm
2 cm
1 cm
5 cm
2.5 cm
1.5 cm
5 cm
3 cm
4 cm
10 cm
135
30 cm
21 cm
d
14 cm
100 m
20 m
14 cm
30 cm
10 cm
7 cm
8 cm
28 mm
20
22 cm
15 cm
60 mm
259
14 cm
7cm
25 cm
2cm
8cm
8 cm
14 cm
4cm
5 A rectangular paddock 38 m by 27 m is fenced with 5 rows of wire. What is the total length of wire needed?
6 MC Which of the following shapes has the same perimeter to the nearest cm as
28 cm
30 cm
14 cm
29 cm
30 cm
8 cm
6 cm
15 cm
10 cm
D 12 cm2
8 The length of a rectangular pool is twice its breadth (or width). If the perimeter of the pool is 81m, find
its dimensions.
9 A length of masking tape, 100 cm long, is wrapped once around the edges of a rectangular block. How
valueof x?
13 A figure has a perimeter of 64 mm. Azi suggests it is a square of side length 16 mm; Robyn suggests
it is a rhombus of side length 16 mm; Lauren suggests it is a square of side length 8 mm and Simon
suggests it is a 20 mm by 12 mm rectangle. Comment on the suggestions made by each person.
14 A bundle of rope is cut into pieces to lay on the ground to mark a soccer field along those lines. The
layout of the pieces is shown below. The marks on each end of the field are identical. What is the total
length of rope required?
110 m
16.2 m
5.4 m
9m
260
40 m 18 m
60 m
15 The track for a school cross-country competition is shown below. Checkpoints are labelled by the
Scale
50 m
Start
Finish
150 m
100 m
Trees
Bushes
Plantation
Bridge
Oval
Building
Road
single diagonal brace. Calculate the length of timber needed to build the gate, correct to the nearest metre.
15
20 mm
10
21.6
60 mm
9.2
12
12.4
f
x
610 cm
28 m
12 m
6m
16 m
24 m
920 cm
12.4
430 cm
34
6.2
21.2
20
m
m
12.6 mm
30
9.
6
4.6
9.2
3.4
d
10.6 mm
19 Consider the figure at right. Find the length of:
a AC
b AD
c AE
d AF
F
E
A
1m
B
D
C
261
8B
Area is a measure of the amount of space within a closed shape. As we have seen in chapter 7, area is
measured in square units.
Most common shapes have a formula we can use to find the area of that shape.
Square
A = s2 (s = side length)
Rectangle
A = l b (l = length, b = breadth)
Triangle
Parallelogram
A = bh (b = base, h = height)
Rhombus
Trapezium
WorkeD exaMple 4
b
19 mm
9.4 cm
62 mm
12.8 cm
8.5 m
think
Write
a A = s2
= 8.52
= 72.25 m2
bA=lb
= 62 19
= 1178 mm2
c A=
1
2
bh
= 12 12.8 9.4
= 60.16 cm2
WorkeD exaMple 5
26
14 m
18 m
5.9 cm
7.2 cm
11.4 cm
262
think
Write
aA=bh
= 14 9
= 126 m2
bA=
1
2
Dd
1
2
18 26
= 234 m2
c A=
1
2
(a + b) h
1
2
= 62.28 cm2
Circles
The area of a circle can only be found exactly in terms of . The area of a circle is found using the
formula A = r 2. To get a numerical answer an approximation needs to be made.
D
think
Write
Atriangle = 2 bh
ABC: b = AB = 8, h = EC = 6
Area of ABC =
ABD: b = AB = 8, h = FD = 2
1
2
1
2
AB EC
= 86
= 24 cm2
263
exercise 8B
8 cm
d
DiGital DoC
GC program Casio
doc-1473
Mensuration
DiGital DoC
GC program TI
doc-1474
Mensuration
3.6 km
29 mm
3.7 cm
12.5 cm
2.9 m
2 We4b Find the area of each of the rectangles below.
b
a
3m
27 mm
9m
38 mm
d
e
2.2 km
3.85 m
49.7 km
47 cm
62 cm
6.4 m
34 m
6.3 m
3 We4c Find the area of each of the triangles below.
b
a
DiGital DoC
Spreadsheet
doc-1475
perimeter and area
6.2 cm
12 m
9.4 cm
76 mm
9m
82 mm
e
6.3 km
8.4 km
4.2 m
3.7 m
9.7 m
c
7.8 m
9.3 m
17 cm
d
38 mm
12.8 km
f
80 cm
87 mm
8m
16.9 km
7m
264
cm
7.7
15
mm
m
9c
31
8.8
14
.25
km
f
20.9 m 10.2 m
3m
39 cm
25
.25
km
5.6 m
3.2 m
97 mm
7m
d
58 mm
e
1m
8.4 m
f
2.8 m
3.65 m
12 m
9m
3.6 cm
9.5 cm
5.4 cm
0.4 m
7 Find the area of each of the following circles correct to 2 decimal places.
a
b
c
7.3 cm
41.8 cm
11.6 cm
7m
20 m
a Find the area of the outer rectangle.
b Find the area of the inner rectangle.
c Find the shaded area by subtracting the area of the inner rectangle from the area of the outer
rectangle.
9 Find the shaded area in each of the following.
a
14 m
8m
5 cm
10 m
5 cm
9 cm
16 m
c
d
8m
3m
5m
9m
10 m
8m
8m
12 m
12 m
265
30
70
17 mm
18 cm
12 cm
345
8 cm
3 cm
28 m
15 cm
2 cm
4 cm
f
28 cm
3.8 m
2.1m
18 cm
5 cm
12 cm
12 MC The area of the triangle at right is:
a
B
C
D
36 cm2
54 cm2
108 cm2
1620 cm2
15 cm
12 cm
9 cm
19 cm
19 cm
38 cm
38 cm
54 m2
165 m2
225 m2
255 m2
17 m
15 m
7m
15 m
Further development
16 A rectangular garden in a park is 15 m long and 12 m wide. A concrete path 1.5 m wide is to be laid
4m
6m
100 mm
c
42 cm
40 cm
36 cm
e
240 m
160 m
3m
6m
2.4 m
h
80 m
16 cm
120 m
18 Find the area of glass in the window shown.
0.9 m
0.8 m
1.8 m
267
8C
Field diagrams
Surveyors are often required to draw scale diagrams and to calculate the area of
irregularly shaped blocks of land. This is done using a traverse survey. In this
survey, a diagonal (traverse) is constructed between two corners of the block. The
diagonal is then measured.
From this diagonal each other corner is sighted at right angles to the diagonal.
Each of these lines, called an offset, is measured.
These offsets then divide the block into triangles and quadrilaterals, hence we can
calculate the area.
The results of a traverse survey are displayed in a field diagram.
The measurements through the centre of the field diagram are the points at which
the offsets are taken. 100 metres is the length of the diagonal. At the sides are the
measurements from the diagonal to the corners.
C
100
interaCtiVitY
int-2407
Field diagram
45
75 40
70
20 30 E
0
A
268
WorkeD exaMple 7
Write/DraW
A2
A3
25
45
40
5
50
D
A4
A1
30
20
E
A5
A
b 1 Calculate the area of the four triangles and
the trapezium.
b A1 =
=
=
A4 =
1
2
1
2
bh
75 45
1687.5 m2
1
2
1
2
1750 m2
1
2
1
2
562.5 m2
A2 =
(a + b) h
(40 + 30) 50
b h A3 =
25 45
A5 =
=
=
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
bh
30 40
= 600 m2
bh
20 30
= 300 m2
WorkeD exaMple 8
Draw a 50 mm line.
50
15 30
Write/DraW
15 20
0
20
15
4
P = 34 + 25 + 40 + 25
= 124 m
269
When you draw a scale diagram of the block of land, you can use measurement to find the perimeter.
inVeStiGate: land survey
1
2
3
4
Find an area of land in or near your school and conduct a traverse survey of it.
Draw a scale diagram of the area of land.
Calculate the area of the land.
Find the perimeter of the block.
exercise 8C
Field diagrams
50
25 40
scale 1 mm = 1 m.
15 20
0
A
D
80
42 65
scale 1 mm = 1 m
b calculate the area of the block of land
c use measurement to find the perimeter.
40 28
35 10
0
3 Use the field diagrams below to calculate the area of each block of land.
b
c
a
C
D
D
100
70
75
C 23 70
C 30 90
B
40 40
30 15
40 30
20 20
50 30
30 40 20
Further development
25 m
35 m
45 m
25 m
C 20 75
B 25 55
20 45 E
0
A
20 m
A
270
6 For the field diagram in question 5 determine if the area ABCD or AED is larger.
7 A traverse line is 100 metres long from point A to point B. Alan is to set an offset at C 25metres at
right angles to the traverse line. Where should Alan set the offset to maximise the area of ABC?
8D
applications of area
In an earlier section we found the area of plane shapes. This needs to be applied to a wide range of
practical situations. In many cases this will require drawing a diagram.
WorkeD exaMple 9
A clock has a minute hand that is 6 cm long and an hour hand that is
3 cm long. In one full revolution of each band, the minute hand would
sweep out a larger circle than the hour hand. What is the difference in
the area they cover (to the nearest square centimetre)?
think
6 cm
Write
R
r
3 cm
R = 6, r = 3
A = 62 32
= 113.097 28.274
= 84.823 cm2
exercise 8D
applications of area
3
4
5
3m
12 m
7m
20 m
3m
Find the cost of the job if the workman charges $40.00 per m2.
6 A yacht race consists of 12 laps around a triangular course. The triangle is equilateral with each side
810 m. Find the total length of the race, in kilometres.
Chapter 8 Perimeter, area and volume
271
figure at right.
If the radius of each tennis ball is 4.6 cm, find the perimeter
of the smallest possible rectangle that will contain the balls.
8 A block of land is in the shape of a square with an equilateral
triangle on top. Each side of the block of land is 50 m.
a Draw a diagram of the block of land.
b Find the perimeter of the block of land.
c Find the area of the block of land.
9 An athletics track consists of a rectangle with two semicircular ends. The dimensions are shown in the
diagram below.
70 m
90 m
82 m
The track is to have a synthetic running surface laid. Calculate the area which is to be laid with the
running surface, correct to the nearest square metre.
10 A garden is to have a concrete path laid around it. The garden is rectangular in shape and measures
40 m by 25 m. The path around it is to be 1 m wide.
a Draw a diagram of the garden and the path.
b Calculate the area of the garden.
c Calculate the area of the concrete that needs to be laid.
d If the cost of laying concrete is $17.50 per m2, calculate the cost of laying the path.
11 Len is having his lounge room carpeted. Carpet costs $27.80/m2. The lounge is rectangular with a
length of 7.2 m and a width of 4.8 m.
a Calculate the area of the lounge room.
b Calculate the cost of carpeting the room.
Further development
12 A rectangular garden in a park is 15 m long and 12 m wide. A concrete path 1.5 m wide is to be laid
120 cm
60 cm
140
45 cm
1 cm
0.5 cm
22 cm
8e
Volume of prisms
The volume of a solid shape is the amount of space within that shape.
Consider the prism at right which has been built with cubes with sides of
1 cm.
We can see by counting squares that the area of the base is 15 cm2. The
height of the prism is 3 cm, and if we count the remaining cubes we find that
the volume of the prism is 57 cm3.
interaCtiVitY
int-1150
Maximising the volume
of a cuboid
Build the prism that has been drawn above. Count the number of cubes that have been used to build
the prism. Build other prisms and count the area of the base, the height and find the volume. Show that
the volume can be found by multiplying the area of the front face (base) by the height perpendicular to
the front face.
When prisms are drawn, they are usually drawn lying down so that we can see the base.
Hence, using the above example we can see that the volume of a prism can be calculated using the
formula:
V=Ah
where A is the area of the base and h is the height.
WorkeD exaMple 10
think
Write
A = 63 cm2
5 cm
V=Ah
= 63 5
= 315 cm3
For some prisms we can develop a more specific formula for volume, without separately calculating the
area of the base.
Cube
The front face of the cube is a square of side length s and the height is s.
V=Ah
V = s2 s since A = s2 for a square.
This becomes the formula used for the volume of a cube.
V = s3
WorkeD exaMple 11
think
Write
V = s3
= 6.83
= 314.432 cm3
6.8 cm
273
rectangular prism
Now consider a rectangular prism with a length of l, a breadth of b and a
height of h.
Substituting into the formula:
V=Ah
V = l b h since A = l b.
h
b
WorkeD exaMple 12
Write
47 mm
29 mm
V=lbh
= 47 29 12
= 16 356 mm3
Cylinders
A cylinder can be considered to be a circular prism. Consider the cylinder at right
with a radius of r and a height of h. Substituting into the formula
V=Ah
r
V = r 2h
2
since for a circle A = r .
We also need to be aware of the relationship between volume and capacity. Capacity refers to the
amount of liquid that a container holds. Capacity is measured in millilitres, litres and kilolitres.
A volume of 1 cm3 = 1 mL and 1 m3 = 1000 L.
WorkeD exaMple 13
Find the capacity of a cylinder with a radius of 1.3 m and a height of 7.8 m.
think
Write
V = r 2h
= (1.3)2 7.8
41.412 m3
For any other prism, to calculate the volume we calculate the area of the base first and then use the
formula V = A h.
274
WorkeD exaMple 14
think
1
5.6 cm
Write
A=
1
2
1
2
1.2 cm
bh
5.6 7.9
= 22.12 cm2
V=Ah
= 22.12 1.2
= 26.544 cm3
exercise 8e
Volume of prisms
5 cm
A = 19 cm2
A = 57 cm2 4 cm
12 cm
f
DiGital DoC
Spreadsheet
doc-1481
Volume
18 mm
9.2 m
A = 27.9
A = 15.93 mm2
A = 77.7 cm2
m2
7.7 cm
2 A prism has a base area of 74.5 m2 and a height of 3.1 m. Calculate the volume.
3 We11 Calculate the volume of each of the cubes below.
b
a
5 cm
2.4 m
d
13 m
f
e
29 mm
8.2 m
5.64 m
4 We12 Find the volume of each of the rectangular prisms below.
b
a
c
3.7 m
3 cm
6 cm
4 cm
42 mm
6.3 m
4.5 m
13 mm
9 mm
275
20.5 m
16.5 m
12.5 m
50 mm
3.2 m
4.2 m
9 mm
9 mm
5 We13 Calculate the volume of each of the cylinders below, correct to 1 decimal place.
a
b
c
27 cm
6 cm
13 cm
12 m
12 cm
3m
15 cm
18.5 cm
9 cm
3 mm
25 cm
47 cm
b
6 cm
8 cm
3 cm
c
12 cm
8 cm
5 cm
d
3.4 m
12.5 m
2.7 m
3.2 m
7.8 m
1.5 m
7 Find the volume of each of the following prisms by first calculating the area of the front face.
a
b
15 m
5m
5m
10 m
15 m
20 m
5m
c
3.1 cm
19 m
12 m
10 m
1.7 cm
276
2.4 cm
8 In each of the following, the prisms front face is made up of a composite figure. For each:
i calculate the area of the front face
ii find the volume of the prism.
a
4 cm
4m
20 cm
10 cm
16 cm
8m
10 cm
9m
d
15 cm
3m
8 cm
12 cm
20 cm
12 m
6m
6 cm
18 m
12 m
cube
square prism
rectangular prism
both B and C
10 MC The area of the front face of a prism is 34.67 cm2, and the height is 3.6 cm. The volume of the
prism is:
a 38.27 cm2
C 124.12 cm2
B 38.27 cm3
D 124.812 cm3
11 MC The dimensions of a rectangular prism are all doubled. The volume of the prism will increase by
a factor of:
a 2
B 4
C 6
D 8
12 A refrigerator is in the shape of a rectangular prism. The internal dimensions of the prism are 60 cm by
60 cm by 140 cm.
a Find the volume of the refrigerator in cm3.
b The capacity of a refrigerator is measured in litres. If 1 cm3 = 1 mL, find the capacity of the
refrigerator in litres.
13 A semi-trailer is 15 m long, 2.5 m wide and 2.7 m high. Find the capacity of the semi-trailer in m3.
14 A petrol tanker is shown below.
2m
12 m
The tank is cylindrical in shape. The radius of the tank is 2 m and the length is 12 m. Calculate:
a the volume of the tank, correct to 3 decimal places
b the capacity of the tank, to the nearest 100 litres. (1 m3 = 1000 L).
10 m
15 At right is a diagram of a concrete slab for a house.
a Calculate the area of the slab.
2.5 m
b The slab is to be 10 cm thick. Calculate the volume of concrete needed for
15 m
the slab. (Hint: Write 10 cm as 0.1 m.)
10 m
c Concrete costs $45.50/m3 to lay. Calculate the cost of this slab.
Chapter 8 Perimeter, area and volume
277
Further development
17 Find the volume of each of the following shapes.
a
Shaded
area = 33 cm2
10.5 mm
>
>
3.5 cm
>
0.5 m
Shaded
area = 42 cm2
55 cm2
>
>
8 cm
18 The figure below shows a concrete paver in the shape of a trapezoidal prism.
60 cm
50 cm
50 cm
1.2 m
Calculate the number of pavers that will have a total volume of 10 m3.
40 cm
19 An apple has a volume of 512 cm3. 160 apples are packed into the box drawn below.
60 cm
38 cm
1.4 m
60 cm
2m
DiGital DoC
WorkSHEET 8.2
doc-10330
278
1.8 m
Summary
perimeter of plane
shapes
The perimeter of a plane shape is the total length of the boundary forming the figure.
There is a formula for the perimeter of a square (P = 4l ), a rectangle (P = 2(l + b)) and for the
circumference of a circle (C = d, C = 2 r). All other shapes will have their perimeter found by
simply adding all the side lengths.
To find the perimeter of some irregular shapes you will need to calculate a side length using a
known formula or Pythagoras theorem.
Trapezium
A = 2 (a + b) h
Circle
A = r2
Composite areas are calculated by breaking the plane shape into smaller regular figures.
Field diagrams
To calculate the area and perimeter of an irregular shape a traverse survey is used to draw a field
diagram from which a scale drawing is made.
Areas are found by dividing the irregular area into trapeziums and triangles.
Perimeters can be found using the scale diagram
applications of area
Volume of prisms
Sphere
V = 3 r 3
Any other prism has its volume calculated by using the formula V = A h, where A is the area of
the base and h is the height.
279
Chapter review
M U lt ip l e
C h oiCe
16 cm
a 50 cm2
C 201 cm2
B 101 cm2
D 402 cm2
B 146 cm2
D 206 cm2
2 A rectangular garden measures 5 m by 4 m. A path 1 m wide is to be built around the garden. The area
13 cm
20
20 mm
c
12 cm
7 cm
5 cm 9 cm
cm
3.2 m
16 cm
21
.3
24
cm
4 cm
18 cm
1.5 m
5.5 m
2.5 m
2 Find the area of each of the figures drawn below.
a
b
c
6.3 cm
32 mm
17.9 cm
74 mm
5.2 cm
26
35 cm
80 cm
mm
43
15 cm
3m
70 cm
40 cm
15.5 cm
18.2 cm
280
40 m
35 m
12.5 cm
12.5 cm
95
70 25
36 30
0
A
82
5 Draw a scale diagram to find the area and perimeter of the represented by the field
46 45
diagram at right.
32 37
15 26
0
6 A rectangular block of land 2.8 m 25 m is surrounded by a concrete path 1 m wide.
a Find the area of the path.
b Find the cost of concreting at $45 per square metre.
7 Use the formulas to calculate the volume of each of the following cubes, rectangular prisms and
cylinders.
a
3.8 m
11.6 m
29 mm
6.5 cm
4.6 m
18 mm
13 cm
41 cm
32 mm
3 cm
3 cm
8 cm
8 A prism has a base area of 45 cm2 and a height of 13 cm. Calculate the volume.
1 A silo is in the shape of a cylinder with a diameter of 5 m and a height of 20 m.
a The silo is to have a square fence built around it. The fence is to come no closer than 1 m at any
ex ten D eD
r eS p o n S e
DiGital DoC
Test Yourself
doc-10331
Chapter 8
281
ICT activities
8B
DiGital DoCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1472): Area converter (DIY) (page 264)
GC program Casio (doc-1473): Mensuration (page 264)
GC program TI (doc-1474): Mensuration (page 264)
Spreadsheet (doc-1475): Perimeter and area (page 264)
8C
Field diagrams
interaCtiVitY
int-2407: Field diagram (page 268)
DiGital DoC
WorkSHEET 8.1 (doc-10329): Apply your knowledge of measurement
to questions. (page 270)
8e
Volume of prisms
interaCtiVitY
int-1150: Maximising the volume of a cuboid (page 273)
282
DiGital DoCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1481): Volume (page 275)
WorkSHEET 8.2 (doc-10330): Apply your knowledge of measurement
to questions. (page 278)
Chapter review
DiGital DoC
Test Yourself Chapter 8 (doc-10331): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 281)
Answers CHAPTER 8
periMeter, area anD
VolUMe
exercise 8a
1 a 26 cm
b 40 mm
c 56.55 cm
d 24 cm
e 15 cm
f 31 cm
g 10 cm
h 30 cm
2 a 64 cm
b 90 mm
c 36 cm
d 78.54 cm
e 44 cm
3 a 77.12 cm
b 74.99 cm
c 43.56 cm
d 95.99 cm
e 262.83 m
f 71.98 cm
g 42.43 cm
h 174.55 cm
i 163.98 cm
4 a 148.54 cm
b 47.14 cm
c 54.27 cm
5 650 m
6A
7 A, D
8 27 m 13.5 m
9 35 cm
10 12.99 cm
11 406.28 m, 412.57 m, 418.85 m
12 12 cm
13 Azis, Robyns and Simons suggestions
14
15
16
17
18
19 a 2
c 2
exercise 8B
1 a
c
e
2 a
c
e
3 a
c
e
4 a
c
e
5 a
c
e
6 a
c
e
7 a
c
8 a
c
9 a
c
b
d
3
5
10 a 37.70 cm2
c 819.96 cm2
11 a 123.29 cm2
c 52 cm2
e 78 cm2
12 B
13 A
14 B
15 a 34.56 m2
16 a
1.5 m
b 870.09 mm2
9 2513 m2
10 a
1m
b 1427.88 m2
d 30.4 m2
f 2015.50 cm2
25 m
40 m
b
c
d
11 a
b
12 a
b $960.77
12 m
15 m
1000 m2
134 m2
$2345
34.56 m2
$960.77
1.5 m
12 m
b 180 m2
c 18 m long and 15 m wide
d 90 m2
17 a 13 927 mm2
b 30.2832 m2
c 2936.64 cm2
d 2313.88 cm2
2
e 28 346.9 m
f 21.6 m2
g 4573.45 m2
h 402.12 cm2
2
18 2.71 m
19 a 5000 km2
b 200 000 000 m2
exercise 8C
1 a
B
Field diagrams
C
10
b 1125
15 m
b 180 m2
c 18 m long and 15 m wide
d 90 m2
13 107 cm2
14 65.2 cm2
15 a 2474 cm2
b 34.4%
exercise 8e
m2
25
25
20
15
2 a
b
3 a
c
4
B 35 65
20 25 D
0
A
applications of area
b 36 m2
1 a 140 m2
c 104 m2
2 11 707.92 c m2
3 21 m2
4 60
5 $840
6 29.16 km
7 128.8 cm
8 a
50 m
c 3582.5 m2
b 250 m
Volume of prisms
1 a 120 cm3
b 228 cm3
c 228 cm3
d 256.68 m3
e 286.74 mm3
f 598.29 cm3
2 230.95 m3
3 a 125 cm3
b 13.824 m3
c 2197 m3
d 24 389 mm3
e 179.406 144 m 3
f 551.368 m3
4 a 72 cm3
b 4914 mm3
c 104.895 m3
d 56.448 m3
e 4050 mm3
f 4228.125 m3
5 a 1357.2 cm3
b 339.3 m3
c 29 772.9 c m3
d 3817.0 cm3
e 26 880.3 c m3
f 13.3 cm3
6 a i 12 cm2
ii 60 cm3
b i 24 cm2
ii 288 cm3
c i 4.59 m2
ii 6.885 m3
d i 12.48 m2
ii 156 m3
7 a 187.5 m3
b 875 m3
c 2280 m3
d 6.324 cm3
8 a i 200 cm2
ii 2000 cm3
b i 99 m2
ii 792 m3
c i 204 cm2
ii 1224 cm3
d i 153 m2
ii 1836 m3
9D
10 D
11 D
12 a 504 000 c m3
b 504 L
13 101.25 m3
14 a 150.796 m3
b 150 800 L
15 a 175 m2
b 17.5 m3
c $796.25
16 a 2.8 m3
b 2800 L
c 24 429 L
d 27.5 cm
17 a 115.5 cm3
b 1218 mm3
c 2750 cm3
d 336 cm3
18 44.45
19 9280 cm3
20 6.12 m3
21 9.2 cm
22 6.694 cm 6.694 cm 13.389 cm
283
Chapter reVieW
4 a
MUltiple ChoiCe
1 a C
2 C
3 C
25 25
b A
40
B
Short anSWer
1 a
c
e
2 a
c
e
3 a
c
284
48 mm
54 cm
13.4 m
27.04 cm2
2368 mm2
787.5 cm2
180 cm2
78.125 cm2
b 16.44 cm
d 49.3 cm
b
d
f
b
d
112.77 cm2
559 mm2
2.4 m2
141.05 cm2
700 m2
36
30
A
b 2897.5 m2
5 Area = 3417.5 m2
6 a 59.6 m2
b $2682
7 a 274.625 cm3
b 24 389 m m3
c 202.768 m3
d 984 cm3
e 367.57 cm3
f 57 905.84 m m3
8 585 cm3
extenDeD reSponSe
1 a 28 m
b 29 m2
c 32.4 t
2 Gary
V = r 2 2h
= 2r2h
Gwenda
V = (2r)2 h
= 4r2h
Gwendas cylinder is larger.
ChapTer 9
9a
Have you ever read a road map or looked at plans for a house? The map or the plan is a scaled
down version of the roads or house. When two objects are identical, except one is a reduction or an
enlargement of the other, the objects are said to be similar. Maps and plans are practical examples of
similarity.
Maps and plans both use a scale. The scale tells us how many times larger an object is in reality
compared to the plan. For example, a house plan may use a scale of 1 : 100. This means that if a wall is
1cm long on the plan, it is 100 cm (or 1 m) in reality. All the angles shown on the plan are the same as
in reality. If two walls meet at right angles on the plan, they meet at right angles in reality.
Similar figures are in proportion and have the same shape. That is, each pair of corresponding sides
are in the same ratio and each pair of corresponding angles are equal.
To show that two triangles are similar, we can show that either of the above conditions is true. The
symbol for similarity is three vertical lines (|||).
For triangles, if two pairs of corresponding sides are in the same ratio and the angles they include are
equal then they are similar.
inTeraCTiviTy
int-2403
Similarity
Worked example 1
X
A
B
Think
WriTe
BAC = YXZ
ACB = XZY
ABC = XYZ
Make a conclusion.
285
Worked example 2
P
L
4 cm
M 3 cm N
Think
15 cm
12 cm
5 cm
Q
9 cm
WriTe
LM : PQ = 4 : 12
= 1:3
MN : QR = 3 : 9
= 1:3
Make a conclusion.
LN : PR = 5 : 15
= 1:3
To determine if other figures are similar, we need to examine the ratio of sides.
Worked example 3
A
4m
D
15 m
10 m
C
S
Think
6m
WriTe
AD : RS = 4 : 6
= 2:3
CD : QR = 10 : 15
= 2:3
Make a conclusion.
When we examine similar figures we can state the ratio of sides between the two figures. The number
by which we multiply measurements on the first figure to get the measurements on the second figure is
called the scale factor.
The scale factor is calculated by replacing the first part of the ratio of sides with one. The second part
of the ratio is then calculated and is the scale factor.
Worked example 4
7.5 cm
3 cm
6 cm
15 cm
286
Think
WriTe
a 6 : 15 = 2 : 5
3 : 7.5 = 30 : 75
= 2:5
Make a conclusion.
Make a conclusion.
b 2:5 = 1:2
2
1
A special case of similarity occurs when the scale factor is 1. These shapes are identical and are called
congruent figures.
exercise 9a
B
C
P
L
5 cm
M
4 cm
6 cm
10 cm
N Q
8 cm
16 cm
12 cm F
12 cm
B 9 cm C
12 cm
16 cm
E
12 cm
N S
287
A 5 cm B
2 cm
D
C
L
3 cm
K
A
4 cm
E
15 cm
W
6 cm
7 cm
8 cm
R
Q
6 cm
D
16 cm
4 cm
B
8 cm
12 cm
40 cm
4 cm
10 cm
6 cm
15 cm
11 In the figure below, !MNO ||| !MPQ.
O
Q
Further development
14 Scale factors can be given as comparative distances or as ratios. Convert each of these scale factors,
c 4 cm to 25 m
f 375 mm to 1 m
15 Write each of the ratios in question 14 as a rule with the real life (RL) as the subject of a formula in
terms of scale length (SL). For example part (a) RL = 1000 SL.
16 A scale plan for the construction of a television unit is drawn. The scale of the plan is 3 cm to 20 cm.
0.55 cm
true or false.
a All squares are similar.
b All rectangles are similar.
c All triangles are similar.
d All equilateral triangles are similar.
e All circles are similar.
inveSTigaTe: enlarging a f igure
We can draw similar figures using an enlargement factor. We will enlarge the triangle below by a
scalefactor of 2.
1 Mark a point, P, external to the figure. This point is
A
called the centre of enlargement.
P
B
C
A
A
P
B
C
A'
A
P
B
C
B'
C'
289
A'
A
P
B
C
B'
C'
Two triangles are similar if they have the same shape but not necessarily the same size. One is an
enlargement or reduction of the other. This means that the corresponding angles of the triangles have
to be equal (to make them the same shape) and the ratio of their corresponding sides must be constant
(making one smaller or larger than the other). As with congruent triangles, we do not need to know
all the information about the three sides and three angles to determine if a pair of triangles is similar.
Certain minimum information is sufficient. Let us investigate.
A
1 Draw the !ABC shown (it is not drawn to scale).
Draw !XYZ, larger than !ABC with X = A,
70
Y = B and Z = C. Measure the lengths of
the sides of the two triangles. Determine the ratios
XY YZ
,
of the lengths of the corresponding sides
AB BC
ZX
60
50
and
. Are these ratios constant (within the limits
B
C
CA
of the accuracy of the constructions)? Does it appear that !XYZ is a true enlargement of !ABC?
Repeat the process, drawing !XYZ smaller than !ABC. Is !XYZ similar to !ABC?
T
2 Construct the two triangles shown where
2 cm
D
!TVW is twice the size of !DEF.
1 cm
The ratio of their corresponding sides is
V
4 cm
E
2 cm
TV VW WT
constant as
=
=
= 2. Measure
1.5 cm
DE EF FD
3 cm
F
their corresponding angles. Are the two triangles
similar?
W
3 Construct !GHJ and !QRS to the
Q
measurements shown at right.
G
6 cm
3 cm
Find the ratio of their corresponding
sides (as in part 1) and measure all
H 30 J
30
2 cm
R
S
angles. What do you conclude?
4 cm
4 Draw the right-angled triangles KLM
N
and NPU to the dimensions given.
Again, find the ratio of their
corresponding sides (as in part 1)
K
and measure all angles. What do you
7.5 cm
conclude?
5 cm
5 Summarise the results of your
investigation. What are the minimum
requirements to ensure the similarity
P
U
L
M
3 cm
4.5 cm
of two triangles?
290
9B
We can use similar figures to solve many problems. By setting up similar triangles we can calculate
measurements of objects such as trees, which we are unable to physically measure. Another example is
house plans. In this case, the ratio of sides becomes the scale of the plan making it similar to the house itself.
Consider the case where we want to measure the height of a tree too tall for us to physically measure.
Using shadows we can create two similar triangles.
Worked example 5
WriTe
1m
7.5 m : 60 cm = 750 : 60
= 25 : 2
h = 25
1 2
h = 12.5 m
7.5 m
60 cm
We use a similar method when reading maps or plans. The map is a similar figure to the place being
mapped. We use the scale given on the map to calculate the distance between two places.
Worked example 6
The scale on a road map is given as 1 cm = 5 km. Jodie uses her ruler and finds the distance between
the towns Huxley and Brownville is 6.2 cm. Calculate the distance between these two towns.
Think
1
WriTe
6.2 cm 5 cm/km = 31 km
The actual distance between Huxley and Brownville is
31 km.
In the case of plans, the scale is often stated as a ratio. The method of solution is the same.
Worked example 7
The scale on a house plan is 1 : 150. The front of the house measures 8.5 cm on the plan. Calculate
the actual length of the front of the house.
Think
1
WriTe
House plans are a very common application of similar figures. As we saw in the previous section, plans
are drawn using a ratio as the scale factor. Measurement enables us to calculate all dimensions within the
house. Corresponding angles on similar figures are equal and so the angles on the plans will be the same
as the angles in reality.
ChapTer 9 Similar figures and trigonometry
291
Worked example 8
WC
Bathroom
Bed 3
Kitchen/Dining
Bed 2
Lounge
Bed 1
Scale 1:100
a Calculate the dimensions of the house.
Think
the plan.
2
WriTe
A = 62
A= 36 m2
House plans are also drawn with a view of what the house will look like from the outside. These
diagrams are called elevations. For example, the front elevation is what the house will look like from the
front. Elevations are also drawn using a scale.
292
Worked example 9
Scale 1:100
a Calculate the height of the eaves on the lower side of the house.
b Measure the angle of the pitch of the roof.
Think
WriTe
b Angle to horizontal = 45
exercise 9B
1m
2.5 m
40 cm
1m
line up with the top and bottom of a tree. The brush is 10 cm long
and is held 1 m away from the artists eye. The tree is 100 m away
from the artist. Calculate the height of the tree.
100 m
5 mC A tree casts a 6 m shadow. At the same time a 1-metre ruler casts a shadow 1.2 m long. The ratio
of sides in the similar figures formed is:
a 5:6
B 5:1
C 6:1
d 10 : 1
ChapTer 9 Similar figures and trigonometry
293
6 We 6 A map gives the scale as being 1 cm = 10 km. Two towns are shown as being 6 cm apart on the
10 mC On a map the scale is given as 1 cm = 5 km. The distance from Freewell to Taleton is 64km.
C 320 cm
d 12.8 km
11 We 7 The scale on a set of house plans is given as 1 : 500. Calculate the length of the house frontage if
Shed
House
Garden
bed
Garage
Driveway
Garden bed
Scale 1:250
a What are the dimensions of the block of land?
294
Lounge
Bed 3
Bed 4
Family
Pantry
Kitchen
Bed 1
Bed 2
Toilet
Bathroom
Laundry
Scale 1:150
Scale 1:100
a Calculate the height of the peak of the roof.
b Calculate the height of the eaves.
c Measure the angle of the pitch of the roof.
Further development
16 Solve each of the following by drawing a pair of similar triangles.
a A low bridge casts a shadow that is 1.44 metres long at the opening. A handymans truck is
2.5metres high. To determine if the truck will pass under the bridge the handyman gets out of
ChapTer 9 Similar figures and trigonometry
295
17
18
19
20
>
>
the truck and finds that a 1.5 m rod casts a 90 cm shadow. Will the truck pass under the bridge?
Explain your answer.
b Steve Hooker is Australias pole vault gold medallist from the Beijing Olympics. Steves
1.8 m pole casts a 96 cm shadow on the ground at the same time as the bar he is about tovault
casts a 2.4m shadow. How high is the bar on the pole vault?
c The fire brigade need to rescue people from atop a building. Their 15 m ladder casts a 20m shadow
while the building casts a 24 m shadow. What length ladder is needed?
Andrew is 1.8 m metres tall and plays basketball. He casts a 60 cm shadow on the court at the same
time as the basketball pole casts a 1 metre shadow. If the basketball ring is 45 cm below the top of the
pole, how high must Andrew reach to slam dunk the basketball?
A triangle with sides 18 cm, 36 cm and 48 cm is similar to a triangle that has a measure of 8cm down
the longest side.
a What is the scale factor?
b What is the perimeter of the smaller triangle?
A data projector is to be set up to project onto a screen that is
1.5m high.
A
The image is projected from a point behind the lens such that
B
AB = 10 cm and the image height is 5 cm. What is the maximum
Lens
distance that the projector can be placed from the screen?
Slide
A rectangle has dimensions 8 cm by 12 cm.
a What is the area of the rectangle?
Projector
b A similar rectangle is drawn with scale factor 2 : 5.
screen
What will be the dimensions of the larger rectangle?
c Find the area of the larger rectangle.
d What is the ratio of the two areas?
e What do you notice when you compare your answer to part d to the scale factor?
Draw a scale diagram showing the floor plan of the classroom you are now in. On your diagram show
the location of all desks, cupboards, the blackboards and any other features of the room.
21 The figure below is a survey plan of a street.
Lot X
30.0
a
b
c
d
e
f
296
5.0
189
.91
607
7.219
13
.21
9
38
23.0
38.
110
630 m2
21.0
21.0
187
27.499
23.0
796 m2
15
.0
g Lot 110 is for sale at $119 700, and Lot 189 is for sale at $159 500.
i Which lot represents the best value per square metre?
ii What features of a block of land might attract a purchaser even though its dollar value per square
metre may be higher than surrounding blocks? (Comparing the positions of Lots 110 and 189 can
assist in your answer, but include as many other features as possible.)
22 The plan at right shows a simple design of
a kitchen.
a What is the scale used in this plan?
b Find the dimensions of the fridge
c Find the length of the side marked x.
d Find the area of cupboard space (i.e. the
space not taken up by the fridge or cook top).
250 cm
Cupboard
space
Fridge
x cm
Cook top
9C
Trigonometry is the study of triangles. Trigonometry allows us to calculate the lengths of sides and size
of angles in different types of triangles. In this chapter we will be looking at right-angled triangles. The
hypotenuse side is the longest side of a right-angled triangle.
In trigonometry, we need to be able to name the two shorter sides
Hypotenuse
as well. We do this with reference to a given angle, and label them
Opposite
opposite and adjacent. They are the sides opposite and adjacent
to the given angle. The diagram shows the sides labelled with
Adjacent
respect to the angle, .
inveSTigaTe: looking at the tangent ratio
digiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1626
Tangent
G
E
C
297
1 a BC = _______ mm
b AB = _______ mm
2 a DE = _______ mm
b AD = _______ mm
3 a FG = _______ mm
b AF = _______ mm
4 a HI = _______ mm
b AH = _______ mm
c BC = _______
AB
DE
= _______
c
AD
FG
c
= _______
AF
HI
= _______
c
AH
Remember that BAC is common to each triangle. In each of the above, part c is the ratio of the
opposite side to the adjacent side of BAC. What do you notice about each of these answers?
Trigonometry uses the ratio of side lengths to calculate the lengths of sides and the size of angles.
The ratio of the opposite side to the adjacent side is called the tangent ratio. This ratio is fixed for any
particular angle.
The tangent ratio for any angle, , can be found using the result:
tan =
opposite side
adjacent side
In the investigation above we found that for a 30 angle the ratio was 0.58. We can find a more
accurate value for the tangent ratio on a calculator by pressing b and entering 30.
For all calculations in trigonometry you will need to make sure that your calculator is in DEGREES
MODE. For most calculators you can check this by looking for a DEG in the display.
When measuring angles:
1 degree = 60 minutes
1 minute = 60 seconds
You need to be able to enter angles using both degrees and minutes into your calculator. Most
calculators use a DMS (Degrees, Minutes, Seconds) button or a $ button. Check with your teacher to
see how to do this.
Worked example 10
WriTe/diSplay
a tan 60 = 1.732
b 15 tan 75 = 55.981
8
= 3.071
tan 69
Method 1
d Press b, enter 49, press
DMS
DMS
Method 2
298
The tangent ratio is used to solve problems involving the opposite side and the adjacent side of a rightangled triangle. The tangent ratio does not allow us to solve problems that involve the hypotenuse.
The sine ratio (abbreviated to sin) is the name given to the ratio of the opposite side and the
hypotenuse.
inveSTigaTe: looking at the sine ratio
The tangent ratio is the ratio of the opposite side and the adjacent side in a right-angled triangle. The
sine ratio is the ratio of the opposite side and the hypotenuse. Look back to the right-angled triangles
used in the tangent investigation on pages2978.
Complete each of the following measurements and calculations by using your calculator or the
spreadsheet Sine from the Maths Quest General Mathematics Preliminary Course eBookPLUS.
As we saw earlier, BAC is common to all of these similar triangles, and so in this exercise, we look
at the ratio of the side opposite BAC to the hypotenuse of each triangle.
1 a BC = _______ mm
b AC = _______ mm
c BC = _______
AC
2 a DE = _______ mm
b AE = _______ mm
DE
= _______
AE
3 a FG = _______ mm
b AG = _______ mm
FG
= _______
AG
4 a HI = _______ mm
b AI = _______ mm
HI
= _______
AI
digiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1627
Sine
In this exercise, part c is the ratio of the opposite side to BAC to the hypotenuse. You should again
notice that the answers are the same (or very close, allowing for measurement error).
In any right-angled triangle with equal angles, the ratio of the opposite side to the hypotenuse will
remain the same, regardless of the size of the triangle. The formula for the sine ratio is:
opposite side
sin =
hypotenuse
The value of the sine ratio for any angle is found using the sin function on the calculator.
sin 30 = 0.5
Check this on your calculator.
Worked example 11
b 9 sin 45
18
sin 44
Think
WriTe/diSplay
a sin 57 = 0.839
b 9 sin 45 = 6.364
enter12, press
DMS
DMS
18
= 25.912
sin 44
299
A third trigonometric ratio is the cosine ratio. This ratio compares the length of the adjacent side and
the hypotenuse.
inveSTigaTe: looking at the cosine ratio
digiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1628
Cosine
Look back to the right-angled triangles used in the tangent investigation on pages 2978.
Complete each of the following measurements and calculations. You may do so by using the
spreadsheet Cosine from the Maths Quest General Mathematics Preliminary Course eBookPLUS.
AB
1 a AB = _______ mm
b AC = _______ mm
c
= _______
AC
2 a AD = _______ mm
b AE = _______ mm
AD
= _______
AE
3 a AF = _______ mm
b AG = _______ mm
AF
= _______
AG
4 a AH = _______ mm
b AI = _______ mm
AH
= _______
AI
Again for part c, you should get the same answer for each triangle. In each case, this is the cosine
ratio of the common angle BAC.
The cosine ratio is found using the formula:
adjacent side
cos =
hypotenuse
To calculate the cosine ratio for a given angle on your calculator, use the cos function. On your
calculator check the calculation:
cos 30 = 0.866
Worked example 12
b 6 cos 55
21.3
cos 74
4.5
.
cos 8246
Think
WriTe/diSplay
a cos 27 = 0.891
b 6 cos 55 = 3.441
21.3
= 77.275
cos 74
4.5
= 35.740
cos 8246
DMS
DMS
Similarly, if we are given the sin, cos or tan of an angle, we are able to calculate the size of that
angle using the calculator. We do this using the inverse functions. On most calculators these are the
2ndfunction of the sin, cos and tan functions and are denoted sin1, cos1 and tan1.
Worked example 13
300
WriTe/diSplay
Press
2nd F
= 48
So far, we have dealt only with angles that are whole degrees. You need to be able to make calculations
using minutes as well. On most calculators, you will use the DMS (Degrees, Minutes, Seconds) function
or the $ function.
Worked example 14
WriTe/diSplay
Method 1
[tan1] and enter 1.647.
Press
2nd F
= 5844
Method 2
1
exercise 9C
1 We10 Calculate the value of each of the following, correct to 3 decimal places.
a tan 57
b 9 tan 63
8.6
tan 12
d tan 3319
2 We11 Calculate the value of each of the following, correct to 3 decimal places.
a sin 37
b 9.3 sin 13
15
sin 72
48
sin 6740
3 We12 Calculate the value of each of the following, correct to 3 decimal places.
a cos 45
b 0.25 cos 9
6
cos 24
d 5.9 cos 23
b cos 15
c tan 45
d 48 tan 85
e 128 cos 60
9.35 sin 8
0.5
tan 20
15
sin 72
4.5
cos 32
301
b tan 5721
c cos 8440
d 9 cos 5530
19
tan 6745
49.6
cos 4725
0.84
sin 755
6 We13 Find , correct to the nearest degree, given that sin = 0.167.
7 Find , correct to the nearest degree, given that:
a sin = 0.698
b cos = 0.173
c tan = 1.517.
8 We14 Find , correct to the nearest minute, given that tan = 17.169.
9 Find , correct to the nearest minute, given that:
a tan = 0.931
b cos = 0.854
c sin = 0.277.
Further development
10 Find the value of each of the following trigonometric ratio pairs. Give your answers correct to
4 decimal places.
a sin 40, cos 50
b sin 70, cos 20
c sin 13, cos 77
d sin 84, cos 6
11 What did you notice about the relationship between sin and cos in question 10? Use this to complete
each of the following.
a sin 30 = cos ___
b cos 75 = sin ___
c sin 28 = ____
d cos 45 = sin ___
12 Find:
a sin 23
b cos 23
sin 23
c
cos 23
d tan 23.
13 Find:
a sin 67
b cos 67
14 Use your answer to question 13 to find (sin 34)2 + (cos 34)2. Check your answer with your calculator.
digiTal doC
WorkSHEET 9.1
doc-10332
15 Fred tries to solve sin = 1.2 on his calculator, however an error statement is returned.
a Explain why there is no solution to this question.
b What is the only trigonometric ratio that can possibly equal 1.2?
9d
We can use the trigonometric ratios to find the length of one side of a righthyp
angled triangle if we know the length of another side and an angle. Consider
x opp
the triangle at right.
30
In this triangle we are asked to find the length of the opposite side and
14 cm
adj
have been given the length of the adjacent side.
opposite
x
We know from the formula that: tan =
. In this example, tan 30 = . From our calculator
adjacent
14
we know that tan30 = 0.577. We can set up an equation that will allow us to find the value of x.
opp
tan =
adj
x
tan 30 =
14
x = 14 tan 30
= 8.083 cm
302
Worked example 15
Use the tangent ratio to find the value of h in the triangle at right,
correct to 2 decimal places.
h
55
Think
1
17 m
WriTe
h opp
55
17 cm
adj
2
Calculate.
tan =
opp
adj
tan 55 = h
17
h = 17 tan 55
= 24.28 cm
In the example above, we were told to use the tangent ratio. In practice, we need to be able to look at
a problem and then decide if the solution is found using the sin, cos or tan ratio. To do this we need to
examine the three formulas.
opposite side
tan =
adjacent side
We use the tan ratio when we are finding either the length of the opposite or adjacent side and are
given the length of the other.
opposite side
sin =
hypotenuse
The sin ratio is used when we are finding the length of the opposite side or the hypotenuse and are
given the length of the other.
adjacent side
cos =
hypotenuse
The cos ratio is for problems where we are finding the length of the adjacent side or the hypotenuse
and are given the length of the other.
To make the decision we need to label the sides of the triangle and make a decision based on these labels.
Worked example 16
WriTe/diSplay
50
opp
x
50
adj
2
sin =
sin 50 =
opp
adj
x
24
ChapTer 9 Similar figures and trigonometry
303
Calculate.
x = 24 sin 50
= 18.39 m
Method 2
inTeraCTiviTy
int-2405
SohCahToa
To remember each of the formulas more easily, we can use this acronym:
SOHCAHTOA
We pronounce this acronym as Sock ca toe her. The initials of the acronym represent the three
trigonometric formulas.
opp
adj
cos =
tan = opp
sin =
hyp
hyp
adj
Trigonometry is used to solve many practical problems. In these cases, it is necessary to draw a
diagram to represent the problem and then use trigonometry to solve the problem. With written problems
that require you to draw the diagram, it is necessary to give the answer in words.
Worked example 17
A flying fox is used in an army training camp. The flying fox is supported by a cable that runs
from the top of a cliff face to a point 100 m from the base of the cliff. The cable makes a 15 angle
with the horizontal. Find the length of the cable used to support the flying fox.
Think
1
WriTe
f
15
100 m
304
cos =
adj
hyp
Calculate.
100
f
f cos 15 = 100
100
f=
cos 15
= 103.5 m
exercise 9d
cos 15 =
1 Label the sides of each of the following triangles, with respect to the angle marked with the
pronumeral.
a
2 We 15 Use the tangent ratio to find the length of the side marked x
13 m
23
4 Use the cosine ratio to find the length of the side marked d
31
5 We 16 The following questions use the tan, sin or cos ratios in their solution. Find the size of the side
c
49
13 cm
12.5 km
48 m
68
41
6 Find the length of the side marked with the pronumeral in each of the following
x
76
9
m
67
8.5 km
116 mm
2.3 m
305
g
20
15.75 km
44.3 m
11
16.75 cm
83
x
m
51'
2.34 m
q
32'
r
26.8 cm
84.6 km
32'
7 mC Look at the diagram at right and state which of the following is correct.
a x = 9.2 sin 69
B x=
9.2
sin 69
C x = 9.2 cos 69
d x=
9.2
cos 69
69
9.2
is correct.
8
B tan = 8
15
d cos = 17
a tan = 15
C sin = 17
17
15
15
8
is correct.
a w = 22 cos 36
22
B w=
sin 36
C w = 22 cos 54
d w = 22 sin 54
22 mm
36
11 We 17 A tree casts a 3.6 m shadow when the suns angle of elevation is 59. Calculate the height of
port. If ship B sends a distress signal, how far must ship A sail to give assistance
(to the nearest kilometre)?
14 A rectangle 13.5 cm wide has a diagonal that makes a 24 angle
Port
60
23 km
16 The wire support for a flagpole makes a 70 angle with the ground. If the support is 3.3 m from the
base of the flagpole, calculate the height of the flagpole (correct to 2 decimal places).
17 A ship drops anchor vertically with an anchor line 60 m long. After one hour the anchor line makes a
Further development
18 Find the length of the side marked c in the triangle at right.
5m
37
c
3m
19 In the diagram at right find the size of angle (to the nearest degree)
60
20
x
her downstream to a point such that the swim line makes a 67 angle with the river bank.
Calculate:
a how far she swam
b how far she finished from the planned finishing point.
23 Peter says that whenever finding the hypotenuse of a right-angled triangle, the solution will involve
307
9e
Finding angles
In this chapter so far, we have concerned ourselves with finding side lengths. We are also able to use
trigonometry to find the sizes of angles when we have been given side lengths. We need to reverse our
previous processes.
Consider the triangle at right. We want to find the size of the angle marked .
10 cm
opp
5 cm
Using the formula sin =
we know that in this triangle
hyp
5
sin = 10
1
=2
= 0.5
We then calculate sin1 (0.5) to find that = 30.
As with all trigonometry it is important that you have your calculator set to degrees mode.
Worked example 18
4.3 m
Think
6.5 m
WriTe/diSplay
Method 1
1
hyp
4.3
opp
6.5
adj
tan = opp
adj
2
Calculate.
Method 2
308
= 4.3
6.5
= 0.6615
= tan1(0.6615)
= 33 (to the nearest degree)
The same methods can be used to solve problems. As with finding sides, we set up the question by
drawing a diagram of the situation.
Worked example 19
A ladder is leant against a wall. The foot of the ladder is 4 m from the base of the wall and the
ladder reaches 10 m up the wall. Calculate the angle that the ladder makes with the ground.
Think
1
WriTe
hyp
4m
adj
2
tan =
= 10
4
= 2.5
= tan1(2.5)
exercise 9e
opp
adj
= 68
The ladder makes an angle of 68 with the
ground.
Finding angles
1 In each of the following, use the tangent ratio to find the size of the angle marked with the pronumeral,
c 25 mm
7m
12 m
162 mm
11 m
3m
2 In each of the following, use the sine ratio to find the size of the angle marked with the pronumeral,
13 m
24 m
4.6 m
6.5 m
9.7 km
5.6 km
309
3 In each of the following, use the cosine ratio to find the size of the angle marked with the pronumeral,
c
27.8 cm
2.6 m
4.6 m
15 cm
9 cm
19.5 cm
4 We18 In the following triangles, you will need to use all three trigonometric ratios. Find the size of
15 cm
11 cm
7 cm
d
14 cm
9 cm
8 cm
e
3.6 m
f
196 mm
32 mm
14.9 m
26.8 m
9.2 m
5 In each of the following, find the size of the angle marked , correct to the nearest degree.
a
b
c
0.6 m
30 m
63 cm
10 cm
19.2 m
d
2.5 m
3.5 m
8.3 m
18.5 m
6.3 m
16.3 m
18.9 m
3
.
2
A
5 cm
10 cm
9.3 m
B
12.5 m
The angle =
B 45
d 90
kite
9 We19 A 10 m ladder leans against a 6 m high wall. Find the angle that the ladder
310
40 m
10 m
1.5 nm
7m
30 m
By dividing the isosceles triangle in half, calculate, to the nearest degree, the angle
within which the footballer must kick to get the ball to go between the posts.
13 A golfer hits the ball 250 m, but 20 m off
centre. Calculate the angle at which the ball
deviated from a straight line, correct to the
nearest degree.
Further development
14 mC The figure below shows a BMX bicycle
d cos1 3
15 mC A flagpole that is 2 metres tall casts a shadow that is 0.6 metres long. The angle of the sun to the
ground is:
a 70
C 72
B 71
d 73
16 A javelin that is 1.95 m long is thrown and sticks 20 cm into the ground. Given that the sun is directly
overhead and that the javelin casts a 90 cm shadow, find the angle that the javelin makes with the
ground.
17 A hot air balloon is hovering in strong winds 10 vertical metres above the ground. The balloon is being
held in place by a rope that is 15 m long. What angle does the rope make with the ground?
18 A cable car follows a direct line from a mountain peak (altitude 1250 m) to a ridge (altitude 840m). If
the horizontal distance between the peak and the ridge is 430 m, calculate the angle through which the
cable car descends.
19 A ramp joins two points 1.2 metres apart. One point is 25 cm higher than the other.
a Find the length of the ramp.
b Find the angle of inclination of the ramp.
311
9F
In earlier sections we have seen some examples of practical problems that can be solved using
trigonometry. One of the major examples that you will need to understand is with angles of elevation and
depression.
The angle of elevation is measured upwards from a horizontal and refers to the angle at which we
need to look up to see an object. Similarly, the angle of depression is the angle at which we need to look
down from the horizontal to see an object.
We are able to use the angles of elevation and depression to calculate the heights and distances of
objects that would otherwise be difficult to measure.
Worked example 20
Calculate.
h
40
50 m
WriTe
h
opp
hyp
40
50 m
adj
opp
adj
h
tan 40 =
50
h = 50 tan 40
tan =
= 42 m
The height of the building is approximately 42 m.
In practical situations, the angle of elevation is measured using a clinometer. Therefore, the angle of
elevation is measured from a persons height at eye level. For this reason, the height at eye level must be
added to the calculated answer.
Worked example 21
WriTe
h
opp
10 m
hyp
10 m
adj
312
64
64
1.6 m
tan =
opp
adj
Calculate h.
h
10
h = 10 tan 64
tan 64 =
= 20.5 m
A similar method for finding the solution is used for problems that involve an angle of depression.
Worked example 22
When an aeroplane is 2 km from a runway, the angle of depression to the runway is 10. Calculate
the altitude of the aeroplane, correct to the nearest metre.
2 km
10
h
Think
WriTe
adj
2 km
10
opp h
hyp
opp
adj
h
tan 10 =
2000
tan =
Calculate.
h = 2000 tan 10
= 353 m
The altitude of the aeroplane is approximately
353m.
Angles of elevation and depression can also be calculated by using known measurements. This is done
by drawing a right-angled triangle to represent a situation.
Worked example 23
A 5.2 m building casts a 3.6 m shadow. Calculate the angle of elevation of the sun, correct to the
nearest degree.
5.2 m
3.6 m
313
Think
1
WriTe
opp
5.2 m
hyp
3.6 m
adj
opp
adj
tan =
tan = 5.2
3.6
Calculate.
= tan1 5.2
3.6
= 55
The angle of elevation of the sun is
approximately55.
To capture the top of the building in this photo the photographer had to tilt the camera upwards, hence,
increase the angle of elevation.
314
exercise 9F
elevation to the top of the building is 15. Calculate the height of the
building, correct to 1 decimal place.
2 The angle of elevation from a ship to an
aeroplane is 60. The aeroplane is 2300 m
due north of the ship. Calculate the altitude
of the aeroplane, correct tothe nearest
60
metre.
15
100 m
2300 m
40 m
12
37
50 m
1.5 m
5 Richard is flying a kite and sights the kite at an angle of elevation of 65.
40 m
x
65
1.8 m
6 We 22 Bettina is standing on top of a cliff, 70 m above sea
level. She looks directly out to sea and sights a ship at an angle
70 m
of depression of 35. Calculate the distance of the ship from
shore, to the nearest metre.
7 From an aeroplane flying at an altitude of 4000 m, the runway
15
is sighted at an angle of depression of 15. Calculate the
distance of the aeroplane from the runway, correct to the
nearest kilometre.
8 There is a fire on the fifth floor of a building. The closest
a fire truck can get to the building is 10 m. The angle of
elevation from this point to where people need to be rescued
is 69. If the fire truck has a 30 m ladder, can the ladder be
used to make the rescue?
9 We 23 A 12 m high building casts a shadow 15 m long. Calculate the
angle of elevation of the sun, to the nearest degree.
12 m
35
4000 m
69
10 m
15 m
10 An aeroplane that is at an altitude of 1500 m is 4000 m from a ship in a horizontal direction, as shown
below. Calculate the angle of depression from the aeroplane to the ship, to the nearest degree.
4000 m
1500 m
Further development
11 A lifesaver sits in a tower 2 m above sea level. He sees a swimmer having difficulty at an angle of
315
13 Two buildings 50 m and 75 m tall are separated by 70 m. Find the angle of elevation from the top of the
digiTal doC
WorkSHEET 9.2
doc-10333
To measure the heights of trees and buildings around your school, try the following.
1 Measure your height at eye level.
2 Take a clinometer and from a point measure the angle of elevation to the top of the tree or building.
3 Measure your distance from the foot of the tree or building.
4 Use trigonometry to calculate the height, remembering to add your height at eye level to the result of the
calculation.
proportional diagrams
4 km
h
40
12 m
15
50 m
Using this diagram, we would estimate that the ship is only 190 m from shore. Such a diagram is a
useful check to a calculation.
inveSTigaTe: Checking with a proportional diagram
Draw diagrams roughly to scale to check the results to the previous investigation.
Such diagrams are used to develop car rally courses, cross-country running courses and orienteering events.
inveSTigaTe: Using proportional diagrams
Plan a track for a cross-country run or orienteering event around your school.
1 Measure the length of each leg and the angle involved in each turn.
2 On a scale diagram, draw the course.
3 By measuring your diagram, calculate the approximate length of the course.
316
Summary
Similar figures
Similar figures have all pairs of corresponding angles equal and corresponding sides in equal ratio.
To show that triangles are similar, we show either that all pairs of corresponding angles are equal
or that all pairs of corresponding sides are in equal ratio.
For other figures it is necessary to show that both properties are true.
Scale factors
Calculating
trigonometric ratios
opp
adj
opp
sin =
hyp
adj
cos =
hyp
tan =
Finding angles
The angle of elevation is the angle we look up from the horizontal to see an object.
The angle of depression is the angle we look down from the horizontal to see an object.
Problems are solved using angles of elevation and depression by the same methods as for all rightangled triangles.
proportional diagrams
317
Chapter review
m U lT ip l e
C h oiCe
6 cm
4 cm
2 cm
4 cm
a
C
III
I and II
II and III
B I and III
d I, II and III
Statement 1. cos =
Statement 2. tan =
9
41
9
40
B Statement II
d Neither statement
41 m
9m
40 m
B 2 only
d neither statement
Sh orT
anS Wer
a cos 30 = tan 60
B cos 30 = sin 60
C cos 30 = sin 30
d cos 60 = sin 60
M
2 cm
18 cm
9 cm
Q
P
2 ABCD and WXYZ are rectangles.
a Prove that the two rectangles are similar.
b State the ratio of sides in the two similar figures.
W
A
2 cm
D
N
4 cm
6 cm
B
C
15 cm
Z 5 cm Y
3 The two triangles at right are similar.
15 cm
9 cm
12 cm
4 When a 1-metre ruler casts a shadow 75 cm long, a building casts a 15 m shadow. Calculate the height
of the building.
5 A 10 m ladder will reach 9 m up a wall. How high up a wall will a 25 m ladder reach, if it is placed at
c sin = 0.8.
c sin = 0.257.
8 Find the length of each side marked with a pronumeral, correct to 1 decimal place.
c
a
b
6.8 m
6 cm
81
3.9 m
65
78
e
z 30'
138 mm
38.5 m
8'
2.9 m
42'
g
63 km
12'
m
9 A rope that is used to support a flagpole makes an angle of 70 with the ground. If the rope is tied down
3.1 m from the foot of the flagpole, find the height of the flagpole, correct to 1 decimal place.
10 A dirt track runs off a road at an angle of 34 to the road. If I travel for 4.5 km along the dirt track, what
2.3 m
43 cm
16 m
4.6 m
116 cm
19 m
12 A kite on an 80 m string reaches a height of 50 m in a strong wind. Calculate the angle the string makes
is 27m back from the base. Calculate the height of the building, correct to the
nearest metre.
h
40
27 m
80 m
1.57 m
50 m
319
e x T ended
r e SponS e
digiTal doC
Test Yourself
doc-10334
Chapter 9
320
4.2 km
B
3.1 km
15
2000 m
ICT activities
9a
inTeraCTiviTy
int-2403: Similarity (page 285)
9C
digiTal doCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1626): Tangent (page 297)
Spreadsheet (doc-1627): Sine (page 299)
Spreadsheet (doc-1628): Cosine (page 300)
WorkSHEET 9.1 (doc-10332): Apply your knowledge to questions.
(page 302)
9d
9F
digiTal doC
WorkSHEET 9.2 (doc-10333): Apply your knowledge of trigonometry
to problems. (page 316)
Chapter review
Test Yourself Chapter 9 (doc-10334): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 320)
inTeraCTiviTy
int-2405: SOHCAHTOA (page 304)
321
Answers CHAPTER 9
Similar FigUreS and
TrigonomeTry
exercise 9a
factors
1 Corresponding angles equal
2 Corresponding angles equal
3 Corresponding sides in equal ratio
4 Corresponding sides in equal ratio
5 Corresponding angles equal
6 Corresponding angles equal
7 They are similar.
8 They are not similar.
1
9 a 2:3
b 12
10 a 2 : 5
b 22
11 2 : 3
12 200
14 a 1 : 1000
c 4 : 2500 = 1 : 625
e 2:1
15 a RL = 1000 SL
16
17
18
19
2500 SL
4
SL
RL =
2
100 cm
1 : 40
1 : 600
True
False
True
13 2 000 000
b
d
f
b
c RL =
a
a
a
a
c
e
b
b
b
b
d
1 : 800
2:5
3:8
RL = 800 SL
5 SL
RL =
2
8 SL
RL =
3
18.75 cm
174 cm and 22 cm
2 mm
False
True
2 a
h
1m
9.5 m
25 cm
b 38 m
3 a
h
170 cm
3m
50 cm
c 10.2 m
b 1:6
4 10 m
5 B
6 60 km
7 a 20 km
b 36 km
c 26 km
d 51.2 km
e 3.6 km
f 1.6 km
8 a 4 cm
b 9 cm
c 4.4 cm
d 68 cm
e 1.6 cm
f 7.5 cm
9 D
10 B
11 20 m
12 4 cm
13 a 20 m 25 m
b 10 m 15 m
14 a 18 m 12 m
b 6.75 m 4.5 m
322
15 a 8.5 m
b 3.5 m
c 40
16 a The truck will not pass under the bridge
b 4.5 m
c 18 metres
2.55 m
a 6:1
b 17 cm
2.9 metres
a 96 cm2
b 20 cm 30 cm
c 600 cm2
d 4 : 25
e It is the square of the scale factor.
21 a 630 m2
b 30 m, 21 m
c Approx. 1 : 1500
d Rectangle is 6 cm by 4.2 cm.
e 632 m2
f i 1063 m2, $151/m2
ii 850 m2 is larger
g i Lot 110
ii Does it front a main road? Is it low
lying? Slope of land, views, aspect.
22 a 1 : 50
b 80 cm 70 cm
c 210 cm
d 22 800 c m2
17
18
19
20
exercise 9C
exercise 9d
1 a
hyp
opp
adj
adj
hyp
opp
adj
opp
hyp
2 148.1 mm
3 5.08 m
4 30.0 cm
b
b
e
h
55.2 m
2.06 km
5.40 m
42.3 km
8 A
10 C
12 4.2 m
c
c
f
i
9.43 km
18.4 mm
5.39 km
13.0 cm
b 6.0 cm
24
13.5 cm
b 0.8083 m
15 a
1.4 m
60
c 1.617 m
16 9.067 m
17 a
b 58 m
15
60 m
Calculating trigonometric
ratios
1 a 1.540
b 17.663
c 40.460
d 0.657
2 a 0.602
b 2.092
c 15.246
d 51.893
3 a 0.707
b 0.247
c 6.568
d 5.896
4 a 0.5
b 0.9659
c 1
d 548.6
e 64
f 1.301
g 5.306
h 1.374
i 15.77
5 a 0.42
b 1.56
c 0.09
d 5.10
e 2.87
f 0.38
g 7.77
h 73.30
i 0.87
6 10
7 a 44
b 80
c 57
8 8640
9 a 4257
b 3121
c 165
10 a 0.6428
b 0.9397
c 0.2250
d 0.9945
11 a 60
b 15
c 62
d 45
12 a 0.3907
b 0.9205
c 0.4245
d 0.4245
13 a 0.9205
b 0.3907
c 1
14 1
15 a For any right-angled triangle, the
opposite side must be smaller in length
than the hypotenuse, Therefore, the
value of sin cannot be greater than 1.
b Tan
5 a 12.1 cm
6 a 5.42 m
d 3.20 cm
g 0.205 m
7 D
9 A
11 6 m
13 20 km
14 a
c 15.5 m
18
19
20
21
22
23
5.3 m
= 30, x = 16.0 m, y = 13.0 m
a 24.3 cm
b 74.2 m
c 4.6 cm
62 m
a 46.7 m
b 18.3 m
Peter is correct. If finding the hypotenuse
of the triangle, the unknown side will be
in the denominator of the formula.
exercise 9e
a 30
a 33
a 53
a 50
d 21
5 a 40
d 79
6 A
8 C
10 76
12 13
14 B
16 59
18 44
19 a 1.23 m
1
2
3
4
exercise 9F
Finding angles
b 75
b 45
b 56
b 32
e 81
b 81
e 63
7 B
9 37
11 9
13 5
15 D
17 42
c
c
c
c
f
c
f
81
35
45
33
34
14
19
b 12
applications of right-angled
triangles
1 26.8 m
2 3984 m
3 190 m
4 39.2 m
5 42.1 m
6 100 m
7 15 km
8 Yes, the ladder needs to be only 28 m long.
9 39
10 21
11 9.41 m
12 66.35 m
13 20
14 Wayne is correct. The same sized rightangled triangle will be drawn between the
two points.
ChapTer revieW
mUlTiple ChoiCe
1C
3B
2 D
4 B
ShorT anSWer
20 cm
20 m
22.5 m
a 54
a 7831
a 37.9 cm
d 1.4 m
g 5.5 km
9 8.5 m
3
4
5
6
7
8
b 2:5
b
b
b
e
51
2634
3.8 m
16.8 mm
c
c
c
f
53
1454
14.6 m
10.6 m
10
11
12
13
14
2.5 km
a 57
39
23 m
57.5
b 27
c 68
exTended reSponSe
1 a 5.22 km
2 a 7500 m
b 54
b 736
323
ChapTer 10
Probability
ChapTer ConTenTs
10a
10b
10C
10d
10e
10F
10g
10h
10i
Multi-stage events
The fundamental counting principle
Probability statements
Relative frequency
Equally likely outcomes
The probability formula
Writing probabilities as decimals and percentages
Range of probabilities
Complementary events
10a
multi-stage events
1st coin
2nd coin
A multi-stage event is where there is more than one part to the probability
Heads
experiment. Tree diagrams are used to find the elements in the sample space
Heads
Tails
in a multi-stage probability experiment. Consider the case of tossing two
Heads
coins. How many elements are there in the sample space? We draw a tree
Tails
Tails
diagram to develop a system that will list the sample space for us.
The tree diagram branches out once for every stage of the probability experiment. At the end of each
branch, one element of the sample space is found by following the branches that lead to that point.
Therefore, when two coins are tossed, the sample space can be written:
S = {Heads-Heads, Heads-Tails, Tails-Heads, Tails-Tails}
There are four elements in the sample space; Heads-Tails and Tails-Heads are distinct elements of the
sample space.
Worked example 1
A coin is tossed and a die is rolled. List all elements of the sample space.
Think
1
WriTe
Coin toss
Head
Tail
Die roll
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
S = {H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, T1, T2, T3, T4, T5, T6}
ChapTer 10 Probability
325
In many cases, the second branch of the tree diagram will be different from the first branch. This
occurs in situations such as those outlined in the following worked examples, where the first event has
an influence on the second event. The card chosen first can then not be chosen in the second event.
Worked example 2
The numbers 2, 4, 7 and 8 are written on cards and are chosen to form a two-digit number. List
the sample space.
Think
WriTe
S = {24, 27, 28, 42, 47, 48, 72, 74, 78, 82, 84, 87}
Each question must be read carefully, to see if repetition is possible or not. In the above example, the
numbers cannot be repeated because we are drawing two cards without replacing the first card. In
examples such as tossing two coins, it is possible for the same outcome on both coins.
When drawing a tree diagram, the tree needs to branch once for every stage of the experiment. When
we roll two dice, there are two levels to the tree diagram. If we were to toss three coins, there would be
three levels to the diagram, as shown below.
1st coin
2nd coin
Heads
Heads
Tails
Heads
Tails
Tails
3rd coin
Heads
Tails
Heads
Tails
Heads
Tails
Heads
Tails
Worked example 3
Think
WriTe
exercise 10a
4th child
Boy
Girl
Boy
Girl
Boy
Girl
Boy
Girl
Boy
Girl
Boy
Girl
Boy
Girl
Boy
Girl
multi-stage events
1 We1 Two coins are tossed. Use a tree diagram to list the sample space.
2 On three red cards, the numbers 1, 2 and 3 are written. On three blue cards, the same numbers are
written. A red card and a blue card are then chosen to form a two-digit number. Draw a tree diagram to
list the sample space.
3 A family consists of 3 children. Use a tree diagram to list all possible combinations of boys and girls.
4 A coin is tossed and then a die is rolled.
a How many elements are in the sample space?
b Does it make any difference to the sample space if the die is rolled first and then the coin is tossed?
5 The five vowels are written on cards and two are selected.
a In how many ways can the cards be selected if the same vowel can be used twice?
b In how many ways can the cards be selected if the same vowel cannot be used twice?
6 In a game of soccer a win, draw and loss are all equally likely. In three matches of soccer how many
a chairman and a secretary. The same person cannot hold both positions. Use a tree diagram to list the
sample space for the different ways the two positions can be filled.
9 A tennis team consists of six players, three males and three females. The three males are Andre, Pat and
Yevgeny. The three females are Monica, Steffi and Lindsay. A male and a female must be chosen for a
mixed doubles match. Use a tree diagram to list the sample space.
10 Chris, Aminta, Rohin, Levi and Kiri are on a Landcare group. Two of them are to represent the group
on a field trip. Use a tree diagram to list all the different pairs that could be chosen. (Hint: In this
example, a pairing of Chris and Aminta is the same as a pairing of Aminta and Chris.)
ChapTer 10 Probability
327
b 6
C 8
d 9
13 mC A two-digit number is formed using the digits 4, 6 and 9. If the same number can be repeated,
C 8
d 9
14 mC A two-digit number is formed using the digits 4, 6 and 9. If the same number cannot be used
d 9
sample space?
b If three cards are chosen and used to form a three-digit number, how many elements are in the
sample space?
c How many four-digit numbers can be formed using these digits?
candidates are Tracey, Jenny and Svetlana and the male candidates are Richard and Mushtaq.
a Draw a tree diagram to find all possible combinations of captain and vice-captain.
b How many elements are in the sample space?
c If boys are filling both positions, how many elements are there?
d If girls are filling both positions, how many elements are there?
e If students of the opposite sex fill the positions, how many elements are there?
18 When two coins are tossed there are three elements in the sample space, 2 Heads, 2Tails
or 1 Head and 1 Tail. Is this statement correct? Explain why or why not.
19 Two dice are rolled.
a Use a tree diagram to calculate the number of elements in the sample space.
b Steve is interested in the number of elements for each total. Copy and complete the table below.
Total
10
11
12
No. of elements
c How many elements of the sample space have a double number?
20 Vanessa is doing a multiple choice exam. Each question has four options A, B, C and D. Vanessa knows
be selected?
b If three cards are chosen at random and repetition is not allowed, how many fewer ways can they
be selected?
23 Explain why a tree diagram is a useful way of displaying the results to a multi-stage experiment.
328
1 Toss two coins 100 times. Copy and complete the table below.
Result
No. of times
digiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1644
Coin toss lister
2 Heads
1 Head, 1 Tail
2 Tails
Does this match your expected outcome?
2 Roll two dice 100 times and record the total of the two dice in a copy of the table below.
Total
10
11
12
No. of times
Percentage
digiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1646
die rolling
Compare your results with your answer to question 19 in the previous exercise.
10b
Main course
Dessert
Beef broth
Calamari
Spaghetti
Roast chicken
Pasta salad
Grilled fish
Ice-cream
Banana split
Strawberries
In how many different ways can the three courses for the
meal be chosen?
There are two possible choices of entree, four choices
for main course and three dessert choices. To find the
sample space for all possible outcomes, we draw a tree
diagram.
By following the path to the end of each branch we
can see that there are 24 elements in the sample space.
If we simply need to know the number of elements in
the sample space, we multiply the number of possible
choices at each level.
Number of elements = 2 4 3
= 24
There are 24 ways in which the three-course meal can be
chosen.
This multiplication principle is called the fundamental
counting principle.
The total number of ways that a
succession of choices can be made is
found by multiplying the number of
ways each single choice could be made.
Entree
Main course
Spaghetti
Beef broth
Calamari
Dessert
Ice-cream
Banana split
Strawberries
Roast
chicken
Ice-cream
Banana split
Strawberries
Pasta salad
Ice-cream
Banana split
Strawberries
Grilled fish
Ice-cream
Banana split
Strawberries
Spaghetti
Ice-cream
Banana split
Strawberries
Roast
chicken
Ice-cream
Banana split
Strawberries
Pasta salad
Ice-cream
Banana split
Strawberries
Grilled fish
Ice-cream
Banana split
Strawberries
ChapTer 10 Probability
329
The fundamental counting principle is used when each choice is made independently of every other
choice. That is, when one selection is made it has no bearing on the next selection. In the case above, the
entree that is chosen has no bearing on what main course or dessert is chosen.
Worked example 4
A poker machine has three wheels. There are 20 symbols on each wheel. In how many different
ways can the wheels of the poker machine finish, once they have been spun?
Think
WriTe
Total outcomes = 20 20 20
= 8000
Worked example 5
In Year 11 at Blackhurst High School, there are four classes with 20, 22, 18 and 25 students in
them respectively. A committee of four people is to be chosen, one from each class to represent
Year 11 on the SRC. In how many ways can this group of four people be chosen?
330
Think
WriTe
Sometimes we need to reconsider examples that have some type of restriction placed on the possible
selections.
Worked example 6
Think
WriTe
exercise 10b
wheel. If the wheels are spun, in how many ways can they finish?
2 Consider each of the following events.
a A 10c coin and a 20c coin are tossed. In how many ways can
they land?
b A red die and blue die are cast. How many ways can the two
dice land?
c A coin is tossed and a die is rolled. How many possible
331
5 Some number plates have two letters followed by 4 numbers. How many of this style of plate are
possible?
6 mC Personalised number plates have six symbols that can be any combination of letters or digits.
7 mC A restaurant menu offers a choice of four entrees, six main courses and three desserts. If
one extra choice is offered in each of the three courses, how many more combinations of meal are
possible?
a 3
b 68
C 72
d 140
8 We5 There are 86 students in Year 11 at Narratime High School. Of these, 47 are boys and 39 are
girls. One boy and one girl are to be chosen as school captains. In how many different ways can the boy
and girl school captain be chosen?
9 A travel agency offers Queensland holiday packages flying with QANTAS and Virgin Blue, travelling
in first, business and economy class to Brisbane, the Gold Coast, The Great Barrier Reef and Cairns for
periods of 7, 10 and 14 days. How many holiday packages does the traveller have to choose from?
10 A punter at the racetrack tries to pick the daily double. This requires her to pick the winner of race 6
and race 7. How many selections of two horses can she make if there are:
a eight horses in each race?
b 12 horses in each race?
c 14 horses in race 6 and 12 in race 7?
d 16 horses in race 6 and seven in race 7?
e 24 horses in race 6 and 16 horses in race 7?
11 A poker machine has five wheels and 20 symbols on each wheel.
a In how many ways can the wheels of the poker machine finish when spun?
b There are 4 aces on the first wheel, 5 on the second wheel, 2 on the third wheel, 6 on the fourth
wheel and 1 on the fifth. In how many ways can five aces be spun on this machine?
12 A punter takes a Big 6 which requires her to select the winner of six races. How many ways can the
Big 6 be selected if there are 15, 12, 7, 8, 18 and 14 runners in the six races?
13 Rhonda takes a mystery holiday. She can go to one of five destinations, fly on one of three airlines and
stay at one of six different hotel chains. How many different mystery holidays are possible?
14 A theme park advertises that every time you ride the Hurricane, the ride will be different. When
the ride begins it can go through two different tunnels after which, they merge before it can
go through one of three different tunnels before merging again, and then go though one of two
different tunnels.
a How many different rides are possible?
b Is the claim made by the theme park operators correct?
15 Radio stations on the AM band have a call sign of a digit from 2 to 9, followed by two letters.
a How many radio stations could there be under this system?
b In NSW all stations begin with a 2. How many stations are possible in NSW?
16 At a shoe store a certain pair of shoes can be bought in black, brown or grey; lace up or buckle up; and
in six different sizes. How many different pairs of shoes are possible?
17 Home telephone numbers in Australia have eight digits.
a How many possible home telephone numbers are there?
b If a telephone number cant begin with either a 0 or 1, how many are possible?
c Freecall 1800 numbers begin with 1800 and then six more digits. How many of these are
possible?
d A certain mobile network has numbers beginning with 015 or 018 followed by six digits. How
does not begin with nine, is an odd number and that all digits are greater than five. How many possible
PIN numbers could he try?
19 mC Postcodes in Australia begin with either 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 or 8 followed by three more digits. How
C 7000
d 10 000
Further development
20 Nadia goes to a restaurant that has a choice of 8 entrees, 15 main courses and 10desserts.
a How many combinations of entree, main course and dessert are possible?
b Nadia is allergic to garlic. When she examines the menu she finds that three entrees and four main
21
22
23
24
25
courses are seasoned with garlic. How many possible choices can she make without choosing a
garlic dish?
Bill is trying to remember Toms telephone number. It has eight digits and Bill can remember that it starts
with 963 and finishes with either a 4 or a 6. How many possible telephone numbers are there for Tom?
A representative from each of six classes must be chosen to go on a committee. There are four classes
of 28 students, a class of 25 students and a class of 20 students. How many committees are possible?
A poker machine with 5 reels has 10 electronic symbols on each reel.
a How many combinations are possible on the poker machine?
b New software increases the number of symbols on each reel by 20%. How many symbols will
now be on each reel?
c Connie claims that the number of combinations on the poker machine will increase by 20%. Is
Connie correct? Use calculations to justify your answer.
A poker machine with 5 reels has 20 symbols on each reel. The machine has the number of symbols on
each reel reduced by 25%. By what percentage is the total number of combinations reduced?
What is the fundamental counting principle?
10C
probability statements
You have booked a ski holiday to Thredbo for the middle of July. What is the chance that there will be
enough snow on the ground for you to ski? There is no exact answer to this question, but by looking at
the amount of snow in Thredbo during July over past years, we know that there is a very good chance
that there will be enough snow to ski again this year.
We can say that it is very likely that we will be able to ski during July at Thredbo. Terms such as very
likely, almost certain, unlikely and fifty-fifty are used in everyday language to describe the chance
of an event occurring. For the purposes of probability, an event is the outcome of an experiment that
we are interested in. We can describe an outcome as a possible result to the probability experiment.
Imagine that you are playing a board game and it is your turn to roll the die. To win the game you
need to roll a number less than 7. If you roll one die, you must get a number less than 7. We would
describe the chance of this event occurring as certain.
When an event is certain to occur, the probability of that event occurring is 1.
certain
1
almost certain
Now lets consider an impossible situation.
In a board game you have one last throw of the die. To win you must roll
probable
a 7. We know that this cannot be done. We would say that this is impossible.
When an event is impossible, the probability of the event is 0.
1
fifty-fifty
2
The chance of any event occurring will often be somewhere between beingcertain
and impossible, and we use a variety of terms to describe where the chance lies in
unlikely
this range as shown in the figure at right.
We use these terms based on our general knowledge of the world, the totalpossible very unlikely
outcomes and how often an event occurs.
impossible
0
Worked example 7
WriTe
333
the lottery.
d There are more spot cards than picture cards
in a deck.
You will need to use these terms to describe events that are more likely to occur than others.
Worked example 8
Mrs Graham is expecting her baby to be born between July 20 and 26. Is it more likely that her
baby will be born on a weekday or a weekend?
Think
WriTe
In the above examples, we have been able to calculate which event is more likely by counting the
number of ways an event may occur. This is not always possible. In some cases we need to use general
knowledge to describe the chance of an event occurring.
Consider the following probability problems.
The letters of the alphabet are written on cards and one card is selected at random. Which letter has
the greatest chance of being chosen, E or Q?
Each letter has an equal chance of being chosen because there is one chance that E will be chosen and
one chance that Q will be chosen.
Stacey sticks a pin into a page of a book and she writes down the letter nearest to the pin. Which
letter has the greater chance of being chosen, E or Q?
This question is more difficult to answer because each letter does not occur with equal frequency.
However, we know from our experience with the English language that Q will occur much less often
than most other letters. We can therefore say that E will occur more often than Q.
This is an example of using your knowledge of the world to make predictions about which event is
more likely to occur. In this way, we make predictions about everyday things such as the weather and
which football team will win on the weekend.
Worked example 9
During the 2006 NRL season, the Brisbane Broncos won 9 of their first 12 games. In Round 13 they
played South Sydney who had won 0 of their first 12 games. Who would be more likely to win?
Think
WriTe
This is one example of past results being used to predict future happenings. There are many other such
examples.
Worked example 10
Weather records show that it has rained on Christmas Day 12 times in the last 80 years. Describe
the chance of it raining on Christmas Day this year.
Think
334
WriTe
We need to look at many probability statements and think critically about what is being said. Is the
source of the statement bias? Has emotive language been used to try to influence opinion? These things
and others mean that probability statements need to be looked at critically.
The project link will look at examples of critical analysis of probability statements.
exercise 10C
invesTigaTion
doc-10348
Chance in the media
probability statements
1 We7 Describe the chance of each of the following events occurring, using an appropriate probability
term.
a Selecting a ball with a double-digit number from a bag with balls numbered 1 to 40
b Selecting a female student from a class with 23 boys and 7 girls
c Selecting a green marble from a barrel with 40 blue marbles and 30 red marbles
d Choosing an odd number from the numbers 1 to 100
2 For each of the events below, describe the chance of it occurring as impossible, unlikely, even chance
holidays?
5 For each event on the left, state whether it is more likely, less likely or equally likely to occur than the
6 We9 Before meeting in the cricket World Cup in 2007, Australia had beaten Bangladesh in 10 of the
Games?
Carl Bailey best time 9.92 s and won his semi-final
Ben Christie best time 10.06 s and 3rd in his semi-final
Give an explanation for your answer.
8 mC A stack of 26 cards has the letters of the alphabet written on them. Vesna draws a card
from that stack. The probability of selecting a card that has a vowel written on it could best be
described as:
a unlikely
b even chance
C probable
d almost certain
9 mC Which of the following events is the most likely to occur?
a
b
C
d
Selecting the first number drawn from a barrel containing 20 numbered marbles
Selecting a diamond from a standard deck of cards
Winning the lottery with one ticket out of 150 000
Drawing the inside lane in the Olympic 100-metre final with eight runners
ChapTer 10 Probability
335
10 mC The ski season opens on the first weekend of June. At a particular ski resort there has been
sufficient snow for skiing on that weekend on 32 of the last 40 years. Which of the following
statements is true?
a It is unlikely to snow at the opening of the ski season this year.
b There is a fifty-fifty chance that it will snow at the opening of the ski season this year.
C It is probable that it will snow at the opening of the ski season this year.
d It is certain to snow at the opening of the ski season this year.
11 We10 On a production line, light globes are tested to see how long they will last. After testing
1000light globes, it is found that 960 will burn for more than 1500 hours. Wendy purchases a light
globe. Describe the chance of the light globe burning for more than 1500 hours.
12 Of 12 000 new cars sold last year, 1500 had a major mechanical problem during the first year. Edwin
purchased a new car. Describe the chance of Edwin having a major mechanical problem in the first year.
13 During an election campaign, 2000 people were asked for their voting preferences. One thousand said
that they would vote for the government. If one person is chosen at random, describe the chance that
they would vote for the government.
numerical value.
16 Explain why the probability of rain tomorrow cannot be exactly defined.
17 Explain why the probability of winning the lottery can be exactly defined.
18 List as many chance words as you can think of.
19 Explain why probabilities range between 0 and 1.
invesTigaTe: Common descriptions of chance
digiTal doC
WorkSHEET 10.1
doc-10335
The English language has many colourful expressions to describe the chance of an event occurring.
Consider the following expressions and research them to answer the questions.
1 That will happen once in a blue moon.
a What is a blue moon?
b How often does a blue moon occur?
2 There is Buckleys chance of that happening.
a Who was Buckley?
b How did this saying originate?
Are there any similar expressions that you can think of? What are their origins?
10d
relative frequency
You are planning to go skiing on the first weekend in July. The trip is costing you a lot of money and you
dont want your money wasted on a weekend without snow. So what is the chance of it snowing on that
weekend? We can use past records to estimate that chance.
If we know that it has snowed on the first weekend of July for 54 of the last 60 years, we could
say that the chance of snow this year is very high. To measure that chance, we calculate the relative
frequency of snow on that weekend. We do this by dividing the number of times it has snowed by the
number of years we have examined. In this case, we can say the relative frequency of snow on the first
weekend in July is 54 60 = 0.9.
The relative frequency is usually expressed as a decimal and is calculated using the formula:
number of times an event has occurred
number of trials
In this formula, a trial is the number of times the probability experiment has been conducted.
Relative frequency =
336
Worked example 11
The weather has been fine on Christmas Day in Sydney for 32 of the past 40 years. Calculate the
relative frequency of fine weather on Christmas Day.
Think
WriTe
Relative frequency =
Relative frequency = 32
40
= 0.8
The relative frequency is used to assess the quality of products. This is done by finding the relative
frequency of defective products.
Worked example 12
A tyre company tests its tyres and finds that 144 out of a batch of 150 tyres will withstand
20 000km of normal wear. Find the relative frequency of tyres that will last 20 000km. Give the
answer as a percentage.
Think
WriTe
Relative frequency =
= 0.96
= 96%
150
A batch of 200 light globes was tested. The batch is considered unsatisfactory if more than 15% of
globes burn for less than 1000 hours. The results of the test are in the table below.
No. of hours
No. of globes
500<750
12
750<1000
15
1000<1250
102
1250<1500
32
1500
35
337
Think
WriTe
= 0.155
= 15.5%
exercise 10d
Relative frequency =
Relative frequency =
31
200
More than 15% of the light globes burn for less than
1000 hours and so the batch is unsatisfactory.
relative frequency
1 We11 At the opening of the ski season, there has been sufficient snow for skiing for 37 out of the past
50 years. Calculate the relative frequency of sufficient snow at the beginning of the ski season.
2 A biased coin has been tossed 100 times with the result of 79 Heads. Calculate the relative frequency of
500mm of rain to fall over the spring months. Past weather records show that this has occurred on
27of the past 60 years. Find the relative frequency of:
a sufficient rainfall
b insufficient rainfall.
5 We12 Of 300 cars coming off an assembly line, 12 are found to have defective brakes. Calculate the
relative frequency of a car having defective brakes. Give the answer as a percentage.
6 A survey of 25 000 new car buyers found that 750 had a major mechanical problem in the first year of
globes, it is found that 960 will burn for more than 1500 hours. Wendy purchases a light globe. What is
the relative frequency that the light globe will:
a burn for more than 1500 hours?
b burn for less than 1500 hours?
8 mC Four surveys were conducted
9 mC A study of cricket players found that of 150 players, 36 batted left handed. What is the relative
C 0.64
d 0.76
10 During an election campaign, 2000 people were asked for their voting preferences. One thousand and
fifty said that they would vote for the government, 875 said they would vote for the opposition and the
remainder were undecided. What is the relative frequency of:
a government voters?
b opposition voters?
c undecided voters?
11 Research over the past 25 years shows that each November there is an average of two wet days on
Sunnybank Island. Travelaround Tours offer one-day tours to Sunnybank Island at a cost of $150 each,
with a money back guarantee against rain.
a What is the relative frequency of wet November days as a percentage?
b If Travelaround Tours take 1200 bookings for tours in November, how many refunds would they
expect to give?
12 An average of 200 robberies takes place each year in the town of Amiak. There are 10 000 homes in
this town.
a What is the relative frequency of robberies in Amiak?
b Each robbery results in an average insurance claim of $20 000. What would be the minimum
premium that the insurance company would need to charge to cover these claims?
13 We13 A car maker recorded the first time that its cars
No. of cars
5
3<6 months
12
6<12 months
37
1<2 years
49
2<3 years
62
3 years
35
The assembly line will need to be upgraded if the relative frequency of cars needing mechanical
repair in the first year is greater than 25%. Determine if this will be necessary.
14 For the table in question 13 determine, as a percentage, the relative frequency of:
a a car needing mechanical repair in the first 3 months
b a car needing mechanical repair in the first 2 years
c a car not needing mechanical repair in the first 3 years.
15 A manufacturer of shock absorbers measures the distance that its shock absorbers can travel before they
20 000<40 000
40 000<60 000
46
60 000<80 000
61
80 000<100 000
90
The relative frequency of the shock absorber lasting is 0.97 for a certain guaranteed distance. What
is the maximum distance the manufacturer will guarantee so that the relative frequency of the shock
absorbers lasting is greater than 0.97?
16 A soccer team plays 40 matches over a season and the results (wins, losses and draws) are shown below.
W
W
W
D
L
L
L
D
W
L
W
D
L
W
W
L
L
L
D
W
W
D
L
L
W
W
W
L
D
L
D
D
L
W
W
W
D
D
L
a Put this information into a table showing the number of wins, losses and draws.
b Calculate the relative frequency of each result over a season.
ChapTer 10 Probability
339
relative frequency of a six is 0.3. Find the overall relative frequency of a six.
20 During a one-year period, an insurance company finds that in a city of 125 000 homes, there has been
3 000 000 drivers. In one year there was approximately 5 000 traffic accidents, of which 800 involved
P plate drivers.
a What is the relative frequency of P plate drivers?
b What was the overall relative frequency of drivers being involved in an accident?
c What was the relative frequency of P plate drivers being involved in accidents?
d What was the relative frequency of an accident involving a P plate driver?
e Explain the difference between parts c and d.
22 Explain why:
a the sum of all relative frequencies will be 1
b the relative frequency of one event increases, if the relative frequency of another event decrease.
invesTigaTe: researching relative frequencies
Choose one of the topics below (or another of your choice) and
calculate the relative frequency of the event. Most of theinformation
needed can be found from books or the Internet.
1 Examine weather records and find out the relative frequencyof rain
on New Years Eve in Sydney.
2 Choose your favourite sporting team. Find the relative frequency of
them winning over the past three seasons.
3 Find the relative frequency of the stock market rising for three
consecutive days.
4 Check the NRL or AFL competitions and find the relative
frequencies of win, loss and draw for each team.
340
10e
Odds
Horse
Odds
Americain
4/1
Hawk Island
150/1
Jukebox Jury
14/1
Illo
20/1
Dunaden
15/2
30/1
Drunken Sailor
40/1
Modun
30/1
Glass Harmonium
30/1
At First Sight
9/1
Manighar
40/1
Moyenne Corniche
30/1
Unusual Suspect
30/1
Saptapadi
80/1
Fox Hunt
30/1
Shamrocker
40/1
Lucas Cranach
12/1
The Verminator
100/1
Mourayan
SCR
Tullamore
20/1
Precedence
50/1
Niwot
8/1
Red Cadeaux
30/1
inTeraCTiviTY
int0089
random number
generator
100/1
In a rugby league match between Brisbane and Parramatta there are three possible outcomes:
Brisbane win, Parramatta win and a draw. Is each outcome equally likely? Explain your answer.
Think
WriTe
In some cases we need to use tree diagrams to calculate if each outcome is equally likely. A statement
may seem logical, but unless further analysis is conducted, we can not be sure.
ChapTer 10 Probability
341
Worked example 15
When two coins are tossed there are three possible outcomes, 2 Heads, 2 Tails and one of each.
Is each outcome equally likely?
Think
1
WriTe
1st coin
Heads
Tails
exercise 10e
2nd coin
Heads
Tails
Heads
Tails
random. Each letter of the alphabet has an equal chance of being selected.
b A book is opened on any page and a pin is stuck in the page. The letter closest to the pin is then
noted. Each letter of the alphabet has an equal chance of being selected.
6 mC In which of the following is each member of the sample space equally likely to occur?
a
b
C
d
Kylies softball team is playing a match that they could win, lose or draw.
A bag contains 4 red counters and 2 blue counters. One counter is selected from the bag.
The maximum temperature on a January day will be between 20 C and 42 C.
A rose that may bloom to be red, yellow or white is planted in the garden.
7 We15 A couple have two children. They could have two boys, two girls or one of each. The
sample space therefore has three elements that are all equally likely. Is this statement correct?
Explain your answer.
342
8 In a game two dice are rolled and the total of the two dice is the players score.
a What is the sample space for the totals of two dice?
b Is each element of the sample space equally likely to occur?
9 A restaurant offers a three-course meal.
Entree
Main course
Dessert
Prawn cocktail
Oysters
Soup
Seafood platter
Chicken Supreme
Roast beef
Vegetarian quiche
Pavlova
Ice-cream
10 There are 10 horses in a race. Ken hopes to select the winner of the race.
a How many elements in the sample space?
b Is each element of the sample space equally likely to occur? Explain your answer.
c Loretta selects her horse by drawing the names out of a hat. In this case, is the sample space the
same? Is each element of the sample space equally likely to occur? Explain your answer.
equally likely.
16 When outcomes are not equally likely:
a explain what we use in order to determine the likelihood of the event occurring
b explain how we describe the likelihood of the event.
10F
In this chapter we discuss the chances of certain events occurring. In doing so, we used informal terms
such as probable and unlikely. While these terms give us an idea of whether something is likely to
occur or not, they do not tell us how likely they are. To do this, we need an accurate way of stating the
probability.
We stated earlier that the chance of any event occurring was somewhere between impossible and
certain. We also said that:
if an event is impossible the probability was 0
if an event is certain the probability was 1.
It therefore follows that the probability of any event must lie between 0 and 1 inclusive.
A probability is a number that describes the chance of an event occurring. All probabilities are
calculated as fractions but can also be written as decimals or percentages. Probability is calculated using
the formula:
P(event) =
The total number of favourable outcomes is the number of different ways the event can occur, while the
total number of outcomes is the number of elements in the sample space.
ChapTer 10 Probability
343
Worked example 16
Zoran is rolling a die. To win a game, he must roll a number greater than 2. List the sample space
and state the number of favourable outcomes.
Think
WriTe
S = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}
Consider the case of tossing a coin. If we are calculating the probability that it will land Heads, there is
1 favourable outcome out of a total of 2 possible outcomes. Hence we can then write P(Heads) = 1. This
2
method is used to calculate the probability of any single event.
Worked example 17
Andrea selects a card from a standard deck. Find the probability that she selects an ace.
Think
1
WriTe
P(ace) =
=
4
52
1
13
The probability formula is used to calculate the probability of multi-stage events once the number of
elements in the sample space has been calculated.
Worked example 18
A coin is tossed and a die is rolled. Calculate the probability of tossing a Tail and rolling a number
greater than 4.
Think
1
WriTe/draW
Coin
344
Simplify.
Die
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
Sample space
H, 1
H, 2
H, 3
H, 4
H, 5
H, 6
T, 1
T, 2
T, 3
T, 4
T, 5
T, 6
2
12
=1
6
Some questions do not require us to calculate the entire sample space, only the sample space for a small
part of the experiment.
Worked example 19
The digits 1, 3, 4, 5 are written on cards and these cards are then used to form a four-digit number.
Calculate the probability that the number formed is:
a even
b greater than 3000.
Think
WriTe
P(even) = 1
4
exercise 10F
345
6 A barrel contains marbles with the numbers 1 to 45 written on them. One marble is drawn at random
from the bag. Find the probability that the marble drawn is:
a 23
b 7
c an even number
d an odd number
e a multiple of 5
f a multiple of 3
g a number less than 20
h a number greater than 35
i a square number.
7 Many probability questions are asked about decks of cards. You should know the cards making up a
standard deck.
8 7 6 5 4 3 2
09
J1
Q
8 7 6 5 4 3 2
09
J1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2
09
J1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2
09
J1
A card is chosen from a standard deck. Find the probability that the card chosen is:
a the ace of diamonds
b a king
c a club
d red
e a picture card
f a court card.
8 We18 A two-digit number is formed using the digits 2, 4, 6 and 7. No digit may be repeated. Draw a
Belinda, Danika, Kate and Adrienne. Use a tree diagram to list all ways in which these three positions
can be filled.
10 The digits 4, 5, 7 and 8 are used to form a three-digit number. If no digit can be used more than once,
random but he does not like pears. Find the probability that Larry does not select a pear.
12 We19 The digits 2, 3, 5 and 9 are written on cards. They are then used to form a four-digit number.
b odd
d less than 3000
13 mC A die is cast. The probability that the number on the uppermost face is less than 4 is:
a
C
1
6
1
2
b
d
1
3
2
3
1
2
14 mC When a die is cast, which of the following outcomes does not have a probability equal to ?
a
b
C
d
15 mC A card is chosen from a standard deck. The probability that the card chosen is a court card is:
a
C
1
52
3
13
b
d
1
13
4
13
16 mC When a card is chosen from a standard deck, which of the following events is most likely to
occur?
a choosing a seven
C choosing a picture card
b choosing a club
d choosing a black card
17 A debating team consists of two men, Ashley and Benito, and three women, Carly, Donna and Ella.
From the team, a first, second and third speaker are to be chosen. Calculate the probability that:
a Ashley is one of the three speakers
b the team is made up of three women
c both men are chosen
d Carly is the first speaker.
346
formed:
a begins with the digit 3?
c is odd?
e is greater than 30 000?
b is even?
d is divisible by 5?
f is less than 20 000?
2
.
5
7
. Another
20
24 A card is drawn at random from a standard deck of cards. Find the probability that the card
selected is:
a a black ace
c not a heart
e a jack or a spade.
b a black card
d a jack or a queen
25 John has a 12 sided die and Lisa has a 20 sided die. They are playing a game where the first person to
roll a 10 wins.
a Find the probability of John rolling a 10.
b Find the probability of Lisa rolling a 10.
c Is the game fair? Explain your answer.
26 A number is chosen at random from the set {1, 2, 3, . . . . . . ., 25}. Find the probability that the number is:
a a multiple of 4
b a multiple of 6
c a multiple of 4 or 6.
27 Events are said to be mutually exclusive if the occurrence of one prevents the occurrence of the other.
State whether each of the following pairs of events are mutually exclusive.
a Obtaining a 4 or an even number.
b Obtaining an odd number or a 6.
c Obtaining a number less than 8 or greater than 5.
d Obtaining a factor of 6 or a multiple of 6.
ChapTer 10 Probability
347
digiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1655
Tossing a coin
digiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1656
rolling a die
In this activity, we compare the probability of certain events to practical results. You may be able to do a
simulation of these activities on a spreadsheet.
1 Tossing a coin
1
a If we toss a coin P(Heads) = . Therefore, if you toss a coin, how many Heads would you expect in:
2
i 4 tosses?
ii 10 tosses?
iii 50 tosses?
iv 100 tosses?
b Now toss a coin 100 times and record the number of Heads after:
i 4 tosses?
ii 10 tosses?
iii 50 tosses?
iv 100 tosses?
Combine your results with the rest of the class. How close to 50% is the total number of Heads thrown
by the class?
2 Rolling a die
When you roll a die, what is the probability of rolling a 1? The probability for each number on the die
is the same.
Roll a die 120 times and record each result in the table below.
Number
1
2
3
4
5
6
Occurrences
Percentage of throws
How close are the results to the results that were expected?
In our exercises so far, we have been writing probabilities as fractions. This is the way that most
mathematicians like to express chance. However, in day-to-day language, decimals and percentages are
also used. Therefore, we need to be able to write probabilities as both decimals and percentages.
When writing a probability as a decimal, we use the same formula and divide the numerator by the
denominator to convert to a decimal.
Worked example 20
If I select a card from a standard deck, what is the probability of selecting a heart, expressed as a
decimal?
Think
1
Convert to a decimal.
WriTe
P(heart) = 13
25
= 0.25
The chance of an event occurring is commonly expressed as a percentage. This is the percentage
chance of an event occurring. When writing a probability as a percentage, we take the fractional answer
and multiply by 100% to convert to a percentage.
348
Worked example 21
In a bag there are 20 counters: 7 are green, 4 are blue and the rest are yellow. If I select one at
random, find the probability (as a percentage) that the counter is yellow.
Think
WriTe
Convert to a percentage.
P(yellow counter) =
9
20
100%
= 45%
c Selecting any 2
8 mC A raffle has 400 tickets. Sonya has bought 8 tickets. The probability that Sonya wins first prize in
b 0.08
C 0.2
d 0.8
9 mC In a class of 25 students, there are 15 boys and 10 girls. If a student is chosen at random from the
C 40%
d 60%
10 mC Which of the following does not describe the chance of selecting a diamond from a standard deck
of cards?
a
13
52
b 0.13
C 0.25
d 25%
ChapTer 10 Probability
349
11 The diagram on the right shows a spinner that can be used in a board game.
When the player spins the spinner, what is the probability of getting the
5
1
following results (expressed as a decimal)?
a A5
4
2
b An even number
3
c An odd number
d A number greater than one
12 The board game in question11 has the following rules. A player spinnning a 2 or a 5 is out of the
game. A player spinning a 3 collects a treasure and automatically wins the game. Write down the
probability, as a percentage, that with the next spin a player:
a wins the game
b is out of the game
c neither wins nor is out of the game.
Further development
13 A survey of the vehicles in a car park is conducted. The results are shown in the table below.
Vehicle type
Number
Bus
30
Car
170
Motor bike
40
4 wheel drive
60
Find the probability (as a decimal) that a vehicle leaving the car park is:
a a car
b a bus
c not a 4 wheel drive.
350
14 The table below shows the origin of visitors to a tourist information centre in Sydney.
Origin
Victoria
Queensland
Other Australian states
Europe
Asia
Total
Male
7
5
3
16
10
41
Female
9
7
2
17
4
39
Total
12
12
5
33
14
80
b a factor of 20
Time (months)
10
11
12
Number
12
15
18
14
Find as a percentage, to the nearest whole number, that a battery will last for more than 10 months.
10h
range of probabilities
=1
When the probability of an event is 1, the event is certain to occur.
Now lets consider an impossible situation:
A die is cast. Calculate the probability that the uppermost face is a number greater than 7.
There are 6 elements in the sample space and there are 0 elements in the event space. Therefore:
P(no. greater than 7) = 0
6
=0
When the probability of an event is 0, the event is impossible.
ChapTer 10 Probability
351
certain
almost certain
probable
fifty-fifty
1
2
unlikely
very unlikely
impossible
Worked example 22
For the following probabilities, describe whether the event would be certain, probable, fifty-fifty,
unlikely or impossible.
4
18
a
b 0
c
9
36
Think
4
9
WriTe
than 12.
impossible.
c
18
36
probability = 1.
2
Worked example 23
In a batch of 400 televisions, 20 are defective. If one television is chosen, find the probability of it
not being defective and describe this chance in words.
Think
1
WriTe
= 19
20
4
There are many situations where this will occur. You need to be able to recognise when you can and
cannot measure the probability. You cannot measure probability when each outcome is not equally likely.
Worked example 24
State whether the following statements are true or false, and give a reason for your answer.
1
a The probability of correctly selecting a number drawn out of a barrel between 1 and 10 is .
10
1
b The weather tomorrow could be fine or rainy, therefore the probability of rain is .
2
352
Think
WriTe
selected.
b Each outcome is not equally likely.
3
2
6
4
6
2
4
5
5
3
4
1
2
1
2
5
5
4
1
4
2
3
2
3
2
5
4
WriTe
Score
1
2
3
4
5
6
Frequency
4
8
4
7
5
2
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1 2 3 4 5 6
Number rolled on die
P(six) =
exercise 10h
Tally
||||
|||| |||
||||
|||| ||
||||
||
2
30
1
15
range of probabilities
1 We22 For each of the probabilities given below, state whether the event would be impossible,
d 1
19
36
10
13
37
40
h 0
c
f
i
3
8
25
52
12
25
2 For each of the events below, calculate the probability and hence state whether the event is impossible,
353
c
d
e
f
g
h
c even chance
4 The probabilities of five events are given below. Write these in order from the most likely to the least
likely event.
7
13
8
19
9
18
13
20
6
25
5 By calculating the probability of each, write the following events in order from least to most likely.
1
2
19
36
22
45
20
32
7 mC Cards in a stack have the letters of the alphabet written on them (one letter per card). Vesna draws
a card from the stack. The probability of selecting a card that has a vowel written on it could best be
described as:
a impossible
b unlikely
C even chance
d probable
8 mC For which of the following events can the
12 We24 For each of the following determine whether the statement is true or false, giving a reason for
your answer.
a The probability of selecting an ace from a standard deck of cards is
4
.
52
1
.
26
1
.
30
1
is 30.
c In a class of 30 students, the probability that Sam tops the class in a Maths test is
d In a class of 30 students the probability that Sharons name is drawn from a hat
13 We25 The data below shows the amount of rain (in mm) that falls each of the 30 days during June.
2
0
0
a
b
c
d
0
0
15
15
0
19
18
9
21
11
39
6
21
32
13
0
21
21
5
16
0
19
4
0
11
0
6
Using classes 04, 59 etc., put the data into a frequency distribution table.
Show the results in a cumulative frequency histogram and ogive.
Use your graph to find the probability that there is less than 5 mm of rain on a certain day in June.
Use the ogive to complete the following statement.: There is a 50% chance that there will be
more than ____ mm of rain on a given day in June.
14 Forty sample pieces of rope are tested in an effort to determine their breaking strain. The results are
Ogive of rope strength
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
100%
50%
40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75
Breaking strain (kg)
Cumulative frequency
Find the probability that a piece of rope will withstand a stain of:
b 65 kg.
a 50 kg
15 A biologist who counts the number of seeds in each of 60 pumpkins presents his findings on the
60
Cumulative frequency
ogive below.
100%
50
40
30
50%
20
10
10 20 30 40 50 60 70
Number of seeds
a Find the probability that a pumpkin chosen at random will produce more than 50 seeds.
b Find the minimum number of seeds such that there is a 75% chance that a pumpkin chosen at
fiftyfifty chance that the second ball will be black. Is Paul correct? Explain your answer.
ChapTer 10 Probability
355
Mark
Number
025
11
2640
16
4150
17
5165
34
6675
57
7685
54
8695
21
96100
4
a Determine the probability that a student from the group passes the exam (i.e. gets a mark greater
than 50).
b Describe the chance that the person selected gets over 95.
21 Consider the probability scale on page 352. Give an example of an event that matches each point
1 Weather statistics
Use the internet to find the number of wet days in Sydney during each month of the last five years. Copy
and complete the table below for each month of the year.
Year
Relative frequency
Draw a radar chart to graph the month against the relative frequency of rain.
2 Sporting results
Choose a sporting competition such as the AFL or NRL. Use the current or most recent season to
calculate the relative frequency of each team winning. Choose an appropriate graph to display the
results.
(If you are using a spreadsheet, you can easily update your results each week.)
3 Topic of interest
Choose a topic of interest. Research your area thoroughly and display your findings in graph form.
Complementary events
10i
When tossing a coin, we know there are two elements in the sample space. P(Heads) = 12 and P(Tails) = 12.
The total of the probabilities is 1. Now consider a slightly more difficult problem.
Worked example 26
In a bag with 10 counters, there are 7 black, and 3 white counters. If one counter is selected at
random from the bag, calculate:
a the probability of selecting a white counter
b the probability of selecting a black counter
c the total of the probabilities.
Think
WriTe
3
10
7
P(black) = 10
3
7
Total = 10
+ 10
a P(white) =
c Add
3
10
and
7
10
together.
=1
356
For each of the following events, write down the complementary event.
a Tossing a coin and getting a Head
b Rolling a die and getting a number less than 5
c Selecting a heart from a standard deck of cards
Think
WriTe
Tails.
b The complementary event is that we get a number
greater than 4.
c The complementary event is that we do not get a
heart.
We can use our knowledge of complementary events to simplify the solution to many problems. The
probability of an event and its complement will always add to give 1. We can use the result:
P(an event does not occur) = 1 P(the event does occur)
Worked example 28
Jessie has a collection of 50 CDs. Of these, 20 are by a rap artist, 10 are by heavy metal performers
and 20 are dance music. If we select one CD at random, what is the probability that it is:
a a heavy metal CD?
b not a heavy metal CD?
Think
WriTe
=5
b This is the complement of selecting a heavy
exercise 10i
=15
1
=5
Complementary events
357
2 A barrel contains 20 marbles. We know that 7 of them are blue, 8 are red and the rest are yellow.
a One marble is selected from the barrel. Calculate the probability that it is:
i blue
ii red
iii yellow.
b Calculate the total of these probabilities.
3 We27 For each of the following, state the complementary event.
a Winning a race
b Passing a test
c Your birthday falling on a Monday
4 Match each event in the left-hand column with the complementary event in the right-hand column.
event.
a Choosing an odd-numbered ball
b Choosing a ball numbered less than 20
c Choosing a ball that has a number greater than 23
d Choosing a ball that is a multiple of 5
8 In a barrel there are 25 balls, 15 of which are coloured (10 pink and 5 orange). The rest are black. What
c a pink ball?
9 mC Wilson rolls two dice. He needs to get a 6 on at least one of the dice. What is the complementary
event?
a Rolling no sixes
b Rolling 2 sixes
event?
a
9
36
C Rolling 1 six
11
. What
36
11
36
25
36
d 1
11 We28 In a barrel with 40 marbles, 20 are yellow, 15 are green and 5 are orange. If one marble is
b not orange.
12 In a barrel there are 40 balls numbered 1 to 40. One ball is chosen at random from the barrel.
a Find the probability that the number is a multiple of 5.
b Use your knowledge of complementary events to find the probability that the number is not a
multiple of 5.
13 There are 40 CDs in a collection. They can be classified as follows.
18 heavy metal
6 rock
10 techno
6 classical
If one CD is chosen at random, calculate the probability that it is:
a heavy metal
b not heavy metal
c classical
d not classical
e heavy metal or rock
f techno or classical.
358
14 In a golf tournament there are 40 players. Of these, 16 are Australian and 12 are American. If they are
15
16
17
18
all of the same skill level, find the probability that the tournament is:
a won by an Australian
b won by an American
c not won by an Australian
d not won by an American
e not won by an Australian or an American.
After studying a set of traffic lights, Karen found that in every 100 seconds they were
red for 60 seconds, amber for 5 seconds and green for 35 seconds. If you were to
approach this set of lights calculate the probability that:
a they will be green
b you will need to stop.
In a game of Scrabble there are 100 lettered tiles.
These tiles include 9 As, 12 Es, 9Is, 8 Os and 4 Us. One tile is chosen.
Find the probability that it is:
a an E
b a vowel
c a consonant.
From past performances it is known that a golfer has a
probability of 0.7 of sinking a putt. What is the probability
that he misses the putt?
A basketballer is about to take a shot from the free-throw
line. His past record shows that he has a 91% success
rate from the free-throw line. What would be the relative
frequency (as a percentage) of his:
a being successful with the shot?
b missing the shot?
Further development
19 Explain whether or not each of the following pairs of events are complementary.
a Having WeetBix or Corn Flakes for breakfast.
b Walking or driving to school.
c Watching TV or surfing the Internet.
d Rolling a number less than 3 or rolling a number greater than 3 with a normal die.
e Passing or failing a test.
20 Two coins are tossed. Are the events of tossing two heads and tossing two tails complementary?
21
22
23
24
digiTal doC
WorkSHEET 10.2
doc-10336
ChapTer 10 Probability
359
Summary
multi-stage events
Tree diagrams are used to list the sample space when there is more than one stage to a probability
experiment.
The tree must branch out once for each stage of the probability experiment.
The fundamental
counting principle
This principle can be used to count the number of elements in a sample space of a multi-stage
experiment.
The total number of possible outcomes is calculated by multiplying the number of ways each stage
of the experiment can occur.
probability statements
The chance of an event occurring can be described as being from certain (a probability of 1) to
impossible (a probability of 0).
Terms used to describe the chance of an event occurring include improbable, unlikely, fifty-fifty,
likely and probable.
The chance of an event occurring can be described by counting the possible outcomes and
sometimes by relying on our general knowledge.
relative frequency
equally likely
outcomes
The probability
formula
range of probabilities
Probabilities range from 0 (impossible) to 1 (certain). The use of a fraction for a probability can
help us describe, in words, the chance of an event occurring.
Complementary
events
The complement of an event is the event that describes all other possible outcomes to the
probability experiment.
The probability of an event and its complement add to give 1.
The probability of an event can often be calculated by subtracting the probability of its
complementary event from 1.
360
Chapter review
1 An Olympic Games shooter hits a target with 46 out of 50 shots. The relative frequency of him hitting
25
m U lTip l e
C ho iC e
25
3 Jason and Kylie are playing a game of Monopoly. To move your piece, you roll two dice and move
the same number of places as the total of the two dice. Kylie needs a total of 7 to land on Mayfair.
The chance of Kylie rolling a 7 could best be described as:
a impossible
b unlikely
C fifty-fifty
d probable
4 To win a game, Rhonda must roll a number greater than 3 with a single die. Which of the following
statements is correct?
a The sample space has 3 elements and there are 3 favourable outcomes.
b The sample space has 3 elements and there are 6 favourable outcomes.
C The sample space has 6 elements and there are 3 favourable outcomes.
d The sample space has 6 elements and there are 6 favourable outcomes.
5 A three-digit number is to be formed using the digits 3, 6, 7 and 8. The same number cannot be used
1 Two coins are tossed. Draw a tree diagram to find the sample space.
2 Two dice are rolled. How many elements are in the sample space?
3 A two-digit number is formed using 5, 6, 7 and 9, without repetition.
a Use a tree diagram to list the sample space.
b If Dan wants to make a number greater than 60, how many favourable outcomes are there?
4 Mary, Neville, Paul, Rachel and Simon are candidates for an election. There are two positions,
6
7
8
9
10
361
11 The dial to a safe consists of 100 numbers. To open the safe, you must turn the dial to each of four
deck. The player with the higher card starts. Graham takes a five. Describe Marcias chance of taking
a higher card.
13 Describe each of the following events as being either certain, probable, even chance (fifty-fifty),
unlikely or impossible.
a Rolling a die and getting a number less than 6
b Choosing the eleven of diamonds from a standard deck of cards
c Tossing a coin and it landing Tails
d Rolling two dice and getting a total of 12
e Winning the lottery with one ticket
14 Give an example of an event which is:
a certain
b impossible.
15 The Chen family are going on holidays to Queensland during January. Are they more likely to
c an odd number
f a double-digit number.
17 A card is to be chosen from a standard deck. Find the probability that the card chosen is:
a the 2 of clubs
b any 2
c any club
d a black card
e a court card
f a spot card.
18 A video collection has 12 dramas, 14 comedies, 4 horror and 10 romance movies. If I choose a movie
at random from the collection, find the probability that the movie chosen is:
a a comedy
b a horror
c not romance.
19 A raffle has 2000 tickets sold and has two prizes. Michelle buys five tickets.
a Find the probability that Michelle wins 1st prize.
b If Michelle wins 1st prize, what is the probability that she also wins 2nd prize?
20 A barrel contains marbles with the numbers 1 to 40 on them. If one marble is chosen at random find, as
21 When 400 cars are checked for a defect, it is found that 350 have the defect. If one is chosen at random
from the batch, find the probability that it has the defect and hence describe the chance of the car
having the defect.
22 State the event that is complementary to each of the following.
a Tossing a coin that lands Tails
b Rolling a die and getting a number less than 5
c Choosing a blue ball from a bag containing 4 blue balls, 5 red balls and 7 yellow balls
23 A barrel contains 20 marbles of which 6 are black. One marble is selected at random. Find the
1 At a school athletics carnival, a relay team must be selected. Below is the list of students who qualified
and the house for which they compete. There must be one member of the relay team from each house.
RED
Richard
Stan
YELLOW
Andrew
Frank
Ned
Voula
BLUE
Boris
Harry
Danny
ex Ten d ed
r es p o n s e
GREEN
Milan
digiTal doC
Test Yourself
doc-10337
Chapter 10
ChapTer 10 Probability
363
ICT activities
10a
multi-stage events
digiTal doCs
Spreadsheet (doc-1644): Coin toss lister (page 329)
Spreadsheet (doc-1646): Die rolling (page 329)
10C
probability statements
digiTal doCs
Investigation (doc-10348): Chance in the media (page 335)
WorkSHEET 10.1 (doc-10335): Apply your knowledge of probability to
problems. (page 336)
10e
inTeraCTiviTY
int-0089: Random number generator (page 341)
10F
digiTal doCs
Spreadsheet (doc-1655): Tossing a coin (page 348)
Spreadsheet (doc-1656): Rolling a die (page 348)
364
10i
Complementary events
digiTal doC
WorkSHEET 10.2 (doc-10336): Apply your knowledge of probability to
problems. (page 359)
Chapter review
digiTal doC
Test Yourself Chapter 10 (doc-10337): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 363)
Answers CHAPTER 10
probabiliTY
exercise 10a
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
multi-stage events
S = {HH, HT, TH, TT}
S = {R1B1, R1B2, R1B3, R2B1, R2B2,
R2B3, R3B1, R3B2, R3B3}
S = {BBB, BBG, BGB, BGG, GBB, GBG,
GGB, GGG}
a 12
b No
a 25
b 20
27
S = {13, 14, 18, 31, 34, 38, 41, 43, 48, 81,
83, 84}
S = {DZ, DM, DK, DS, ZD, ZM, ZK, ZS,
MD, MZ, MK, MS, KD, KZ, KM, KS,
SD, SZ, SM, SK}
S = {AM, AS, AL, PM, PS, PL, YM,
YS, YL}
S = {CA, CR, CL, CK, AR, AL, AK, RL,
RK, LK}
a Check with your teacher.
b S = {HHHH, HHHT, HHTH, HHTT,
HTHH, HTHT, HTTH, HTTT,
THHH, THHT, THTH, THTT,
TTHH, TTHT, TTTH, TTTT}
c 6
C
D
B
a S = {22, 25, 27, 28, 52, 55, 57, 58, 72,
75, 77, 78, 82, 85, 87, 88}
b S = {25, 27, 28, 52, 57, 58, 72, 75, 78,
82, 85, 87}
a 12
b 24
c 24
a S = {TJ, TS, TR, TM, JT, JS, JR, JM,
ST, SJ, SR, SM, RT, RJ, RS, RM,
MT, MJ, MS, MR}
b 20
c 2
d 6
e 12
The statement is not correct because there
are four elements to the sample space. The
one Head and one Tail can occur in either
order.
a 36
b
Total
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
No. of elements 1 2 3 4 5 6 5 4 3 2 1
c 6
20 a 64
21 a
First die
b 24
Second die
6
6
not 6
6
not 6
not 6
22 a 4
b 40
23 A tree diagram is a way of systematically
probability statements
1 a Probable
b Unlikely
c Impossible
d Fifty-fifty
2 a Impossible
b Certain
c Even chance
d Even chance
e Probable
f Unlikely
g Impossible
h Even chance
3 Check with your teacher.
4 More likely during school term
5 a More likely
b Equally likely
c Less likely
d More likely
e Less likely
6 Australia
7 Carl Bailey because he has better past
performances.
A
B
C
Probable
Unlikely
Fifty-fifty
Answers will vary.
Common language is used to describe
how likely an event is to occur, and unless
mathematical calculations are to be made
the exact likelihood will not need to be
defined.
16 Each outcome for the weather is not
equally likely to occur.
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
exercise 10d
1
3
4
5
6
7
8
10
11
12
13
14
relative frequency
0.74
2 0.79
0.375
a 0.45
b 0.55
4%
a 0.03
b 0.97
a 0.96
b 0.04
A
9 A
a 0.525
b 0.4375
c 0.0375
a 6.67%
b 80
a 0.02
b $400
Yes, the relative frequency is 27%.
a 2.5%
b 51.5%
c 17.5%
40 000 km
15
16 a
Result
Number
Win
Loss
Draw
15
14
11
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
ChapTer 10 Probability
365
10 a 10
b No. Each horse has a different rider and
11
12
13
14
15
16
ability.
c Yes. Yes. The selection of horse is made
randomly.
a Tomorrows weather depends heavily on
the weather today.
b Scientific factors affect the likelihood of
rain.
a The selection of winner is not random.
b Ability is the main factor affecting the
outcome.
a There is one face with a 6 and five faces
that are not.
b The likelihood of each face is equally
likely.
The outcome of one boy and one girl can
occur in either order making it twice as
likely as the other two outcomes.
Answers will vary.
a Science and experience
b Informal chance words
Captain
Vice-captain
Belinda
Danika
Kate
Adrienne
10
1st
digit
1
2
5 a
d
6 a
d
g
7 a
d
8
1
6
1
2
1
45
23
45
19
45
1
52
1
2
b
e
b
e
h
b
e
1st
digit
2
366
1
6
2
3
1
45
1
5
2
9
1
13
3
13
c
f
c
f
i
c
f
1
2
1
3
22
45
1
3
2
15
1
4
3
13
26
27
42
46
47
62
64
67
72
74
76
Belinda, Adrienne
Belinda
Danika, Belinda
Kate
Danika, Kate
Adrienne
Danika, Adrienne
Belinda
Kate, Belinda
23 15
Danika
Kate, Danika
Adrienne
Kate, Adrienne
Belinda
Adrienne, Belinda
Danika
Adrienne, Danika
Kate
Adrienne, Kate
7
8
4
5
8
4
5
7
10
12 a
d
13
14
15
16
3
4
1
2
=
2
4
C
C
C
D
3
17 a 5
b 10
c 10
18 a
d 5
Destination
Season
Peak
Disneyland
(California)
Off-peak
Peak
Disneyworld
(Florida)
Off-peak
Peak
Euro Disney
(France)
Off-peak
1
6
4
5
1
5
24 a
1
26
1
2
2
13
4
13
25 a
1
12
1
20
6
25
3
4
8
25
1
4
27 a
b
c
d
1
4
1
4
26 a
3rd Sample
digit space
457
7
458
8
475
5
478
8
485
5
487
7
547
7
548
8
574
4
578
8
584
4
587
7
745
5
748
8
754
4
758
8
784
4
785
5
845
5
847
7
854
4
857
7
874
4
875
5
11 12 = 6
2nd Sample
digit space
24
4
6
Adrienne
1
5
4
5
Belinda, Kate
Belinda, Danika
1
5
1
5
Kate
exercise 10F
19 a
Danika
2nd
digit
Sample space
Class
Sample space
Econ
Bus
First
Econ
Bus
First
Econ
Bus
First
Econ
Bus
First
Econ
Bus
First
Econ
Bus
First
30
range of probabilities
Even chance
b Probable
Unlikely
d Certain
Probable
f Unlikely
Probable
h Impossible
Unlikely
0, impossible
1, certain
3
c , even chance
6
d
e
f
26
,
52
40
,
52
4
,
52
even chance
20
10
5
5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40
Rainfall (mm)
37%
d 10 mm
20%
b 85%
20%
b 48
Answers will vary.
No
No, since each outcome is not equally
likely.
probable
18
unlikely
even chance
3 Check with your teacher.
13 7 9 8 6
4 , , , ,
20 13 18 19 25
19
A, D, C, B, E
D
B
D
a 0.025
b Unlikely
98
10
, very probable
100
11 a Very unlikely
b Even chance
c Probable
d Unlikely
12 a True, as there are 4 aces from 52 cards
in the deck.
b False, as each letter does not occur
equally often.
c False, as each student is not of equal
ability.
d True, as the name is chosen randomly.
5
6
7
8
9
13 a
04
11
11
59
15
10 14
12
18
15 19
17
24
20 24
22
28
25 29
27
28
30 34
32
29
35 39
37
30
d
e
7 a
b
c
d
8 a
b
c
9 A
10 C
11 a
12 a
13 a
d
17 a 2
b No, he is not correct as the probability
49
6
,
12
Class
50%
15
c
14 a
15 a
16 a
b
c
g 0, impossible
h
100%
25
exercise 10h
1 a
c
e
g
i
2 a
b
Ogive of rainfall
iii 0.175
iii 20%
Cumulative frequency
14 a i 0.0875
ii 0.2125
b i 6.25%
ii 8.75%
15 a Arlo 0.125
20
21
exercise 10i
14 a
d
15 a
16 a
Complementary events
1
6
c 1
2 a i
b
3 a
b
c
4
7
20
ii
8
20
c
6 a
b
c
5
20
1
Losing a race
Failing a test
Your birthday not falling on a Monday
iii
1 1 10 1 99 4
, , , , ,
2 2 13 2 100 5
1
Rolling an odd number
Rolling a number less than 4
Rolling a number greater than 2
1
8
1
5
9
20
17
20
2
5
7
10
7
20
3
25
b
b
b
e
b
e
b
b
7
8
4
5
11
20
3
5
3
10
3
10
13
20
21
50
c
f
c
3
20
2
5
3
5
29
50
17 0.3
18 a 91%
b 9%
19 a Not complementary as this does not
1 a S = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6}
b
Not rolling a 6
Rolling a 1
Choosing an even-numbered ball
Choosing a ball numbered greater
than 19
Choosing a ball that has a number less
than 24
Choosing a ball that is not a multiple
of 5
Selecting a coloured ball
Selecting a black ball
Not selecting a pink ball
20
21
22
23
24
ChapTer revieW
mUlTiple ChoiCe
1 D
4 C
2 B
5 C
3 B
6 C
shorT ansWer
b 9
ChapTer 10 Probability
367
b 8
5 a S = {TCB, TCM, TCZ, TDB, TDM,
b 15
759 375
7 20
272
9 160
a 10 000
b 500
a 100 000 000
b 94 109 400
Marcia will probably get a higher card.
a Probable
b Impossible
c Even chance
d Unlikely
e Unlikely
14 Check with your teacher.
15 Hot weather
6
8
10
11
12
13
16 a
d
368
1
25
1
5
b
e
1
25
9
25
c
f
13
25
16
25
17 a
d
18 a
19 a
1
52
1
2
7
20
1
400
b
e
b
b
1
13
3
13
1
10
4
1999
c
f
c
1
4
10
13
3
4
20 a 0.025
b 0.5
c 0.75
7
8
defect.
22 a Tossing a coin that lands Heads
b Rolling a die and getting a number
greater than 4
3
10
7
10
5
12
18
25
exTended response
b
c
d
e
2 a
b
c
3 a
b
c
24
6
Certain
No. Each runner is of different ability.
S = {GD, GK, GC, DK, DC, KC}
E = {GC, DC, KC}
90
1
5
2
5
3
5
4 a 0.7
b 0.3
c The missile will probably hit its target.
ChapTer 11
Algebraic manipulation
ChapTer ConTenTS
11a
11B
11C
11d
11e
In algebra, each pronumeral used stands in place of a number. Consider the expression:
5+5+5+5+5+5+5=75
We can write this addition as a multiplication because the same number is being added. We can say that
like terms are used.
Similarly, we can simplify a similar expression using pronumerals:
a + a + a + a + a + a + a + a = 8a
Note that we do not use the multiplication sign in algebra. The multiplication sign is implied when it is
not used.
Now consider the expression
9+9+9+9+9+9+4+4+4+4+4
We can not write this as a single expression because the terms are not like. We can only simplify the like
terms.
9+9+9+9+9+9+4+4+4+4+4=69+54
Similarly:
x + x + x + x + x + y + y + y = 5x + 3y
Only like terms, that is, the same pronumerals, can be added together.
Worked example 1
b p + p + p + q + q + q + q + q + q.
Think
WriTe
a m + m + m + m + m + m + m = 7m
b 1 Write p + p + p as a multiplication.
Write q + q + q + q + q + q as a multiplication.
p + p + p + q + q + q + q + q + q = 3p + 6q
We are able to add or subtract any expressions that use the same pronumerals.
In each expression where more than one different pronumeral is used, we collect all the like terms (the
same pronumeral). The addition or subtraction sign in such expressions belongs with what follows it. For
example, in 4x 6y + 2x the minus sign belongs to the 6y and the plus sign to the 2x.
ChapTer 11 Algebraic manipulation
369
Worked example 2
Simplify:
a 5k + 9k k
b 5b + 2 + 2b 6
Think
c 4m 3n + 2m 5n.
WriTe
c 1
2
b 5b + 2 + 2b 6 = (5b + 2b) + (2 6)
= 7b 4
c 4m 3n + 2m 5n = (4m + 2m) + (3n 5n)
= 6m 8n
When we are multiplying and dividing algebraic expressions, the same rule about like terms applies;
however, care needs to be taken with the notation of multiplication and division. Earlier, we saw the
shorthand way of writing a repeated addition.
We said:
4+4+4+4+4+4+4+4=84
For multiplication, we use indices:
4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 = 48
In this expression, 4 is the base and 8 is the index.
The same method applies to pronumerals, provided they are like terms.
We can write:
p p p p p = p5
Worked example 3
b mmmm
Think
WriTe
a 3 is shown 6 times.
a 3 3 3 3 3 3 = 36
b m is shown 4 times.
b m m m m = m4
We can use index laws to simplify expressions already in index form. Consider:
a3 a4 = (a a a) (a a a a)
= a7
This leads us to the first index law.
Index Law 1:
ax ay = ax+y
When using the index laws, the indices of the same base are added in turn. If there are coefficients
(numbers in front of the pronumerals) in the expression, these are multiplied.
Worked example 4
b 4m3 6m2
Think
WriTe
a t5 t4 = t9
370
c 12a2b 4a5b3
The reverse to the index law for multiplication is the index law for division.
Index Law 2: a x a y = a xy or
ax
= a xy
ay
Division questions can be written as either a division or in fraction form. This may involve simplifying a
fraction as well as applying this law. We need to be able to divide terms which are linear, quadratic and
cubic in particular, as well as higher powers.
Worked example 5
b 24d4 6d
Think
WriTe
a w8 w3 = w5
b 24d 4 6d = 4d3
exercise 11a
c w+w+w+w+w+w
f n+n+n+n+n+n+n+n
c 9s
f 4r
5y + 7y
34j + 13j
14r 6r
4w + 6w
4j 2j j
b
e
h
k
n
15x + 4x
17k + 8k
9w 8w
2s 5s
2p 17p + 25p
c
f
i
l
o
15e + 24e
14k 10k
m 5m
14m + 5m + 3m
5z 15z + 9z
c
f
i
l
o
r
7k + 5k + 3k 2k
2t + 7t + 4t
5b 16 + 11b 10
6r 17 2r
9d 15 + 4d + 7
8z 4w 8z + 6w
b 777777
e ppppp
c 99
f www
b 45
e y2
c 87
f j9
c
f
i
l
o
r
y7 y8
s s2
7g4 5g6
4m 6m
9a3b7 7a2b2
9r3s2t 4 6rst 6
ChapTer 11 Algebraic manipulation
371
b b8 b4
18 g5
3g 3
c9
c7
g 56j7k 5 7j 4k 3
d e5 e
24h6 4h2
84 s 7
72r 6
k
7s 5
8r 3
9 Explain why 4xy and 5yx are like terms and 4x2 and 5x are not like terms.
i
42p9q4 6pq
64 m 7n3
16m 4 n 2
6t 8
18t 5
8 p6 3 p 4
16 p5
12bb5 4 b 2
18b 2
5a3 6a 4
2a 4 5a
12m 4
2m 2 3m 3
11 Simplify.
a
8 p3 7r 2 2s
6 p 14 r
27a9 18b3 4c 2
18aa 4 12b 2 2c
81 f 15 25g12 16h34
27 f 9 15g10 12h30
12 Gordon says that (5x4)2 = (5x2)4. Explain whether or not Gordon is correct.
11B
Many algebraic calculations may involve the use of fractions. The process of multiplying algebraic
fractions is relatively simple. The numerators are multiplied together and the denominators are
multiplied together.
Worked example 6
WriTe
6m2 8m = 48m3
1
5
5
8m 48m3
2
6m
=
5
5
When dividing fractions, remember the method is to multiply by the reciprocal of the second fraction.
Worked example 7
3
Simplify 2v 3v .
5
5
Think
372
WriTe
2v 3v3 = 2v 10
5
10
5
3v3
= 2 22
1 3v
= 42
3v
exercise 11B
5a
3
2b 3
5
c 4
2 9
3e
e 4
5d
2
4
7h
g g
h 5h
2g
10
2 We 7 Simplify each of the following.
d
3x 2
5
3t t
c
4
3 Simplify each of the following.
x 20
x 12
a
b
5 y
4 y
a
x 25
10 2 y
3w 7
14 x
x 9z
5y x
j
3x 8 y
3z 2 y
4 Simplify the following expressions.
3 5
2 9
a
b
x x
x x
i
4
c
9 2f
3
4y 2
5
2v
d 2
3
b
y 16
4 x
x 9
2 2y
3 y 8z
4x 7y
y 6z
3x 7 y
20 y 21z
7x
5y
y
x
3w 2 y
4 12
x x
20 20
x 3y
1
5
5w w
7
3
2 x 5x
3 xy 3 x
7
4y
2 xy 5 x
5
y
6 y 3x
9 4 xy
8 wx 3w
5
4y
2 xy 3 xy
5
5
10 xy 3 xy
5
5
2a 9b
3
2
3 10 x
5 3y
5
3q
12 p 5
4
3b
15a 4 a
x 9
3 x
4 y
y 12
4 m
3 16
n 3
9 2m
7m 10
5
m
5
x
3 x 15
20 6
3y 5
2 x 15 y
3y 6x
4 m 2 9n
27n 7m
2 p 7 pq
15 p2 21
x
11y 2 6 z
22 y 12 z xy
2a
2
5 15b
3 3
4 8x
5 15
6y 6
9 p 36q
10 10
x x
3 9
4 12
m m
a a
5 20
6 20
b b
3a 2 a
14 7
21b 2 3
3
4
b
6m 6 2m 3
15
3
ab ac
9 24
2m 10 m
3 p 9 pq
3 10 12
5 m m
3x 3 2 y2 y2
8y
15
4
ChapTer 11 Algebraic manipulation
373
To expand an algebraic expression means to remove a set of brackets. This is done by multiplying what
is inside the brackets by what is directly outside the brackets.
Worked example 8
c x(2x + 3y)
WriTe
a 5(x + 3)
= 5(x) + 5(3)
= 5x + 15
b a(x y)
= a(x) a(y)
= ax + ay
c x(2x + 3y)
= x(2x) + x(3y)
= 2x2 + 3xy
An algebraic expression may be composed of brackets that need to be expanded, as well as other terms.
In such cases, after expansion it may be possible to simplify the expression by collecting like terms.
Worked example 9
WriTe
a 7x + 6( y 2x)
= 7x + 6( y) + 6(2x)
= 7x + 6y 12x
= 5x + 6y
= 5x + 10y + 6x 18y
= 11x 8y
374
= xy 10xy2 + 24x2
c
f
i
l
o
5(m + 4)
7(x 1)
3( p 2)
(x 2)
6(5m 4)
c
f
i
l
o
a(a + 5)
y(5 + y)
2x( y + 2)
10p(q + 9)
6a(5 3a)
c
f
i
l
o
7( p + 2) 3
2m(m + 5) 3m
4p( p 2) + 5p
3p( p 2q) + 4pq 1
6p + 3 4(2p + 5)
c
f
i
l
o
b
e
h
k
n
y( y + 3)
x(4 + x)
q(8 q)
3y(x + 4)
7m(5 n)
mC
c c(d 2) + c(d + 5)
f 7a(b 3) b(2a + 3)
i 3m(2m + 4) 2(3m + 5)
a 5a + 6b
B 7a + 4b
C 5(3a + b)
d 7a + 8b
a 4x + 11y
B 4x 11y
C 4x + 11y
d 4x + 7y
a 3m + 4n 8
B 5mn + 4m
C 5mn + 10m
d 5mn + 6m
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 11.1
doc-10338
375
11d
Substitution
When the numerical values of pronumerals are known, we can substitute them into an algebraic
expression and evaluate it. It can be useful to place any substituted values in brackets when evaluating
an expression.
Worked example 10
WriTe
aab
=42
Simplify.
=2
b a3 + 9b c
Simplify.
= 64 + 18 + 7
= 89
An algebraic expression has little or no meaning without a value being substituted for the pronumeral.
An algebraic expression that is used in common calculations is called a formula. When using a formula,
we substitute for one unknown to allow us to calculate the value of another.
When substituting into a formula, we replace a pronumeral with a number and then calculate the value
of the entire expression.
Worked example 11
The formula V = 43 r3 is used to calculate the volume of a sphere. Calculate the value of V, correct
to 2 decimal places, when r = 4.7.
Think
WriTe
V = 43 r3
= 43 (4.7)3
= 434.89
In many such examples you will be required to do calculations that require more than one substitution.
Worked example 12
In the formula v = u + at, calculate the value of v when u = 12.8, a = 9.8 and t = 5.
Think
Method 1
1 Write the formula.
376
WriTe/diSplaY
v = u + at
= 12.8 + 9.8 5
= 61.8
Method 2
1
Substitution
exercise 11d
b cb
d c (a b)
e 7a + 8b 11c
g abc
h ab(c b)
k a b c
c2
+a
cab
a b c
+ +
f
2 3 5
i a2 + b2 c2
l 2.3a 3.2b
f
b dk
e d(k + 1)
g k3
3 If x =
1
3
c kd
f d2
k 1
d
3k 5d
(r = 5)
b P = 4s
(s = 7.3)
c L= l 2
(l = 4.9)
2
p
d C = 45 + 65d (d = 1.4)
e S = 4 r2
(r = 8.8)
f Q=
( p = 6.5)
9.8
6 We12 In the formula A = (1 + r)n, find the value of A when r = 0.075 and n = 4. (Give your answer
correct to 3 decimal places.)
PRT
7 a Given that I =
, find I when P = 2000, R = 6 and T = 5.
100
b Given that T = a + 8d, find T when a = 56 and d = 8.
c Given that P = 2l + 2w, find P when l = 34 and w = 54.
1
d Given that A = bh, find A when b = 9.8 and h = 6.7.
2
e Given that V = lbh, find V when l = 6.5, b = 6.5 and h = 5.6.
D
f Given that S = , find S when D = 900 and T = 12.
T
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1489
Substitution
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1490
Substitution game
377
5
9
1
3
B 7
C 10
d 25
10 The formula V = r2h is used to calculate the volume of a cone, where r is the radius and h is the
height. Use the formula to calculate the volume of a cone, correct to 2 decimal places, where:
a the radius is 4 cm and the height is 8 cm
b the radius is 32 mm and the height is 17 mm
c the radius is 4.6 cm and the height is 9.7 cm.
m
, calculate the value of B when:
h2
a m = 56 and h = 2
b m = 3.6 and h = 6
yA
12 In the formula D =
, find the value of D when:
y + 12
a y = 6 and A = 2
b y = 4.2 and A = 7
13 Frieds rule to calculate the infant dosage of a medicine
mA
is given by the formula D =
, where D is the infant
150
dosage, m is the infants age in months and A is the
adult dosage.
Calculate the dosage of medicine given to:
a a nine-month-old baby, where the adult dosage is
50 mL
b an 18-month-old child, where the adult dose is 30 mL
c a two-year-old child, where the adult dose is
40 mL.
11 In the formula B =
yA
. In this formula, D is the
y + 12
childs dose, y is the age of the child in years and A is the adults dose.
Calculate the dosage for a three-year-old child taking a medicine for which the adult dose is 45 mL.
kA
15 Clarks rule for calculating a dosage is D =
, where k is the mass of the child in kilograms and A is
70
the adult dose. Calculate the dosage required for a child who weighs 20kg, where the adult dosage
is 35 mL.
16 Gavin is eight years old and weighs 28 kg. The adult dosage of a medicine is 30 mL. Calculate the
dosage of medicine that should be given to Gavin according to:
a Frieds rule
b Youngs rule
c Clarks rule.
m
17 The Body Mass Index, B, is a measure of how healthy a person is. The formula is B = 2 , where m is a
h
persons mass in kilograms and h is a persons height in metres. A person is considered to be healthy
if 21 B 25.
Calculate the Body Mass Index, correct to 1 decimal place, of the following people and comment on
the health of each person.
a Caroline, who is 71 kg and 1.7 m tall
b Neil, who is 86 kg and 1.65 m tall
c Bronwyn, who is 42 kg and 1.68 m tall
14 Youngs rule for the calculation of a childs dose of medicine is D =
c a = b = 6.
19 The volume of any prism can be found using the formula V = Ah where A is the cross-sectional area
20 Eulers formula, E = F + V 2, is used to find the number of edges on a prism given the number of
faces and vertices. Use the formula to find the number of edges on a prism with:
b 7 faces and 10 vertices
c 10 faces and 12 vertices.
21 The kinetic energy of an object is found using the formula E = 2mv2, where m is the mass and vis the
22 The volume of a cylinder can be found using the formula V = r2h where r is the radius of the cylinder
and h is the height. Use the formula to determine which of the following cylinders has the greater
volume:
Cylinder A: with radius of 6 cm and a height of 5.2 cm
Cylinder B: with a radius of 5.2 cm and a height of 6 cm.
23 The surface area of a cylinder can be found using the formula SA = 2r2 + 2rh. Use the formula to
determine which of the cylinders in question 22 has the greater surface area.
11e
An equation is an incomplete mathematical sentence. When we are given an equation, our task is to
solve it. That is, to find a value for the pronumeral which makes the sentence true.
The basic idea to follow when solving an equation is to undo those operations performed on the
pronumeral. We do this by writing an equivalent equation made by using one of four possible steps.
Step 1. We can add the same number to each side of an equation.
Step 2. We can subtract the same number from each side of an equation.
Step 3. We can multiply both sides of an equation by the same number.
Step 4. We can divide both sides of an equation by the same number.
The simplest type of equation is the one-step equation. The solution to these equations uses only one
of the above four steps.
Worked example 13
b y 43 = 56
c 7d = 91
Think
q
= 29
13
WriTe
a x + 48 = 75
x = 27
ChapTer 11 Algebraic manipulation
379
b y 43 = 56
y = 99
d 1
2
7d = 91
d = 13
q
= 29
13
q = 377
When solving equations that involve more than one step to the solution, we must show the equivalent
equation formed after using each of our chosen steps.
Worked example 14
m
14 = 25
7
Think
WriTe
a 12 + 3x = 45
3x = 33
x = 11
m
14 = 25
7
m
= 11
7
m = 77
The solution to an equation can be checked by substituting the value found into the equation.
For example, if we check x = 11 in 12 + 3x = 45.
LHS = 12 + 3 11
= 45
= RHS
Since x = 11 gives a true number sentence, we know the solution x = 11 is the correct solution to this
equation. The substitution can be written, although this is not usually necessary. This is normally done
mentally or on the calculator as a check that the value we have is correct.
In each of these examples we calculated the value of the subject of the formula. In many cases, after
substitution we may be left with a value to calculate that is not the subject of the formula. Hence, the
solution will require you to solve an equation.
Worked example 15
9C
+ 32 is used to convert degrees Celsius to degrees Fahrenheit. Use the
5
formula to convert 68 Fahrenheit to degrees Celsius.
The formula F =
Think
380
WriTe
Substitute 68 for F.
9C
+ 32
5
9C
68 =
+ 32
5
340 = 9C + 160
180 = 9C
F=
C = 20
exercise 11e
y
d
= 19
14
g 17x = 306
e r + 387 = 435
p
= 851
23
j k 56 = 34
k 15b = 240
u
f
m
= 4
n
=8
45
5
v
p 5c = 17
q
= 9.5
3.2
2 mC Which of the following is the exact solution to 7x = 23?
2
7
a x=
B x = 37
h
23
C x = 3.28
t 253 = 78
e + 79 = 45
7a = 84
o d + 8.5 = 13.7
r
t 25 = 32
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1496
equation solver
d x = 3.29
b 7x = 45
e 13x = 45
c 6x = 37
f 9x = 2
c 9q = 162
q 8y
3
4
1
22
c
f
i
l
o
3z + 6 = 27
13x 85 = 227
4c + 70 = 2
9v 10 = 5
23 2b = 1
1 7h = 65
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1497
Solving equations
diGiTal doC
GC program Casio
doc-1498
equations
s
v
r
f
+ 7 = 12
b
8=9
c
+ 5 = 11
d
1 = 12
3
7
8
4
p
s
k
v
e
+ 3 = 11
f
10 = 2
g
+ 20 = 27
h
4=0
11
4
15
3
m
j
p
g
l
10 = 4
k
+ 35 = 4
j
13 = 11
i
1 = 1
6
10
7
8
6 Solve each of the following equations.
4y
3p
2q
a
=8
b
=9
c
=8
5
2
3
2s
5w
12m
d
= 8
e
= 10
f
= 6
5
9
5
7 In each of the following equations, check by substitution if the answer given is correct.
a x + 67 = 98
(x = 31)
b r 6.8 = 45.9
(r = 51.7)
b 3
3
=
c 32p = 256
( p = 8)
d
(b = 6 4 )
9 4
e 5t 98 = 56
(t = 30.8)
f 7y + 13 = 65
( y = 11.1)
3w 2
2e
2
=3
g
(w = 4 3 )
h
+1=7
(e = 9)
4
3
a
diGiTal doC
GC program TI
doc-1499
equations
diGiTal doC
GC program Casio
doc-1500
expanding
diGiTal doC
GC program TI
doc-1501
expanding
5x
x4
+ 1 = 16
B 4x 7 = 53 x
C 4x 12 = 48 x
d
=4x
4
2
9 Solve each of the following equations by first expanding the brackets.
a 3(b + 5) = 30
b 5(n + 6) = 40
c 7(h 5) = 56
d 9( p 4) = 54
e 4(k 8) = 72
f 3(m 16) = 45
g 6(t + 9) = 84
h 4(2n + 5) = 52
i 9(3r 7) = 72
a
381
6(6g + 5) = 210
m 6(z 2) = 44
k 4(5g 1) = 44
n 3(6y + 13) = 76
o 5(4u 9) = 34
A = 56 and l = 8.
a P = 64 and w = 18
b P = 142 and w = 17
c P = 12.4 and w = 3.4.
PRT
, find R when I = 500,
100
P = 2500 and T = 2.
Given that T = a + 8d, find d when T = 59 and a = 11.
Given that P = 2l + 2w, find w when l = 34 and
P = 176.
1
Given that A = 2 bh, find h when A = 19.43 and b = 5.8.
Given that V = lbh, find b when V = 74.375, l = 2.5 and
h = 3.5.
D
Given that S = , find D when S = 90 and T = 12.
T
14 a Given that I =
b
c
d
e
f
b 21 9x = 3
c 63 7x = 21
d 15 6x = 2
16 The cost of hiring a taxi can be found using the formula C = 4 + 2.5d, where d is the distance travelled
a $29.00
382
c $25.25.
17 An operator connected phone call costs $1.50 connection fee plus $2.20 per minute.
a Write a formula connecting the cost of the call, C, to the length of the call, m.
b Calculate the cost of a call lasting:
i 1 minute
ii 5 minutes
iii 8 minutes.
c Calculate the length of a call for which the charge is:
i $8.10
ii $16.90
iii $34.50.
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 11.2
doc-10339
383
Summary
operations with
algebraic expressions
y
Index Law 2: a a = a
ay
When multiplying or dividing expressions, we treat each pronumeral separately, applying the index
laws when necessary.
When an expression involves the use of brackets, we multiply each term in the brackets by the term
immediately outside.
Further multiplication
and division
To multiply fractions, simplify where possible, then multiply the numerators together and the
denominators together.
To divide fractions, multiply the first fraction by the reciprocal of the second fraction.
expanding and
simplifying algebraic
expressions
Expansion means to multiply everything inside the brackets by what is directly outside.
After expanding simplify by collecting any like terms.
Substitution
Solving linear
equations
An equation is a mathematical sentence with a missing value. The object of solving an equation is
to find the missing value that makes the sentence correct.
In solving an equation, we can add, subtract, multiply or divide both sides of the equation to make
the unknown value the subject of the equation.
Whatever is done to one side of an equation must be done to the other to maintain the equality.
Always begin by writing the equation, then write each step in the solution.
The answer to an equation can be checked by substituting the value found into the equation.
Equations can be formed when substituting into a formula. This occurs when the subject of the
formula is not the value we need to find.
384
Chapter review
1 7x 5y 6x + 4y =
a x+y
2 5x4 3x3 =
a 8x7
B xy
C x + 9y
d x 9y
B 8x12
C 15x7
d 15x12
C 48
d 144
C x=4
d x=5
m U lTip l e
C ho iC e
B 48
B x = 4
b 8w + 9w
e 6q 5q
c 6r + 9r r
f 9x + 6x x
b 6a + 4 3a 9
e 5x + 20 + 3x 6
c 12k 5l + 3l 8k
f 12m 20 2m + 4
S ho rT
a n S W er
b a a6
5p3
5x5y4 6x7y6
c 4x5 6x3
5y 6y
5ab3 4a3b2
k 7g3h2 4gh
o 45r6 5r3
p 63y5 7y
m b6 b2
n f4 f
q 45r5s2 5r4s3
36s3t5 9st
28 p
v k5 k4 k3
4
12 p
4 Simplify the following expressions.
2 y
a 12
a
b
y 8
6 a
e a 4 10
f aa
12 5 a
2 4
5m 15m
20
a 4 ab
j
i
6 y 3 xy
14c 7c
d 9 4q3
6x2
h 4r4 3r4
8x4
64 a6
16a 4
12m4n3 4mn3
32m 6
8m 4
7
x
2 x 14
g 5 30
m m
b 5p(2p 6q)
3)
4pq(3p2
2w3(3w2
1 6p
3p 5
24 8
h
7y y
c x3(4x5 2)
2q4)
7a6(3a8 9b2)
a
, find the value of S when a = 20 and r = 12 .
1 r
3e + 18
7 The formula N =
+ 70 is used to calculate the number of video-recorders, N, that can be
5
produced by e employees. Calculate the number of video-recorders that can be produced by
89 employees.
h
8 In the formula A = (a + b), calculate the value of A when h = 5, a = 8.5 and b = 6.2.
2
1
9 Given that S = ut + at2, find S when u = 9.5, t = 5 and a = 5.8.
2
6 In the formula S =
d
= 42
23
a a + 98 = 165
b b 76 = 84
c 43c = 3827
e 8e = 96
f
= 19
4
g g + 45 = 12
h 9h = 25
385
12 i = 23
m 45 + 3m = 18
4j 17 = 47
n 33 4n = 7
k 7k + 13 = 76
o
t
+ 9 = 17
5
3r
= 15
7
11 Solve the following equations by substituting the given values.
a A = lw
(A = 56, w = 7)
b P = 2l + 2w
a
5
c C = (F 32) (C = 25)
d S=
9
1 r
q
e x T ended
r e SponS e
1 In the formula v = ut +
a
b
2a
b
diGiTal doC
Test Yourself
doc-10340
Chapter 11
386
5q
= 15
4
c
d
5l + 43 = 2
p 8
p
= 5
5
1
2
at2:
calculate the value of v when u = 0.8, t = 12 and a = 6
calculate the value of u when v = 100, t = 4 and a = 1.6.
Simplify 4x + 9y 5x 8y.
4 x 3 y2 6 x 2 y4
Simplify
.
3 xy8
(2 x 3 y)
Simplify the expression
.
8 x 5 y9
Solve the equation 7x + 15 = 113.
(P = 94, l = 16)
(S = 6, a = 3)
ICT activities
11C expanding and simplifying
algebraic expressions
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 11.1 (doc-10338): Solve problems involving algebra.
(page 375)
11d
Substitution
diGiTal doCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1489): Substitution (page 377)
Spreadsheet (doc-1490): Substitution game (page 377)
11e
Chapter review
Test Yourself Chapter 11 (doc-10340): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 386)
diGiTal doCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1496): Equation solver (page 381)
Spreadsheet (doc-1497): Solving equations (page 381)
387
Answers CHAPTER 11
alGeBraiC manipUlaTion
exercise 11a operations with algebraic
expressions
1 a 2t
b 3r
c 6w
d 4x
e 7q
f 8n
2 a m+m
b n+n+n+n+n+n
c s+s+s+s+s+s+s+s+s
d w+w+w+w+w+w+w+w
e y+y+y
f r+r+r+r
3 a 12y
b 19x
c 39e
d 47j
e 25k
f 4k
g 8r
h w
i 4m
j 2w
l 22m
k 7s
mj
n 6p
o z
4 a 10x + 7
b 4h 4
c 13k
d 3p + 7q
f 13t
e 5 + 4w
g 4j + 8k
h 3x 15
i 16b 26
j 3a 8
k 17b 6
l 4r 17
m 10y 6
n 3c b
o 13d 8
p 19e 4p
r 2w
q 20t 23s
5 a 24
b 76
c 92
d q7
e p5
f w3
6 a 333333
b 44444
c 8888888
d mmm
e yy
f jjjjjjjjj
7 a q7
b x11
c y15
d 47
6
e a
f s3
g 6b6
h 10d8
10
i 35g
j 27j 6
4
k 8k
l 24m2
m 20x7y9
n 20m5n9
5
9
o 63a b
p 48j 4k10
5
3
q 50p q
r 54r4s3t10
4
8 a a
b b4
c c2
d e4
2
e 6g
f 6h4
3
2
g 8j k
h 4m3n
8
3
i 7p q
j 9r3
t3
k 12s2
l
3
9 The order of terms when multiplied does
not matter, they give the same result;
hence, 4xy and 5yx are like terms, but 4x2
and 5x will always give different values.
3 p5
8b 5
10 a
b
2
3
2
2
c 3a
d
m
2
4 p rs
9a5bc
11 a
b
3
2
388
20 f 6 g 2 h 4
3
(5x2)4 = 625x8.
exercise 11B
and division
10 a
1 a
3
16
c
c
6b
5
18
d
5d
f
h
3x
2 a
10
c 4
3 a
4x
y
4y
x
5x
e
4y
c
6z
7x
3x
i
2y
12 z
k
x
g
4 a 5
1
c 3
1
e 25
4 y2
7
8 y2
i
9
g
k 3
5 a 3ab
c
q
4p
e 3
g
m
12
i 14
8
k
y
4m
m
21
o
d
b
d
6f
7h 2
2
2y
5
3
v
3x
y
9x
4y
3w
2x
2z
h
7x
f
5
24
x
6w
2
9
d 3
f
h
j
35
6
y2
2x
b
y
b
d
5a 2
l
1
3
n
6m
1
9
5
3
2q
45
b 2x
1
c
3y
p
4q
e 3
1
3
or
2 y2
25
32 xy
15
1
4
6 a 3ab
3a
2
3m 3
k
5
3q
m
5
x3
o
5y
g 2
Further multiplication
e 6e
g 4
5
6
j
l
n
1 a
d
g
j
2 a
d
g
5
6
30
27
11
30
125
3
10
7b 5
4
8b
3c
1
2
and simplifying
4x + 12
2p + 10
7x 7
5a 5
x + 1
x + 2
24m 16
27p + 15
y2 + 3y
c2 + 4c
5y + y2
8q q2
5pq + 20p
10pq 90p
35m + 7mn
28x + 16x2
5x 17
12p + 3
2m2 + 7m
4y2 4y + 7
4x 13y
3p2 + 10pq 1
7cd 12c2 5c
3 3m
10p + 8q
19c + 22d
6x 11y
14p 8q
4x y
8c + 9d
7p + 11q
8c + d
2xy + 4x 2y
2pq 2p
5ab 21a 3b
6cd 36c
c D
15a2 + 2b2 9ab
12m2 20m 4
7x2 + 41x 6
Substitution
b 2
e 17
h 12
k 30
b 1
e 24
h 1
c
f
i
l
c
f
i
0
3
12
5
1
36
15
3 a
7
12
d 1
1
3
4 a 68 F
5 a 30
d 136
6 1.335
7 a 600
d 32.83
g 100
j 25.5
8 a C = 4.5 + 0.6d
b i $7.50
9C
10 a 134.04
11 a 14
12 a
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
2
3
a 3 mL
2
3
4
1
12
1
576
1
12
f 48
b 95 F
b 29.2
e 973.14
c 22.46 F
c 6.93
f 4.31
b 8
e 236.6
h 80
c 176
f 75
i 85.4
ii $16.50
iii $34.50
b 18 229.61
b 0.1
c 214.94
c 2.5
b 1.81
c 1.88
b 3.6 mL
c 6.4 mL
9 mL
10 mL
a 19.2 mL
b 12 mL
a 24.6 ideal weight
b 31.6 overweight
c 14.9 severely underweight
a 10
b 17
a 63 cm3
b 576 cm3
a 10
b 15
a 46.08
b 38.88
Cylinder A
Cylinder A
exercise 11e
g e = 2
h d = 2
j r = 11.6
k f = 2
mt = 6
n g = 3
p s = 1.55
5 a s = 15
d f = 52
g k = 105
j j = 20
6 a y = 10
d s = 20
7 a Correct
d Correct
g Correct
8D
9 a b=5
d p = 10
g t=5
j g=5
mz = 9
c 12 mL
c
c
c
c
8.5
8.28 cm3
20
40
q y=
30 x + 20
5
b $12
b=7
a l = 19
a l = 14
a R = 10
d h = 6.7
a x = 8
15
c x=6
l v=1
r h=9
v = 119
p = 88
v = 12
p = 273
p=6
w = 18
Incorrect
Correct
Correct
n=2
k = 26
n=4
g = 2
1
n y=2
18
=
b
b
b
e
b
2
3
o b = 12
13
32
c
f
i
l
c
f
c
f
3
7
r = 48
s = 48
g=0
m = 36
q = 12
m = 2.5
Correct
Incorrect
h = 13
m = 31
r=5
v = 4
o u = 3.95
b
e
h
k
1
3
10 a
11
12
13
14
b
e
h
k
b
e
b
e
h
i c = 17
6
7
c
f
i
l
25 x + 4
4
b = 5.75
l = 54
d=6
b = 8.5
x=2
d x=2
2
5
1
6
3a 5
8x + 14
a7
5p4
12r8
28g4h3
f3
9r
q
s
t 4m2
b
e
b
e
h
k
n
c
f
c
f
i
l
o
4k 2l
10m 16
24x8
30y2
30x12y10
48m5n6
9r3
r 4s2t4
u
7
3 p3
1
4
c 1
2
3
f 2
3
7
5
2b
a m2 + 3m
c 4x8 2x3
e 12p3q 8pq5
40
36.75
a a = 67
d d = 966
g g = 33
j j = 16
m m = 9
p p = 65
a l=8
c F = 77
x
6
j
5
11
1
6
10p2 30pq
6w5 6w3
21a14 63a6b2
127
120
b = 160
c c = 89
e = 12
f f = 76
i i = 11
h = 27
9
k=9
l l = 9
n = 6.5
o t = 40
q = 12
r r = 35
w = 31
r=1
b
d
f
7
9
b
e
h
k
n
q
b
d
exTended reSponSe
1 a 441.6
2 a x + y
c
mUlTiple ChoiCe
3 C
s 4a2
v k6
4 a 2
c l = 2.8
c w = 54
f D = 1080
ChapTer reVieW
2 C
p 9y4
6
8
10
16 a 10 km
b 18 km
c 8.5 km
17 a C = 1.5 + 2.2m
b i $3.70
ii $12.50
iii $19.10
c i 3 min
ii 7 min
iii 15 min
1 B
2 a 5m + 4n
d 16m 6
3 a w8
d 36q3
g 48x6
j 20a4b5
m b4
1
4 x 2 y8
b 21.8
8x 4
y2
d x = 14
b
4 D
ShorT anSWer
1 a 4y
d 6t
b 17w
e q
c 14r
f 14x
389
ChapTer 12
12a
The table below shows the amount of money earned by a wage earner.
Hours (H)
Wage (W)
10
85
20
170
30
255
40
340
50
425
draW
W
450
400
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
10 20 30 40 50 H
In many examples we are required to draw a graph from an algebraic rule. In such an example we need
to create our own table. To do this, we can choose any sensible value to use for the independent variable.
ChapTer 12 Modelling linear relationships
391
Worked example 2
Draw up a table of values and plot the graph of y = 2 x + 3 and label the line.
Think
WriTe/draW
y = 2x + 3
y
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
y = 2x + 3
0
5 4 3 21
1
2
3
4
5
1 2 3 4 5
process
output.
The independent variable is the input, a calculation is made which is the process and the output is the
value of the dependent variable.
An independent variable is substituted (input), a calculation is made (process) according to the rule
defined by the function and the dependent variable (output) is the result.
Worked example 3
A preschool has hired an entertainment group to entertain their children at a concert. The cost of
staging the concert is given by the function C = 80 + 3n, where C is the cost and n is the number of
children attending the concert.
Draw the graph of this function.
Think
1
392
WriTe/draW
50
100
150
200
80
230
380
530
680
C
800
700
600
500
400
300
200
100
0
exercise 12a
1 We1 The table below shows the amount of money, M, earned for delivering a number of pamphlets,
P, to letterboxes.
P
1000
2000
3000
4000
5000
50
100
150
200
250
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1531
Graph paper
100
8000
200
300
400
diGiTal doC
GC program Casio
doc-1525
linear
500
diGiTal doC
GC program TI
doc-1526
linear
2
1
2
diGiTal doC
GC program TI
doc-1528
myrule
Rule: y = 2x
x
g Rule: y = 4x + 1
diGiTal doC
GC program Casio
doc-1527
myrule
d Rule: y = 2x 3
e Rule: y = 3x 5
c Rule: y = 3x
b Rule: y = x 1
h Rule: y = 5x + 4
1
5
x
y
2
6
5 We2 Draw up a table of values and plot the graph for each of the following rules. Label each graph.
a y=x+2
b y=x4
c y=x5
d y=x+6
e y = 5x
f y = 7x
g y = 4x 3
h y = 2x + 4
i y = 3x + 2
j y = 2x 2
k y = 6x + 2
l y = 3x + 2
6 We3 The cost of an international telephone call can be given by the rule C = 1.5t, where C is the cost
of the call and t is the length of the call in minutes. Draw a graph showing the cost of a telephone call.
7 Use the graph from question 6 to calculate the cost of a telephone call that lasts for:
a 17 minutes
b 45 minutes.
ChapTer 12 Modelling linear relationships
393
8 The distance, d, travelled by a cyclist can be given by the algebraic rule d = 15t, where t is the time
in hours that the cyclist has been riding. Draw a graph showing the distance travelled by the cyclist
against time.
9 The cost, C, of a taxi journey can be given by the rule C = 4 + 1.5d, where d is the distance of the
graph that will show the height of the tree each year.
11 Casey has a job that pays $10 per hour. Draw a graph that will show the money earned against hours
worked.
12 It costs Bill $1850 per week to operate his business developing photographs. Bill charges $8 to develop
a roll of film. Draw a graph that shows the profit or loss he makes against the number of rolls of film
developed.
a Write an equation for the total cost in terms of the hourly rate.
b Sketch a graph of this relationship.
c What would be the charge for 3 hours?
14 A singing telegram service charges a $60 appearance fee and $8 per minute sung.
a Write an equation for the total cost of a singing telegram in terms of the number of minutes sung.
b Sketch a graph of the relationship.
c What would be the charge for a 5 minute singing telegram?
d How many minutes can be bought with $150? (Whole minutes only)
15 Colleen delivers junk mail and is paid $32 to traverse a particular route and a further 10centsper leaflet
delivered.
a What method of payment is Colleen being paid?
b Write an equation for the total payment that she receives.
c Sketch a graph of the relationship expressed in b.
d What would Colleens pay be if she delivered 1650 pamphlets?
16 A pay TV salesperson receives $300 per week plus $20 for every household that he signs up to have
pay-TV connected. How much does he receive in a week where he signs up 33households?
17 a Draw a graph of the relationship described in question 16.
b What is the point where the graph cuts the vertical axis?
c How does this relate to the rate at which he is paid?
18 A person is running at 10 km/h. The speed at which she runs decreases by 1 km/h for every 30minutes
Not all graphs can be drawn as a straight line. Consider the case of
height and age.
1 Find a person of each age from 120. Measure their height and plot
their age and height as a pair of coordinates.
2 Draw a line of best fit for the points plotted.
3 The graph will flatten where people stop growing and so does not
continue to rise indefinitely. Suggest a point at which this graph
should stop.
12B
Using this formula, the gradient can be calculated by measurement from a graph by choosing any two
points on the graph.
The graph at right shows the function
C = 2 + 0.5d
C
C = 2 + 0.5d.
(8, 6)
6
On the graph, the two points (2, 3) and (8, 6)
5
3 units
4
are marked. Between these two points the vertical
(2, 3)
3
rise = 3 and the horizontal run = 6. Using the gradient 2
6 units
1
formula:
0
gradient =
3
6
1
2
10 d
Worked example 4
D = 4t
6 t
395
Think
1
WriTe
D
20
18
16
14
12
10
8
6 (1, 4)
4
2
0
0 1
gradient =
D = 4t (5, 20)
16
4
2
6 t
=4
16
4
A function with a positive gradient is called an increasing function. That means that the value of the
dependent variable increases as the value of the independent variable increases.
A decreasing function has a negative gradient. In such cases when calculating the gradient, we take
the vertical rise to be negative. In a decreasing function, the value of the dependent variable decreases as
the value of the independent variable increases.
Worked example 5
y
5
4
3
2
1
Think
1
54321 0
1
2
3
4
5
WriTe
1 2 3 4 5
y=4x
y
5 (0, 4)
4
4
3
2
1
54321 0
1
2
3
4
5
396
gradient =
y=4x
= 1
4
(4, 0)
1 2 3 4 5
4
4
The gradient of 1 in the example above means that for every one-unit increase in x, there is a one unit
decrease in y.
In the example above, the graph cuts the y-axis at 4. Therefore, for this function the y-intercept is 4.
During this course you will need to look at using linear graphs in a practical context. In such a context
you need to consider which of the variables is the independent variable, which is the dependent variable
and the meaning of both the gradient and vertical intercept in context.
Consider the scenario in Worked example 3. A preschool hired an
C
entertainment group in a concert and the cost of hiring the entertainment
800
700
group was given by the equation C = 80 + 3n.
600
The independent variable is the number of students who attend the
500
400
concert.
300
The dependent variable is the cost of staging the concert. This is
200
100
because the cost depends on the number of students who attend.
0
The gradient of this graph is 3. In this situation the cost of staging the
0 50 100 150 200 n
concert rises by $3 for every extra student who attends.
The vertical intercept of the graph is 80. In this situation this means there is a cost of $80 to stage the
concert even if no students attend. This is known as a fixed cost.
Worked example 6
The table below shows the cost of running an excursion for a given number of students.
No. of students
Cost
20
40
60
80
100
$200
$300
$400
$500
$600
Cost ($)
WriTe/draW
20 40 60 80 100
Number of students
600
550
500
450
400
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
600
550
500
450
400
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
100
20
20 40 60 80 100
Number of students
397
gradient =
=5
3
vertical axis.
2
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
01 23 45
01 23 45 6 x
y
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
c Intercept = 100
exercise 12B
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1530
Gradient
y
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
01 23 4 x
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1531
Graph paper
398
3 We6 The table below shows the payment made to a person on a newspaper delivery round.
Deliveries
Payment
200
120
400
180
600
240
800
300
1000
360
No. of people
Profit
20
50
0
60
100
100
150
200
200
300
x
y
T ($)
3200
1700
200
1
2 n (Days)
Cost ($)
76
68
60
1 2 Time (min)
Garage
way
Drive
2m
17m
399
0.85 m
15 m
What is the gradient of the sloping section? Give your answer as a simplified fraction.
13 A passenger jet takes off on the following path.
150 m
110 m
Runway
500 m
Hire Ch
arges
Book
in
Hourly g fee $5
rate
$10
Explain how the booking fee and the hourly rate relate to the function that would represent the hire
cost of the court.
5
4
3
2
1
54321 0
1
2
3
4
5
y = 2x + 1
1 2 3 4 5
Worked example 7
b y = 7 2x.
Think
gradient = 3
y-intercept = 4
WriTe
gradient = 2
y-intercept = 7
We can use the gradient and y-intercept to draw the graph of a function in the form y = mx + b. By
plotting the y-intercept we are able to use the gradient to plot other points. For example, a gradient of
2 means a rise of 2 units for a 1 unit increase in x. Therefore, from the y-intercept we count a rise of
2 units and a run of 1 unit to plot the next point. It is a useful check to repeat this process from the next
point plotted. The points plotted can then be joined by a straight line that is the graph of the function.
Worked example 8
WriTe
gradient = 3
y-intercept = 2
y
5
4
3
2
1
54321 0
1
2
3
4
5
y
5
4
3
2
1
54321 0
1
2
3
4
5
1 2 3 4 5
y = 3x 2
1 2 3 4 5
If the gradient is a fraction, the numerator indicates the vertical change in position and the denominator
the horizontal change in position. The method of drawing the graph then remains unchanged.
ChapTer 12 Modelling linear relationships
401
Worked example 9
2
WriTe
2
gradient =
2
3
y-intercept = 2
y
5
4
3
2
1
4321 0
1
2
3
4
5
1 2 3 4 5 6
y
5
4
3
2
1
y = 23 x 2
4321 0
1
2
3
4
5
1 2 3 4 5 6
When sketching functions with a negative gradient we need to remember to treat the rise as negative;
that is, the function decreases.
Worked example 10
WriTe/draW
gradient = 2
y-intercept = 3
y
5
4
3
2
1
54321 0
1
2
3
4
5
402
1 2 3 4 5
y
5
4
3
2
1
54321 0
1
2
3
4
5
1 2 3 4 5
y = 3 2x
1 We7 For each of the functions below, state the gradient and the y-intercept.
a y = 2x + 2
b y = 3x 8
c y = 2 4x
3
d y = 4x + 3
e y=
x
+1
2
y = 3 2x
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1532
equation of a
straight line
b y = 3x 6
1
x
2
c y = 5x.
+ 2.
a y = 4x 1
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1533
linear graphs
b y = 3x
c y = 2x 4
b y = 2x 3
c y = 2 x + 4.
1
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet
doc-1534
Graph paper
B y = 2x + 1
1
2
1
x
2
C y= x1
d y=
+1
403
Further development
12 a How is a graph with a negative gradient recognised?
b How do you know that y = 5 2x has a negative gradient?
13 a How is a graph with a positive vertical intercept recognised?
b Does the graph of y = 5 2x have a positive or negative vertical intercept?
14 By making y the subject of the formula 3x y = 10 find:
a the gradient
b the vertical intercept.
15 What would be the equation of a line that has:
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 12.1
doc-10341
12d
Simultaneous equations
Consider the equation y = 2x 3. When we graph this equation every point on the graph represents a
value of x and y which together satisfy this equation. There is an infinite number of solutions to this
equation.
If a second linear equation is drawn on the same set of axes there will be one point only that satisfies
both equations. The point of intersection of the two graphs will give the x and y value for this solution.
Finding these values is known as solving the equations simultaneously.
Worked example 11
Use the graph of the given simultaneous equations below to write down the point of intersection
and, hence, the solution of the simultaneous equations.
x + 2y = 4
y
y = 2x 3
3
y = 2x 3
2
1
1 0
1
x + 2y = 4
1
2
3
Think
404
WriTe
x + 2y =
y = 2x
4
3
[1]
[2]
The only time where there will be no solution to a pair of linear simultaneous equations will be when the
lines drawn are parallel.
Worked example 12
WriTe/draW
x+y=6
y = 5 12 x
Equation [1]
x-intercept: when y = 0,
x+0=6
x=6
The x-intercept is at (6, 0).
y-intercept: when x = 0,
0+y=6
y=6
The y-intercept is at (0, 6).
Equation [2]
x-intercept: when y = 0,
1
0 = 5 2x
[1]
[2]
5 = 2 x
x = 10
The x-intercept is at (10, 0).
y-intercept: when x = 0,
1
y=520
y=5
The y-intercept is at (0, 5).
y
6
5
4
3
2
1
(2, 4)
x
3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1
2
3
4
5
6
405
RHS = 6
=51
=4
LHS = RHS
Distance (km)
Car A is travelling at a constant speed of 60 km/h. Car B leaves 2 hours later and travels at a
constant speed of 90 km/h. This is represented by the linear model below.
How far from the starting point does car B overtake car A?
406
600
500
400
300
200
100
0
B
A
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Time (h)
Think
WriTe
Simultaneous equations
exercise 12d
1 We11 Use the graphs below of the given simultaneous equations to write down the point of
a x+y=3
y
6
5
4
3
2
1
1 10
2
3
4
5
6
6
5
4
3
2
1
0.510
2
3
4
5
6
xy=1
5x
x+y=3
c 5y 8x + 7 = 0
y
5y 6x = 1
e yx=4
3x + 2y = 8
3x + 2y = 8
yx=4
1 0
2
xy=2
y 3x = 2
xy=2
x
3
2
4
6
1.5
2.0 2.5
y 2x = 8
y 2x = 8
1 20
4
10 6
8
10
12
4x + y =
y + 2x = 3
2y + x = 0
y
3
y + 2x = 3
1 0
1
3
1.0
12
10
8
6
4
2
g y 3x = 2
0.5
2
3
x+y=2
3x y = 2
d 4x + y = 10
5y 6x = 1
6
5
4
3
2
5y 8x + 7 = 0
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
2
3
4
5
6
3x y = 2
2y + x = 0
h 2x + y = 8
y
12
10
8
6
4
2
1 20
4
6
8
10
12
4x + y = 15
4x + y = 15
2x + y = 8
1
5x
407
2y + 3x 9 =
2y 3x = 1
2y 4x =
5
y
5
4
2
0
1.0 0.5
1
0
2y 4x = 5
2y 3x = 1
4y + 2x = 5
4y + 2x = 5
0.5
1.0
1.5 2.0
2
1
2y + 3x 9 = 0
2 We12 Solve each of the following pairs of simultaneous equations using a graphical method.
a y=8x
b y = 3x + 10
y=x+2
y = 2x + 8
c y = 2x 3
d y = 3 + 4x
e y = 16 3x
x=5
y = 11 2x
y = 1 + 3x
y=7
y = 2x + 15
cost $2 per kg. Rhonda spends $30 on 9kg of fruit. This can be
represented by the linear functions at right, where a represents the
number of apples and b represents the number of bananas.
Use the graph to find the mass of apples and bananas that
Rhonda bought.
b
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
5a + 2b = 30
a+b=9
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 a
b The length of the rectangle is 5 cm longer than the width. This can be represented by the linear
c Use the intersection of the two graphs to determine the length and width of the rectangle.
6 a Steve earns twice as much money each week as Theo. This can be represented by the linear function
s = 2t, where s represents the amount of money Steve earns and t represents the amount of money
Theo earns. Draw the graph of this function.
b The total of Theo and Steves wages is $750. This can be represented by the linear function
t + s = 750. Draw this function on the same set of axes.
c Use the intersection of these graphs to find Theos wage and Steves wage.
represent this piece of information and draw the graph on the same set of axes.
c Use the intersection of your two graphs to find Tanyas mark in both English and Maths.
408
10
11
12
troubleshooting of its systems after sale. The cost of signing up for the service plan is $215, and
there is an hourly rate of $65 for the servicepersons time. Purchasers not signing up for the plan are
charged a flat rate of $150 per hour for service. Would it be advisable to sign up for the service plan
if you expected to need 3 hours of service assistance during the life of a computer purchased from
SuperComputers Inc?
A telephone company, Opus, offers calls to Biddelonia for a connection fee of $14, and $1per minute
thereafter. Its rival, Belecom, offers calls for $2 per minute (no connection fee) to the same country.
a Compare the cost of a 10 minute call to Biddelonia using each company.
b At what point would it be cheaper to use Opus?
It costs you $6 to get into a taxi (the flagfall), and $1.50 per kilometre if you use PinkCabs, while
NoTop taxis charge $8 flagfall, and $1.20 per kilometre.
a How much would it cost with each company to travel 15 km in one of its cabs?
b When would it cost the same to use both companies?
Medirank, a health insurance company, charges $860 per year (for a single person), and requires
customers to pay the first $100 of any hospital visit. HAB, on the other hand, charges an annual fee
of $560 and requires its members to pay the first $150 of any hospital visit. Determine the number of
hospital visits in a year for which the cost of health services is the same for either company.
Nifty is a car hire firm that charges insurance of $135, and $50 per day car hire. A competitor, Savus,
simply charges $65 per day and offers free insurance. You are planning a holiday and would prefer to
use Savus. Under what conditions (days hired) could you justify this choice?
practical applications
of linear functions
1 Step functions
12e
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
inTeraCTiViTY
int-0804
linear modelling
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Number of hours
Worked example 14
A telephone call is charged at 75c for the first minute and 25c per minute after that. Draw a graph
of the cost of the telephone call.
1
draW
Think
3.00
2.75
2.50
2.25
2.00
1.75
1.50
1.25
1.00
0.75
0.50
0.25
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Time (min)
409
2 Conversion graphs
A conversion graph is a linear function that shows a conversion between one quantity and another. A
common application of a conversion graph is to convert between currencies.
Worked example 15
The conversion graph below shows the currency exchange rate between Australian dollars (A$)
and US dollars (US$) on a particular day. (We say on a particular day as currency exchange
rates change constantly by small amounts.)
a How many Australian dollars are needed to buy US$50?
b How many US dollars will A$20 buy?
Conversion between US$ and A$
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
10
20
30
40 50 60 70 80
Australian dollars (A$)
Think
90
100
WriTe
As we saw in chapter 1 a linear function can be used to show the growth of an investment over a period
of time.
Worked example 16
A sum of $5000 is invested at 6% p.a. simple interest. Draw a graph of the interest earned against
the length of the investment.
Think
410
WriTe
I = Prn
= $5000 0.06 1
= $300
I = Prn
= $5000 0.06 2
= $600
3500
Interest in $
3000
2500
2000
1500
1000
500
0
5
6
Years
10
In many cases when looking at representing a practical situation there are physical limitations on the
function.
For example, consider the case earlier when we considered the preschool staging a concert. The
equation was C = 80 + 3n. In such an example negative values of n would have no meaning. There would
also be maximum values for n when you consider the maximum number of students that could attend;
that is, there is a finite number of people who can attend.
exercise 12e
1 We14 The cost of a bus fare is $1.20 for one section and 40c per section thereafter. Show this in a
step graph.
2 The cost of posting a parcel is shown in the table below.
Mass
Cost
500 g or less
$2.50
500 g to 2 kg
$3.75
Over 2 kg
$5.50
28 g
Algeria
15 g
Argentina
48 g
Poland
126 g
Uganda
445 g
Lithuania
320 g
Germany
200 g
Chile
150 g
Netherlands
50 g
Afghanistan
103 g
Iraq
10.00
Charge ($)
Weight
12.00
8.00
6.00
4.00
2.00
0 50 125
250
Mass (g)
500
411
5 Look at the information in the following table on Air Mail charges for large letters to the Asia/Pacific
zone.
Air Mail charges for
Asia/Pacific zone
8.00
7.00
Air Mail
charge
0 up to 50 g
$1.20
Over 50 g up to 125 g
$2.40
$3.60
$7.20
6.00
Charge ($)
Weight
5.00
4.00
3.00
2.00
1.00
0
250
Mass (grams)
500
a Copy and complete the step graph for Air Mail charges for posting large letters to the Asia/Pacific
region.
b What is the Air Mail cost to send a 75 g letter to Indonesia?
c What is the Air Mail cost to send a 460 g letter to New Zealand?
6 We15 The exchange rate between Australian dollars (A$) and Japanese yen () for a particular day is
9000
8000
Japanese yen ()
7000
6000
5000
4000
3000
2000
1000
0
10
20
30
40 50 60 70 80
Australian dollars (A$)
90 100
7 mC This graph shows the conversion of Australian dollars (A$) to US dollars (US$).
80
75
70
65
60
55
50
US$ 45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
10 20
30
40 50 60
A$
70 80
90 100
On coming home from a holiday in the United States of America, Robert had US$60 left. If he
then wants to convert this to Australian dollars, how much should he receive?
a $48
B $60
C $75
d $80
8 We16 Hayley invests $2000 at 8% p.a. simple interest. Draw the graph of the value of Hayleys
dollars and m is the weight of the parcel in kilograms. The maximum cost of sending the parcel is set at
$7.20.
a Draw a graph of the cost against weight.
b Explain why a negative value for m and C are both unreasonable.
c What is the maximum value of C?
d What is the smallest value of m to produce this maximum value of C?
This means that calls of less than 30 seconds are free. Draw the graph of cost versus call length for calls
of up to 150 seconds
12 A hotel charges the following rates for a one week holiday package:
1 person $1800
2 people $3300
each extra person $1200.
a Explain why the number of people on the holiday is a discrete variable.
b Find the cost for:
i 1 person
ii 2 people
iii 3 people
iv 5 people
v 10 people.
c As the data is discrete the cost is graphed using only a dot on each point. Graph the cost of the
holiday for up to 10 people.
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 12.2
doc-10342
413
Summary
Graphing linear
functions
A function is a rule for calculation that involves an independent variable and a dependent variable.
If the function is a straight line when graphed, then the function is called a linear function.
The independent variable is shown on the horizontal axis and the dependent variable on the vertical
axis.
The function can be graphed by drawing a table of values and then plotting the points generated,
joining them with a straight line.
Gradient and
y-intercept
The gradient is the increase in the dependent variable per one unit increase in the independent
variable.
The gradient (m) can be found using the formula
vertical change in position
.
m=
horizontal change in position
If the function is decreasing, then the gradient will be negative.
The intercept on the vertical axis gives the value of the dependent variable when the independent
variable is equal to zero.
A function is written in the form:
y = mx + b
where m equals the gradient and b equals the y-intercept.
The gradient and the y-intercept can be used to help draw the graph of a function.
Simultaneous
equations
The point of intersection of two linear functions gives the point where both functions hold true
simultaneously.
This is known as solving simultaneous equations.
practical applications
of linear functions
A step function is where the dependent variable increases in steps rather than a continuous gradual
increase.
A conversion graph is a linear function that converts one quantity to another.
Linear functions can be used in many practical situations. However, in those practical cases there
may be limitations on the values that one or both of the variables can take.
414
Chapter review
1 Look at the linear function drawn below.
m U lTip l e
C ho iC e
2
x
1
2
d 2
B 1
d 6
3 For which of the functions drawn below is the gradient the greatest?
y
y
a
B
a y= x1
B y=
+1
C y=1
d y=
1
x
2
1
x
2
2
S ho rT
a n S W er
1 The table below shows the labour charge for working on a motor vehicle.
Hours (h)
Cost (C )
55
80
105
130
155
1
x
y
3
x
3
415
4 The table below shows the profit or loss that would be made from a cake stall given the number of
cakes sold.
Number
Profit
20
30
40
20
60
70
80
120
100
170
context.
5 For each of the linear functions below, state the gradient and the y-intercept.
3
a y = 3x 2
b y = 4x + 7
c y=5x
b y = 6 3x
c y = 2x + 3
7 Use the graphs below, showing the given simultaneous equations, to write down the point of
intersection of the graphs and, hence, the solution of the simultaneous equations.
a x + 3y = 6
b 3x + 2y = 12
y = 2x 5
2y = 3x
y
3
2
4 2 0
2
4
6
416
6
5
4
3
2
1
2 10
2
3
4
5
c y = 10 2x
y = 8 2x
y = 4x + 6
y=2
b The perimeter of the rectangle is 40 cm. This can be represented by a linear function. On the same
set of axes draw this function. (Hint: Use the perimeter formula.)
c Use the point of intersection of your two functions to find the length and the width of the
rectangle.
10 The table below shows the cost per minute of a long distance telephone call.
Distance of call
Less than 150 km
150 km750 km
Over 750 km
x
y
2
1
3
3
4
5
Plot the points and draw the graph of the linear function.
What is the gradient of the function?
What is the y-intercept?
Write the equation of this function.
On the same axes, draw the graph of y = 5 2x.
Write the solution to the pair of simultaneous equations represented on your diagram.
2 a An equation is known to have a gradient of 2 and a y-intercept of 0. What is the equation of this
function?
b A second graph has an equation y = 3x 5. What is the gradient and y-intercept of this function?
c Find the point of intersection of the two graphs.
a
b
c
d
e
f
diGiTal doC
Test Yourself
doc-10343
Chapter 12
417
ICT activities
12a
diGiTal doCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1531): Graph paper (page 393)
GCprogram Casio (doc-1525): Linear (page 393)
GCprogram TI (doc-1526): Linear (page 393)
GCprogram Casio (doc-1527): Myrule (page 393)
GCprogram TI (doc-1528): Myrule (page 393)
12B
diGiTal doCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1530): Gradient (page 398)
Spreadsheet (doc-1531): Graph paper (page 398)
12C
diGiTal doCS
Spreadsheet (doc-1532): Equation of a straight line (page 403)
Spreadsheet (doc-1533): Linear graphs (page 403)
Spreadsheet (doc-1534): Graph paper (page 403)
WorkSHEET 12.1 (doc-10341): Draw graphs of linear functions.
(page 404)
418
12d
Simultaneous equations
diGiTal doC
Spreadsheet (doc-1539): Simultaneous equations (page 408)
12e
diGiTal doC
WorkSHEET 12.2 (doc-10342): Apply your knowledge of linear
relationships to problems. (page 413)
inTeraCTiViTY
int-0804: Consolidate your understanding of linear modelling.
(page 409)
Chapter review
diGiTal doC
Test Yourself Chapter 12 (doc-10343): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 417)
Answers CHAPTER 12
modellinG linear
relaTionShipS
exercise 12a
M
500
400
300
200
100
0
11
1
8
0
5
1
2
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2
3
4 y = 3x 5
5
(5000, 250)
0 00 00 00 00 00 P
20 40 60 80 10 0
f
Y = 80A
y
2
1
x
0
21
1 1 2 3 4 5
2
3
4
5 y = x 5
6
7
90 000
80 000
70 000
60 000
50 000
40 000
30 000
20 000
10 000
0
(500, 40 000)
0 00 00 00 00 00 A
2 4 6 8 10
3 2 1
y=x+4
1 2 3
x
y
y
10
8
6
4
2
14
x
y
y
6
4
2
y
y
3
2
1
4 y = 5x + 4
3
2
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2
1
3
0
0
1
3
2
6
y = 3x
2
7
y
3
2
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2
3 y = 2x 3
1
5
0
3
1
1
2
1
y
2
1
x
0
21
1 1 2 3 4
2
3 y = x 4
4
10
10
14
14
y = 5x
y = 7x
11
y
6
4
2
3210 1 2 3 x
4 y = 4x 3
6
8
10
12
y
3 y=x+2
2
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2
3
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2
3
2 4 6
x
321 01 2 3
4
6
g
5 a
y=x+6
x
0
321
2 1 2 3
4
6
8
10
y
y
3 y=x1
2
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2
3
6 4 2
4
8
6
4
2
y
6
4
2 y = 4x + 1
321 01 2 3 x
4
6
y
3
2
1 y = 2x
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2
3
2
y
6
5
4
3
2
1
x
y
2 a $400.00
b $475.00
3
Y
4 a
y
8
7
6
5
4 y = 2x + 4
3
2
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
419
y
8
7
6
5
4
3 y = 3x + 2
2
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2
3
4
10
2
11
y
2
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2 y = 2x 2
3
4
5
6
14
10
y
3
2 y = 6x + 2
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2
3
420
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 d
2
1.8
1.6
1.4
1.2
1
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
(10, 2)
(20, 700)
600
500
400
300
200
100
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 910
Years
600
500
400
300
200
100
0
(60, 600)
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45
Number of households
b 300
c This is the fixed cost.
18 a
10
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Hours worked
7000
6000
5000
4000
3000
2000
1000
0
1000
2000
(1000, 6150)
8
6
4
2
0
0 0 0 0 0
20 40 60 80 100
Number of rolls of film
20
15
10
5
0
exercise 12B
1 2 3 4
Time (hrs)
1 a 2
b 16
c 3
d 0.5
2 D
3 a
c $17.50
14 a C = 60 + 8m
b Cost ($)
76
68
60
C = 1.5t
2 3 4 5
Time (hours)
400
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
(1000, 360)
0 00 00 00 00 00
2 4 6 8 10
No. of newspapers delivered
b 0.3
c 60
4 a
1 2 Time (min)
(60, 90)
b 5 hours
Payment ($)
c $100
15 a Piecework
c
P
d 11 minutes
b P = 32 + 0.1n
150
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 t
7 a $25.50
b $67.50
8
d
160
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
700
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
50
100
100
(200, 300)
C
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
800
13 a C = 2.5 + 5t
b
C
y
8
7
6
5
4
3
2 y = 3x + 2
1
x
0
321
1 1 2 3
2
3
4
900
Profit ($)
16 $960
17 a
Profit ($)
12
C = 4 + 1.5d
(60, 94)
C
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
Height (m)
Distance (km)
Income ($)
d = 15t
50
(10, 150)
attending
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 910 t
d $197
500
1000
No. of pamphlets
n
1500
5 a
11
(2, 6)
y = 5x 4
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
54321
1 1 2 3 4 5
2
3
4
5
7 a
b
c
8 a
b
9 a
b
10 a
b
11
13
right.
y = 12 x + 2
(2, 3)
the origin.
5 a
b Positive
14 a 3
b 10
15 a y = 3x + 4
b y = x 4
c 2y = 2 x
16 The lines are parallel.
y = 34 x 1
(4, 2)
17 a
exercise 12d
1 a (2, 1)
d (3, 2)
(3, 1)
y = 32x 4
2
2 3
exercise 12C
e Gradient = , y-intercept = 1
3
2
f Gradient = , y-intercept = 3
(1, 1)
1
1 2
(1, 1)
3 a
y
1
b (2, 5)
5 a, 2x + 2y = 22
10
b
y = 4 3x
7 a
x
0
108642
2 2 4 6 8 10
4
6
8
y = x 5 10
(1, 3)
x
2
y = 6 3x
y
1 12
x
3
(1, 5)
700
600
500
400
300
200
100
y = 2x 3
y = 2x + 1
(1, 3)
y
4
y = 12 x + 4
8
2
(1, 3)
t + s = 750
t
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80
y = 3x 6
8
6
4
2
12
y
4
3
y = 2x 3
0
10864 2 2 4 6 8 10 x
4
6
y=7x
8
10
10
8
6
4
2
17
300
y = 13x
y
Simultaneous equations
b (1, 1)
c (4, 5)
e (0, 4)
f (2, 1)
g (2, 4)
h (3 , 1)
i (1 3 , 2 )
2
2
j (0.5, 1.5)
2 a (3, 5)
b (2, 4)
c (5, 7)
d (2, 5)
e (5, 1)
f (4, 7)
3 4 kg of apples and 5 kg of bananas
4 a
y
y = 2x +1
1
2
and 2
b The lines are perpendicular.
4
3
14 c = 10H + 5
(2, 1)
2
25
1
2
c y= x1
y = 5x
2
17
12
(1, 5)
Gradient = 5, y-intercept = 4
Gradient = 1500, vertical intercept = 200
There is a $200 delivery charge.
The generator costs an extra
$1500 per day.
Gradient = 8, vertical intercept = 60
There is a $60 appearance charge.
The singing telegram costs $8 per minute.
Answers will vary.
Lines with the same gradient are
parallel.
Answers will vary.
Lines with zero gradient are horizontal.
Answers will vary.
Vertical lines have no horizontal change
in position. This causes the gradient
to be a fraction over zero which is
undefined.
c
6 a
b
c
8 C
9 C
10 Some possible answers are:
a y = 2x + 1
b y = 2x + 1
c y = 3x + 5
d y = 6x
e y = 2x 1
f y=6
g y = 2x 1
E + M = 135
421
Fare ($)
2 3 4
Sections
6.00
5.50
5.00
4.50
4.00
3.50
3.00
2.50
2.00
1.50
1.00
0.50
150
Cost (cents)
Cost ($)
35
30
$1.80
$5.40
$5.40
$3.60
b $1.80
e $10.80
h $5.40
c $1.80
f $10.80
i $1.80
6 a
30 60 90120150
whole number.
$1800
$3300
$4500
$6900
$12 900
b i
ii
iii
iv
v
c
5.00
4.00
3.00
2.00
1.00
0 50 125 250 375 500
Mass (grams)
c $7.20
ii 6750
iii 4050
ii $90
iii $30
ii 180 000
iv profit of A$45.45
14000
12000
10000
8000
6000
4000
2000
0
4
6
Time (years)
(1, 3)
y = 12 x + 3
(2, 4)
3
6
0
8
4
6
Number of people
7 a (3, 1)
b (2, 3)
8 a x = 2, y = 7
b x = 4, y = 7
c x = 4, y = 2
9 a, w
b 20
2 B
4 B
c
300
250
200
150
100
50
0
10
15
ShorT anSWer
y
6
ChapTer reVieW
1 a
1
2
y = 6 3x
1 C
3 D
2000
0
1
mUlTiple ChoiCe
4000
y y = 2x 1
6.00
b $2.40
6 a i 900
b i $15
c i 90
iii 4000
7 C
8
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
30 60 90 t (min)
11
4 8 12 16 20
Number of calls
Investment ($)
400
300
200
100
0
100
25
422
c Gradient = 1, y-intercept = 3
4 a
500
50
40
1
2
b Gradient = , y-intercept = 2
100
8 12 16 20 k (km)
200
4 a
d
g
j
5 a
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Weight (kg)
b $56
3 a Gradient = 2, y-intercept = 1
2.80
2.40
2.00
1.60
1.20
0.80
1
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Profit ($)
hire.
2 a C ($)
9 a
Cost ($)
b $230
w = l 10
10
5
0
l
5 10 15 20
2l + 2w = 40
01 2 3 45 67 8 h
c l = 15, w = 5
10
11
exTended reSponSe
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
1 a,
e
b
c
d
f
2 a
b
c
1200
NZ cents
1000
800
600
400
200
y = 2x 3
0
54321
1 1 2 3 4 5
2
3
4
5
y = 5 2x
0 00 00 00 00 00
2 4 6 8 10
Distance of call (km)
1400
y
5
4
3
2
1
2
3
y = 2x 3
(2, 1)
y = 2x
Gradient = 3, y-intercept = 5
x = 1, y = 2
100
0
Australian cents
423
ChaptEr 13
Calculating costs
Reading a mobile phone bill
Phone usage
Choosing the best mobile phone plan for your needs
Units of storage
Digital transfer rates
Random selection
Calculating costs
425
Regardless of whether you have a pre-paid (need to recharge) or post-paid (sent a bill each month)
phone, the way in which the charges are calculated are the same.
Usually the actual price of each varies based on the type of plan you have; however, the way in which
the costs are calculated is the same.
InvEstIgatE: Class discussion
Before we go any further we need to define some of the commonly used terms when dealing with
mobile phones. As a class discuss your understanding of the following terms and compare these to the
definitions on a phone companys website. Once you have a good understanding of each term create your
own glossary for this Focus Study by writing a definition for each term that you will refer to throughout
this chapter.
Pre-paid plan
Post-paid plan
Cap plan
Connection fee (also called flag fall)
SMS
MMS
Standard call
International call
Voice mail
Excess usage
Recharge
Video calling
The above list is not exhaustive; remember to add new terms to your glossary as you come across them.
WorkEd ExamplE 1
thInk
1
WrItE
Cost = 22 35
= 770 100
= $7.70
WorkEd ExamplE 2
426
WrItE
Cost = 5 50
= 250 100
= $2.50
WorkEd ExamplE 3
thInk
WrItE
Cost = 15 55
= 825 100
= $8.25
When calculating the cost of phone calls charges are often either in 1 minute or 30 second blocks. Costs
are rounded up to the nearest minute or nearest 30 seconds respectively. For example: a call of 2minutes
and 28 seconds would be charged either as 3 minutes or as five 30-second blocks depending on the
details of the call plan, although this is not clearly written in most plans. It is always important to read
the fine print. As well as charging for the actual length of the call an additional fee called a connection
fee (or flag fall) is often charged. This is a cost used by the company for actually allowing the call to
pass over their network.
WorkEd ExamplE 4
WrItE
Number of minutes
charged = 4 minutes
Calculate 99 4 + 35 (cost
per minute no. of minutes
plus connection fee).
Call cost = 99 4 + 35
Exercise 13a
= $4.31
Calculating costs
427
5 Juans phone bill shows that his SMS messages for the month cost $24.15. He knows that he sent
62 standard SMS messages. Use the table below to calculate the total cost of all messages sent.
Standard SMS
Standard MMS
International SMS
International MMS
8 WE3 Excess data usage on Weis phone plan is charged at 50c/MB. He has gone over his limit by
standard calls at 98c per minute or part thereof plus 42c flag fall. How much did Renas call cost?
12 Brrrring Bring Phone company charges mobile calls as per the details in the table below:
13 A section of Joss phone bill is shown below. His mobile service is provided by the RingMYBell
phone company, which charges standard calls at 98c per minute plus 42c flag fall.
Date
23/05
23/05
23/05
23/05
25/05
25/05
25/05
28/05
28/05
Day
Wed
Wed
Wed
Wed
Fri
Fri
Fri
Mon
Mon
Charge Type
Mobile Call Charges
Mobile Call Charges
Mobile Call Charges
Mobile Call Charges
Mobile Call Charges
Mobile Call Charges
Mobile Call Charges
Mobile Call Charges
Mobile Call Charges
Origin
Miller
Lurnea
Moorebank
Crossroads
Chippendale
Moorebank
Moorebank
World Square
Haymarket
Time
9:12
9:16
14:21
16:48
13:27
17:19
17:21
15:13
15:14
Destination
Liverpool
Mobile
Mobile
Nowra
Liverpool
Mobile
Mobile
Sydney
Melbourne
min:sec
0:01:00
0:18:00
0:01:00
0:07:00
0:02:00
0:01:00
0:10:00
0:01:00
0:04:00
of $7.42. The phone company Bryce uses charges standard calls at 95c per minute plus 50c connection
fee and standard SMS at 23c per 160 characters.
a What is the total amount of credit Bryce has available after he recharges his phone?
b On Saturday Bryce is organising to meet his friends to go to the movies. He contacts his friends
using 2 phone calls, one lasting 5 minutes 42 seconds and the other 2 minutes 6 seconds. In
addition Bryce sent 3 SMS, each of less than 160 characters. How much credit does he have
remaining on his phone when he completes these calls?
428
15 Juan made a total of 89 phone calls, each of less than one minute duration, in a one month period. His
mobile service is provided by the RingMYBell phone company which charges standard calls at 98c per
minute plus 42c flag fall. Calculate the total cost of these calls.
16 Paul Power is with the Sunny Telephone Company. A list of their charges appears below:
Voicemail
Standard SMS
Standard MMS
50c
International SMS
International MMS
Premium SMS
Time
1730
1800
2200
2314
0610
0612
0618
0715
2022
Number
XXX
XXX
XXX
Special
9-Feb
10-Feb
11:28
17:00
1800XXX
13XXX
XXX
XXX
XXX
XXX
Destination
Other mobile
Sunny mobile
Other mobile
DIV-VoiceMail
Haymarket
Sydney
VoiceMail
Sunny mobile
Other mobile
Description
Std national call
Free Sunny to Sunny
Std national call
Voicemail Deposit
Std national call
Std national call
Retrieval
Free Sunny to Sunny
Std national call
min:sec Amount
05:30
23:00
00:30
02:30
01:00
01:30
03:00
10:30
4:30
Sub-total
Special
Special
1800 Number
13 Number
16:00
05:30
Sub-total
SMS
8-Feb
9-Feb
10-Feb
MMS
8-Feb
8-Feb
9-Feb
10-Feb
Quantity
72
31
86
Sub-total
National SMS
National SMS
National SMS
1757
2311
0803
1854
XXX
XXX
XXX
XXX
Other Mobile
Sunny mobile
Other Mobile
Other Mobile
Picture message
Picture message
Picture message
Picture message
Sub-total
(continued)
ChaptEr 13 Mathematics and communication
429
Time
Number
20:03
20:03
20:03
20:03
Destination
Description
min:sec
Amount
The amount column has been left blank. Use the charge information to answer the following
questions:
a Calculate the cost of all SMS.
b Calculate the cost of all MMS.
c Calculate the total cost of all phone calls. Dont forget to include those listed as Special.
d Calculate the cost of the premium SMS listed under Other.
e What is the total cost of all charges to this phone?
reading a mobile
phone bill
13B
dIgItal doC
doc-10349
Bills
For this activity you will need copies of at least 3 different mobile
bills, preferably from different phone companies. Although all bills
contain the same basic information, the way in which that information
is displayed varies.
Use the different bills provided on the eBookPLUS or bills that you
have obtained to answer the following questions.
InvEstIgatIon
Answer questions 120 for each of the 3 phone bills, giving 60 answers in all.
1 What phone company is the bill for?
2 What was the issue date of the bill?
3 When is the bill due to be paid?
4 What methods of payment are available for this bill?
5 What is the tax invoice number? Why might you need it?
6 What is a customer number and what can you use it for?
7 Does the bill show the phone plan and details? If so what are they?
8 What is the invoice period for the bill?
9 How many phone calls were made during the billing period?
10 What was the total duration of the calls made?
11 On average how many calls were made per day?
12 What was the average length and cost of each call made?
13 How many SMS and MMS were made during the billing period?
14 What is the cost of an SMS on this phone plan?
15 What is the cost of an MMS on this phone plan?
16 Are calls charged in one minute or 30 second blocks of time? What is the cost and explain how you
calculated this.
17 How much data was used in total?
18 What was the value of the inclusions on the plan calls, SMS, MMS, data?
19 What is the cost of the recurring or advance charges on the bill? What do you think these costs mean?
20 What other observations can you make about this bill?
Based on your study of the 3 different phone bills, which did you find easiest to read and understand?
Explain why.
430
Once you have completed the above investigation, visit some of the phone companies websites and
see if they have a guide on reading their mobile phone bills.
What new information, if any, did you find?
Exercise 13B
Calls/SMS/MMS
$200 included
value*
Data
200 MB mobile
internet data
included
Specials
Unlimited social
media access
National calls
Standard SMS
Standard MMS
Special
$50
Minimum spend
$50 per month
Minimum cost over
24 months is $1200
$450 included
value*
750 MB mobile
internet data
included
Unlimited social
media access
Excess data
National calls
Standard SMS
Standard MMS
Special
$60
Minimum spend
$60 per month
Minimum cost over
24 months is $1440
$750 included
value*
1 GB mobile
internet data
included
Unlimited social
media access
Excess data
National calls
Standard SMS
Standard MMS
Special
$80
Minimum spend
$80 per month
Minimum cost over
24 months is $1920
$900 included
value*
1.5 GB mobile
internet data
included
Unlimited social
media access
Excess data
National calls
Standard SMS
Standard MMS
Special
$99
Minimum spend
$99 per month
Minimum cost over
24 months is $2376
Unlimited
standard national
voice calls, SMS
and MMS within
Australia
3 GB
Unlimited social
media access
Excess data
National calls
Standard SMS
Standard MMS
Special
Excess data
Charges
99c/min + 40c flagfall
30c National, 60c
International
50c National, 75c
International
1300/1800 numbers
90c + 40c flagfall
60c/MB
99c/min + 40c flagfall
30c National, 60c
International
50c National, 75c
International
1300/1800 numbers
90c + 40c flagfall
60c/MB
90c/min + 40c flagfall
25c National, 50c
International
40c National, 70c
International
1300/1800 numbers
90c + 40c flagfall
60c/MB
80c/min + 40c flagfall
15c National, 40c
International
50c National, 75c
International
1300/1800 numbers
90c + 40c flagfall
60c/MB
included
45c International
60c International
1300/1800 numbers
80c + 40c flagfall
50c/MB
*National voice calls to Australian GSM mobiles, SMS and MMS within Australia only included. Does not include call to premium services
1800/13 etc.
ChaptEr 13 Mathematics and communication
431
1 All contracts have the same length. What is the length of each contract?
2 Explain how the minimum cost over this period is calculated.
3 What is the cost of a 2 minute 15 second call using:
a a $30 plan?
b a $50 plan?
c a $80 plan?
4 Why doesnt the $99 plan list the cost of national SMS and MMS?
5 Which plan has the cheapest international SMS?
6 What is the cost of a standard SMS on the $60 plan?
7 What is the cost of a standard MMS on the $30 plan?
8 What calls need to be paid for under the $99 plan?
9 What will be the total monthly bill for a person on the $99 plan if they send 12 international SMS,
For this investigation you will need to collect a mobile phone rate plan information from 3 different
Australian providers. Ensure you get details for both pre-paid and post-paid plans for personal
users only.
1 Select a post-paid plan from each company with a similar monthly cost.
a Compare the cost of standard national calls, SMS and MMS for each company.
b Compare the amount of data included.
c Compare the hidden costs, i.e. the excess charges or costs for special services.
d Compare and contrast the free options/inclusions in each plan.
e What options are given for bill payments for each company? Are there costs involved for paying your
bill in cash, by credit card, etc?
f Which plan do you think offers the best value for money? Use your answers to the previous questions
to justify your choice.
2 Select two different pre-paid plans from each company.
a State the inclusions charges for both of these; i.e. long credit expiry, lots of texts etc.
b Do the benefits for each plan change based on the value of the recharge?
13C
phone usage
One of the factors used to help decide which mobile plan is most appropriate is how and when the
phone is used. One way of comparing mobile phone usage is to display the data graphically, as shown in
chapter 5, Displaying single data sets. This makes the data easy to read and interpret. You can also use
graphs to display call costs similar to those used in chapter 12, Modelling linear relationships.
432
Exercise 13C
phone usage
Call cost
over a two month period. Call times are rounded up to the nearest EVEN hour.
Time of day
Midnight
2:00 am
4:00 am
6:00 am
8:00 am
10:00 am
Noon
2:00 pm
4:00 pm
6:00 pm
8:00 pm
10:00 pm
a
b
c
d
3 The table below shows the costs of a monthly mobile phone bill.
Item
Cost ($)
Percentage of total bill
Mobile calls
310
SMS
80
MMS
10
Data charges
50
Total cost of bill
450
Note: The total cost of the bill shown above is before plan bonuses have been applied.
ChaptEr 13 Mathematics and communication
433
a Calculate the percentage of the total bill represented by each of the previously listed items. Round
chart.
c Describe the pattern of usage shown by this graph.
For questions 4 and 5 you will need copies of the phone bills used earlier.
4 Use three monthly mobile phone bills from the same person and on the same plan to
a Complete the frequency table below:
dIgItal doC
doc-10349
Bills
Time of day
Midnight
2:00 am
4:00 am
6:00 am
8:00 am
10:00 am
Noon
2:00 pm
4:00 pm
6:00 pm
8:00 pm
10:00 pm
Number of calls
made
month 1
Number of calls
made
month 2
Number of calls
made
month 3
Number of calls
made
total
b On the same pie chart show the number of calls made for each of the three months listed. Use
c
d
e
f
Excel chart wizard to assist you. Dont forget you will need to make sure you use different
coloured lines for each month and a legend for the chart.
Compare and contrast the usage for each month shown.
Display the total number of calls made for the three month period on a separate radar chart
Describe the pattern of calls shown on your radar chart.
Compare and contrast the total number of calls made with the individual months.
Item
Cost ($)
Mobile calls
SMS
MMS
Data charges
Total cost of bill
Note: The total cost of the bill shown above is before plan bonuses have been applied. You may need to do
some calculations if the bill shows that plan bonuses have already been applied.
b Construct a pie chart to represent the data for each month. Use Excel chart wizard to assist you in
Deciding which phone plan to use is an important choice as the wrong decision could have a
big impact on your finances. The questions below should assist you in deciding on the best
plan for you by making the costs visible. It is important to remember that with a pre-paid
plan you buy the phone outright and then need to recharge when your credit runs out
(expires). There are several different plan options for a pre-paid mobile;
some have long expiry for your credit, some give you free text messages
and others allow only limited downloads before you have to recharge. The
availability of the actual telephones themselves may be restricted and those
available may not have all the latest features. It may be possible to buy the latest
handset outright and then just buy a pre-paid sim card to use with the phone. Buying
the latest phone outright can be expensive.
A post-paid phone requires signing a contract, which is basically a form of applying for
credit. For these contracts you pay an agreed amount each month and in return have set limits
on included calls (either by cost or minutes), downloads and messages. Plans are referred to as having a
cap. The purpose of the cap concept is to allow you to be able to predict your monthly phone bill and
this should keep costs lower; however, if you exceed the limits within your cap your bill often increases
dramatically. Rates for excess call and data charges are often much higher once your cap is exceeded.
Another factor to consider when choosing your plan is the phone that comes with the plan and
whether you are charged extra per month for the particular phone. This is called a handset cost and
is added to the price of your plan each month. It may be possible to pay out the handset cost at the
beginning of the plan. Contracts usually run for 24 months when packaged with a new handset (phone);
however, shorter contracts are available, especially if you are not upgrading or replacing the handset. It
is also possible to find a contract where you can bring your existing phone, either one you have bought
outright or by changing your pre-paid plan to a post-paid plan.
Points to consider when selecting a phone plan include:
Do you already have a phone or do you want a new phone included in your plan?
How many calls do you make each month?
What time of day do you make calls? Are there different charges for peak and off-peak calls? If so,
what hours are defined as peak and off-peak?
How many SMS/MMS do you send each month?
How long do you usually spend on a call?
What is the data allowance?
What are the excess usage charges if you go over the limit?
What charges are not included within the plan (for example, international calls)?
Which phone company are your friends and/or family with? Does the company that most of them are
with offer deals or discounts, such as free calls or texts when calling/texting other mobiles from their
company?
What is the cost of ending your contract early?
How flexible is the plan? Can you change to another plan? If so what are the costs, if any, involved?
What are the phone insurance costs in case your phone is lost or stolen?
Does the company have good service in the area where you live, work, attend school?
Are there any hidden costs? Check the fine print.
InvEstIgatIon
Often clients ask mobile phone providers to recommend the best plan for them based on their usage
details. Based on your research in the previous investigation on reading mobile phone plans, consider
the needs of each of the following users and make recommendations about which plan would be the
most suitable for them. (Note: all clients are happy with their current phone.) Each recommendation
435
should include a summary of the users needs, clearly highlighting the overall cost of the plan, listing all
inclusions and giving a justification as to why this is the most appropriate plan.
Client 1: A university student who uses her mobile to keep in touch with friends via SMS and Facebook,
downloads podcasts of lectures, and plays games online when travelling to and from home. She also uses
internet banking.
Monthly usage summary:
Phone calls: 600 minutes
SMS: 350
MMS: 120
Internet usage: 3000 MB
Client 2: A mature gentlemen who uses his mobile for all calls; he doesnt have a home phone and
checks his email online when travelling to work.
Monthly usage summary:
Phone calls: 800 minutes
SMS: 150
MMS: 10
Internet usage: 500 MB
Client 3: A mum who uses her mobile phone for calls and text messages to keep in touch with her
children and her husband.
Monthly usage summary:
Phone calls: 400 minutes
SMS: 160
MMS: 0
Internet usage: 0 MB
dIgItal doC
WorkSHEET 13.1
doc-10350
Now reconsider each of your above recommendations if all the clients would like to package a new phone
with their plan.
Units of storage
Adding a third bit doubles the memory again as there are now eight states that the memory can be
in. These states are represented by the following numbers: 000, 001, 010, 011, 100, 101, 110, 111.
As we are working with only two digits, 0 and 1, we can say that we are working in base 2,
which is also known as binary.
With every increase of one extra digit the amount of memory doubles.
1 bit = 21 = 2 states
2 bits = 22 = 4 states
3 bits = 23 = 8 states
4 bits = 24 = 16 states and so on..... up to
8 bits = 28 = 256 states
The memory in digital devices is generally measured in bytes. There are 8 bits in a byte, meaning that
each byte can be in 256 states (28).
The number of bytes in a computers memory continues to build in powers of 2.
1 kilobyte = 210 = 1024 bytes.
So as you can see the units that are used to measure digital storage vary from metric measures as the
term kilo in metric measure represents exactly 1000.
Other common measures of digital storage are
1 megabyte = 220 = 1 048 576 bytes
1 gigabyte = 230 = 1 073 741 824 bytes
1 terabyte = 240 = 1 099 511 627 776 bytes.
WorkEd ExamplE 5
WrItE
The common sizes and terms used for electronic data are:
Bit
Megabyte
Byte
Gigabyte
Kilobyte
Terabyte.
List the correct standard symbol used to denote each of the above measures.
When converting between units of memory it can be useful to use powers of 2.
WorkEd ExamplE 6
WrItE
2048 MB = 211 MB
= 211 220
= 231 bytes
= 231 230 GB
= 2 GB
437
1024
Gigabytes (GB)
1024
1024
Megabytes (MB)
1024
1024
Kilobytes (KB)
WorkEd ExamplE 7
WrItE
Exercise 13E
Units of storage
21 = 22 = 23 = 24 = 25 = 26 = 27 = 28 = 29 = 210 =
2 WE5 A computer is advertised as having a 500 gigabyte hard drive. Convert this to bytes.
3 Convert each of the following to bytes:
a 8 MB
b 4 GB
e 1.2 TB
f 2.8 MB
c 2 TB
g 6.2 MB
d 0.5 GB
h 0.05 TB
c 512 GB to TB
c 0.8 TB to MB
c 8192 MB = ___ GB
f 0.15 TB = ___ GB
5.3 MB of memory, estimate the memory of the MP3 player correct to the nearest GB.
12 Georgia is going on a 6 week European holiday. She estimates that she will take 100 photos per day.
In a class discussion identify the commonly used types of digital storage devices. Do the most
common devices come in a standard range of size? What are these? Convert these sizes to a common set
of units. By having these in common units we are then able to get a better feel for comparison of sizes. It
will also assist later on when we are calculating the number of photos, songs or other documents that can
be held on the device.
Have you noticed when you buy a device it mentions, for example, that it can hold 10 000 songs? Do
you think this is true? What may impact on this; for example, song length, etc?
13F
Do you ever hear, Hurry up, its my turn on the computer? If you are downloading data or copying files
from one device to another, can you tell someone how much longer it is going to take? Perhaps you just
sit and wait or possibly your computer tells you. Have you noticed that when the computer tells you how
long a particular operation will take that the time prediction can jump around a lot?
Sometimes a file may start out taking 39 minutes to download, but a few seconds later the time
has changed to, say, 3 minutes. Why does this happen? The size of the file being downloaded hasnt
changed. The answer is that the download rate may be changing. Does this rate only vary when
downloading from the web? What happens to the rate if you are just transferring from one device to
another? Consider copying music from a CD to your iTunes folder on your computer.
The transfer rate may be given as 56 kbs.
Notice the use of the lower case b. This is because the lower case b represents bits, hence kbs stands
for kilobits per second.
1 kilobit = 1024 bits
WorkEd ExamplE 8
A song is downloading from the Internet at 350 KB/s. The song uses a total of 5.3 MB of memory.
Calculate the amount of time it will take for the song to download.
thInk
WrItE
Generally upload speeds are much slower than download speeds. Uploading occurs when you send an
email or post something to the Internet.
WorkEd ExamplE 9
Gavin is posting an article to his website. The article is 17 MB and the upload speed is 2500 kbs.
Calculate the length of time that this article will take to upload.
thInk
WrItE
17 MB = 17 1024 1024
= 17 825 792 bits 8
= 142 606 336 1024 kilobits
= 139 264 kilobits
Exercise 13F
1 WE8 A song is downloading from the Internet at 350 KB/s. The song uses a total of 6.2 MB of
memory. Calculate the amount of time it will take for the song to download.
2 A television program is being downloaded from the Internet. The file size is given as 1 MB and the
download speed is 400 KB/s. Calculate the length of time that it will take to download the program.
ChaptEr 13 Mathematics and communication
439
3 Calculate the length of time for each of the following files to download given a download speed of
420KB/s.
a 2 MB
b 7.2 MB
c 548 MB
d 1.3 GB
4 WE9 Tanya is uploading a file to the Internet that uses 45 KB of memory. If Tanyas upload speed is
320 kbs calculate the time that it will take to upload the file.
5 Andrew has an Internet connection with a download speed of 900 KB/s. Calculate the size of a file that
download time of
a 30 sec
d 15 min 34 sec
b 1 min 45 sec
e 1 hr 27 min
c 5 min 7 sec
7 A file that is 2.3 MB takes 23 seconds to download. Calculate the download speed in KB/s.
8 Calculate the download speed of the following Internet connections given that
a A 3 MB file takes 15 seconds to download
b A 10.4 MB file takes 33 seconds to download
c A 1.2 GB file takes 15 minutes to download
d A 4.2 GB file takes 1 hour to download
9 Jenny has an Internet plan that allows her unlimited downloads at off-peak times. For Jenny this means
that she has unlimited downloads between 12 midnight and 10:00 am. When Jenny gets up at 7:30 am
she decides to download a movie. The file is 3 GB and the download speed is 360 KB/s. Will the
download be completed before Jennys unlimited download time expires?
10 Tom is downloading a song and his computer tells him that 2 minutes 30 seconds are remaining. The
13g
random selection
Ever use the shuffle option when playing music? Does it occasionally seem that some songs are played
more often than others? Theoretically all songs should have an equally likely chance of being played.
Mathematics, in particular probability, is applied to the selection of music played.
Use this simulation to investigate playing songs on shuffle mode. Remember this simulation is an
example of experimental probability.
InvEstIgatE: ipod music using shuffle mode
IntEraCtIvItY
int-0089
random number
generator
Your music device is based on computer technology, so it cant be purely random as we would see in
nature. The actual selection of songs is based on the use of a random number generator.
We can use the work we completed earlier on probability to calculate the likelihood of certain songs
being played.
440
WorkEd ExamplE 10
Ians iPod holds 10 000 songs and he has it on shuffle mode. He has a
favourite song which is one of 80 by his favourite band Aeroseat.
a What is the probability of Ians favourite song being played next?
b What is the probability that the next song played is by Aeroseat?
thInk
WrItE
a P(Favourite song) =
of 10 000.
b Aeroseat has 80 chances of being played out
of 10 000.
b P(Aeroseat) =
1
10 000
80
10 000
2
250
Also consider the work done earlier on the fundamental counting principle.
WorkEd ExamplE 11
Andy buys a new MP3 player and downloads 5 songs onto it. If the songs are played in random
order in how many ways can the songs be played without any one song being repeated?
thInk
WrItE
Exercise 13g
No. of arrangements = 5!
= 5 4 3 2 1 = 120
random selection
1 WE10 Ilas MP3 player holds 4000 songs and she has it on shuffle mode. One track on the iPod is a
stand up comedy routine, while 100 songs are by her favourite band The Caterpillars.
a What is the probability of the comedy routine being played next?
b What is the probability that the next song played is by The Caterpillars?
2 An iPod has 150 songs stored on it. Of these 15 songs are from the album 22 at 44
by John Elton. If the iPod is on shuffle mode what is the probability that the next
song played is from the album 22 at 44?
3 On Michaels MP3 player each song is classified by its genre. Of 4500 songs on the
player, 750 are classified as being of the metal genre. What is the probability that the
next song played is one of this genre?
4 Kim has an iPod with 3000 songs. The genres of her songs are
Rock 500
Pop 1000
Dubstep 50
Punk 800
Find the probability that the next song played is:
a rock
b metal
Metal 300
Soul 350
c not pop
5 Jaspers iPod has 3750 songs and they are categorised as 950 by male solo artists, 225 by female solo
to play these songs in random order, in how many ways can they be played without any song repeating?
7 Nguyen decides to play the album Brothers At Arms by Dyre Straights. This album has 12 songs.
Nguyen randomly plays the songs from this album. In how many different ways can they be played?
8 Beth has 1750 songs on her iPod. The iPod is left on shuffle mode and the last song she listened to was
called Boogie, Oogie, Oogie. The average song length on Beths iPod is 3 minutes 30 seconds.
a How many hours of listening time will it be before Beth can expect to hear Boogie, Oogie,
Oogie start to play again?
b Given that Beth listens to her iPod for 2 hours a day, how long will it be before she hears this song
again?
dIgItal doC
WorkSHEET 13.2
doc-10351
441
Summary
Calculating costs
Mobile phone plans can be either pre-paid, in which case you purchase credit, or post-paid where
you receive a bill.
Calls are charged according to a flag fall (to connect to the network) and then in 30 second or one
minute blocks.
You may be on a plan where you receive a lot more call value than you pay; however, you need to
be sure that you do not exceed any caps on calls or data. If you do it can become very expensive.
phone usage
Units of storage
Digital documents are transferred in rates that are given in kbs (kilobits per second) or KBs
(kilobytes per second).
Use your work on rates to calculate the time that it will take to transfer a file, the size of a file or
the transfer speed.
random selection
Probability can be used to calculate the chance of a certain song being played on an MP3 player in
shuffle mode.
The fundamental counting technique can be used to determine the number of different ways in
which tracks can be played without repetition.
442
Chapter review
1 Calculate the cost of 45 SMS messages sent at the standard rate of 25c per 160 characters.
2 If a standard SMS is charged at 30c per 160 characters, what is the total cost of sending two SMS if one
3
4
5
Call length
(min:sec)
00:30
01:00
01:30
02:00
02:30
03:00
03:30
04:00
04:30
05:00
Call cost
8 The frequency table below records the number of mobile phone calls made at different times of the day
over a two month period. The times are rounded up to the nearest EVEN hour.
Time of day
12 midnight
2:00 am
4:00 am
6:00 am
8:00 am
10:00 am
12 noon
2:00 pm
4:00 pm
6:00 pm
8:00 pm
10:00 pm
443
c 28
b 2048 MB = ___ GB
d 210
c 768 MB = ___ GB
12 A USB flash drive has a memory of 8 GB. If the drive is to be used to store photos with an average file
13
14
15
16
dIgItal doC
Test Yourself
doc-10345
Chapter 13
444
size of 2.8 MB, how many photos can be stored? Give your answer correct to the nearest 100 photos.
A song is downloading from the Internet at 360 KB/s. The song uses a total of 6.4 MB of memory.
Calculate the amount of time it will take for the song to download.
Calculate the size of a file that takes 4 minutes 30 seconds to download given an Internet download
speed of 720 KB/s.
A file that is 3.2 GB takes 1 hour to download. Calculate the average download speed.
There are 8000 songs on Roys MP3 player.
a Roy has one song that was recorded by his own band. If his iPod is on shuffle mode what is the
probability that the next song played is by Roys own band?
b There are 2500 songs by groups on Roys iPod. What is the probability that the next song played
is by a group?
c On his iPod Roy has 6 podcasts (one for each subject) that summarise work for his HSC. If he
plays these in random order in how many different ways is it possible for these to be played?
ICT activities
13B
dIgItal doC
Bills (doc-10349): Review the bills provided to assist you in answering
questions (page 430)
13C
phone usage
dIgItal doC
Bills (doc-10349): Review the bills provided to assist you in answering
questions (page 434)
13g
random selection
IntEraCtIvItY
int-0089: Random number generator (page 440)
dIgItal doC
WorkSHEET 13.2 (doc-10351): Apply your knowledge of
communication to problems (page 441)
Chapter review
dIgItal doC
Test Yourself Chapter 13 (doc 10345): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 444)
dIgItal doC
WorkSHEET 13.1 (doc-10350): Apply your knowledge of
communication to problems (page 436)
445
Answers CHAPTER 13
mathEmatICs and
CommUnICatIon
Exercise 13a
1
2
3
4
6
8
10
12
13
14
15
16
$5.75
$2.75
$613.80
90c
$9.75
$10
$11.49
a $3.44
c $11.50
$47.88
a $37.42
$124.60
a $47.25
c $41.16
e $114.30
c $3.95
d The cost is calculated on time periods
Calculating costs
5
7
9
11
b
d
23c
$27.25
$21.20
$6.30
$34.30
84c
1 a
10
0
6:00 pm
6:00 am
8:00 am
2:00 pm
10:00 am
Noon
3 a
Item
Mobile calls
SMS
MMS
Data charges
Total cost of bill
b
Cost ($)
310
80
10
50
450
Percentage
of total bill
69%
18%
2%
11%
Cost ($)
Exercise 13g
2 10
$1.25
SMS
1:00
$1.25
3 6
MMS
1:30
$2.15
Data charges
4 a 6
2:00
$2.15
2:30
$3.05
3:00
$3.05
3:30
$3.95
4:00
$3.95
4:30
$4.85
5:00
$4.85
1
1
2
3
4
5
Call length (minutes)
1
2
c 3
19
random selection
1
b 40
b 10
4
d 15
Units of storage
c 150
6 24
7 479 001 600
8 a 102 hours and 5 min
b 52 days
ChaptEr rEvIEW
$11.25
$1.50
15c
$6.75
a $2.34
b $3.78
c $8.10
d $15.30
6 a 2 years
b 1GB
c 75c
d $200
1
2
3
4
5
103
b 150
47
1 21 = 2, 22 = 4, 23 = 8, 24 = 16, 25 = 32,
5 a 75
Exercise 13E
b 3
Mobile calls
b 0.25 TB
d 2048 MB
f 153 GB
38seconds.
0:30
b 3481
1 18.14 sec
2 2.56 sec
3 a 4.88 sec
b 17.55 sec
c 22 min 16.1 sec
d 54 min 6 sec
4 1.125 sec
5 158.2 MB
6 a 21.1 MB
b 73.8 MB
c 215.9 MB
d 656.7 MB
e 3.58 GB
7 102.4 KB/s
8 a 204.8 KB/s
b 323 KB/s
c 1398 KB/s
d 1223.3 KB/s
9 Yes, it will take 2 hours 25 minutes
1 a 4000
Call cost
Exercise 13F
b 4 MB
phone usage
4:00 am
20
8:00 pm
b $2.00
d $26.40
446
4:00 pm
Call length
(min:sec)
b $27.18
4 4 TB
5 a 2 KB
c 0.5 TB
6 6144 KB
7 a 1228
c 838860
8 a 4 KB
c 8 GB
e 5324 KB
9 a 4096 MB
b 1280
10 a 16 384 M B
b 2400 songs
11 20 GB
12 a 1500
Call length
(min:sec)
Call cost
00:30
$0.55
01:00
$0.85
01:30
$1.15
02:00
$1.45
02:30
$1.75
03:00
$2.05
03:30
$2.35
04:00
$2.65
04:30
$2.95
05:00
$3.25
7 a
3
2
1
0
1
2
3
4
5
Call length (minutes)
c $2.65
8
10
0
4:00 pm
6:00 am
9 a 8
b 32
c 256
d 1024
10 3 355 443
11 a 262 144 G B
b 2 GB
c 0.75 GB
12 2900
13 18.2 sec
14 189.8 MB
15 932.1 KB/s
1
16 a 8000
5
b 16
c 720
8:00 am
2:00 pm
10:00 am
Noon
447
ICT activities
The cost of piracy
SEARCHLIGHT ID: PRO-0135
scenario
In this activity students are asked to estimate the cost of
video piracy each year in Australia and compare this to
the worldwide cost.
Video piracy is the illegal downloading and
reproduction of movies. If you have hired a DVD it is
likely that you will have seen an advertisement very
similar to the one here explaining video piracy.
Advertisements such as this often refer to piracy as
theft in the same way that pirates at sea would steal
from other boats and ships. This is because by copying
a video you are denying not just actors but all those
involved in the production of the movie payments such
as royalties.
448
Your task
1. Watch the introductory video.
process
dIgItal doC
pro-0135
projectsplUs
449
ChApTer 14
451
14A
Many of you may now be at the stage of thinking about buying your first car.
However, have you considered the actual cost of getting a car on the road before you even leave the
car yard? There are many decisions that need to be made.
Should I buy a new or used car?
What make of car should I buy?
Should I buy from a dealer or private sales?
How will I insure the vehicle?
In this section we will look at some of these decisions and what some of the hidden costs of
purchasing a car or motorcycle actually are.
The first decision that you will need to make is whether to buy a new or used vehicle. Obviously it
will be much cheaper to buy a used or second-hand car. This loss of value between a new car and a used
car is called depreciation. It is often said that the value of a car depreciates significantly as soon as it is
driven out of the car yard.
WorkeD exAmple 1
Think
car price.
b Write the savings as a percentage of the new
car price.
452
WriTe
= $9000
$9000
100%
$36 000
= 25%
b Percentage saving =
exercise 14A
the percentage decrease in the price of the motorbike. Give your answer correct to 2 decimal places.
4 Michael is starting a trucking business and can purchase a new 18-wheeler for $750 000. Michael saves
money by purchasing a one-year-old truck for $590 000. Calculate the percentage saving that Michael
has made, correct to 1 decimal place.
5 The table below shows the new price and one-year-old price of a variety of cars.
Type of car
New price
One-year-old price
$28 990
$24 995
$14 990
$13 500
Ford Focus
$19 990
$16 800
$39 990
$31 990
$25 990
$21 790
Percentage decrease
New price
Percentage decrease
Holden Captiva
$43 990
20%
$22 990
15%
$20 490
12.5%
Kia Magentis
$23 990
17.5%
Toyota Yaris YR
$14 990
9.5%
One-year-old price
9 mC A new Toyota Rav 4 costs $39 000. However, a one-year-old equivalent will cost $32 175. This
represents a saving of
A 10%
B 17.5%
C 21%
D 82.5%
453
10 mC The price of a one-year-old Yamaha motorcycle is 12.5% cheaper than the new equivalent. Given
that a one-year-old Yamaha motorcycle can be bought for $28 875 the price of the equivalent new
motorbike will be closest to
A $25 000
B $32 500
C $33 000
D $41 000
11 The price of a one-year-old Ford Fiesta is $27 000. This price represents a decrease of 10% on the price
of the same car when sold new. Calculate the price of a new Ford Fiesta.
12 The price of a one-year-old Honda motorcycle is $18 275. This motorcycle has depreciated by 15%
since purchased new. Calculate the price of the motorcycle when purchased new.
invesTigATe: new or used?
14B
454
invesTigATion
For this investigation you will need to visit three insurance company websites.
Suppose that you are interested in purchasing a new Toyota Camry.
Obtain three quotes for CTP insurance assuming that the car is a sedan used for private purposes and
being driven by an 18 year old.
What will be the difference in the price of the CTP insurance if:
1 The car is a hatchback?
2 The age of the youngest driver is 30?
3 The driver has been involved in accidents in the last two years?
4 The driver has a 60% no claim bonus?
Also compare the cost of the insurance for a car that is
5 Garaged in various suburbs in Sydney with being garaged in various country areas
6 Used for business purposes.
Comprehensive insurance
Comprehensive insurance is the insurance that you take out to cover the cost of repairing or replacing
your own vehicle if it is damaged in an accident or stolen. Comprehensive insurance covers all that is
covered by third party property insurance as well as your own vehicle.
invesTigATion: Comprehensive insurance
For the purpose of this investigation we will assume that you are buying a five-year-old Toyota Camry.
The car is to be garaged at your home each night.
1 To understand comprehensive insurance you will need to understand each of the following terms. Go to
an insurance company website and find the definition of each of the following terms.
a excess
b no claim bonus
c agreed value
d market value
2 When you first take out insurance it will be very expensive. This is because you are a young driver, who
has never had an insurance policy previously and hence will not have a no claim bonus.
a Use an online calculator to get a quote for first time insurance.
b Repeat part a, however this time enter that you are 28 years old and have maximum no claim bonus.
What is the maximum amount of no claim bonus? How much is the saving?
3 Using the online calculator, is there the option to increase the amount of the excess in order to save
money on the premium? If so, how much can be saved?
4 Does the policy give the customer a choice between agreed value and market value? Which of these
twomethods of valuing the car give a cheaper premium?
5 Consider the body type of the car. Compare what the insurance premium would be if the car is a
a sedan
b hatchback
c station wagon.
6 Can money be saved on the premium by having nominated drivers (that is, the car will only be covered
when the nominated drivers are at the wheel)?
455
stamp duty
Stamp duty is a tax that is levied by the Office of State Revenue. Stamp duty is payable on many things,
such as house purchases and registration of contracts. In this section we consider how stamp duty is
levied on motor vehicle purchases.
Stamp duty is levied at the rate of 3% of the market value of the vehicle up to $45 000, plus 5% of the
value over $45 000.
The stamp duty calculation is based on $3 or $5 per $100 or part thereof. This means that before
calculating the stamp duty the price needs to be rounded up to the nearest $100.
WorkeD exAmple 2
Stamp duty is levied at 3% on the first $45 000 and 5% on the balance of the price of a motor
vehicle. Calculate the stamp duty payable on a car that has a market value of $55 000.
Think
WriTe
exercise 14B
c $30 000
g $91 250
d $45 000
h $112 000
have to pay stamp duty as the cost of the car is $0. This is not correct as the car has a market value
of $4000 and in the case of a gift, stamp duty is paid on the cars value. Calculate the amount of
stamp duty that Meridee must pay.
5 a Calculate the stamp duty on a car that costs
i $35 000
ii $45 000
iii $55 000.
b Explain why the difference between these amounts is not the same.
456
Price
($1000)
Stamp duty
10
20
30
40
45
50
55
60
b Use the answers to part a to draw a graph that shows stamp duty from $0 to $60 000.
14C
April borrows $12 000 to buy a car at a flat rate of 8.5% p.a. interest. April is to repay the loan,
plus interest, over 3 years. Calculate the total amount that April is to repay on this loan.
Think
WriTe
r = 8.5 100
= 0.085
SI = Prn
= $3060
WorkeD exAmple 4
Bianca borrows $15 000 to buy a car. This is to be repaid over 5 years at $420 per month. Calculate
the flat rate of interest that Bianca has been charged.
Think
WriTe
$2040
100%
$15 000
= 0.136
= 13.6%
Interest rate =
The examples above both refer to using bank finance. If you choose to use finance from the car
dealership things get a little more complicated and you need to be a lot more aware of the hidden costs.
ChApTer 14 Mathematics and driving
457
ELTHAM MOTORS
FREE
SERVICING FOR
THE 1st YEAR*
ALL NEW
ALL NEW
FROM
JEEP
COMPASS
$68^a
PER WEEK
ALL NEW
FROM
JEEP
GRAND
JEEP
CHEROKEE
GRAND
$118^c
PER WEEK
LEASE FROM
$102^b
PER WEEK
CHEROKEE
LAREDO
LAREDO
JEEP COMPASS
SportsManual
Manual
Sports
Jeep Wrangler -
Jeep Patriot -
Approved applicant only for business purposes on Commercial Hire Purchase over 60 months at 10.99%. Cash
selling price a) $26 500 b) $39 990 c) $46 500 d)$32 990 e) $25 000. Monthly repayment a) $296.59
b) $443.46 c) $514.33 d) $389.13 e) $280.26; Deposit a) $7950 b) $11 997 c) $13 950 d) $9897 e) $7500.
Total amount payable including the deposit a) $33 695 b) $50 601 c) $58 759.80 d) $41 829 e) $31 815.60.
Fees and charges apply.
*Servicing is free for the first 2 years or the first 48 000 km, whichever is reached first.
On the advertisement on the previous page the Jeep Compass is advertised at $68 per week.
Convert this to a monthly repayment
Think
458
WriTe
You can simplify the steps to this question by multiplying $34 by 52 and dividing by 12 in one step.
In this advertisement if you read the small print you will see that the monthly repayment is $296.59.
This slight discrepancy is due to the advertisement rounding the true weekly payment of $68.44 off to
the nearest dollar.
When buying a car on dealer finance you are actually using commercial hire purchase. This means
that you pay a deposit of 30% of the cash price of the car and then you are hiring the car for the term of
the agreement. At the end of the term you are then required to pay an amount equal to a percentage of
the original cash price. This is called paying a residual.
WorkeD exAmple 6
In the advertisement on the previous page all cars are repaid over a 5 year term and have a
30%deposit and 30% residual to be paid at the end of the finance agreement. For the Dodge
Journey SXT:
a What is the cash price of the car?
b Calculate the amount of each monthly repayment
c Calculate the amount of the residual
d Calculate the total cost of the car on terms.
Think
WriTe
= $442.00
residual.
= $11 997
= $50 514
In most cases when you see a car advertised at a certain price, this is not the price at which you are
able to drive the car away for. There are costs involved in simply getting a car on the road. The most
significant of these are registration, stamp duty and insurance.
All of the above examples used the simple interest formula. Some loans are calculated using what is
called a reducing balance personal loan. This is where the interest that is charged, usually each month, is
calculated using the outstanding balance on the loan. To calculate the monthly repayment on a reducing
balance personal loan we need to use either a table or an online calculator.
The table below shows the monthly repayment per $1000 on a reducing balance personal loan.
Interest rate
Year
7%
8%
9%
10%
11%
12%
$86.53
$86.99
$87.45
$87.92
$88.38
$88.85
$44.77
$45.23
$45.68
$46.14
$46.61
$47.07
$30.88
$31.34
$31.80
$32.27
$32.74
$33.21
$23.95
$24.41
$24.89
$25.36
$25.85
$26.33
$19.80
$20.28
$20.76
$21.25
$21.74
$22.24
$17.05
$17.53
$18.03
$18.53
$19.03
$19.55
$15.09
$15.59
$16.09
$16.60
$17.12
$17.65
$13.63
$14.14
$14.65
$15.17
$15.71
$16.25
459
WorkeD exAmple 7
Steven borrows $12 000 to purchase a second-hand car. The loan is to be repaid over 4 years at
9% p.a. reducible rate of interest.
a Calculate the amount of each monthly repayment
b Calculate the total repayments on the loan
Think
WriTe
exercise 14C
= $14 336.64
1 We3 Luke borrows $9000 for a new motorcycle. The loan is to be repaid over 3 years at 12% p.a. flat
20%deposit with the balance repaid over 2 years at 12.5% p.a. flat interest in equal monthly
instalments. Calculate:
a the deposit
b the balance owing
c the interest on the loan
d the total repayments
e the amount of each monthly repayment.
4 mC A trail bike with a cash price of $2700 is bought on the following terms: 20% deposit with the
balance paid in 12 equal monthly instalments at 12% p.a. flat interest. The total cost of the trail bike
when purchased on terms is:
A $259.20
B $324.00
C $2959.20
D $3024.00
460
5 We4 Sun-Le borrows $6400, which is to be repaid over 4 years at $176 per month. Calculate the flat
repayment.
The advertisement below is to be used for questions 7 to 10.
ELTHAM MOTORS
DONT MISS OUT
Near New Cars
Jeep Wrangler -
Jeep Patriot -
Approved applicant only for business purposes on Commercial Hire Purchase over 60 months at 10.99%. Cash
selling price a) $32 990 b) $25 000. Monthly repayment a) $389.13 b) $280.26; Deposit a) $9897 b) $7500.
Total amount payable including the deposit a) $41 829 b) $31 815.60. Fees and charges apply.
*Servicing is free for the first 2 years or the first 48 000 km, whichever is reached first.
7 By reading the small print at the bottom of the advertisement find the monthly repayment on a
a Dodge Journey SXT
b Jeep Compass
c Jeep Grand Cherokee
8 By reading the small print at the bottom of the advertisement find
a the cash price of the Jeep Patriot
b the residual of the Jeep Patriot
c what percentage of the cash price is the residual.
9 We6 The Grand Cherokee has a cash price of $46 500.
a Convert the weekly repayment to a monthly repayment.
b Calculate the total amount to be made in repayments over 5 years
c What is the total cost of the vehicle, as stated in the fine print?
d Explain how this advertisement is misleading.
10 The fine print at the bottom of the advertisement contains all details of the finance agreement. By
reading the fine print answer the following questions about the Jeep Compass.
a What is the advertised interest rate being charged?
b What is the cash price of the vehicle?
c What is the total repayment on the vehicle?
d How much interest is being charged on the vehicle?
e Calculate the amount of interest being charged as a percentage of the cash price of the vehicle.
Answer as a percentage correct to 2 decimal places.
f Explain the discrepancy between your answer and the advertised interest rate.
11 We7 Sandra borrows $15 000 to purchase a second-hand car. The loan is to be repaid over 5 years at
loans.
a $21 000 at 7% p.a. over 3 years
c $42 500 at 12% p.a. over 8 years
461
total repayments.
d Who has the cheaper loan and by how much?
14 Delilah borrows $18 000 to be repaid at 10% p.a. reducible rate of interest over 3 years.
a Calculate the amount of Delilahs monthly repayment.
b Calculate Delilahs total repayments
c Calculate the amount of interest that Delilah has paid on the loan.
d Calculate the equivalent rate of simple interest paid per annum on this loan. Answer as a
A motorbike travels 425 km on a tank of 25 litres of fuel. Express the fuel consumption in
L/100km. Give your answer correct to 1 decimal place.
Think
1
2
WriTe
WorkeD exAmple 9
A Mitsubishi Colt is advertised as having fuel economy of 12.1 L/100 km of city driving and
8.7L/100 km of country driving. Calculate the amount of fuel used in a 470 km of city driving and
b 730 km of country driving.
Think
462
WriTe
WorkeD exAmple 10
A Holden Commodore is advertised as having a fuel consumption of 13.4 L/100 km of city driving.
Joel drives 560 km in the city each week. Calculate:
a his weekly fuel consumption
b his weekly petrol costs at an average price of 152.9 cents per litre.
Think
WriTe
petrolprice.
exercise 14D
= 11473.616 cents
= $114.74
Fuel costs
travelling the 580 km to and from work each week. Express Barrys weekly fuel consumption in
L/100km correct to 1 decimal place.
6 We10 A Holden Commodore is advertised as having a fuel consumption of 13.4L/100 km of city
463
7 During a certain week the average price of petrol is 161.9c per litre. For each of the following vehicles
10
11
12
13
DigiTAl DoC
WorkSHEET 14.1
doc-10352
464
Often on news broadcasts focus will turn to the price of petrol, not only because it is a product almost
everyone needs, but also because of the flow-on effect petrol prices has on almost all other products.
1 Research the average price per litre of ULP over the past five years.
2 Compare this information with the price per barrel of oil on international markets.
3 Record the daily price of petrol at a petrol station near you each day for 4 weeks. Is there a pattern about
the days on which it is cheapest? Can you explain this?
14e
Earlier in this chapter we saw that the older that a vehicle is, the cheaper it is to buy. The longer you own
the car the less value it has. This is known as depreciation. Straight line depreciation is where the value
of an item depreciates by a constant amount each year. The depreciated value of an item is called the
salvage value, S. The salvage value of an asset can be calculated using the formula:
S = V0 Dn
Where V0 is the purchase price of the asset, D is the amount of depreciation apportioned per period
and n is the number of periods.
WorkeD exAmple 11
A new car is bought for $48 000. The car depreciates at a rate of $4500 per year. Calculate the
salvage value of the car after 6 years.
Think
WriTe
S = V0 Dn
= $21 000
By solving an equation we are able to calculate when the value of an asset falls below a particular
amount.
WorkeD exAmple 12
A van for work costs $60 000. The value of the van is depreciated by $7500 per year. When the
value of the equipment falls below $10 000 it can be written off for tax purposes. Calculate the
number of years after which the equipment should be replaced.
Think
WriTe
S = V0 Dn
7500n = 50 000
2
n = 63
465
exercise 14e
1 We11 A car that is purchased for $45 000 depreciates by $5000 each year. Calculate the salvage value
2
4
5
7
8
9
10
30 000
25 000
20 000
15 000
10 000
5000
0
a
b
c
d
e
466
5 6
Years
10
11 Find the new price of the following vehicles that have been subject to straight line depreciation.
a After 5 years the value is $50 000 and is depreciating at $12 000 per year.
b After 15 years the value is $4000 and is depreciating at $1500 per year.
c After 25 years the value is $2000 and is depreciating at $500 per year.
12 Angelo owns a taxi that depreciates at $6500 per year and is written off after 12 years. Calculate the
depreciation of the vehicle and use the graph to find the number of years after which the vehicle
becomes worthless.
The declining balance method of depreciation occurs when the value of an asset depreciates by a given
percentage each period.
Consider the case of a car purchased new for $30 000, which depreciates at the rate of 20%p.a. Each
year the salvage value of the car is 80% of its value at the end of the previous year.
After 1 year: S = 80% of $30 000
= $24 000
After 2 years: S = 80% of $24 000
= $19 200
After 3 years: S = 80% of $19 200
= $15 360
WorkeD exAmple 13
Think
WriTe
The salvage value under a declining balance can be calculated using the formula:
S = V0(1 r)n
where S is the salvage value, V0 is the purchase price, r is the percentage depreciation per period
expressed as a decimal and n is the number of periods.
This formula can be considered as being similar to the compound interest formula. In the case of
depreciation, however, you need to subtract the depreciation rather than add the interest expressed as a
decimal from 1.
ChApTer 14 Mathematics and driving
467
WorkeD exAmple 14
The purchase price of a small motorcycle is $15 000. The value of the motorcycle depreciates by
10%p.a. Calculate the salvage value of the motorcycle after 8 years.
Think
WriTe
= $6457.00
To calculate the amount by which the asset has depreciated, we subtract the salvage value from the
purchase price.
WorkeD exAmple 15
The purchase price of a motor vehicle is $40 000. The vehicle depreciates by 12%p.a. Calculate
the amount by which the vehicle depreciates in 10 years.
Think
WriTe
S = V0(1 r)n
= $11 140.04
1 We13 The purchase price of a new Mazda RX7 is $50 000. The value of the car depreciates by 20% p.a.
By calculating the value of the car at the end of each year, find the salvage value of the car after 4years.
2 A trailer is purchased for $5000. The value of the trailer depreciates by 15% each year. By calculating
3 A trucking company purchases a semi-trailer for $3 000 000. The value of the semi-trailer depreciates
by 15% p.a. By calculating the value at the end of each year, find the number of years that it takes for
the salvage value of the semi-trailer to fall below $1 000 000.
468
4 We14 Use the formula S = V0(1 r)n to calculate the salvage value after 7 years of a truck purchased
5
6
7
10
11
12
13
14
for $800 000 that depreciates at a rate of 10% p.a. (give your answer correct to the nearest $1000).
Calculate the salvage value of a vehicle (correct to the nearest $100) with a purchase price of:
a $10 000 that depreciates at 10% p.a. for 5 years
b $250 000 that depreciates at 15% p.a. for 8 years
c $5000 that depreciates at 25% p.a. for 5 years
d $2.2 million that depreciates at 30% p.a. for 10 years
e $50 000 that depreciates at 40% p.a. for 5 years.
A plumber purchases a panel van for work at a cost of $48 000. If the value of the panel van depreciates
by 30% each year, calculate the value of the van after 3 years.
We15 A luxury car is purchased new for $95 000. The value of the car depreciates by 22% p.a.
Calculate the amount that the car will depreciate in value over the first 5 years (correct to the nearest
$1000).
A new car is purchased for $35 000. The owner plans to keep the car for 5 years and then trade the car
in on another new car. The estimate is that the value of the car will depreciate by 16% p.a. Calculate:
a the amount the owner can expect as a trade in for the car in 5 years (correct to the nearest $100)
b the amount by which the car will depreciate in 5 years.
mC A bus company purchases a new bus for $520 000. Three years later, the bus company is asked to
value the bus for insurance. If the bus company allows for depreciation of 15% on the bus, which of the
following calculations will give the correct estimate of their value?
A 520 000 0.853
B 520 000 0.153
C 520 000 0.55
D 520 000 0.45
mC A car purchased for $30 000 will depreciate by 25% p.a. The salvage value of the car after 4 years
will be closest to:
A $0
B $100
C $9500
D $20 000
An electrician purchases a van for $80 000. Each year the electrician is entitled to a tax deduction for
the depreciation of the van. If the rate of depreciation allowed is 33%, calculate:
a the value of the van at the end of one year (correct to the nearest $1)
b the tax deduction allowed in the first year
c the value of the van at the end of two years (correct to the nearest $1)
d the tax deduction allowed in the second year.
A motorbike is purchased for $24 000. The value
of the motorbike depreciates by 33%p.a. When the
value of the bike falls below $5000, the owner will
no longer insure the bike. For how many years will
the owner insure the bike?
A new car has a price of $40 000. The car
depreciates by 25% in the first year.
a Calculate the value of the car after one year.
b In each year after the first year the car
depreciates by 10% p.a. Calculate the value
of the car after five years.
Maya purchases a new car for $40 000 which she uses for her work-from-home business. For this
reason Maya is allowed to claim the depreciation on the car as a tax deduction. When claiming a tax
deduction for a vehicle the taxpayer has the choice of using the straight line depreciation method or the
declining balance depreciation method.
Once the vehicle falls below 10% of its purchase price under either method the entire remaining
balance is depreciated in that year and the car is written off for tax purposes.
a Given that Maya can depreciate this car by $4000 per year under the straight line method or
15%p.a. under the declining balance method complete the tables below.
Straight line method
Year
10
Depreciation
Car value
469
10
Depreciation
Car value
b Use the table to draw the graph to show the value of the car each year over 10 years.
15 The figure below shows the depreciating value of a new car under both straight line and declining
balance depreciation.
40 000
35 000
Value ($)
30 000
25 000
20 000
15 000
10 000
Declining balance
value
5000
0
5 6
Years
10
a Find the amount of depreciation in the first year under both methods.
b What is the percentage depreciation under the declining balance method?
c How many years does it take before the car is worth more under declining balance depreciation
14g
Its a wet day; you are driving a modern car with good brakes. A child runs onto the road 45 metres
ahead of you while you are travelling at 60 km/h. You brake hard but will you stop in time?
The answer is NO! You will actually hit the child while still travelling at 32 km/h. Travelling at
50km/h, however, you will stop the car with 5 metres to spare.
The stopping distance of a vehicle is the distance travelled in the reaction time plus the distance
travelled under brakes. The average reaction time of a driver is 1.5seconds.
470
The graph below shows what happens in the above situation at various speeds.
Wet stopping distance
200
180
160
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
This also explains one of the reasons that speed limits were reduced in most urban streets from
60km/h to 50km/h.
It is important that you understand the difference in stopping distance between wet and dry conditions.
The graph below shows the same situation with a dry road.
Dry stopping distance
160
Stoppig distance (m)
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
In dry conditions the car would have just touched the child as it would take 45 metres to stop the car.
In a previous chapter we looked at converting speeds from kilometres per hour to metres per second.
This is important when we are calculating stopping distances which are measured in metres and time is
measured in seconds.
WorkeD exAmple 16
Frank is travelling at 58 km/hr. It takes him 1.6 seconds to react to seeing a red light. Calculate the
distance that Franks car travels in his reaction time. Give your answer correct to 1 decimal place.
Think
WriTe
Once we have calculated the reaction time distance we need to calculate how far the car will travel under
brakes; that is, the braking distance. The braking distance is different under wet and dry conditions.
Because a car will skid slightly in the wet it takes longer to come to a complete stop.
ChApTer 14 Mathematics and driving
471
The braking distance is a function of the square of the speed of the car. For an average-size car, with
tyres in good condition and with good brakes travelling on a road with a good surface, the relationship
can be approximated as follows:
Dry braking distance 0.0056 s2
Wet braking distance 0.0078 s2
where s is the speed on the car in km/h.
WorkeD exAmple 17
Use the formula dry braking distance = 0.0056 s2 to calculate the braking distance of a car that is
travelling at 78 km/h on a dry road. Give your answer correct to the nearest metre.
Think
WriTe
Substitute.
= 0.0056 782
Calculate.
= 34 m
Stopping distance = reaction-time distance + braking distance.
WorkeD exAmple 18
Julie is travelling at 100 km/h on a wet road when she sees a kangaroo ahead. Julie has a reaction
time of 1.75 sec. Calculate Julies stopping distance.
Think
472
WriTe
Substitute.
= 0.0078 1002
Calculate.
= 78 m
exercise 14g
7
8
9
is travelling at 60 km/h on a dry road. Give your answer correct to the nearest metre.
Use the formula wet braking distance = 0.0078s2 to calculate the braking distance of a car that is
travelling at 60 km/h on a wet road. Give your answer correct to the nearest metre.
Calculate the braking distance of each of the following vehicles.
a Travelling at 50 km/h in dry conditions
b Travelling at 62 km/h in wet conditions
c Travelling at 79 km/h in dry conditions
d Travelling at 95 km/h in wet conditions
e Travelling at 110 km/h in wet conditions
Ian is driving at a speed of 56 km/h on a dry road.
a When Ian sees a pedestrian ahead he has a reaction time of 1.6 seconds. Calculate the distance
that Ians car travels in that time.
b Use the formula dry braking distance = 0.0056s2 to calculate Ians braking distance.
c What is Ians total stopping distance?
We18 Linda is travelling at 110 km/h on a dry freeway when she sees the car ahead braking. Linda
has a reaction time of 1.4 sec. Calculate Lindas stopping distance.
Greg is travelling at 92 km/h on a wet road when he is forced to brake. Given that Greg has a reaction
time of 2 sec, calculate his stopping distance.
a Complete the table below to calculate the stopping distance of a car at various speeds under both wet
and dry conditions. In each case assume a reaction time of 1.5 seconds.
Speed
Dry road
Wet road
40 km/h
50 km/h
60 km/h
70 km/h
80 km/h
90 km/h
100 km/h
110 km/h
120 km/h
b Show your results on a line graph.
ChApTer 14 Mathematics and driving
473
14h
40 kg
0.05
0.10
0.15
0.20
0.25
0.30
0.35
0.40
0.45
0.51
45 kg
0.04
0.05
0.08
0.09
0.11
0.14
0.15
0.18
0.19
0.23
0.23
0.27
0.26
0.32
0.30
0.36
0.34
0.41
0.38
0.45
110 kg
0.02
0.02
0.03
0.04
0.05
0.06
0.06
0.08
0.08
0.09
0.09
0.11
0.11
0.13
0.13
0.15
0.14
0.17
0.16
0.19
WorkeD exAmple 19
Yu-Lin is female and weighs approximately 60 kg. Yu-Lin goes out with her friends and over
a three hour period has 6 glasses of wine. Will Yu-Lin be over a BAC of 0.05%? Explain your
answer.
Think
WriTe
Make a conclusion.
Ken is an 80 kg man who drinks five middies of full strength beer in two hours. Estimate Kens
BAC content and decide if Ken should drive or not.
Think
WriTe
(10N 7.5H)
6.8M
BACmale =
N = 5, H = 2, M = 80
Substitute.
(10 5 7.5 2)
6.8 80
= 0.064%
=
When testing drivers the police measure BAC and if a driver is over the limit they are charged with one
of the following PCA (prescribed content of alcohol) offences.
Low range PCA if between 0.05% and 0.08%
Mid range PCA if between 0.08% and 0.15%
High range PCA if over 0.15%
ChApTer 14 Mathematics and driving
475
Your bloodstream can quickly absorb alcohol, causing your BAC to rise, but reducing your BAC is
a much slower process. There have been many cases of people still being over the legal BAC limit the
morning after.
One rule of thumb that is used is that BAC will drop by 0.01% each hour that you do not have a drink.
One formula that can be used to calculate the waiting time before driving is
Number of hours =
BAC
.
0.015
WorkeD exAmple 21
Julio has a BAC of 0.1%. How many hours should Julio wait before Julio considers driving?
Think
WriTe
BAC
0.015
Number of hours =
BAC = 0.015
Substitute.
Calculate.
exercise 14h
= 6.
Julio should wait at least 6 hours and 40 minutes
before considering driving again.
476
6 We20 Ken is an 80 kg man who drinks five middies of full strength beer in two hours. Use the
(10N 7.5H)
to estimate Kens BAC content and decide if Ken should drive or not.
6.8M
Carly is a 95 kg woman who drinks eight standard drinks in five hours. Use the formula
BACfemale = (10N 7.5H) to estimate Carlys BAC content and decide if Carly should drive or not.
5.5M
When testing drivers the police measure BAC and if a driver is over the limit they are charged with one
of the following PCA (prescribed content of alcohol) offences.
Low range PCA if between 0.05% and 0.08%
Mid range PCA if between 0.08% and 0.15%
High range PCA if over 0.15%
Use the formulas in questions 6 and 7 to determine the BAC of each of the following people and
what range they would be charged with if caught driving.
a Sandra, a 59 kg woman who has 6 standard drinks in four hours
b Michael, a 55 kg male who has 9 standard drinks in five hours
c Terry, a 87 kg male who has 15 standard drinks in six hours
d Grace, a 82 kg female who has 12 standard drinks in five hours.
BAC
We21 Xanthe has a BAC of 0.12%. Use the formula Numberofhours=
to estimate the length
0.015
of time Xanthe should wait before she considers driving.
For each of the people in question 8 find the length of time that each should wait before they consider
driving again.
Frank is a 90 kg male. After the football one day he arrives at the club at 5:00pm and spends the next
eight hours drinking 15 standard drinks, leaving the club at 1:00am.
a Use the formula BACmale = (10N 7.5H) to estimate his BAC.
6.8M
b Frank is woken to go to work at 7:00 am. Considering that it is now 14 hours since he started
drinking use the formula to again find his BAC.
BAC
0.015
Narelle is a 53 kg female. At a party Narelle drinks 12 standard drinks between 6:00 pm and midnight.
(10N 7.5H) to estimate Narelles BAC at midnight.
a Use the formula BACfemale =
5.5M
b Again use the formula to find Narelles BAC at 8:00 am the next morning.
BAC
c Use Narelles midnight BAC together with the formula Numberofhours=
to estimate
0.015
when Narelle can start driving again. Give your answer to the nearest half hour.
BAC
d Use Narelles 8:00 am BAC together with the formula Numberofhours=
to estimate when
0.015
Narelle can start driving again. Give your answer to the nearest half hour.
e Explain any discrepancy in the answers between parts c and d.
Nick is 75 kg and began drinking at 5:00 pm. The table below shows the number of drinks consumed
each hour.
formula BACmale =
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Time
5:00 pm to 6:00 pm
6:00 pm to 7:00 pm
7:00 pm to 8:00 pm
8:00 pm to 9:00 pm
9:00 pm to 10:00 pm
10:00 pm to 11:00 pm
Drinks consumed
3
2
1
2
3
3
BAC
DigiTAl DoC
WorkSHEET 14.2
doc-10353
477
Summary
Depreciation of new
cars
Finance for a car or other type of vehicle can come in a number of forms.
The finance may take the form of a loan which can be taken out at either:
Simple interest, which is calculated using the formula SI = Prn
Reducible interest, which calculates the interest each month on the reducing balance. A table of
values is usually used to calculate the amount of each monthly repayment.
Many car dealerships offer finance that is a lease arrangement. A payment is made at the start of
the deal, monthly payments are made and then a final amount called a residual is paid at the end of
the agreement.
Fuel costs
Depreciation
Depreciation is the rate by which the value of an asset (in this case a motor vehicle) loses value.
The value of the vehicle at any point in time is called the salvage value.
Depreciation can be calculated in two ways
Straight line depreciation is where the value of the vehicle depreciates by the same amount of
money each year. The salvage value is calculated using the formula S = V0 Dn.
Declining balance depreciation is where the value of the vehicle depreciates by a fixed
percentage each year. The salvage value is found using the formula S = V0(1 r)n.
The distance that it takes to stop a vehicle is the total of the reaction time distance and the stopping
distance.
To calculate the reaction time distance, convert the speed of the vehicle to metres per second and
then multiply by the reaction time.
The braking distance of a car can be approximated using the following rules.
Dry braking distance = 0.0056s2
Wet braking distance = 0.0078s2
Blood alcohol
concentration (BAC)
Blood alcohol concentration (BAC) is measured as grams of alcohol per 100 milligrams of blood.
The higher your BAC the lower your ability to handle a motor vehicle.
For drivers with a full drivers licence the maximum BAC is 0.05% but for P plate drivers the limit
is 0%.
BAC can be estimated by using charts or formulas but is subject to many variables and so these can
only be considered an estimate.
Drink and drive no one thinks big of you.
478
Chapter review
1 A new Suzuki motorcycle costs $28 500. A similar motorcycle that is one year old costs $24 225. This
represents a saving of
A 5%
B 10%
C 15%
D 17.6%
m u lTip l e
C ho iC e
2 Joels car uses 23 L in 189 km of city driving and 28 L in 312 km of country driving. Which of the
New (0)
1
2
3
4
C Year
New (0)
1
2
3
4
Salvage value
$20 000
$18 000
$16 200
$14 580
$13 122
B Year
Salvage value
$20 000
$18 000
$16 500
$15 580
$15 000
D Year
New (0)
1
2
3
4
New (0)
1
2
3
4
Salvage value
$20 000
$18 200
$16 400
$14 600
$12 800
Salvage value
$20 000
$17 000
$15 200
$14 000
$13 500
4 The value of a new car depreciates by 12.5% p.a. The salvage value in five years of a car that was
C $19 200
D $32 800
5 Ken and Barbie are both 70 kg and both have 4 standard drinks in a 2 hour period. Use the formulas
(10N 7.5H)
(10N 7.5H)
and BACfemale =
to determine which of the following
5.5M
6.8M
statements will most likely be correct.
A Kens BAC will be 0.013% higher than Barbies
B Kens BAC will be 0.013% lower than Barbies
C Kens BAC will be 0.036% higher than Barbies
D Kens BAC will be 0.036% lower than Barbies
BACmale =
B 7.5 m/s
C 20.8 m/s
D 48 m/s
1 A new Toyota Yaris costs $49 500. The purchase price of a similar one-year-old Yaris would cost
$40 000. What is the percentage saving that can be made by buying a one-year-old model?
s ho rT
A n s W er
2 Jim has purchased a used car for $9500. To take out comprehensive insurance the premium for Jim
would be $1615.50. Each year that Jim has comprehensive insurance he receives a no claim bonus that
increases by 10% each year. Calculate the number of years that it would take for Jim to pay more in
insurance premiums than he would for the cost of the car.
3 Stamp duty is levied at 3% on the first $45 000 and 5% on the balance of the price of a motor vehicle.
Calculate the stamp duty payable on a car that has a market value of $59 950.
4 Madison borrows $15 000 to purchase a car at 9% p.a. flat interest to be repaid over 4 years.
a Calculate the amount of interest that Madison must pay.
b Calculate the total amount to be made in repayments.
c Calculate the amount of each monthly repayment.
ChApTer 14 Mathematics and driving
479
5 Gary also purchases a car by borrowing $15 000 at 9% p.a. over 4 years. However, Garys loan is a
number of years that it takes to fall below $6000 and its value at the time.
8 A trucking company buys a new rig for $780 000. The rig depreciates under declining balance at a rate
of 8% p.a.
a Calculate the salvage value of the rig after 6 years (answer to the nearest $1000).
b Calculate the number of years that it takes for the rig to fall to a value of less than $100 000.
9 Leanne is female and weighs approximately 55 kg. Leanne has 6 standard drinks in 3 hours. Use the
table on page 474 to determine if Leanne will be over the 0.05% legal BAC limit.
10 Tim is an 89 kg male who has 7 standard drinks between 4:00 pm and 7:00 pm.
a Use the formula BACmale = (10N 7.5H) to estimate his BAC correct to 2 decimal places.
6.8M BAC
0.015
b 12 m/s to km/h.
13 Raymond is driving his car at a dangerous speed of 120 km/h on a wet road. He sees danger ahead and
480
1 Bryce buys a new Holden Commodore with a cash price of $49 000 on terms. He must pay weekly
repayments of $278.92 over 4 years, leaving him with a 30% residual payment at the end of the
agreement.
a Calculate the total cost of the vehicle.
b How much must Bryce pay up front with expenses for insurance of $1318.75, registration of
$278.15, green slip insurance of $274.90 and stamp duty at a rate of 3% on the first $45 000 and
5% on the balance of the price?
c The average fuel consumption of the vehicle is estimated at 13.1 L/100 km. Given that Bryce
estimates he will drive 30 000 km per year and that petrol costs an average 172.9c/L, calculate the
amount Bryce will spend each week on petrol.
d Bryce must plan a budget. How much should he set aside for weekly car expenses given that
he must pay for petrol, his repayments as well as setting money aside for the following years
insurance and registration?
e The value of the car depreciates at a rate of 12.5% p.a. Calculate the value of the car after 4 years
and determine whether the car is worth more or less than the residual payment that Bryce must
make at this time.
2 Aiden is at a party and over a period of 5 hours has 11 standard drinks, having his last drink at 11:00pm.
a Given that Aiden weighs 95 kg, use the formula BACmale = (10N 7.5H) to estimate his BAC.
6.8M
b Aiden is asked to drive his mother to work the next morning at 7:00 am. Explain whether Aiden
BAC
.
0.015
c Aidens normal reaction time to a braking situation when driving is 1.5 seconds. Calculate the
total stopping distance when Aiden is driving at 60 km/h on a dry road by using the formula Dry
braking distance = 0.0056s2.
d If Aiden were to drive home from the party his reaction time would have slowed to 2.7 seconds.
Calculate the percentage increase in his reaction time.
e Calculate the percentage increase in his stopping distance.
would be fit to do so by using the formula, Number of hours =
DigiTAl DoC
Test Yourself
doc-10347
Chapter 14
481
ICT activities
14D
Fuel costs
DigiTAl DoC
WorkSHEET 14.1 (doc-10352): Apply your knowledge of driving to
problems. (page 464)
14h
DigiTAl DoC
WorkSHEET 14.2 (doc-10353): Apply your knowledge of driving to
problems. (page 477)
482
Chapter review
Test Yourself Chapter 14 (doc-10347): Take the end-of-chapter test to
check your progress. (page 481)
Answers CHAPTER 14
mAThemATiCs AnD Driving
exercise 14A
1 a $10 800
b 20%
2 a $3995
b 13.8%
3 25.84%
4 21.3%
5
6 a
Type
of car
New
price
a Toyota
Oneyear- Percentage
old price decrease
13.8%
9.9%
Camry
Altise
auto
Getz 1.6
c
Ford
Focus
d Nissan
16.0%
20.0%
16.2%
X-Trail
manual
e Honda
Civic
Manual
6 a $12 150
7 $34 000
8
a Holden
$43 990
20%
$35 200
$22 990
15%
$19 500
Captiva
b Holden
Astra
Equipe
c
Mazda3
Neo
Sport
d Kia
$20 490
12.5%
$17 900
$23 990
17.5%
$19 800
$14 990
9.5%
$13 600
Yaris YR
9
10
11
12
B
C
$30 000
$21 500
exercise 14B
1 $386.64
2 $1544.40
3 a $150
b $375
c $900
d $1350
e $1600
f $2850
g $3662.50
h $4700
4 a $749.70
5 a i $1050
0
10
20
30
40
45
50
55
60
0
$300
$600
$900
$1200
$1350
$1600
$1850
$2100
$
2500
2000
1500
1000
500
0
iii $1850
12
13
Stamp duty
10 a
d
f
11 a
12 a
c
13 a
d
14 a
c
a 71.55 L
b 53.53 L
17.2 L/100 km
a 75.04 L
b $114.74
a $58.59
b $77.59
c $100.54
d $120.34
B
a 101.725 L
b $165.71
a 15 000 L b $24 435
c $11 385
It will be worth converting her car as there
is an annual saving of $1181.21, saving
her $3543.63 on fuel over three years.
This more than covers the $2200 cost of
converting the car to LPG.
34 000 km
a $54.58
b $76.41
c The saving over three weeks will be
$87.33 (average $29.11 per week). You
could, however, discuss if this saving is
worth spending an extra one hour per
day travelling.
exercise 14e
5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60
Price ( $1000)
exercise 14D
b $120
ii $1350
8
9
10
11
1 $12 240
2 a $4800
b $7752
c $34 952
d $970.89
3 a $1900
b $7600
c $1900
d $9500
e $395.83
4 C
5 8%
6 $99.67
7 a $443.46
b $296.59
c $514.33
8 a $25 000
b $7500
c 30%
9 a $511.33
b $30 680
c $58 759.80
d The main part of the advertisement
Magentis
e Toyota
Stamp
duty
exercise 14C
b $36 450
Type
of car
Price
($1000)
4
5
6
7
Fuel costs
1 5.3 L/100 km
2 a 5.6 L/100 km
b 7.2 L/100 km
c 6.4 L/100 km
3 a 12 L/100 km
c 4 L/100 km
b 16 L/100 km
1 $20 000
2 a $1000
c $270 000
e $32 000
3 a $7 125 000
4 $10 600
5 8 years
6 a 6 years
c 8 years
7 $2500 per year
8 a $4000
c $22 277.78
9 $25 000
10 a $35 000
c $2250
e 15 years
11 a $110 000
c $14 500
12 $78 000
13
$
25 000
b $10 300
d $56 200
b $3 750 000
b 5 years
d 7 years
b $12 500
b $23 000
d 8 years
b $26 500
Salvage value
6 years 8 months
Years
exercise 14F Declining balance method
of depreciation
1 $20 480
2 a $2220
b i $750
ii $391.50
3 7 years
4 $383 000
5 a $5900
b $68 100
c $1200
d $62 100
e $3900
6 $16 464
7 $68 000
8 a $14 600
b $20 400
9 A
10 C
483
11 a $53 600
b $26 400
c $35 912
d $17 688
12 4 years
13 a $30 000
b $19 683
14 a Straight line method
exercise 14g
distances
1 26.5 m.
2 a 20 m
c 35 m
e 50.1 m
3 20 m
4 28 m
5 a 14 m
c 35 m
e 94 m
6 a 25 m
c 43 m
7 111 m
8 117 m
b 30 m
d 70 m
9
10
36 000
4 000
32 000
4 000
28 000
4 000
24 000
4 000
20 000
40 km/h
26
29
4 000
16 000
50 km/h
35
40
4 000
12 000
60 km/h
45
53
4 000
8 000
70 km/h
57
67
4 000
4 000
80 km/h
69
83
10
4 000
90 km/h
83
101
Speed
34 000
5 100
28 900
4 335
24 565
3 685
20 880
3 132
17 748
2 662
15 086
2 263
12 823
1 923
10 900
1 635
9 265
10
1 390
7 875
40000
35000
30000
25000
20000
15000
10000
5000
0
Declining
balance value
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Year
b 18 m
11
12
13 a
BAC
100 km/h
98
120
110 km/h
114
140
5:00 pm to
6:00 pm
0.04%
120 km/h
131
162
6:00 pm to
7:00 pm
0.07%
7:00 pm to
8:00 pm
0.07%
8:00 pm to
9:00 pm
0.10%
9:00 pm to
10:00 pm
0.14%
10:00 pm to
11:00 pm
0.19%
Time
BAC
Midnight
0.17%
1:00 am
0.16%
2:00 am
0.14%
3:00 am
0.13%
4:00 am
0.11%
5:00 am
0.10%
6:00 am
0.08%
7:00 am
0.07%
8:00 am
0.05%
9:00 am
0.04%
160
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
10 a
b
c
d
Drinks
consumed
Time
b
Stopping distance (m)
4 000
9 a
6
7
b 24.4 m
d 31.9m
484
Wet road
Dry road
50 m
58 m
66 m
76 m
BAC
0.20%
0.18%
0.16%
0.14%
0.12%
0.10%
0.08%
0.06%
0.04%
0.02%
BAC
5:
00
6: pm
00
7: pm
00
8: pm
00
9: pm
0
10 0 p
:0 m
11 0 p
:0 m
12 0 p
:0 m
0
1: am
00
2: am
00
3: am
00
4: am
00
5: am
00
6: am
00
7: am
00
8: am
00
9: am
00
am
3 $2097.50
4 a $5400
b $20 400
c $425
5 a $373.35
b $17 920.80
c $2920.80
d $2479.20
6 a 6.55 L/100
b $25.44
7 a $21 500
b 10 years value = $5000
8 a $473 000
b 25 years
9 Leanne will be over her .05 drink limit in three hours.
10 a BAC = 0.08%
b After midnight
11 a 63 km/h
b 168 km
c 40 min
12 a 15.6 m/s
b 43.2 km/h
13 a 60 m
b 112 m
c 172m
exTenDeD response
ChApTer revieW
mulTiple ChoiCe
1C
3A
5B
shorT AnsWer
1 19.2%
2 9 years
2 A
4 C
6 C
1 a $72 715.36
b $3421.80
c $130.67
d $445.61
e The car is worth more ($28 700) than the residual payment
($14 700).
2 a 11.2%
1
b It would take Aiden 7 hours to be fit to drive so he should be
2
able to drive.
c 45 m
d 80%
e 44%
485
ICT activities
Causes of accidents
SEARCHLIGHT ID: PRO-0136
scenario
Your task is to review penalties for both minor and more
serious traffic offences. To determine which offences
are considered minor and which are more serious you
will need to look at the statistics behind the causes of
accidents, in particular fatal accidents.
486
your task
process
Open the ProjectsPLUS application for this chapter in
your eBookPLUS. Watch the introductory video, click
the Start Project button and then set up your project
DigiTAl DoC
pro-0136
projectsplus
487
Glossary
Adjacent: The side next to the angle used for reference in a rightangled triangle.
Allowance: An extra payment made to a worker for working in
unfavourable conditions.
Angle of depression: The angle through which you must look down
from the horizontal to sight an object.
Angle of elevation: The angle through which you must look up from
the horizontal to sight an object.
Annual leave: A period of time that each permanent employee is
allowed each year for holidays.
1
Annual leave loading: An extra payment of 17 2 % of the gross pay
made to employees when they take their annual leave.
Appreciation: The amount by which an item grows in value over
time.
Bar graph: A graph where categorical data are displayed in
horizontal bars, with the categories on a vertical axis and quantity on
the horizontal axis.
Bias: Bias occurs when the results of a survey are influenced by
outside factors such as a poorly chosen sample. In such a case, one set
of circumstances is more prevalent than in the wider population.
Bimodal: A set of scores for which two scores occur most often.
Box-and-whisker-plot: A method of graphically displaying a fivenumber summary. The plot is drawn to scale with the box representing
the interquartile range and the whiskers representing the range. Within
the box, the median is also shown.
Budget: A list of a persons income and expenses. A personal budget
is made to try to avoid spending more than is earned. A balanced
budget is where income equals expenditure.
Casual rate: A higher rate of pay to compensate casual workers for
the lack of holiday and sick pay.
Categorical data: Data which are not numerical and are put into
categories such as types of car.
Census: Data gathered from the entire population.
Central tendency: A method for describing a typical score in a data
set. There are three measures of central tendency mean, median
and mode.
Column graph: Similar to a bar graph, but the data are displayed in
vertical columns.
Commission: Payment made to a salesperson. A commission is
usually paid as a percentage of sales.
Complementary events: Two events that cover all possible
outcomes to a probability experiment. The sum of the probabilities of
complementary events is 1.
Compound interest: A form of interest payment. The interest paid at
the end of one period is added to the principal before the next interest
calculation is made. Compound interest can be calculated using the
formula A = P(1 + r)n.
Compound value interest factor: The amount to which $1 will
amount under a compound interest investment.
Compounded value: see Future value.
Compounding period: The length of time between interest payments
in a compound interest investment.
Concentration: The amount of one substance that is contained in
another. The concentration of a mixture is usually stated as a mass/
mass rate or a mass/volume rate.
Congruent figures: A special case of similar figures where the scale
factor is equal to 1. Congruent figures are identical in shape and size.
Continuous data: Data that can take any value within a given range.
Cosine ratio: The ratio of the adjacent side and hypotenuse in a rightangled triangle.
Glossary
489
490
Glossary
Mean: The average of a data set, found by totalling all the scores then
dividing by the number of scores.
Median: The middle score or the average of the two middle scores in
a data set.
Medicare levy: A payment made as part of our tax system that
covers the cost of basic health care services. The basic levy is 1.5%
of gross income; however, low income earners pay the levy at a
reduced rate.
Mode: The score in a data set with the highest frequency.
Multi-stage event: This occurs when there is more than one part
to a probability experiment. For example, tossing two coins can be
considered as tossing one coin then tossing another, therefore there are
two parts to this experiment.
Net pay: The amount of money actually received by an employee
after all deductions have been subtracted from the gross pay.
Offset: In a traverse study, an offset is a line perpendicular to the
transversal. It is drawn from the transversal to a vertex on the area
being surveyed.
Ogive: Another term for cumulative frequency polygon.
Opposite: The side opposite to the angle used for reference in a rightangled triangle.
Ordinary rate: The normal hourly rate for a wage earner.
Outcome: A possible result to a probability experiment.
Overtime: This is when a person earns more than the regular hours
each week.
PAYG: Pay As You Go. The method usually applied to the collection
of tax.
Payment by piece (Piecework): Payment for the amount of work
completed.
Penalty rate: A higher rate of pay made to a person who is working
overtime.
Per annum: Per year.
Percentage chance: The probability of an event expressed as a
percentage.
Percentage error: The maximum error in a measurement as a
percentage of the measurement given.
Piecewise linear function: A linear function that follows different
rules for different values of the independent variable.
Piecework: see Payment by piece.
Poll: A collection of information obtained by questionnaire.
Polygon: A line graph displaying the frequency for a set of scores.
Population: An entire group of people or objects to which a statistical
inquiry is applied.
Power: An index. The number to which a base is raised, indicating
the number of times the base is multiplied by itself.
Prefix: The first part of a word. In measurement, the prefix indicates
the relative size of the units of measurement.
Present value: The current value of an investment.
Prism: A solid shape with a constant cross-section.
Principal: The amount on which interest calculations are made.
Probability: A number between 0 and 1 that describes the chance of
an event occurring.
Proportional to: Two quantities are proportional to each other (in
proportion) when one quantity can be found by multiplying the other
by a constant amount.
Pyramid: A solid shape with a plane shape as its base and triangular
sides meeting at an apex.
Quadratic: A function with a greatest power of 2.
Quality control: A statistical process used by companies to ensure
that their product meets the required standard.
Quantitative data: Data that can be measured. A numerical value can
be assigned to them.
Quartile: 25% of the data set. The upper quartile is the top 25% of
the data set and the lower quartile is the bottom 25% of the data set.
Questionnaire: A set of questions completed for a statistical
investigation.
Radar chart: A type of line graph drawn around a central point. The
categories are labelled in a circle and data points marked on each line
emanating from the centre. The points are then joined. A radar chart
is suitable to show a pattern that is likely to repeat. For example, sales
made during each month of the year.
Random sample: The members of the sample are chosen by a
method in which luck is the only factor in deciding which members
are to participate in the sample.
Range: A number that represents the spread of a data set. The range is
calculated by subtracting the smallest score from the largest score.
Rate: A comparison of two quantities of a different type.
Rate of change: The change in one quantity per one unit change in
another.
Ratio: A comparison of two quantities of the same type.
Reduction: A similar figure, drawn smaller in size than the original.
Relation: A rule connecting two variables.
Relative frequency: A number between 0 and 1, usually a decimal,
which describes how often an event has occurred. The relative
frequency is found by dividing the number of times an event has
occurred by the total number of trials.
Retainer: A fixed payment usually paid to someone receiving
commission. They receive the retainer regardless of the number of
sales made.
Royalty: A royalty is a payment made to the owner of a copyright
such as a musician or author. The royalty is usually a percentage of
sales.
Salary: A form of payment where a person is paid a fixed amount to
do their job. A salary is usually based on an annual amount divided
into weekly or fortnightly instalments.
Sample: When data are gathered from a portion of the population,
that is taken to be representative of the whole population.
Sample space: A list of all possible outcomes to a probability
experiment.
Scale factor: A number by which the side lengths on the first of two
similar figures is multiplied by to obtain the measurements on the
second of the figures.
Score: Each piece of quantitative data is a score.
Sector graph: A graph where a circle is cut into sectors. Each sector
then represents a section of the data set. Each sector is the same
proportion of the circle as the part of the data set it represents.
Shares: A share is a part ownership of a company. Shares are traded on
the stock exchange and fluctuate in value daily. The return from investing
in shares comes from both the dividend and the share rising in value.
Significant figures: The number of non-zero digits to which a number
is approximated.
Similar figures: Two or more figures with corresponding angles equal
and corresponding sides in the same ratio.
Simple interest: Interest that is paid without any interest payments
being added to the principal before the next interest calculation.
Simple interest is calculated using the formula I = Prn.
Sine ratio: The ratio of the opposite side and the hypotenuse in a
right-angled triangle.
Glossary
491
Index
abnormal conditions in sample selection 126
accuracy of measurements 2313
alcohol, effect on body 4747
algebraic expressions
expanding and simplifying 3745
operations with 36972
allowances
government 19
for unfavourable working conditions 4
angles
of elevation and depression 31214
finding in right-angled triangles 30811
annual leave loading 23
appreciation 6871
area
applications of 2712
of plane shapes 2628
units of 235
balancing budgets 28
bias in statistics 12531
bills, household 2733
bimodal distributions 200
blood alcohol concentration (BAC) 4747
bonds, investment 46
box-and-whisker plots (boxplots) 1659
braking distance 471
budgeting 279
calculators
in degrees mode 298
finding point of intersection using
4067
inverse functions on 300
in statistics mode 1923
call caps for mobile phones 435
capacity units 234
car insurance 4547
car purchase
buying new or used 452, 454
financing 45762
carbon tax 94
cars, fuel costs 4624
casual rates of pay 5
categorical data 1223
census, collecting data from 114
certainty of event occurrence 333, 3512
chance of event occurrence 333
characteristics of populations 11822
circles, areas of 263
clinometers 312
column graphs 111
commission 89
complementary events 3569
composite figures, areas of 263
compound interest
calculation 537
spreadsheets for 57
compound value interest factor (CVIF) 578
compounded value 53
compounded values, tables of 5760
compounding period 54
comprehensive insurance on cars 455
compulsory third party (CTP) insurance
on cars 4545
492
Index
computer applications
calculating taxable income 889
compound interest spreadsheets 57
simple interest spreadsheets 52
spreadsheets 78
tax calculation 967
wages 18
wages template 26
concentration of substances 244
congruent figures 287
connection fees for mobile phones 427
Consumer Price Index (CPI) 68
continuous data 123
conversion between rates 244
conversion graphs 41011
cosine ratio 300, 303
cube volume 273
cumulative frequency 14652
cumulative frequency histogram and
polygon (ogive) 1489
cylinder, volume of 274
data
collection 11418
in statistical processes 11014
types 1225
debentures 46
deciles 157
decimals, writing probabilities as
34851
declining balance method of
depreciation 46770
decreasing functions 396
deductions from gross pay 223
dependent variables 391
depreciation
declining balance method 46770
straight line method 4657
depreciation of new cars 4524
digital file storage, units of 4369
digital transfer rates 43940
discrete data 123
dividend yield 62
dividends on shares 624
division of algebraic functions 3723
dot plots 142
double time wages rate 14
download speeds 439
elevations 292
equally likely outcomes
extrapolation 64
3413
97100
mobile phones
calculating costs of 42530
choosing best plan 4356
reading bills 4301
reading plans 4312
terms used 426
usage 4324
mode 2005
multi-stage events 3259
multiple-step equations 380
multiplication of algebraic fractions 3723
music files, random selection of 4401
net pay 22
new cars, depreciation of 4524
nominal data 123
non-linear scales on graph axes 172
non-random methods of sampling 126
non-response rate in sampling 126
offsets 268
omission of values on graphs
one-step equations 37980
ordinal data 123
ordinary rates of pay 3
outcomes
equally likely 3413
of experiments 333
outliers in data sets 213
overtime 1418
171
pronumerals 369
proportional diagrams 316
Pythagoras theorem 258
quantitative data 1223
quartiles 155
questionnaire design, bias in
126
395400
Index
493